ml_tn/tn_MAT.tsv

2832 lines
637 KiB
Plaintext
Raw Permalink Blame History

This file contains ambiguous Unicode characters

This file contains Unicode characters that might be confused with other characters. If you think that this is intentional, you can safely ignore this warning. Use the Escape button to reveal them.

Reference ID Tags SupportReference Quote Occurrence Note
front:intro sa9c 0 # Introduction to the Gospel of Matthew\n## Part 1: General Introduction\n\n### Outline of the Book of Matthew\n\n1. The birth of Jesus Christ and the beginning of his ministry (1:1-4:25)\n1. Jesus Sermon on the Mount (5:1-7:28)\n1. Jesus illustrates the kingdom of God through acts of healing (8:1-9:34)\n1. Jesus teaching about mission and the kingdom (9:35-10:42)\n1. Jesus teaching about the gospel of the kingdom of God. The beginning of opposition to Jesus. (11:1-12:50)\n1. Jesus parables about the kingdom of God (13:1-52)\n1. Further opposition to Jesus and misunderstanding of the kingdom of God (13:53-17:57)\n1. Jesus teaching about life in the kingdom of God (18:1-35)\n1. Jesus ministers in Judea (19:1-22:46)\n1. Jesus teaching about the final judgment and salvation (23:1-25:46)\n1. The crucifixion of Jesus, his death and resurrection (26:1-28:19)\n\n### What is the book of Matthew about?\n\nThe Gospel of Matthew is one of four books in the New Testament that describe some of the life of Jesus Christ. The authors of the gospels wrote about different aspects of who Jesus was and what he did. Matthew showed that Jesus was the Messiah, and God would save Israel through him. Matthew often explained that Jesus fulfilled the Old Testament prophecies about the Messiah. This may indicate that he expected most of his first readers to be Jewish. (See: [[rc://*/tw/dict/bible/kt/christ]])\n\n### How should the title of this book be translated?\n\nTranslators may choose to call this book by its traditional title, “The Gospel of Matthew,” or “The Gospel according to Matthew.” Or they may choose a title that may be clearer, such as, “The Good News about Jesus that Matthew wrote.” (See: [[rc://*/ta/man/translate/translate-names]])\n\n### Who wrote the Book of Matthew?\n\nThe book does not give the name of the author. However, since early Christian times, most Christians have thought that the author was the Apostle Matthew.\n\n## Part 2: Important Religious and Cultural Concepts\n\n### What is the “kingdom of heaven?”\n\nMatthew spoke of the kingdom of heaven in the same way that other gospel writers spoke of the kingdom of God. The kingdom of heaven represents God ruling over all people and all creation everywhere. Those whom God accepts into his kingdom will be blessed. They will live with God forever.\n\n### What were Jesus teaching methods?\n\nThe people regarded Jesus as a rabbi. A rabbi is a teacher of Gods law. Jesus taught in similar ways as other religious teachers in Israel. He had students who followed him wherever he went. These students were called disciples. He often told parables. Parables are stories that teach moral lessons. (See: [[rc://*/tw/dict/bible/kt/lawofmoses]] and [[rc://*/tw/dict/bible/kt/disciple]] and [[rc://*/tw/dict/bible/kt/parable]])\n\n## Part 3: Important Translation Issues\n\n### What are the Synoptic Gospels?\n\nThe Gospels of Matthew, Mark, and Luke are called the Synoptic Gospels because they have many similar passages. The word “synoptic” means to “see together.”\n\nThe texts are considered “parallel” when they are the same or almost the same among two or three gospels. When translating parallel passages, translators should use the same wording and make them as similar as possible.\n\n### Why does Jesus refer to himself as the “Son of Man”?\n\nIn the gospels, Jesus calls himself the “Son of Man.” It is a reference to Daniel 7:13-14. In this passage there is a person described as a “son of man.” That means the person was someone who looked like a human being. God gave authority to the son of man to rule over the nations forever. And all the people will worship him forever.\n\nJews of Jesus time did not use “Son of Man” as a title for anyone. Therefore, Jesus used it for himself to help them understand who he truly was. (See: [[rc://*/tw/dict/bible/kt/sonofman]])\n\nTranslating the title “Son of Man” can be difficult in many languages. Readers may misunderstand a literal translation. Translators can consider alternatives, such as “The Human One.” It may also be helpful to include a footnote to explain the title.\n\n### What are the major issues in the text of the Book of Matthew?\n\nThe following verses are found in older versions of the Bible but are not included in most modern versions:\n\n* “Bless those who curse you, do good to those who hate you” (5:44)\n* “For yours is the kingdom and the power and the glory forever. Amen” (6:13)\n* “But this kind of demon does not go out except with prayer and fasting” (17:21)\n* “For the Son of Man came to save that which was lost” (18:11)\n* “Many are called, but few are chosen” (20:16)\n* “Woe to you, scribes and Pharisees, hypocrites! for you devour widows houses, while you make a show of long prayers. You will therefore receive greater condemnation.” (23:14)\n\nTranslators are advised not to include these passages. However, if in the translators region, there are older versions of the Bible that include one or more of these passages, the translators can include them. If they are included, they should be put inside square brackets ([]) to indicate that they were probably not original to Matthews Gospel. (See: [[rc://*/ta/man/translate/translate-textvariants]])
1:intro y7kk 0 # Matthew 01 General Notes\n## Structure and formatting\n\nSome translations set a quotation from the Old Testament farther to the right on the page than the rest of the text. The ULT does this for the quoted material in 1:23.\n\n## Special concepts in this chapter\n\n### Genealogy\n\nA genealogy is a list that records a persons ancestors or descendants. Jews used genealogies to choose the right man to become king. They did this because only a son of a king could become king. Most important people had records of their genealogies.\n\n## Important figures of speech in this chapter\n\n### Use of the passive voice\n\nMatthew uses the passive voice very purposefully in this chapter to indicate that Mary did not have a sexual relationship with anyone. She became pregnant with Jesus because the Holy Spirit performed a miracle. Many languages do not have a passive voice, so translators in those languages must find other ways to present the same truths. (See: [[rc://*/ta/man/translate/figs-activepassive]])
1:1 ava1 0 The author begins with Jesus genealogy in order to show that he is a descendant of King David and of Abraham. The genealogy continues through [Matthew 1:17](../01/17.md).
1:1 y31w βίβλος γενέσεως Ἰησοῦ Χριστοῦ 1 You could translate this as a complete sentence. Alternate translation: “This is the list of the ancestors of Jesus Christ”
1:1 vpg1 Ἰησοῦ Χριστοῦ, υἱοῦ Δαυεὶδ, υἱοῦ Ἀβραάμ 1 There were many generations between Jesus, David, and Abraham. Here “son” means “descendant.” Alternate translation: “Jesus Christ, a descendant of David, who was a descendant of Abraham”
1:1 tka3 υἱοῦ Δαυεὶδ 1 Sometimes the phrase “son of David” is used as a title, but here it seems to be used only to identify Jesus ancestry.
1:2 ejp6 Ἀβραὰμ ἐγέννησεν τὸν Ἰσαάκ 1 “Abraham became the father of Isaac” or “Abraham had a son Isaac” or “Abraham had a son named Isaac.” There are different ways you could translate this. Whichever way you translate it here, it would be best to translate it the same way throughout the list of Jesus ancestors.
1:2 mxm2 rc://*/ta/man/translate/figs-ellipsis Ἰσαὰκ & ἐγέννησεν & Ἰακὼβ & ἐγέννησεν 1 Here the word “was” is understood. Alternate translation: “Isaac was the father … Jacob was the father” (See: [[rc://*/ta/man/translate/figs-ellipsis]])
1:3 g8y6 rc://*/ta/man/translate/translate-names Φαρὲς & Ζάρα & Ἑσρώμ & Ἀράμ 1 These are names of men. (See: [[rc://*/ta/man/translate/translate-names]])
1:3 t7jg rc://*/ta/man/translate/figs-ellipsis Φαρὲς & ἐγέννησεν & Ἑσρὼμ & ἐγέννησεν 1 Here the word “was” is understood. Alternate translation: “Perez was the father … Hezron was the father” (See: [[rc://*/ta/man/translate/figs-ellipsis]])
1:4 fe3u rc://*/ta/man/translate/figs-ellipsis Ἀμιναδὰβ & ἐγέννησεν & Ναασσὼν & ἐγέννησεν 1 Here the word “was” is understood. Alternate translation: “Amminadab was the father … Nahshon was the father” (See: [[rc://*/ta/man/translate/figs-ellipsis]])
1:5 yr52 Σαλμὼν & ἐγέννησεν τὸν Βόες ἐκ τῆς Ῥαχάβ 1 “Salmon was the father of Boaz, and Boazs mother was Rahab” or “Salmon and Rahab were the parents of Boaz”
1:5 lj86 rc://*/ta/man/translate/figs-ellipsis Βόες & ἐγέννησεν & Ἰωβὴδ & ἐγέννησεν 1 Here the word “was” is understood. Alternate translation: “Boaz was the father … Obed was the father” (See: [[rc://*/ta/man/translate/figs-ellipsis]])
1:5 q5bd Βόες & ἐγέννησεν τὸν Ἰωβὴδ ἐκ τῆς Ῥούθ 1 “Boaz was the father of Obed, and Obeds mother was Ruth” or “Boaz and Ruth were the parents of Obed”
1:6 r84m rc://*/ta/man/translate/figs-ellipsis Δαυεὶδ & ἐγέννησεν τὸν Σολομῶνα ἐκ τῆς τοῦ Οὐρίου 1 Here the word “was” is understood. “David was the father of Solomon, and Solomons mother was Uriahs wife” or “David and the wife of Uriah were the parents of Solomon” (See: [[rc://*/ta/man/translate/figs-ellipsis]])
1:6 bp35 τῆς τοῦ Οὐρίου 1 “the widow of Uriah.” Solomon was born after Uriah died.
1:7 r881 rc://*/ta/man/translate/figs-ellipsis Ῥοβοὰμ & ἐγέννησεν τὸν Ἀβιά, Ἀβιὰ & ἐγέννησεν τὸν Ἀσάφ 1 The word “was” is understood in both of these phrases. Alternate translation: “Rehoboam was the father of Abijah, and Abijah was the father of Asa” (See: [[rc://*/ta/man/translate/figs-ellipsis]])
1:10 bh7r τὸν Ἀμώς 1 Sometimes this is translated “Amos.”
1:11 dk1j Ἰωσίας & ἐγέννησεν τὸν Ἰεχονίαν 1 A more specific term for “ancestor” can also be used, particularly if the word “ancestor” would only be used for someone who lived before ones grandparents. Alternate translation: “Josiah was a grandfather of Jechoniah”
1:11 rj7p ἐπὶ τῆς μετοικεσίας Βαβυλῶνος 1 “when they were forced to move to Babylon” or “when the Babylonians conquered them and made them go live in Babylon.” If your language needs to specify who went to Babylon, you could say “the Israelites” or “the Israelites who lived in Judah.”
1:11 v2im Βαβυλῶνος 1 Here this means the country of Babylon, not just the city of Babylon.
1:12 y7cx μετὰ & τὴν μετοικεσίαν Βαβυλῶνος 1 Use the same wording you used in [Matthew 1:11](../01/11.md).
1:12 tx6g Σαλαθιὴλ & ἐγέννησεν τὸν Ζοροβαβέλ 1 Shealtiel was Zerubbabels grandfather.
1:15 lqk9 0 The author concludes Jesus genealogy, which began in [Matthew 1:1](../01/01.md).
1:16 b3bm rc://*/ta/man/translate/figs-activepassive Μαρίας, ἐξ ἧς ἐγεννήθη Ἰησοῦς 1 This can be stated in active form. Alternate translation: “Mary, who gave birth to Jesus” (See: [[rc://*/ta/man/translate/figs-activepassive]])
1:16 z2rg rc://*/ta/man/translate/figs-activepassive ὁ λεγόμενος Χριστός 1 This can be stated in active form. Alternate translation: “whom people call Christ” (See: [[rc://*/ta/man/translate/figs-activepassive]])
1:17 jzq4 rc://*/ta/man/translate/translate-numbers δεκατέσσαρες 1 “14” (See: [[rc://*/ta/man/translate/translate-numbers]])
1:17 z5xw τῆς μετοικεσίας Βαβυλῶνος 1 Use the same wording you used in [Matthew 1:11](../01/11.md).
1:18 gnl6 0 This begins a new part of the story in which the author describes the events leading up to the birth of Jesus.
1:18 cqt1 rc://*/ta/man/translate/figs-explicit μνηστευθείσης τῆς μητρὸς αὐτοῦ Μαρίας τῷ Ἰωσήφ 1 “His mother, Mary, was going to marry Joseph.” Parents normally arranged the marriages of their children. Alternate translation: “The parents of Mary, the mother of Jesus, had promised her in marriage to Joseph” (See: [[rc://*/ta/man/translate/figs-explicit]])
1:18 e4ur rc://*/ta/man/translate/figs-explicit μνηστευθείσης τῆς μητρὸς αὐτοῦ Μαρίας 1 Translate in a way that makes it clear that Jesus was not already born when Mary was engaged to Joseph. Alternate translation: “Mary, who would be the mother of Jesus, was engaged” (See: [[rc://*/ta/man/translate/figs-explicit]])
1:18 xvk1 rc://*/ta/man/translate/figs-euphemism πρὶν & συνελθεῖν αὐτοὺς 1 “before they got married.” This may refer to Mary and Joseph sleeping together. Alternate translation: “before they had slept together” (See: [[rc://*/ta/man/translate/figs-euphemism]])
1:18 in4a rc://*/ta/man/translate/figs-activepassive εὑρέθη ἐν γαστρὶ ἔχουσα 1 This can be stated in active form. Alternate translation: “they realized that she was going to have a baby” or “it happened that she was pregnant” (See: [[rc://*/ta/man/translate/figs-activepassive]])
1:18 a71d ἐκ Πνεύματος Ἁγίου 1 The power of the Holy Spirit had enabled Mary to have a baby before she had slept with a man.
1:19 j8eb rc://*/ta/man/translate/figs-explicit Ἰωσὴφ & ὁ ἀνὴρ αὐτῆς 1 Joseph had not married Mary yet, but when a man and woman promised to marry each other, Jews considered them husband and wife though they did not live together. Alternate translation: “Joseph, who was supposed to marry Mary” (See: [[rc://*/ta/man/translate/figs-explicit]])
1:19 pu3p ἀπολῦσαι αὐτήν 1 “cancel their plans to get married”
1:20 iip4 αὐτοῦ ἐνθυμηθέντος 1 “As Joseph thought”
1:20 fb7e κατ’ ὄναρ ἐφάνη αὐτῷ 1 “came to him while Joseph was dreaming”
1:20 lc8r υἱὸς Δαυείδ 1 Here “son” means “descendant.”
1:20 va5e rc://*/ta/man/translate/figs-activepassive τὸ & ἐν αὐτῇ γεννηθὲν ἐκ Πνεύματός ἐστιν Ἁγίου 1 This can be stated in active form. Alternate translation: “the Holy Spirit caused Mary to become pregnant with this child” (See: [[rc://*/ta/man/translate/figs-activepassive]])
1:21 j38f τέξεται & υἱὸν 1 Because God sent the angel, the angel knew the baby was a boy.
1:21 glq8 καλέσεις τὸ ὄνομα αὐτοῦ 1 “you must name him” or “you must give him the name.” This is a command.
1:21 bf5z αὐτὸς γὰρ σώσει 1 Translator may add a footnote that says “The name Jesus means the Lord saves.’”
1:21 em9q τὸν λαὸν αὐτοῦ 1 This refers to the Jews.
1:22 p47i rc://*/ta/man/translate/writing-background 0 The author quotes the prophet Isaiah to show that Jesus birth was according to scripture. (See: [[rc://*/ta/man/translate/writing-background]])
1:22 p9la τοῦτο & ὅλον γέγονεν 1 The angel is no longer speaking. Matthew is now explaining the importance of what the angel said.
1:22 c1vw rc://*/ta/man/translate/figs-activepassive τὸ ῥηθὲν ὑπὸ Κυρίου διὰ τοῦ προφήτου 1 This can be stated in active form. Alternate translation: “what the Lord told the prophet to write long ago” (See: [[rc://*/ta/man/translate/figs-activepassive]])
1:22 p39k rc://*/ta/man/translate/figs-explicit τοῦ προφήτου 1 There were many prophets. Matthew was speaking of Isaiah. Alternate translation: “the prophet Isaiah” (See: [[rc://*/ta/man/translate/figs-explicit]])
1:23 q19h ἰδοὺ & Ἐμμανουήλ 1 Here Matthew quotes the prophet Isaiah.
1:23 dw7z ἰδοὺ, ἡ παρθένος 1 “Pay attention, because what I am about to say is both true and important: the virgin”
1:23 sln1 rc://*/ta/man/translate/translate-names Ἐμμανουήλ 1 This is a male name. (See: [[rc://*/ta/man/translate/translate-names]])
1:23 lm6t ὅ ἐστιν μεθερμηνευόμενον, μεθ’ ἡμῶν ὁ Θεός 1 This is not in the book of Isaiah. Matthew is explaining the meaning of the name “Immanuel.” You could translate it as a separate sentence. Alternate translation: “This name means God with us.’”
1:24 iue3 0 The author concludes his description of the events leading up to the birth of Jesus.
1:24 iz4r ὡς προσέταξεν & ὁ ἄγγελος Κυρίου 1 The angel had told Joseph to take Mary as his wife and to name the child Jesus.
1:24 nr5e παρέλαβεν τὴν γυναῖκα αὐτοῦ 1 “he married Mary”
1:25 i7p5 rc://*/ta/man/translate/figs-euphemism οὐκ ἐγίνωσκεν αὐτὴν 1 This is a euphemism. Alternate translation: “he did not have sexual relations with her” (See: [[rc://*/ta/man/translate/figs-euphemism]])
1:25 dlm9 υἱόν 1 “to a male baby” or “to her son.” Make sure it is clear that Joseph is not portrayed as the actual father.
1:25 jtz8 καὶ ἐκάλεσεν τὸ ὄνομα αὐτοῦ, Ἰησοῦν 1 “Joseph named the child Jesus”
2:intro dz1c 0 # Matthew 02 General Notes\n## Structure and formatting\n\nSome translations set each line of poetry farther to the right than the rest of the text to make it easier to read. The ULT does this with the poetry in verses 6 and 18, which are words from the Old Testament.\n\n## Special concepts in this chapter\n\n### “His star”\n\nThese words probably refer to a star that the learned men believed to be the sign of a new king of Israel. (See: [[rc://*/tw/dict/bible/kt/sign]])\n\n## Other possible translation difficulties in this chapter\n\n### “Learned men”\n\nEnglish translations use many different words to translate this phrase. These words include “magi” and “wise men.” These men could have been scientists or astrologers. If you can, you should translate this with the general word “learned men.”
2:1 j9yn 0 A new part of the story begins here and continues through the end of the chapter. Matthew tells about Herods attempt to kill the new King of the Jews.
2:1 k518 Βηθλέεμ τῆς Ἰουδαίας 1 “the town of Bethlehem in the province of Judea”
2:1 id55 ἐν & ἡμέραις Ἡρῴδου τοῦ βασιλέως 1 “when Herod was king there”
2:1 kf5g Ἡρῴδου 1 This refers to Herod the Great.
2:1 p6gc μάγοι ἀπὸ ἀνατολῶν 1 “men from the east who studied the stars”
2:1 ft22 ἀπὸ ἀνατολῶν 1 “from a country far east of Judea”
2:2 v5t4 ποῦ ἐστιν ὁ τεχθεὶς Βασιλεὺς τῶν Ἰουδαίων? 1 The men knew from studying the stars that the one who would become king had been born. They were trying to learn where he was. Alternate translation: “A baby who will become the king of the Jews has been born. Where is he?”
2:2 zj7c αὐτοῦ τὸν ἀστέρα 1 They were not saying that the baby was the rightful owner of the star. Alternate translation: “the star that tells about him” or “the star that is associated with his birth”
2:2 a7y9 ἐν τῇ ἀνατολῇ 1 “as it came up in the east” or “while we were in our country”
2:2 v248 προσκυνῆσαι 1 Possible meanings are (1) they intended to worship the baby as divine, or (2) they wanted to honor him as a human king. If your language has a word that includes both meanings, you should consider using it here.
2:3 p5rw ἐταράχθη 1 “he was worried.” Herod was worried that this baby would replace him as king.
2:3 qu3d rc://*/ta/man/translate/figs-metonymy πᾶσα Ἱεροσόλυμα 1 Here “Jerusalem” refers to the people. Also, “all” means “many.” Matthew is exaggerating to emphasize how many people were worried. Alternate translation: “many of the people in Jerusalem” (See: [[rc://*/ta/man/translate/figs-metonymy]] and [[rc://*/ta/man/translate/figs-hyperbole]])
2:4 ne4v 0 In verse 6, the chief priests and scribes of the people quote the prophet Micah to show that the Christ would be born in Bethlehem.
2:5 w68n ἐν Βηθλέεμ τῆς Ἰουδαίας 1 “In the town of Bethlehem in the province of Judea”
2:5 z2i4 rc://*/ta/man/translate/figs-activepassive οὕτως & γέγραπται διὰ τοῦ προφήτου 1 This can be stated in active form. Alternate translation: “this is what the prophet wrote long ago” (See: [[rc://*/ta/man/translate/figs-activepassive]])
2:6 kmw7 rc://*/ta/man/translate/figs-apostrophe σύ Βηθλέεμ & οὐδαμῶς ἐλαχίστη εἶ ἐν τοῖς ἡγεμόσιν Ἰούδα 1 Micah was speaking to the people of Bethlehem as if they were with him but they were not. Also, “are not the least” can be translated with a positive phrase. Alternate translation: “you, people of Bethlehem, … your town is among the most important towns in Judah” (See: [[rc://*/ta/man/translate/figs-apostrophe]] and [[rc://*/ta/man/translate/figs-litotes]])
2:6 tg5d rc://*/ta/man/translate/figs-metaphor ὅστις ποιμανεῖ τὸν λαόν μου τὸν Ἰσραήλ 1 Micah speaks of this ruler as a shepherd. This means he will lead and care for the people. Alternate translation: “who will lead my people Israel as a shepherd leads his sheep” (See: [[rc://*/ta/man/translate/figs-metaphor]])
2:7 b487 Ἡρῴδης λάθρᾳ καλέσας τοὺς μάγους 1 This means that Herod talked to the learned men without other people knowing.
2:7 tax3 rc://*/ta/man/translate/figs-quotations ἠκρίβωσεν παρ’ αὐτῶν τὸν χρόνον τοῦ φαινομένου ἀστέρος 1 This can be translated as a direct quotation. Alternate translation: “men, and he asked them, When exactly did this star appear?’” (See: [[rc://*/ta/man/translate/figs-quotations]])
2:7 vng3 rc://*/ta/man/translate/figs-explicit τὸν χρόνον τοῦ φαινομένου ἀστέρος 1 It is implied that the learned men told him when the star appeared. Alternate translation: “what time the star had appeared. The learned men told Herod when the star first appeared” (See: [[rc://*/ta/man/translate/figs-explicit]])
2:8 v7y2 τοῦ παιδίου 1 This refers to Jesus.
2:8 t4u1 ἀπαγγείλατέ μοι 1 “let me know” or “tell me” or “report back to me”
2:8 jtw7 προσκυνήσω αὐτῷ 1 See how you translated this in [Matthew 2:2](../02/02.md).
2:9 h1zx οἱ δὲ ἀκούσαντες 1 “After the learned men”
2:9 wl4r εἶδον ἐν τῇ ἀνατολῇ 1 “they had seen come up in the east” or “they had seen in their country”
2:9 hy1i προῆγεν αὐτούς 1 “guided them” or “led them”
2:9 jp2j ἐστάθη ἐπάνω 1 “stopped over”
2:9 w3v1 οὗ ἦν τὸ παιδίον 1 “the place where the young child was staying”
2:11 pv3r 0 Here the scene shifts to the house where Mary, Joseph, and the young Jesus were living.
2:11 tu5s ἐλθόντες 1 “The learned men went”
2:11 d41d rc://*/ta/man/translate/translate-symaction πεσόντες προσεκύνησαν αὐτῷ 1 “They knelt down and put their faces close to the ground.” They did this to honor Jesus. (See: [[rc://*/ta/man/translate/translate-symaction]])
2:11 r452 rc://*/ta/man/translate/figs-metonymy τοὺς θησαυροὺς αὐτῶν 1 Here “treasures” refers to the boxes or bags they used to carry their treasures. Alternate translation: “the containers that held their treasures” (See: [[rc://*/ta/man/translate/figs-metonymy]])
2:12 zyq6 χρηματισθέντες 1 “Afterwards, God warned the learned men.” God knew that Herod wanted to harm the child.
2:12 dr1p rc://*/ta/man/translate/figs-quotations κατ’ ὄναρ μὴ ἀνακάμψαι πρὸς Ἡρῴδην 1 This can be translated as a direct quotation. Alternate translation: “dream, saying, Do not go back to King Herod, so” (See: [[rc://*/ta/man/translate/figs-quotations]])
2:13 brp5 0 In verse 15, Matthew quotes the prophet Hosea to show that the Christ would spend time in Egypt.
2:13 iw8p ἀναχωρησάντων & αὐτῶν 1 “the learned men had departed”
2:13 zwj5 φαίνεται κατ’ ὄναρ τῷ Ἰωσὴφ 1 “came to Joseph while he was dreaming”
2:13 u4a4 rc://*/ta/man/translate/figs-you ἐγερθεὶς, παράλαβε & φεῦγε & ἴσθι & σοι 1 God is speaking to Joseph, so these should all be singular forms. (See: [[rc://*/ta/man/translate/figs-you]])
2:13 v88f rc://*/ta/man/translate/figs-explicit ἕως ἂν εἴπω σοι 1 The full meaning of this statement can be made explicit. Alternate translation: “until I tell you it is safe to come back” (See: [[rc://*/ta/man/translate/figs-explicit]])
2:13 g3t7 εἴπω σοι 1 Here “I” refers to God. The angel is speaking for God.
2:15 ft3a rc://*/ta/man/translate/figs-explicit ἦν 1 It is implied that Joseph, Mary, and Jesus remained in Egypt. Alternate translation: “They remained” (See: [[rc://*/ta/man/translate/figs-explicit]])
2:15 d11g ἕως τῆς τελευτῆς Ἡρῴδου 1 Herod does not die until [Matthew 2:19](../02/19.md). This statement describes the length of their stay in Egypt, and it does not say that Herod died at this time.
2:15 d5wl ἐξ Αἰγύπτου ἐκάλεσα τὸν Υἱόν μου 1 “I have called my son out of Egypt”
2:15 dr9b τὸν Υἱόν μου 1 In Hosea this refers to the people of Israel. Matthew quoted it to say that this was true of Gods Son, Jesus. Translate it using a word for son that could refer to the only son or the first son.
2:16 s2la rc://*/ta/man/translate/figs-events 0 These events happen before Herods death, which Matthew mentioned in [Matthew 2:15](../02/15.md). (See: [[rc://*/ta/man/translate/figs-events]])
2:16 yq7p 0 Here the scene shifts back to Herod and tells what he did when he learned that the learned men had deceived him.
2:16 g513 rc://*/ta/man/translate/figs-activepassive ἐνεπαίχθη ὑπὸ τῶν μάγων 1 This can be stated in active form. Alternate translation: “the learned men had embarrassed him by tricking him” (See: [[rc://*/ta/man/translate/figs-activepassive]])
2:16 d8d5 rc://*/ta/man/translate/figs-explicit ἀποστείλας, ἀνεῖλεν πάντας τοὺς παῖδας 1 Herod did not kill the children himself. Alternate translation: “He gave orders for his soldiers to kill all the boys” or “He sent soldiers there to kill all the boy babies” (See: [[rc://*/ta/man/translate/figs-explicit]])
2:16 nkr1 rc://*/ta/man/translate/translate-numbers διετοῦς καὶ κατωτέρω 1 “2 years old and younger” (See: [[rc://*/ta/man/translate/translate-numbers]])
2:16 dr3r κατὰ τὸν χρόνον 1 “based on the time”
2:17 q1y9 0 Matthew quotes the prophet Jeremiah to show that the death of all of the male children in the region of Bethlehem was according to scripture.
2:17 l8g5 rc://*/ta/man/translate/figs-activepassive τότε ἐπληρώθη 1 This can be stated in active form. Alternate translation: “This fulfilled” or “Herods actions fulfilled” (See: [[rc://*/ta/man/translate/figs-activepassive]])
2:17 v6a1 rc://*/ta/man/translate/figs-activepassive τὸ ῥηθὲν διὰ Ἰερεμίου τοῦ προφήτου 1 This can be stated in active form. Alternate translation: “what the Lord spoke long ago through the prophet Jeremiah” (See: [[rc://*/ta/man/translate/figs-activepassive]])
2:18 p9gk φωνὴ & ἠκούσθη & οὐκ εἰσίν 1 Matthew is quoting the prophet Jeremiah.
2:18 k91t rc://*/ta/man/translate/figs-activepassive φωνὴ & ἠκούσθη 1 This can be stated in active form. Alternate translation: “People heard a voice” or “There was a loud sound” (See: [[rc://*/ta/man/translate/figs-activepassive]])
2:18 zm17 Ῥαχὴλ κλαίουσα τὰ τέκνα αὐτῆς 1 Rachel lived many years before this time. This prophecy shows Rachel, who has died, weeping for her descendants.
2:18 rgg1 rc://*/ta/man/translate/figs-activepassive οὐκ ἤθελεν παρακληθῆναι 1 This can be stated in active form. Alternate translation: “no one could comfort her” (See: [[rc://*/ta/man/translate/figs-activepassive]])
2:18 p9ri rc://*/ta/man/translate/figs-euphemism ὅτι οὐκ εἰσίν 1 “because the children were gone and would never return.” Here “were no more” is a mild way of saying they are dead. Alternate translation: “because they were dead” (See: [[rc://*/ta/man/translate/figs-euphemism]])
2:19 kt2i 0 Here the scene shifts to Egypt, where Joseph, Mary, and the young Jesus are living.
2:19 r4yu ἰδοὺ 1 This marks the beginning of another event in the larger story. It may involve different people than the previous events. Your language may have a way of doing this.
2:20 hz2m rc://*/ta/man/translate/figs-euphemism οἱ ζητοῦντες τὴν ψυχὴν τοῦ παιδίου 1 Here “sought the childs life” is a way of saying they wanted to kill the child. “Alternate translation: “those who were looking for the child in order to kill him” (See: [[rc://*/ta/man/translate/figs-euphemism]])
2:20 y6r6 οἱ ζητοῦντες 1 This refers to King Herod and his advisors.
2:22 kg7u 0 This is the end of the part of the story that began in [Matthew 2:1](../02/01.md) about Herods attempt to kill the new King of the Jews.
2:22 uq8p ἀκούσας δὲ 1 “But when Joseph heard”
2:22 h4cq rc://*/ta/man/translate/translate-names Ἀρχέλαος 1 This is the name of Herods son. (See: [[rc://*/ta/man/translate/translate-names]])
2:22 zk37 ἐφοβήθη 1 “Joseph was afraid”
2:23 dx5i rc://*/ta/man/translate/figs-activepassive τὸ ῥηθὲν διὰ τῶν προφητῶν 1 This can be stated in active form. Alternate translation: “what the Lord spoke long ago through the prophets” (See: [[rc://*/ta/man/translate/figs-activepassive]])
2:23 hc8g rc://*/ta/man/translate/translate-names Ναζωραῖος κληθήσεται 1 Here “he” refers to Jesus. The prophets before the time of Jesus would have referred to him as the Messiah or the Christ. Alternate translation: “people would say that the Christ is a Nazarene” (See: [[rc://*/ta/man/translate/translate-names]])
3:intro a6h3 0 # Matthew 03 General Notes\n## Structure and formatting\n\nSome translations set quotations from the Old Testament farther to the right on the page than the rest of the text. The ULT does this with the quoted material in verse 3.\n\n## Special concepts in this chapter\n\n### “Bear fruit worthy of repentance”\n\nFruit is a common picture word in the scriptures. Writers use it to describe the results of either good or bad behavior. In this chapter, good fruit is the result of living as God commands. (See: [[rc://*/tw/dict/bible/other/fruit]])\n\n## Other possible translation difficulties in this chapter\n\n### “The kingdom of heaven is near”\n\nNo one knows for sure whether the “kingdom of heaven” was present or still coming when John spoke these words. English translations often use the phrase “at hand,” but these words can be difficult to translate. Other versions use the phrases “is coming near” and “has come near.”
3:1 xp3z 0 This is the beginning of a new part of the story where Matthew tells of the ministry of John the Baptist. In verse 3, Matthew quotes the prophet Isaiah to show that John the Baptist was Gods appointed messenger to prepare for Jesus ministry.
3:1 d74m ἐν & ταῖς ἡμέραις ἐκείναις 1 This is many years after Joseph and his family left Egypt and went to Nazareth. This is probably near the time that Jesus begins his ministry. Alternate translation: “Some time later” or “Some years later”
3:2 w7e9 rc://*/ta/man/translate/figs-you μετανοεῖτε 1 This is plural in form. John is speaking to the crowds. (See: [[rc://*/ta/man/translate/figs-you]])
3:2 hvx8 rc://*/ta/man/translate/figs-metonymy ἤγγικεν & ἡ Βασιλεία τῶν Οὐρανῶν 1 The phrase “kingdom of heaven” refers to God ruling as king. This phrase is only in the book of Matthew. If possible, use the word “heaven” in your translation. Alternate translation: “our God in heaven will soon show himself to be king” (See: [[rc://*/ta/man/translate/figs-metonymy]])
3:3 fl4v rc://*/ta/man/translate/figs-activepassive οὗτος γάρ ἐστιν ὁ ῥηθεὶς διὰ Ἠσαΐου τοῦ προφήτου λέγοντος 1 This can be stated in active form. Alternate translation: “For Isaiah the prophet was speaking of John the Baptist when he said” (See: [[rc://*/ta/man/translate/figs-activepassive]])
3:3 hxb6 φωνὴ βοῶντος ἐν τῇ ἐρήμῳ 1 This can be expressed as a sentence. Alternate translation: “The voice of one calling out in the wilderness is heard” or “They hear the sound of someone calling out in the wilderness”
3:3 yhe7 rc://*/ta/man/translate/figs-parallelism ἑτοιμάσατε τὴν ὁδὸν Κυρίου; εὐθείας ποιεῖτε τὰς τρίβους αὐτοῦ 1 These two phrases mean the same thing. (See: [[rc://*/ta/man/translate/figs-parallelism]])
3:3 y8b5 rc://*/ta/man/translate/figs-metaphor ἑτοιμάσατε τὴν ὁδὸν Κυρίου 1 “Get the road ready for the Lord.” Doing this represents being prepared to hear the Lords message when he comes. People do this by repenting of their sins. Alternate translation: “Prepare to hear the Lords message when he comes” or “Repent and be ready for the Lord to come” (See: [[rc://*/ta/man/translate/figs-metaphor]] and [[rc://*/ta/man/translate/figs-explicit]])
3:4 j647 rc://*/ta/man/translate/writing-background δὲ & μέλι ἄγριον 1 The word “Now” is used here to mark a break in the main story line. Here Matthew tells background information about John the Baptist. (See: [[rc://*/ta/man/translate/writing-background]])
3:4 x7f3 rc://*/ta/man/translate/translate-symaction εἶχεν τὸ ἔνδυμα αὐτοῦ ἀπὸ τριχῶν καμήλου καὶ ζώνην δερματίνην περὶ τὴν ὀσφὺν αὐτοῦ 1 This clothing symbolizes that John is a prophet like the prophets from long ago, especially the prophet Elijah. (See: [[rc://*/ta/man/translate/translate-symaction]] and [[rc://*/ta/man/translate/figs-explicit]])
3:5 j8ke rc://*/ta/man/translate/figs-metonymy τότε & Ἱεροσόλυμα, καὶ πᾶσα ἡ Ἰουδαία, καὶ πᾶσα ἡ περίχωρος 1 The words “Jerusalem,” “Judea,” and “the region” are metonyms for the people from those areas. The word “all” is an exaggeration to emphasize that very many people went out. Alternate translation: Then very may people from Jerusalem, Judea, and that region” (See: [[rc://*/ta/man/translate/figs-metonymy]] and [[rc://*/ta/man/translate/figs-hyperbole]])
3:6 v5xn rc://*/ta/man/translate/figs-activepassive ἐβαπτίζοντο & ὑπ’ αὐτοῦ 1 This can be stated in active form. Alternate translation: “John baptized them” (See: [[rc://*/ta/man/translate/figs-activepassive]])
3:6 gi4r ἐβαπτίζοντο 1 This refers to the people coming from Jerusalem, Judea, and the region around the Jordan River.
3:7 b2br 0 John the Baptist begins to rebuke the Pharisees and Sadducees.
3:7 fjl3 rc://*/ta/man/translate/figs-metaphor γεννήματα ἐχιδνῶν, τίς 1 This is a metaphor. Here “offspring” means “having the characteristic of.” Vipers are a kind of dangerous snakes and represent evil. This can be stated as a separate sentence. Alternate translation: “You evil poisonous snakes! Who” or “You are evil like poisonous snakes! Who” (See: [[rc://*/ta/man/translate/figs-metaphor]])
3:7 c4cl rc://*/ta/man/translate/figs-rquestion τίς ὑπέδειξεν ὑμῖν φυγεῖν ἀπὸ τῆς μελλούσης ὀργῆς? 1 John uses a question to rebuke the Pharisees and Sadducees because they were asking him to baptize them so that God would not punish them, but they did not want to stop sinning. Alternate translation: “you cannot flee from Gods wrath like this.” or “do not think that you can flee from Gods wrath just because I baptize you.” (See: [[rc://*/ta/man/translate/figs-rquestion]])
3:7 h7ac rc://*/ta/man/translate/figs-metonymy φυγεῖν ἀπὸ τῆς μελλούσης ὀργῆς 1 The word “wrath” is being used to refer to Gods punishment because his wrath precedes it. Alternate translation: “run away from the punishment that is coming” or “escape because God is about to punish you” (See: [[rc://*/ta/man/translate/figs-metonymy]])
3:8 s8ac rc://*/ta/man/translate/figs-metaphor ποιήσατε οὖν καρπὸν ἄξιον τῆς μετανοίας 1 The phrase “bear fruit” is a metaphor referring to a persons actions. Alternate translation: “Let your actions show that you have truly repented” (See: [[rc://*/ta/man/translate/figs-metaphor]])
3:9 q7b1 rc://*/ta/man/translate/figs-explicit πατέρα ἔχομεν τὸν Ἀβραάμ 1 “Abraham is our ancestor” or “We are descendants of Abraham.” The Jewish leaders thought that God would not punish them since they were descendants of Abraham. (See: [[rc://*/ta/man/translate/figs-explicit]])
3:9 r29p λέγω γὰρ ὑμῖν 1 This adds emphasis to what John is about to say.
3:9 k843 ὁ Θεὸς ἐκ τῶν λίθων τούτων ἐγεῖραι τέκνα τῷ Ἀβραάμ 1 “God is able to make physical descendants out of even these stones and give them to Abraham”
3:10 ls7m 0 John the Baptist continues to rebuke the Pharisees and Sadducees.
3:10 ke4s rc://*/ta/man/translate/figs-metaphor ἤδη δὲ ἡ ἀξίνη πρὸς τὴν ῥίζαν τῶν δένδρων κεῖται; πᾶν οὖν δένδρον μὴ ποιοῦν καρπὸν καλὸν ἐκκόπτεται καὶ εἰς πῦρ βάλλεται 1 This metaphor means God is ready to punish sinners. This can be stated in active form. Alternate translation: “God has his axe and he is ready to cut down and burn any tree that grows bad fruit” or “As a person gets his axe ready to cut down and burn a tree that grows bad fruit, God is ready to punish you for your sins” (See: [[rc://*/ta/man/translate/figs-metaphor]] and [[rc://*/ta/man/translate/figs-activepassive]])
3:11 lx69 εἰς μετάνοιαν 1 “to show that you have repented”
3:11 mc2r ὁ δὲ ὀπίσω μου ἐρχόμενος 1 Jesus is the person who comes after John.
3:11 c1xf ἰσχυρότερός μού ἐστιν 1 “is more important than I am”
3:11 gtm7 rc://*/ta/man/translate/figs-metaphor αὐτὸς ὑμᾶς βαπτίσει ἐν Πνεύματι Ἁγίῳ καὶ πυρί 1 This metaphor compares Johns baptism with water to the future baptism with fire. This means Johns baptism only symbolically cleanses people of their sins. The baptism by Holy Spirit and fire will truly cleanse people of their sins. If possible, use the word “baptize” in your translation to keep the comparison to Johns baptism. (See: [[rc://*/ta/man/translate/figs-metaphor]])
3:12 gcq8 rc://*/ta/man/translate/figs-metaphor οὗ τὸ πτύον ἐν τῇ χειρὶ αὐτοῦ; καὶ διακαθαριεῖ τὴν ἅλωνα αὐτοῦ 1 This metaphor compares the way Christ will separate the righteous people from the unrighteous people to the way a man separates wheat grain from chaff. Alternate translation: “Christ is like a man whose winnowing fork is in his hand” (See: [[rc://*/ta/man/translate/figs-metaphor]])
3:12 sq4p rc://*/ta/man/translate/figs-idiom οὗ τὸ πτύον ἐν τῇ χειρὶ αὐτοῦ 1 Here “in his hand” means the person is ready to act. Alternate translation: “Christ is holding a winnowing fork because he is ready” (See: [[rc://*/ta/man/translate/figs-idiom]])
3:12 b5m4 rc://*/ta/man/translate/translate-unknown τὸ πτύον 1 This is a tool for tossing wheat up into the air to separate the wheat grain from the chaff. The heavier grain falls back down and the unwanted chaff is blown away by the wind. It is similar in shape to a pitchfork but with wide tines made of wood. (See: [[rc://*/ta/man/translate/translate-unknown]])
3:12 yw29 διακαθαριεῖ τὴν ἅλωνα αὐτοῦ 1 Christ is like a man with a winnowing fork who is ready to clear off his threshing floor.
3:12 r2ua τὴν ἅλωνα αὐτοῦ 1 “his ground” or “the ground where he separates the grain from the chaff”
3:12 av8l rc://*/ta/man/translate/figs-metaphor συνάξει τὸν σῖτον αὐτοῦ εἰς τὴν ἀποθήκην & τὸ & ἄχυρον κατακαύσει πυρὶ ἀσβέστῳ 1 This is a metaphor showing how God will separate righteous people from evil people. The righteous will go to heaven like wheat into a farmers storehouse, and God will burn the people who are like chaff with a fire that will never be put out. (See: [[rc://*/ta/man/translate/figs-metaphor]])
3:12 bdb7 rc://*/ta/man/translate/figs-activepassive ἀσβέστῳ 1 This can be stated in active form. Alternate translation: “will never burn out” (See: [[rc://*/ta/man/translate/figs-activepassive]])
3:13 vl93 0 Here the scene shifts to a later time when John the Baptist baptizes Jesus.
3:13 zbj9 rc://*/ta/man/translate/figs-activepassive βαπτισθῆναι ὑπ’ αὐτοῦ 1 This can be stated in active form. Alternate translation: “so John could baptize him” (See: [[rc://*/ta/man/translate/figs-activepassive]])
3:14 cl7t rc://*/ta/man/translate/figs-rquestion ἐγὼ χρείαν ἔχω ὑπὸ σοῦ βαπτισθῆναι, καὶ σὺ ἔρχῃ πρός με? 1 John uses a question to show his surprise at Jesus request. Alternate translation: “You are more important than I am. I should not baptize you. You should baptize me.” (See: [[rc://*/ta/man/translate/figs-rquestion]])
3:15 h6ca rc://*/ta/man/translate/figs-exclusive ἡμῖν 1 Here “us” refers to Jesus and John. (See: [[rc://*/ta/man/translate/figs-exclusive]])
3:16 n8bk 0 This is the end of the part of the story about John the Baptist. It describes what happened after he baptized Jesus.
3:16 inf6 rc://*/ta/man/translate/figs-activepassive βαπτισθεὶς δὲ 1 This can be stated in active form. Alternate translation: “After John baptized Jesus” (See: [[rc://*/ta/man/translate/figs-activepassive]])
3:16 sf5w ἰδοὺ 1 The word “behold” here alerts us to pay attention to the surprising information that follows.
3:16 jh1v rc://*/ta/man/translate/figs-activepassive ἀνεῴχθησαν αὐτῷ οἱ οὐρανοί 1 This can be stated in active form. Alternate translation: “Jesus saw the sky open” or “God opened the heavens to Jesus” (See: [[rc://*/ta/man/translate/figs-activepassive]])
3:16 e3na rc://*/ta/man/translate/figs-simile καταβαῖνον ὡσεὶ περιστερὰν 1 Possible meanings are (1) this is simply a statement that the Spirit was in the form of a dove or (2) this is a simile that compares the Spirit coming down upon Jesus gently, the way a dove would. (See: [[rc://*/ta/man/translate/figs-simile]])
3:17 m2wk rc://*/ta/man/translate/figs-metonymy φωνὴ ἐκ τῶν οὐρανῶν λέγουσα 1 “Jesus heard a voice from heaven.” Here “voice” refers to God speaking. Alternate translation: “God spoke from heaven” (See: [[rc://*/ta/man/translate/figs-metonymy]])
3:17 myz8 rc://*/ta/man/translate/guidelines-sonofgodprinciples ὁ Υἱός μου 1 This is an important title for Jesus that describes his relationship to God. (See: [[rc://*/ta/man/translate/guidelines-sonofgodprinciples]])
4:intro hgw2 0 # Matthew 04 General Notes\n## Structure and formatting\n\nSome translations set each line of poetry farther to the right than the rest of the text to make it easier to read. The ULT does this with the poetry in verses 6, 15 and 16, which are words from the Old Testament.\n\nSome translations set quotations from the Old Testament farther to the right on the page than the rest of the text. The ULT does this with the quotation in verse 10.\n\n## Other possible translation difficulties in this chapter\n\n### “the kingdom of heaven has come near”\n\nNo one knows for use whether the “kingdom of heaven” was present or still coming when Jesus spoke these words. English translations often use the phrase “at hand,” but these words can be difficult to translate. Other versions use the phase “is coming near” and “has come near.”\n\n### “If you are the Son of God”\n\nThe reader should not understand these words in verses 3 and 6 to mean that Satan did not know whether Jesus was the Son of God. God had already said that Jesus was his Son ([Matthew 3:17](../../mat/03/17.md)), so Satan knew who Jesus was. He also knew that Jesus could make stones become bread and could throw himself off of high places and not be hurt. He was trying to make Jesus do these things and so disobey God and obey Satan. These words can be translated as “Because you are the Son of God” or “You are the Son of God. Show me what you can do.” (See: [[rc://*/tw/dict/bible/kt/satan]] and [[rc://*/tw/dict/bible/kt/sonofgod]])
4:1 k51m 0 Here Matthew begins a new part of the story in which Jesus spends 40 days in the wilderness, where Satan tempts him. In verse 4, Jesus rebukes Satan with a quotation from Deuteronomy.
4:1 aq3s rc://*/ta/man/translate/figs-activepassive ὁ Ἰησοῦς ἀνήχθη & ὑπὸ τοῦ Πνεύματος 1 This can be stated in active form. Alternate translation: “the Spirit led Jesus” (See: [[rc://*/ta/man/translate/figs-activepassive]])
4:1 wy4b rc://*/ta/man/translate/figs-activepassive πειρασθῆναι ὑπὸ τοῦ διαβόλου 1 This can be stated in active form. Alternate translation: “so the devil could tempt Jesus” (See: [[rc://*/ta/man/translate/figs-activepassive]])
4:2 iw2i νηστεύσας & ἐπείνασεν 1 These refer to Jesus.
4:2 cft7 rc://*/ta/man/translate/translate-numbers ἡμέρας τεσσεράκοντα καὶ νύκτας τεσσεράκοντα 1 “40 days and 40 nights.” This refers to 24-hour periods. Alternate translation: “40 days” (See: [[rc://*/ta/man/translate/translate-numbers]])
4:3 vl86 ὁ πειράζων 1 These words refer to the same being as “the devil” (verse 1). You may have to use the same word to translate both.
4:3 l1lk εἰ Υἱὸς εἶ τοῦ Θεοῦ, εἰπὲ 1 It is best to assume that Satan knew that Jesus is the Son of God. Possible meanings are (1) this is a temptation to do miracles for Jesus own benefit. Alternate translation: “You are the Son of God, so you can command” or (2) this is a challenge or accusation. Alternate translation: “Prove that you are the Son of God by commanding”
4:3 c1ac rc://*/ta/man/translate/guidelines-sonofgodprinciples Υἱὸς & τοῦ Θεοῦ 1 This is an important title for Jesus that describes his relationship to God. (See: [[rc://*/ta/man/translate/guidelines-sonofgodprinciples]])
4:3 m1va rc://*/ta/man/translate/figs-quotations εἰπὲ ἵνα οἱ λίθοι οὗτοι ἄρτοι γένωνται 1 You could translate this with a direct quotation. Alternate translation: “say to these stones, Become bread.’” (See: [[rc://*/ta/man/translate/figs-quotations]])
4:3 t3xm rc://*/ta/man/translate/figs-synecdoche ἄρτοι 1 Here “bread” refers to food in general. Alternate translation: “food” (See: [[rc://*/ta/man/translate/figs-synecdoche]])
4:4 fd67 rc://*/ta/man/translate/figs-activepassive γέγραπται 1 This can be stated in active form. Alternate translation: “Moses wrote this in the scriptures long ago” (See: [[rc://*/ta/man/translate/figs-activepassive]])
4:4 rld7 οὐκ ἐπ’ ἄρτῳ μόνῳ ζήσεται ὁ ἄνθρωπος 1 This implies that there is something more important to life than food.
4:4 jl6f rc://*/ta/man/translate/figs-metonymy ἀλλ’ ἐπὶ παντὶ ῥήματι ἐκπορευομένῳ διὰ στόματος Θεοῦ 1 Here “word” and “mouth” refer to what God says. Alternate translation: “but by listening to everything that God says” (See: [[rc://*/ta/man/translate/figs-metonymy]])
4:5 r4a5 0 In verse 6, Satan quotes from the Psalms in order to tempt Jesus.
4:6 fa8l εἰ Υἱὸς εἶ τοῦ Θεοῦ, βάλε σεαυτὸν κάτω 1 It is best to assume that Satan knew that Jesus is the Son of God. Possible meanings are (1) this is a temptation to do a miracle for Jesus own benefit. Alternate translation: “Since you are truly the Son of God, you can throw yourself down” or (2) this is a challenge or accusation. Alternate translation: “Prove that you are truly the Son of God by throwing yourself down”
4:6 x2vg rc://*/ta/man/translate/guidelines-sonofgodprinciples Υἱὸς & τοῦ Θεοῦ 1 This is an important title for Jesus that describes his relationship to God. (See: [[rc://*/ta/man/translate/guidelines-sonofgodprinciples]])
4:6 c5kr βάλε σεαυτὸν κάτω 1 “let yourself fall to the ground” or “jump down”
4:6 a5h2 rc://*/ta/man/translate/figs-activepassive γέγραπται γὰρ 1 This can be stated in active form. Alternate translation: “for the writer wrote in the scriptures” or “for it says in the scriptures” (See: [[rc://*/ta/man/translate/figs-activepassive]])
4:6 ebc9 rc://*/ta/man/translate/figs-quotations τοῖς ἀγγέλοις αὐτοῦ ἐντελεῖται περὶ σοῦ, καὶ 1 “God will command his angels to take care of you, and” This can be translated with a direct quotation. Alternate translation: “God will say to his angels, Take care of him, and” (See: [[rc://*/ta/man/translate/figs-quotations]])
4:6 f1mm ἀροῦσίν σε 1 “The angels will hold you”
4:7 j6cb 0 In verse 7, Jesus rebukes Satan with another quotation from Deuteronomy.
4:7 u5jp rc://*/ta/man/translate/figs-activepassive πάλιν γέγραπται 1 It is understood that Jesus is quoting scripture again. This can be stated in active form. Alternate translation: “Again, I will tell you what Moses wrote in the scriptures” (See: [[rc://*/ta/man/translate/figs-activepassive]] and [[rc://*/ta/man/translate/figs-ellipsis]])
4:7 c7t5 οὐκ ἐκπειράσεις 1 Here “you” refers to anyone. Alternate translation: “One should not test” or “No person should test”
4:8 d12q πάλιν & ὁ διάβολος 1 “Next, the devil”
4:9 bq1u εἶπεν αὐτῷ 1 “The devil said to Jesus”
4:9 al72 ταῦτά σοι πάντα δώσω 1 “I will give you all these things.” The tempter is emphasizing here that he will give “all these things,” not just some of them.
4:9 eas8 rc://*/ta/man/translate/translate-symaction πεσὼν 1 “put your face near the ground.” This was a common action to show that a person was worshiping. (See: [[rc://*/ta/man/translate/translate-symaction]])
4:10 s91r 0 In verse 10, Jesus rebukes Satan with another quotation from Deuteronomy.
4:10 h8fd 0 This is the end of the part of the story about how Satan tempted Jesus.
4:10 k49q rc://*/ta/man/translate/figs-activepassive γέγραπται γάρ 1 This can be stated in active form. Alternate translation: “For Moses also wrote in the scriptures” (See: [[rc://*/ta/man/translate/figs-activepassive]])
4:10 rig8 rc://*/ta/man/translate/figs-you προσκυνήσεις & λατρεύσεις 1 Both instances of “you” are singular, a command to everyone who hears it. (See: [[rc://*/ta/man/translate/figs-you]])
4:11 s49z ἰδοὺ 1 The word “behold” here alerts us to pay attention to the important new information that follows.
4:12 v7p4 rc://*/ta/man/translate/writing-background 0 This is the beginning of a new part of the story in which Matthew describes the beginning of Jesus ministry in Galilee. These verses explain how Jesus came to be in Galilee. (See: [[rc://*/ta/man/translate/writing-background]])
4:12 wib2 δὲ 1 This word is used here to mark a break in the main story line. Here Matthew starts to tell a new part of the story.
4:12 d1vi rc://*/ta/man/translate/figs-activepassive Ἰωάννης παρεδόθη 1 This can be stated in active form. Alternate translation: “the king had arrested John” (See: [[rc://*/ta/man/translate/figs-activepassive]])
4:13 hpm4 rc://*/ta/man/translate/figs-explicit ἐν ὁρίοις Ζαβουλὼν καὶ Νεφθαλείμ 1 “Zebulun” and “Naphtali” are the names of the tribes that lived in these territories many years earlier before foreigners took control of the land of Israel. (See: [[rc://*/ta/man/translate/figs-explicit]])
4:14 n85z 0 In verses 15 and 16, Matthew quotes the prophet Isaiah to show that Jesus ministry in Galilee was a fulfillment of prophecy.
4:14 jb4p ἵνα 1 This refers to Jesus going to live in Capernaum.
4:14 tj7c rc://*/ta/man/translate/figs-activepassive τὸ ῥηθὲν 1 This can be stated in active form. Alternate translation: “what God said” (See: [[rc://*/ta/man/translate/figs-activepassive]])
4:15 egx6 γῆ Ζαβουλὼν καὶ γῆ Νεφθαλείμ & Γαλιλαία τῶν ἐθνῶν 1 These territories describe the same area.
4:15 bmz6 ὁδὸν θαλάσσης 1 This is the Sea of Galilee.
4:16 e278 ὁ λαὸς ὁ καθήμενος 1 These words can be combined with the sentence beginning with “The land of Zebulun” (verse 15). Alternate translation: “In the territory of Zebulun and Naphtali … where many Gentiles live, the people who sat”
4:16 h2xr rc://*/ta/man/translate/figs-metaphor ὁ λαὸς ὁ καθήμενος ἐν σκοτίᾳ φῶς εἶδεν μέγα 1 Here “darkness” is a metaphor for not knowing the truth about God. And “light” is a metaphor for Gods true message that saves people from their sin. (See: [[rc://*/ta/man/translate/figs-metaphor]])
4:16 nn1r rc://*/ta/man/translate/figs-parallelism τοῖς καθημένοις ἐν χώρᾳ καὶ σκιᾷ θανάτου, φῶς ἀνέτειλεν αὐτοῖς 1 This basically has the same meaning as the first part of the sentence. Here “those who sat in the region and shadow of death” is a metaphor. It represents those who did not know God. These people were in danger of dying and being separated from God forever. (See: [[rc://*/ta/man/translate/figs-parallelism]] and [[rc://*/ta/man/translate/figs-metaphor]])
4:17 dku3 rc://*/ta/man/translate/figs-metonymy ἤγγικεν & ἡ Βασιλεία τῶν Οὐρανῶν 1 The phrase “the kingdom of heaven” refers to God ruling as king. This phrase is only in the book of Matthew. If possible, include a word that means “heaven” in your translation. See how you translated this in [Matthew 3:2](../03/02.md). Alternate translation: “our God in heaven will soon show himself to be king” (See: [[rc://*/ta/man/translate/figs-metonymy]])
4:18 yrx7 0 This begins a new scene within the part of the story about Jesus ministry in Galilee. Here he begins to gather men to be his disciples.
4:18 yfh5 rc://*/ta/man/translate/figs-explicit βάλλοντας ἀμφίβληστρον εἰς τὴν θάλασσαν 1 The full meaning of this statement can be made explicit. Alternate translation: “throwing a net into the water to catch fish” (See: [[rc://*/ta/man/translate/figs-explicit]])
4:19 y3zg δεῦτε ὀπίσω μου 1 Jesus invites Simon and Andrew to follow him, live with him, and become his disciples. Alternate translation: “Be my disciples”
4:19 n9h3 rc://*/ta/man/translate/figs-metaphor ποιήσω ὑμᾶς ἁλιεῖς ἀνθρώπων 1 This metaphor means Simon and Andrew will teach people Gods true message, so others will also follow Jesus. Alternate translation: “I will teach you to gather men to me like you used to gather fish” (See: [[rc://*/ta/man/translate/figs-metaphor]])
4:21 pcg6 0 Jesus calls more men to be his disciples.
4:21 utn4 ἐκάλεσεν αὐτούς 1 “Jesus called John and James.” This phrase also means that Jesus invited them to follow him, live with him, and become his disciples.
4:22 dlk3 οἱ & εὐθέως ἀφέντες 1 “at that moment they left”
4:22 gr2i ἀφέντες τὸ πλοῖον & ἠκολούθησαν αὐτῷ 1 It should be clear that this is a life change. These men are no longer going to be fishermen and are leaving the family business to follow Jesus for the rest of their lives.
4:23 y3qe rc://*/ta/man/translate/writing-endofstory 0 This is the end of the part of the story about the beginning of Jesus ministry in Galilee. These verses summarize what he did and how the people responded. (See: [[rc://*/ta/man/translate/writing-endofstory]])
4:23 ztr8 διδάσκων ἐν ταῖς συναγωγαῖς αὐτῶν 1 “teaching in the synagogues of the Galileans” or “teaching in the synagogues of those people”
4:23 jt3m rc://*/ta/man/translate/figs-metonymy κηρύσσων τὸ εὐαγγέλιον τῆς βασιλείας 1 Here “kingdom” refers to Gods reign as king. Alternate translation: “preaching the good news that God will show himself as king” (See: [[rc://*/ta/man/translate/figs-metonymy]])
4:23 nr8m πᾶσαν νόσον καὶ πᾶσαν μαλακίαν 1 The words “disease” and “sickness” are closely related but should be translated as two different words if possible. “Disease” is what causes a person to be sick.
4:23 uc55 μαλακίαν 1 is the physical weakness or affliction that results from having a disease.
4:24 i296 rc://*/ta/man/translate/figs-activepassive δαιμονιζομένους 1 This can be stated in active form. Alternate translation: “those whom demons controlled” (See: [[rc://*/ta/man/translate/figs-activepassive]])
4:24 p3nf rc://*/ta/man/translate/figs-genericnoun σεληνιαζομένους 1 This refers to anyone there who had epilepsy, not to a particular epileptic. Alternate translation: “those who sometimes had seizures” or “those who sometimes became unconscious and moved uncontrollably” (See: [[rc://*/ta/man/translate/figs-genericnoun]])
4:24 qk4c rc://*/ta/man/translate/figs-genericnoun καὶ παραλυτικούς 1 This refers to anyone there who was paralyzed, not to a particular paralytic. Alternate translation: “and any who were paralyzed” or “and those who could not walk” (See: [[rc://*/ta/man/translate/figs-genericnoun]])
4:25 i9m7 rc://*/ta/man/translate/translate-names Δεκαπόλεως 1 This name means “the Ten Towns.” This is the name of a region to the southeast of the Sea of Galilee. (See: [[rc://*/ta/man/translate/translate-names]])
5:intro awz8 0 # Matthew 05 General Notes\n## Structure and formatting\n\nMany people call the words in Matthew 5-7 the Sermon on the Mount. This is one long lesson that Jesus taught. Bibles divide this lesson into three chapters, but this can sometimes confuse the reader. If your translation divides the text into sections, be sure that the reader understands that the whole sermon is one large section.\n\nMatthew 5:3-10, known as the Beatitudes or Blessings, has been set apart by being set farther to the right on the page than the rest of the text, with each line beginning with the word “blessed.” This way of placing the words on the page highlights the poetic form of this teaching.\n\nJesus spoke about many different subjects in this sermon, so you may wish to help the reader by putting an empty line into the text whenever Jesus changed the subject.\n\n## Special concepts in this chapter\n\n### “His disciples”\n\nIt is possible to refer to anyone who followed Jesus as a follower or disciple. Jesus selected twelve of his followers to become his closest disciples, “the twelve disciples.” They would later become known as the apostles.
5:1 hz26 0 In verse 3, Jesus begins to describe the characteristics of people who are blessed.
5:1 c5rq 0 This is the beginning of a new part of the story in which Jesus begins to teach his disciples. This part continues through the end of chapter 7 and is frequently called the Sermon on the Mount.
5:2 q9mm rc://*/ta/man/translate/figs-idiom ἀνοίξας τὸ στόμα αὐτοῦ 1 This is an idiom. Alternate translation: “Jesus began to speak” (See: [[rc://*/ta/man/translate/figs-idiom]])
5:2 ji1p ἐδίδασκεν αὐτοὺς 1 The word “them” refers to his disciples.
5:3 j7ct rc://*/ta/man/translate/figs-idiom οἱ πτωχοὶ τῷ πνεύματι 1 This means someone who is humble. Alternate translation: “those who know they need God” (See: [[rc://*/ta/man/translate/figs-idiom]])
5:3 wpi6 rc://*/ta/man/translate/figs-metonymy ὅτι αὐτῶν ἐστιν ἡ Βασιλεία τῶν Οὐρανῶν 1 Here “kingdom of heaven” refers to Gods rule as king. This phrase is only in the book of Matthew. If possible, keep “heaven” in your translation. Alternate translation: “for God in heaven will be their king” (See: [[rc://*/ta/man/translate/figs-metonymy]])
5:4 pgy8 οἱ πενθοῦντες 1 Possible reasons they are sad are (1) the sinfulness of the world or (2) their own sins or (3) the death of someone. Do not specify the reason for mourning unless your language requires it.
5:4 lie5 rc://*/ta/man/translate/figs-activepassive αὐτοὶ παρακληθήσονται 1 This can be stated in active form. Alternate translation: “God will comfort them” (See: [[rc://*/ta/man/translate/figs-activepassive]])
5:5 mvb1 οἱ πραεῖς 1 “the gentle” or “those who do not rely on their own power”
5:5 iy1y αὐτοὶ κληρονομήσουσι τὴν γῆν 1 “God will give them the entire earth”
5:6 bi1j rc://*/ta/man/translate/figs-metaphor οἱ πεινῶντες καὶ διψῶντες τὴν δικαιοσύνην 1 This metaphor describes people who strongly desire to do what is right. Alternate translation: “those who desire to live right as much as they desire food and drink” (See: [[rc://*/ta/man/translate/figs-metaphor]])
5:6 hlq2 rc://*/ta/man/translate/figs-activepassive αὐτοὶ χορτασθήσονται 1 This can be stated in active form. Alternate translation: “God will fill them” or “God will satisfy them” (See: [[rc://*/ta/man/translate/figs-activepassive]])
5:8 s9gd rc://*/ta/man/translate/figs-metonymy οἱ καθαροὶ τῇ καρδίᾳ 1 “people whose hearts are pure.” Here “heart” is a metonym for a persons inner being or intentions. Alternate translation: “those who only want to serve God” (See: [[rc://*/ta/man/translate/figs-metonymy]])
5:8 t6ni αὐτοὶ τὸν Θεὸν ὄψονται 1 Here “see” means they will be able to live in Gods presence. Alternate translation: “God will allow them to live with him”
5:9 p1ez οἱ εἰρηνοποιοί 1 These are the people who help others to have peace with one another.
5:9 tv19 rc://*/ta/man/translate/figs-activepassive ὅτι αὐτοὶ υἱοὶ Θεοῦ κληθήσονται 1 This can be stated in active form. Alternate translation: “for God will call them his children” or “they will be children of God” (See: [[rc://*/ta/man/translate/figs-activepassive]])
5:9 vcr2 υἱοὶ Θεοῦ 1 It is best to translate “sons” with the same word your language would naturally use to refer to a human son or child.
5:10 bqu7 rc://*/ta/man/translate/figs-activepassive οἱ δεδιωγμένοι 1 This can be stated in active form. Alternate translation: “those people whom others treat unfairly” (See: [[rc://*/ta/man/translate/figs-activepassive]])
5:10 xnb6 ἕνεκεν δικαιοσύνης 1 “because they do what God wants them to do”
5:10 f3li rc://*/ta/man/translate/figs-metonymy αὐτῶν ἐστιν ἡ Βασιλεία τῶν Οὐρανῶν 1 Here “kingdom of heaven” refers to Gods rule as king. This phrase is only in the book of Matthew. If possible, keep “heaven” in your translation. See how you translated this in [Matthew 5:3](../05/03.md). Alternate translation: “for God in heaven will be their king” (See: [[rc://*/ta/man/translate/figs-metonymy]])
5:11 jvm4 0 Jesus finishes describing the characteristics of people who are blessed.
5:11 t5kb rc://*/ta/man/translate/figs-you μακάριοί ἐστε 1 The word “you” is plural. (See: [[rc://*/ta/man/translate/figs-you]])
5:11 rk69 εἴπωσιν πᾶν πονηρὸν καθ’ ὑμῶν ψευδόμενοι 1 “say all kinds of evil lies about you” or “say bad things about you that are not true”
5:11 eez3 ἕνεκεν ἐμοῦ 1 “because you follow me” or because you believe in me”
5:12 ssk9 rc://*/ta/man/translate/figs-doublet χαίρετε καὶ ἀγαλλιᾶσθε 1 “Rejoice” and “be very glad” mean almost the same thing. Jesus wanted his hearers not merely to rejoice but to do even more than rejoice if possible. (See: [[rc://*/ta/man/translate/figs-doublet]])
5:13 qp6l 0 Jesus begins to teach about how his disciples are like salt and light.
5:13 i3zp rc://*/ta/man/translate/figs-metaphor ὑμεῖς ἐστε τὸ ἅλας τῆς γῆς 1 Possible meanings are (1) just as salt makes food good, disciples of Jesus influence the people of the world so that they will be good. Alternate translation: “You are like salt for the people of the world” or (2) just as salt preserves food, disciples of Jesus keep people from becoming totally corrupt. Alternate translation: “As salt is for food, you are for the world” (See: [[rc://*/ta/man/translate/figs-metaphor]])
5:13 jv56 rc://*/ta/man/translate/figs-metaphor ἐὰν & τὸ ἅλας μωρανθῇ 1 Possible meanings are (1) “if the salt has lost its power to do things that salt does” or (2) “if the salt has lost its flavor.” (See: [[rc://*/ta/man/translate/figs-metaphor]])
5:13 wp9g rc://*/ta/man/translate/figs-rquestion ἐν τίνι ἁλισθήσεται? 1 “how can it be made useful again?” Jesus uses a question to teach the disciples. Alternate translation: “there is no way for it to become useful again.” (See: [[rc://*/ta/man/translate/figs-rquestion]] and [[rc://*/ta/man/translate/figs-metaphor]])
5:13 e7cz rc://*/ta/man/translate/figs-activepassive εἰ μὴ βληθὲν ἔξω, καταπατεῖσθαι ὑπὸ τῶν ἀνθρώπων 1 This can be stated in active form. Alternate translation: “except for people to throw it out into the road and walk on it” (See: [[rc://*/ta/man/translate/figs-activepassive]])
5:14 wgh5 rc://*/ta/man/translate/figs-metaphor ὑμεῖς ἐστε τὸ φῶς τοῦ κόσμου 1 This means Jesus followers bring the message of Gods truth to all the people who do not know God. Alternate translation: “You are like a light for the people of the world” (See: [[rc://*/ta/man/translate/figs-metaphor]])
5:14 bn28 rc://*/ta/man/translate/figs-explicit οὐ δύναται πόλις κρυβῆναι ἐπάνω ὄρους κειμένη 1 At night when it is dark, people can see the city lights shining. This can be stated in active form. Alternate translation: “During the night, no one can hide the lights that shine from a city on a hill” or “Everyone sees the lights of a city on a hill” (See: [[rc://*/ta/man/translate/figs-explicit]] and [[rc://*/ta/man/translate/figs-activepassive]])
5:15 s5sb οὐδὲ καίουσιν λύχνον 1 “People do not light a lamp”
5:15 c8el τιθέασιν αὐτὸν ὑπὸ τὸν μόδιον 1 “place the lamp under a basket.” This is saying it is foolish to create light only to hide it so people do not see the light of the lamp.
5:16 qhp8 rc://*/ta/man/translate/figs-metaphor λαμψάτω τὸ φῶς ὑμῶν ἔμπροσθεν τῶν ἀνθρώπων 1 This means a disciple of Jesus should live in such a way that others can learn about Gods truth. Alternate translation: “Let your lives be like a light that shines before people” (See: [[rc://*/ta/man/translate/figs-metaphor]])
5:16 iiu8 τὸν Πατέρα ὑμῶν τὸν ἐν τοῖς οὐρανοῖς 1 It is best to translate “Father” with the same word your language would naturally use to refer to a human father.
5:17 p63n 0 Jesus begins to teach about how he has come to fulfill the Old Testament law.
5:17 gg3k rc://*/ta/man/translate/figs-metonymy τοὺς προφήτας 1 This refers to what the prophets wrote in the scriptures. (See: [[rc://*/ta/man/translate/figs-metonymy]])
5:18 lky5 ἀμὴν, & λέγω ὑμῖν 1 “I tell you the truth.” This phrase adds emphasis to what Jesus says next.
5:18 cv3m rc://*/ta/man/translate/figs-merism ἕως ἂν παρέλθῃ ὁ οὐρανὸς καὶ ἡ γῆ 1 Here “heaven” and “earth” refer to the entire universe. Alternate translation: “as long as the universe lasts” (See: [[rc://*/ta/man/translate/figs-merism]])
5:18 ylz6 rc://*/ta/man/translate/figs-explicit ἰῶτα ἓν ἢ μία κερέα οὐ μὴ 1 The jot was the smallest Hebrew letter, and the tittle was a small mark that was the difference between two Hebrew letters. Alternate translation: “not even the smallest written letter or the smallest part of a letter” (See: [[rc://*/ta/man/translate/figs-explicit]])
5:18 m5pf rc://*/ta/man/translate/figs-activepassive πάντα γένηται 1 This can be stated in active form. Alternate translation: “all things have happened” or “God causes all things to happen” (See: [[rc://*/ta/man/translate/figs-activepassive]])
5:18 n77j rc://*/ta/man/translate/figs-explicit πάντα 1 The phrase “all things” refers to everything in the law. Alternate translation: “everything in the law” or “all that is written in the law” (See: [[rc://*/ta/man/translate/figs-explicit]])
5:19 uxz2 ὃς ἐὰν & λύσῃ 1 “whoever disobeys” or “whoever ignores”
5:19 k9th μίαν τῶν ἐντολῶν τούτων τῶν ἐλαχίστων 1 “any of these commandments, even the least important one”
5:19 dv5c rc://*/ta/man/translate/figs-activepassive ὃς ἐὰν & διδάξῃ οὕτως τοὺς ἀνθρώπους & κληθήσεται 1 This can be stated in active form. Alternate translation: “if anyone … teaches others to do so, God will call that person” (See: [[rc://*/ta/man/translate/figs-activepassive]])
5:19 bg2v rc://*/ta/man/translate/figs-metonymy ἐλάχιστος & ἐν τῇ Βασιλεία τῶν Οὐρανῶν 1 The phrase “kingdom of heaven” refers to Gods rule as king. This phrase is found only in Matthew. If possible use “heaven” in your translation. Alternate translation: “the least important in his heavenly kingdom” or “the least important under the rule of our God in heaven” (See: [[rc://*/ta/man/translate/figs-metonymy]])
5:19 u5kp ποιήσῃ καὶ διδάξῃ 1 “obeys all these commandments and teaches others to do the same”
5:19 nk9n μέγας 1 most important
5:20 jwm9 λέγω γὰρ ὑμῖν 1 This adds emphasis to what Jesus says next.
5:20 vsc5 rc://*/ta/man/translate/figs-you ὑμῖν & ὑμῶν 1 These are plural. (See: [[rc://*/ta/man/translate/figs-you]])
5:20 l3lv rc://*/ta/man/translate/figs-doublenegatives ὅτι ἐὰν μὴ περισσεύσῃ ὑμῶν ἡ δικαιοσύνη & οὐ μὴ εἰσέλθητε 1 This can be stated in a positive form. Alternate translation: “that your righteousness must exceed … Pharisees in order to enter” (See: [[rc://*/ta/man/translate/figs-doublenegatives]])
5:21 x5vy rc://*/ta/man/translate/figs-you 0 Jesus is talking to a group of people about what they as individuals should and should not do. The “you” is plural in “you have heard” and “I say to you.” The understood “you” is singular in “Do not kill,” but in some languages it may need to be plural. (See: [[rc://*/ta/man/translate/figs-you]])
5:21 us5a 0 Jesus continues to teach about how he has come to fulfill the Old Testament law. Here he begins to speak about murder and anger.
5:21 t6k5 rc://*/ta/man/translate/figs-activepassive ἐρρέθη τοῖς ἀρχαίοις 1 This can be expressed with an active verb. Alternate translation: “God said to those who lived long ago” or “Moses said to your ancestors long ago” (See: [[rc://*/ta/man/translate/figs-activepassive]])
5:21 mij2 rc://*/ta/man/translate/figs-explicit ὃς & ἂν φονεύσῃ, ἔνοχος ἔσται τῇ κρίσει 1 Here “the judgment” implies that a judge will condemn the person to die. Alternate translation: “A judge will condemn anyone who kills another person” (See: [[rc://*/ta/man/translate/figs-explicit]])
5:21 y44x φονεύσεις & φονεύσῃ 1 This word refers to murder, not to all forms of killing.
5:21 r2k4 rc://*/ta/man/translate/figs-explicit ἔνοχος ἔσται τῇ κρίσει 1 It seems here Jesus is not referring to a human judge but rather to God condemning the person who is angry with his brother. (See: [[rc://*/ta/man/translate/figs-explicit]])
5:22 e9gg ἐγὼ δὲ λέγω 1 Jesus agrees with God and his word, but he does not agree with the way the religious leaders have applied Gods word. The “I” is emphatic. This indicates that what Jesus says is equally important to the original commands from God. Try to translate this phrase in a way that shows that emphasis.
5:22 d5nl τῷ ἀδελφῷ 1 This refers to a fellow believer, not to a literal brother or a neighbor.
5:22 w721 ῥακά & μωρέ 1 These are insults for people who cannot think correctly. “Worthless person” is close to “brainless,” where “fool” adds the idea of disobedience to God.
5:22 s89d Συνεδρίῳ 1 This was likely a local council, not the main Sanhedrin in Jerusalem.
5:23 msz4 rc://*/ta/man/translate/figs-you προσφέρῃς 1 Jesus is talking to a group of people about what they as individuals should or should not do. All occurrences of “you” and “your” are singular, but in some languages they may need to be plural. (See: [[rc://*/ta/man/translate/figs-you]])
5:23 r49y προσφέρῃς τὸ δῶρόν σου 1 “giving your gift” or “bringing your gift”
5:23 chv4 rc://*/ta/man/translate/figs-explicit ἐπὶ τὸ θυσιαστήριον 1 It is implied that this is Gods altar at the temple in Jerusalem. Alternate translation: “to God at the altar in the temple” (See: [[rc://*/ta/man/translate/figs-explicit]])
5:23 dz75 κἀκεῖ μνησθῇς 1 “while you are standing at the altar you remember”
5:23 xvf5 ὁ ἀδελφός σου ἔχει τι κατὰ σοῦ 1 “another person is angry with you because of something you did”
5:24 z9m5 rc://*/ta/man/translate/figs-activepassive πρῶτον διαλλάγηθι τῷ ἀδελφῷ σου 1 This can be stated in active form. Alternate translation: “First make peace with the person” (See: [[rc://*/ta/man/translate/figs-activepassive]])
5:25 x4ta rc://*/ta/man/translate/figs-you ἴσθι εὐνοῶν τῷ ἀντιδίκῳ σου 1 Jesus is talking to a group of people about what they as individuals should or should not do. All occurrences of “you” and “your” are singular, but in some languages they may need to be plural. (See: [[rc://*/ta/man/translate/figs-you]])
5:25 sr9d τῷ ἀντιδίκῳ σου 1 This is a person who blames someone for doing something wrong. He takes the wrongdoer to court to accuse him before a judge.
5:25 x1tk rc://*/ta/man/translate/figs-idiom σε παραδῷ & τῷ κριτῇ 1 Here “hand you over” means to give someone into the control of someone else. Alternate translation: “will let the judge deal with you” (See: [[rc://*/ta/man/translate/figs-idiom]])
5:25 pq6d rc://*/ta/man/translate/figs-idiom ὁ κριτὴς τῷ ὑπηρέτῃ 1 Here “hand you over” means to give someone into the control of someone else. Alternate translation: “the judge will give you over to the officer” (See: [[rc://*/ta/man/translate/figs-idiom]])
5:25 gcm5 τῷ ὑπηρέτῃ 1 a person who has authority to carry out the decisions of a judge
5:25 pzh4 rc://*/ta/man/translate/figs-activepassive εἰς φυλακὴν βληθήσῃ 1 This can be stated in active form. Alternate translation: “the officer might put you in prison” (See: [[rc://*/ta/man/translate/figs-activepassive]])
5:26 gec9 ἀμὴν, λέγω σοι 1 “I tell you the truth.” This phrase adds emphasis to what Jesus says next.
5:26 eem5 ἐκεῖθεν 1 “from prison”
5:27 c8dn rc://*/ta/man/translate/figs-you 0 Jesus is talking to a group of people about what they as individuals should and should not do. The “you” is plural in “you have heard” and “I say to you.” The understood “you” is singular in “Do not commit adultery,” but in some languages it may need to be plural. (See: [[rc://*/ta/man/translate/figs-you]])
5:27 mj3g 0 Jesus continues to teach about how he has come to fulfill the Old Testament law. Here he begins to speak about adultery and lust.
5:27 jxg5 rc://*/ta/man/translate/figs-activepassive ὅτι ἐρρέθη 1 This can be stated in active form. Alternate translation: “that God said” or “that Moses said” (See: [[rc://*/ta/man/translate/figs-activepassive]])
5:27 yn7m μοιχεύσεις 1 This word means to act out or do something.
5:28 qfl6 ἐγὼ δὲ λέγω 1 Jesus agrees with God and his word, but he does not agree with the way the religious leaders have applied Gods word. The “I” is emphatic. This indicates that what Jesus says is equally important to the original commands from God. Try to translate this phrase in a way that shows that emphasis. See how you translated this in [Matthew 5:22](../05/22.md).
5:28 glg9 rc://*/ta/man/translate/figs-metaphor πᾶς ὁ βλέπων γυναῖκα πρὸς τὸ ἐπιθυμῆσαι αὐτὴν, ἤδη ἐμοίχευσεν αὐτὴν ἐν τῇ καρδίᾳ αὐτοῦ 1 This metaphor indicates that a man who lusts after a woman is as guilty of adultery as a man who actually commits the act of adultery. (See: [[rc://*/ta/man/translate/figs-metaphor]])
5:28 k7sc πρὸς τὸ ἐπιθυμῆσαι αὐτὴν 1 “and lusts after her” or “and desires to sleep with her”
5:28 eqs8 rc://*/ta/man/translate/figs-metonymy ἐν τῇ καρδίᾳ αὐτοῦ 1 Here “heart” is a metonym for a persons thoughts. Alternate translation: “in his mind” or “in his thoughts” (See: [[rc://*/ta/man/translate/figs-metonymy]])
5:29 et3n rc://*/ta/man/translate/figs-you εἰ & σου 1 Jesus is talking to a group of people about what they as individuals should or should not do. All instances of “you” and “your” are singular, but in some langugaes they may need to be plural. (See: [[rc://*/ta/man/translate/figs-you]])
5:29 ikp5 rc://*/ta/man/translate/figs-metonymy εἰ & ὁ ὀφθαλμός σου ὁ δεξιὸς σκανδαλίζει σε 1 Here “eye” refers to what a person sees. And, “stumble” is a metaphor for “sin.” Alternate translation: “if what you see causes you to stumble” or “if you want to sin because of what you see” (See: [[rc://*/ta/man/translate/figs-metonymy]] and [[rc://*/ta/man/translate/figs-metaphor]])
5:29 mb58 rc://*/ta/man/translate/figs-idiom ὁ ὀφθαλμός & ὁ δεξιὸς 1 This means the most important eye, as opposed to the left eye. You may need to translate “right” as “better” or “stronger.” (See: [[rc://*/ta/man/translate/figs-idiom]])
5:29 v6jr rc://*/ta/man/translate/figs-hyperbole ἔξελε αὐτὸν 1 This is an exaggerated command for a person to do whatever he needs to do to stop sinning. It means “forcefully remove it” or “destroy it.” If the right eye is not specifically mentioned, you may need to translate this “destroy your eyes.” If eyes have been mentioned, you may need to translate this “destroy them.” (See: [[rc://*/ta/man/translate/figs-hyperbole]])
5:29 zg1v βάλε ἀπὸ σοῦ 1 “get rid of it”
5:29 im6u ἀπόληται ἓν τῶν μελῶν σου 1 “you should lose one part of your body”
5:29 v1cn rc://*/ta/man/translate/figs-activepassive καὶ μὴ ὅλον τὸ σῶμά σου βληθῇ εἰς Γέενναν 1 This can be stated in active form. Alternate translation: “than for God to throw your whole body into hell” (See: [[rc://*/ta/man/translate/figs-activepassive]])
5:30 zx8x rc://*/ta/man/translate/figs-metonymy εἰ ἡ δεξιά σου χεὶρ σκανδαλίζει σε 1 In this metonymy, the hand stands for the actions of the whole person. (See: [[rc://*/ta/man/translate/figs-metonymy]])
5:30 hk9z rc://*/ta/man/translate/figs-idiom ἡ δεξιά σου χεὶρ 1 This means the most important hand, as opposed to the left hand. You may need to translate “right” as “better” or “stronger.” (See: [[rc://*/ta/man/translate/figs-idiom]])
5:30 qs74 rc://*/ta/man/translate/figs-hyperbole ἔκκοψον αὐτὴν 1 This is an exaggerated command for a person to do whatever he needs to do to stop sinning. (See: [[rc://*/ta/man/translate/figs-hyperbole]])
5:31 fdr8 0 Jesus continues to teach about how he has come to fulfill the Old Testament law. Here he begins to speak about divorce.
5:31 dh23 rc://*/ta/man/translate/figs-activepassive ἐρρέθη δέ 1 This can be stated in active form. Alternate translation: “God also said” or “Moses also said” (See: [[rc://*/ta/man/translate/figs-activepassive]])
5:31 quq9 rc://*/ta/man/translate/figs-euphemism ἀπολύσῃ τὴν γυναῖκα αὐτοῦ 1 This is a euphemism for divorce. (See: [[rc://*/ta/man/translate/figs-euphemism]])
5:31 tp9l δότω 1 “he must give”
5:32 q6aq ἐγὼ δὲ λέγω 1 Jesus agrees with God and his word, but he does not agree with the way the religious leaders have applied Gods word. The “I” is emphatic. This indicates that what Jesus says is equally important to the original commands from God. Try to translate this phrase in a way that shows that emphasis. See how you translated this in [Matthew 5:22](../05/22.md).
5:32 j2aq ποιεῖ αὐτὴν μοιχευθῆναι 1 It is the man who divorces the woman improperly who “causes her to commit adultery.” In many cultures it would be normal for her to remarry, but if the divorce is improper, such a remarriage is adultery.
5:32 zai7 rc://*/ta/man/translate/figs-activepassive ἀπολελυμένην 1 This can be stated in active form. Alternate translation: “her after her husband has divorced her” or “the divorced woman” (See: [[rc://*/ta/man/translate/figs-activepassive]])
5:33 i5ak rc://*/ta/man/translate/figs-you 0 Jesus is talking to a group of people about what they as individuals should and should not do. The “you” is plural in “you have heard” and “I say to you.” The “you” and “your” are singular in “Do not swear” and “carry out your oaths,” but in some languages they may need to be plural. (See: [[rc://*/ta/man/translate/figs-you]])
5:33 dg2a 0 Jesus continues to teach about how he has come to fulfill the Old Testament law. Here he begins to speak about swearing oaths.
5:33 vv1e πάλιν ἠκούσατε 1 “Also, you” or “Here is another example. You”
5:33 fk86 rc://*/ta/man/translate/figs-activepassive ἐρρέθη τοῖς ἀρχαίοις 1 This can be expressed with an active verb. Alternate translation: “God said to those who lived long ago” or “Moses said to your ancestors long ago” (See: [[rc://*/ta/man/translate/figs-activepassive]])
5:33 tk9y οὐκ ἐπιορκήσεις, ἀποδώσεις δὲ τῷ Κυρίῳ τοὺς ὅρκους σου 1 “Do not swear that you will do something and then not do it. Instead do whatever you have sworn to the Lord that you will do”
5:34 mpk1 ἐγὼ δὲ λέγω 1 Jesus agrees with God and his word, but he does not agree with the way the religious leaders have applied Gods word. The “I” is emphatic. This indicates that what Jesus says is equally important to the original commands from God. Try to translate this phrase in a way that shows that emphasis. See how you translated this in [Matthew 5:22](../05/22.md).
5:34 m2n6 μὴ ὀμόσαι ὅλως 1 “Do not swear at all” or “Do not swear by anything”
5:34 u7su rc://*/ta/man/translate/figs-metaphor θρόνος ἐστὶν τοῦ Θεοῦ 1 Because God reigns from heaven, Jesus speaks of heaven as if it were a throne. Alternate translation: “it is from here that God rules” (See: [[rc://*/ta/man/translate/figs-metaphor]])
5:35 c8lx 0 Jesus finishes his words from verse 34, telling the people not to swear.
5:35 v2hf μήτε ἐν τῇ γῇ & πόλις ἐστὶν τοῦ μεγάλου Βασιλέως 1 Here Jesus means that when people make a promise or when they say that something is true, they must not swear by anything. Some people were teaching that if a person swears by God that he will do something, then he must do it, but if he swears by something else, such as by heaven or earth, then it is less offensive if he does not do what he swore to do. Jesus says that swearing by heaven or earth or Jerusalem is just as serious as swearing by God because those things all belong to God.
5:35 e7z8 rc://*/ta/man/translate/figs-metaphor ὑποπόδιόν ἐστιν τῶν ποδῶν αὐτοῦ 1 This metaphor means the earth also belongs to God. Alternate translation: “it is like a footstool where a king rests his feet” (See: [[rc://*/ta/man/translate/figs-metaphor]])
5:35 e6zn ὅτι πόλις ἐστὶν τοῦ μεγάλου Βασιλέως 1 “for it is the city that belongs to God, the great King”
5:36 kr2d 0 Previously Jesus told his hearers that Gods throne, footstool, and earthly home are not theirs to swear by. Here he says that they may not swear even by their own heads.
5:36 l9c8 rc://*/ta/man/translate/figs-you σου 1 Jesus is talking to a group of people about what they as individuals should and should not do. All occurrences of these words are singular, but you may have to translate them as plural. (See: [[rc://*/ta/man/translate/figs-you]])
5:36 z5vu ὀμόσῃς 1 This refers to taking an oath. See how you translated this in [Matthew 5:34](../05/34.md).
5:37 tke6 ἔστω & ὁ λόγος ὑμῶν, ναὶ ναί, οὒ οὔ 1 “if you mean yes, say yes, and if you mean no, say no.’”
5:38 quy6 rc://*/ta/man/translate/figs-you 0 Jesus is talking to a group of people about what they as individuals should and should not do. The “you” is plural in “you have heard” and “I say to you.” The “you” in “whoever strikes you” and the understood “you” in “turn to him” are both singular, but in some languages they may need to be plural. (See: [[rc://*/ta/man/translate/figs-you]])
5:38 s39u 0 Jesus continues to teach about how he has come to fulfill the Old Testament law. Here he begins to speak about retaliating against an enemy.
5:38 zar1 rc://*/ta/man/translate/figs-activepassive ὅτι ἐρρέθη 1 This can be stated in active form. See how you translated this in [Matthew 5:27](../05/27.md). Alternate translation: “that God said” or “that Moses said” (See: [[rc://*/ta/man/translate/figs-activepassive]])
5:38 w53l ὀφθαλμὸν ἀντὶ ὀφθαλμοῦ καὶ ὀδόντα ἀντὶ ὀδόντος 1 The law of Moses allowed a person to harm a person in the same way he had harmed him, but he could not harm him worse.
5:39 x2y9 ἐγὼ δὲ λέγω 1 Jesus agrees with God and his word, but he does not agree with the way the religious leaders have applied Gods word. The “I” is emphatic. This indicates that what Jesus says is equally important to the original commands from God. Try to translate this phrase in a way that shows that emphasis.
5:39 qrx1 τῷ πονηρῷ 1 “an evil person” or “someone who harms you”
5:39 ec5y ῥαπίζει & τὴν δεξιὰν σιαγόνα 1 To strike the side of a mans face was an insult in Jesus culture. As with the eye and the hand, the right cheek is the more important one, and striking that cheek was a terrible insult.
5:39 d5xg ῥαπίζει 1 hits with the back of an open hand
5:39 wz54 στρέψον αὐτῷ καὶ τὴν ἄλλην 1 “let him hit your other cheek also”
5:40 gr2x rc://*/ta/man/translate/figs-you 0 Jesus is talking to a group of people about what they as individuals should and should not do. All occurrences of “you” and “your” are singular, including the understood “you” in the commands “let,” “go,” “give,” and “do not turn away.” In some languages they may need to be plural. (See: [[rc://*/ta/man/translate/figs-you]])
5:40 t9f4 τὸν χιτῶνά & ἱμάτιον 1 The “coat” was worn close to the body, like a heavy shirt or a sweater. The “cloak,” the more valuable of the two, was worn over the “coat” for warmth and also used as a blanket for warmth at night.
5:40 p5m2 ἄφες αὐτῷ καὶ τὸ ἱμάτιον 1 “give also to that person”
5:41 i867 rc://*/ta/man/translate/figs-explicit ὅστις 1 “Anyone who.” The context implies that he is speaking about a Roman soldier. (See: [[rc://*/ta/man/translate/figs-explicit]])
5:41 i86s μίλιον ἕν 1 This is one thousand paces, which is the distance a Roman soldier could legally force someone to carry something for him. If “mile” is confusing, it can be translated as “one kilometer” or “a distance.”
5:41 n8r4 μετ’ αὐτοῦ 1 This refers to the one who compels you to go.
5:41 zv6i ὕπαγε μετ’ αὐτοῦ δύο 1 “go the mile he forces you to go, and then go another mile.” If “mile” is confusing, you can translate it as “two kilometers” or “twice as far.”
5:42 pe6x μὴ ἀποστραφῇς 1 “do not refuse to lend to.” This can be stated in a positive form. Alternate translation: “lend to”
5:43 cyz3 rc://*/ta/man/translate/figs-you 0 Jesus is talking to a group of people about what they as individuals should and should not do. The “you” is plural in “you have heard” and “I say to you.” The “you” and “your” are singular in “You must love your neighbor and hate your enemy,” but in some languages they may need to be plural. All occurrences of “you” and “your” after that are plural. (See: [[rc://*/ta/man/translate/figs-you]])
5:43 xf8l 0 Jesus continues to teach about how he has come to fulfill the Old Testament law. Here he begins to speak about loving enemies.
5:43 fp6x rc://*/ta/man/translate/figs-activepassive ὅτι ἐρρέθη 1 This can be stated in active form. See how you translated this in [Matthew 5:27](../05/27.md). Alternate translation: “that God said” or “that Moses said” (See: [[rc://*/ta/man/translate/figs-activepassive]])
5:43 tqj3 rc://*/ta/man/translate/figs-genericnoun τὸν πλησίον σου 1 Here the word “neighbor” does not refer to a specific neighbor, but to any members of ones community or people group. These are people whom one usually desires to treat kindly or at least believes he ought to treat kindly. Alternate translation: “your countrymen” or “those who belong to your people group” (See: [[rc://*/ta/man/translate/figs-genericnoun]])
5:44 f9lp ἐγὼ δὲ λέγω 1 Jesus agrees with God and his word, but he does not agree with the way the religious leaders have applied Gods word. The “I” is emphatic. This indicates that what Jesus says is equally important to the original commands from God. Try to translate this phrase in a way that shows that emphasis. See how you translated this in [Matthew 5:22](../05/22.md).
5:45 my3d γένησθε υἱοὶ τοῦ Πατρὸς ὑμῶν 1 It is best to translate “sons” with the same word your language would naturally use to refer to human sons or children.
5:45 jzu9 rc://*/ta/man/translate/guidelines-sonofgodprinciples Πατρὸς 1 This is an important title for God. (See: [[rc://*/ta/man/translate/guidelines-sonofgodprinciples]])
5:46 g5t7 rc://*/ta/man/translate/figs-you 0 Jesus is talking to a group of people about what they as individuals should and should not do. All instances of “you” and “your” are plural. (See: [[rc://*/ta/man/translate/figs-you]])
5:46 sf7k 0 Jesus finishes teaching about how he has come to fulfill the Old Testament law. This section began in [Matthew 5:17](../05/17.md).
5:46 se4k rc://*/ta/man/translate/figs-rquestion τίνα μισθὸν ἔχετε? 1 Jesus uses this question to teach the people that loving those who love them is not something special that God will reward them for. This rhetorical question can be translated as a statement. Alternative translation: “you will get no reward.” (See: [[rc://*/ta/man/translate/figs-rquestion]])
5:46 cb77 rc://*/ta/man/translate/figs-rquestion οὐχὶ καὶ οἱ τελῶναι τὸ αὐτὸ ποιοῦσιν? 1 This rhetorical question can be translated as a statement. Alternative translation: “Even the tax collectors do the same thing.” (See: [[rc://*/ta/man/translate/figs-rquestion]])
5:47 ba6e rc://*/ta/man/translate/figs-rquestion τί περισσὸν ποιεῖτε? 1 This question can be translated as a statement. Alternate translation: “you do nothing more than others.” (See: [[rc://*/ta/man/translate/figs-rquestion]])
5:47 ben5 ἀσπάσησθε 1 This is a general term for showing a desire for the well-being of the hearer.
5:47 elw9 rc://*/ta/man/translate/figs-rquestion οὐχὶ καὶ οἱ ἐθνικοὶ τὸ αὐτὸ ποιοῦσιν? 1 This question can be translated as a statement. Alternate translation: “Even the Gentiles do the same thing.” (See: [[rc://*/ta/man/translate/figs-rquestion]])
5:48 l6pa rc://*/ta/man/translate/guidelines-sonofgodprinciples Πατὴρ 1 This is an important title for God. (See: [[rc://*/ta/man/translate/guidelines-sonofgodprinciples]])
6:intro jrj2 0 # Matthew 06 General Notes\n## Structure and formatting\n\nMatthew 6 continues Jesus extended teaching known as “The Sermon on the Mount.”\n\nYou may wish to set apart the prayer in 6:9-11 by placing it farther to the right on the page than the rest of the text.\n\nJesus spoke about many different subjects in this sermon, so you may wish to help the reader by putting an empty line into the text whenever Jesus changed the subject.
6:1 zvn1 rc://*/ta/man/translate/figs-you 0 Jesus is talking to a group of people about what they as individuals should and should not do. All occurrences of “you” and “your” are plural. (See: [[rc://*/ta/man/translate/figs-you]])
6:1 at4q 0 Jesus continues to teach his disciples in his Sermon on the Mount, which began in [Matthew 5:3](../05/03.md). In this section, Jesus addresses the “acts of righteousness” of alms, prayer, and fasting.
6:1 bgc7 rc://*/ta/man/translate/figs-explicit ἔμπροσθεν τῶν ἀνθρώπων, πρὸς τὸ θεαθῆναι αὐτοῖς 1 It is implied that those who see the person will honor him. This can be stated in active form. Alternate translation: “in front of people just so that they can see you and give you honor for what you have done” (See: [[rc://*/ta/man/translate/figs-explicit]] and [[rc://*/ta/man/translate/figs-activepassive]])
6:1 juj5 rc://*/ta/man/translate/guidelines-sonofgodprinciples τῷ Πατρὶ 1 This is an important title for God. (See: [[rc://*/ta/man/translate/guidelines-sonofgodprinciples]])
6:2 d8kw rc://*/ta/man/translate/figs-metaphor μὴ σαλπίσῃς ἔμπροσθέν σου 1 This metaphor means to do something that purposefully gets peoples attention. Alternate translation: “do not draw attention to yourself like someone who plays a loud trumpet in a crowd” (See: [[rc://*/ta/man/translate/figs-metaphor]])
6:2 dk6u ἀμὴν, λέγω ὑμῖν 1 “I tell you the truth.” This phrase adds emphasis to what Jesus says next.
6:3 z4c1 rc://*/ta/man/translate/figs-you 0 Jesus is talking to a group of people about what they as individuals should and should not do. All occurrences of “you” and “your” are plural. (See: [[rc://*/ta/man/translate/figs-you]])
6:3 te4n 0 Jesus continues to teach his disciples about alms.
6:3 vca2 rc://*/ta/man/translate/figs-metaphor μὴ γνώτω ἡ ἀριστερά σου τί ποιεῖ ἡ δεξιά σου 1 This is a metaphor for total secrecy. Just as hands usually work together and each can be said to “know” what the other is doing at all times, you should not let even those closest to you know when you are giving to the poor. (See: [[rc://*/ta/man/translate/figs-metaphor]])
6:4 h4we rc://*/ta/man/translate/figs-activepassive ᾖ σου ἡ ἐλεημοσύνη ἐν τῷ κρυπτῷ 1 This can be stated in active form. Alternate translation: “you can give to the poor without other people knowing” (See: [[rc://*/ta/man/translate/figs-activepassive]])
6:5 m54u rc://*/ta/man/translate/figs-you 0 Jesus is talking to a group of people about what they as individuals should and should not do. All occurrences of “you” and “your” in verses 5 and 7 are plural; in verse 6 they are singular, but in some languages they may need to be plural. (See: [[rc://*/ta/man/translate/figs-you]])
6:5 a7z4 0 Jesus begins to teach about prayer.
6:5 e12v rc://*/ta/man/translate/figs-explicit ὅπως φανῶσιν τοῖς ἀνθρώποις 1 It is implied that those who see them will give them honor. This can be stated in active form. Alternate translation: “so that people will see them and give them honor” (See: [[rc://*/ta/man/translate/figs-explicit]] and [[rc://*/ta/man/translate/figs-activepassive]])
6:5 z3h6 ἀμὴν, λέγω ὑμῖν 1 “I tell you the truth.” This phrase adds emphasis to what Jesus says next.
6:6 dqv4 εἴσελθε εἰς τὸ ταμεῖόν σου καὶ κλείσας τὴν θύραν σου 1 “go to a private place” or “go where you can be alone”
6:6 vdr7 τῷ Πατρί σου τῷ ἐν τῷ κρυπτῷ 1 Possible meanings are (1) no one can see God. Alternate translation: “Father, who is invisible” or (2) God is in that private place with the praying person. Alternate translation: “Father, who is with you in private”
6:6 kkn7 rc://*/ta/man/translate/guidelines-sonofgodprinciples τῷ Πατρί 1 This is an important title for God. (See: [[rc://*/ta/man/translate/guidelines-sonofgodprinciples]])
6:6 eb6r ὁ Πατήρ σου, ὁ βλέπων ἐν τῷ κρυπτῷ 1 “your Father will see what you do in private and”
6:7 d1t2 μὴ βατταλογήσητε 1 Possible meanings are (1) the repetitions are useless. Alternate translation: “do not keep uselessly saying things over and over again” or (2) the words or sentences are meaningless. Alternate translation: “do not keeping repeating meaningless words”
6:7 a8ai rc://*/ta/man/translate/figs-activepassive εἰσακουσθήσονται 1 This can be stated in active form. Alternate translation: “their false gods will hear them” (See: [[rc://*/ta/man/translate/figs-activepassive]])
6:8 fr1d rc://*/ta/man/translate/figs-you 0 Jesus is talking to a group of people about how they as individuals should pray. The words “you” and “your” are plural in the first sentence. Within the prayer, the words “you” and “your” are singular and refer to God, “Our Father in heaven.” (See: [[rc://*/ta/man/translate/figs-you]])
6:8 nv9i rc://*/ta/man/translate/guidelines-sonofgodprinciples ὁ Πατὴρ 1 This is an important title for God. (See: [[rc://*/ta/man/translate/guidelines-sonofgodprinciples]])
6:9 ad6l Πάτερ ἡμῶν, ὁ ἐν τοῖς οὐρανοῖς 1 This is the beginning of the prayer and how Jesus teaches the people to address God.
6:9 mq4x rc://*/ta/man/translate/figs-metonymy ἁγιασθήτω τὸ ὄνομά σου 1 Here “your name” refers to God himself. Alternate translation: “make everyone honor you” (See: [[rc://*/ta/man/translate/figs-metonymy]])
6:10 n67c rc://*/ta/man/translate/figs-metonymy ἐλθέτω ἡ βασιλεία σου 1 Here “kingdom” refers to Gods rule as king. Alternate translation: “May you rule over everyone and everything completely” (See: [[rc://*/ta/man/translate/figs-metonymy]])
6:10 pdc5 rc://*/ta/man/translate/figs-activepassive γενηθήτω τὸ θέλημά σου, ὡς ἐν οὐρανῷ καὶ ἐπὶ γῆς 1 This can be stated in active form. Alternate translation: “May everything on earth happen in accordance with your will as everything in heaven does” (See: [[rc://*/ta/man/translate/figs-activepassive]])
6:11 njr9 rc://*/ta/man/translate/figs-exclusive 0 This is part of a prayer that Jesus was teaching the people. All instances of “we,” “us,” and “our” refer only to those who would pray this prayer. Those words do not also refer to God, to whom they would be praying. (See: [[rc://*/ta/man/translate/figs-exclusive]])
6:11 dft8 rc://*/ta/man/translate/figs-synecdoche τὸν ἄρτον & τὸν ἐπιούσιον 1 Here “bread” refers to food in general. (See: [[rc://*/ta/man/translate/figs-synecdoche]])
6:12 yi9s rc://*/ta/man/translate/figs-metaphor τὰ ὀφειλήματα 1 A debt is what one person owes another. This is a metaphor for sins. (See: [[rc://*/ta/man/translate/figs-metaphor]])
6:12 i8fq rc://*/ta/man/translate/figs-metaphor τοῖς ὀφειλέταις ἡμῶν 1 A debtor is a person who owes a debt to another person. This is a metaphor for those who have sinned against us. (See: [[rc://*/ta/man/translate/figs-metaphor]])
6:13 l8u6 rc://*/ta/man/translate/figs-abstractnouns μὴ εἰσενέγκῃς ἡμᾶς εἰς πειρασμόν 1 The word “temptation,” an abstract noun, can be expressed as a verb. Alternate translation: “Do not let anything tempt us” or “Do not let anything cause us to desire to sin” (See: [[rc://*/ta/man/translate/figs-abstractnouns]])
6:14 ns3m rc://*/ta/man/translate/figs-you 0 All instances of “you” and “your” are plural. However, Jesus is telling them what will happen to them as individuals if each person does not forgive others. (See: [[rc://*/ta/man/translate/figs-you]])
6:14 z79a rc://*/ta/man/translate/figs-abstractnouns τὰ παραπτώματα αὐτῶν 1 The abstract noun “trespasses” can be translated as a verb. Alternate translation: “when they trespass against you” (See: [[rc://*/ta/man/translate/figs-abstractnouns]])
6:14 v7ne rc://*/ta/man/translate/guidelines-sonofgodprinciples ὁ Πατὴρ 1 This is an important title for God. (See: [[rc://*/ta/man/translate/guidelines-sonofgodprinciples]])
6:15 pi3z rc://*/ta/man/translate/figs-abstractnouns τοῖς ἀνθρώποις & τὰ παραπτώματα ὑμῶν 1 The abstract noun “trespasses” can be translated as a verb. Alternate translation: “when they trespass against you … when you trespass against God” or “when they do things that harm you … when you do things that make your Father angry” (See: [[rc://*/ta/man/translate/figs-abstractnouns]])
6:16 j7xg rc://*/ta/man/translate/figs-you 0 Jesus is talking to a group of people about what they as individuals should or should not do. In verse 16 all occurences of “you” are plural. In verses 17 and 18 where Jesus teaches them how to behave when they fast, all occurrences of “you” and “your” are singular. In some languages those occurences of “you” may also need to be plural. (See: [[rc://*/ta/man/translate/figs-you]])
6:16 q19r 0 Jesus begins to teach about fasting.
6:16 xv6b ἀφανίζουσιν & τὰ πρόσωπα αὐτῶν 1 The hypocrites would not wash their faces or comb their hair. They did this purposely to draw attention to themselves so that people would see them and give them honor for fasting.
6:16 ix6h ἀμὴν, λέγω ὑμῖν 1 “I tell you the truth.” This phrase adds emphasis to what Jesus says next.
6:17 k283 ἄλειψαί σου τὴν κεφαλὴν 1 “put oil in your hair” or “groom your hair.” To “anoint” the head here is to take normal care of ones hair. It has nothing to do with “Christ” meaning “anointed one.” Jesus means that people should look the same whether they are fasting or not.
6:18 d27s τῷ Πατρί σου τῷ ἐν τῷ κρυφαίῳ 1 Possible meanings are (1) no one can see God. Alternate translation: “Father, who is invisible” or (2) God is with that person who fasts secretly. Alternate translation: “Father, who is with you in private” See how you translated this in [Matthew 6:6](../06/06.md).
6:18 m56a rc://*/ta/man/translate/guidelines-sonofgodprinciples τῷ Πατρί 1 This is an important title for God. (See: [[rc://*/ta/man/translate/guidelines-sonofgodprinciples]])
6:18 tby8 ὁ βλέπων ἐν τῷ κρυφαίῳ 1 “who sees what you do in private.” See how you translated this in [Matthew 6:6](../06/06.md).
6:19 afg9 rc://*/ta/man/translate/figs-you 0 Jesus is talking to a group of people about what they as individuals should or should not do. All occurrences of “you” and “your” are plural, except in verse 21, where they are singular. In some languages these occurrences of “you” and “your” may also need to be plural. (See: [[rc://*/ta/man/translate/figs-you]])
6:19 z3jx 0 Jesus begins to teach about money and possessions.
6:19 tqp1 θησαυροὺς 1 riches, the things to which a person gives the most value
6:19 z9wd ὅπου σὴς καὶ βρῶσις ἀφανίζει 1 “where moth and rust ruin treasures”
6:19 tqc9 σὴς 1 a small, flying insect that destroys cloth
6:19 enl6 βρῶσις 1 a brown substance that forms on metals
6:20 v5tn rc://*/ta/man/translate/figs-metaphor θησαυρίζετε & ὑμῖν θησαυροὺς ἐν οὐρανῷ 1 This is a metaphor that means do good things on earth so God will reward you in heaven. (See: [[rc://*/ta/man/translate/figs-metaphor]])
6:21 b74q rc://*/ta/man/translate/figs-metonymy ἐκεῖ ἔσται καὶ ἡ καρδία σου 1 Here “heart” means a persons thoughts and interests. (See: [[rc://*/ta/man/translate/figs-metonymy]])
6:22 g215 rc://*/ta/man/translate/figs-you 0 Jesus is talking to a group of people about what they as individuals should or should not do. The instances of “you” and “your” are all singular, but in some languages they may need to be plural. (See: [[rc://*/ta/man/translate/figs-you]])
6:22 sbl1 rc://*/ta/man/translate/figs-metaphor ὁ λύχνος τοῦ σώματός ἐστιν ὁ ὀφθαλμός & φωτεινὸν ἔσται 1 This compares healthy eyes that allow a person to see to diseased eyes that cause a person to be blind. This is a metaphor referring to spiritual health. Often Jewish people used the phrase “bad eye” to refer to greed. The meaning is that if a person is completely devoted to God and sees or considers things the way God does, then he is doing what is right. If a person is greedy for more, then he is doing what is evil. (See: [[rc://*/ta/man/translate/figs-metaphor]])
6:22 r4d1 rc://*/ta/man/translate/figs-metaphor ὁ λύχνος τοῦ σώματός ἐστιν ὁ ὀφθαλμός 1 This metaphor means the eyes allow a person to see just as a lamp helps a person see in the dark. Alternate translation: “Like a lamp, the eye allows you to see things clearly” (See: [[rc://*/ta/man/translate/figs-metaphor]])
6:22 u47q ὀφθαλμός 1 You may have to translate this as plural, “eyes.”
6:23 dl86 rc://*/ta/man/translate/figs-metaphor ἐὰν δὲ ὁ ὀφθαλμός σου & ἐστίν τὸ σκότος πόσον 1 This compares healthy eyes that allow a person to see to diseased eyes that cause a person to be blind. This is a metaphor referring to spiritual health. Often Jewish people used the phrase “bad eye” to refer to greed. The meaning is that if a person is completely devoted to God and sees or considers things the way God does, then he is doing what is right. If a person is greedy for more, then he is doing what is evil. (See: [[rc://*/ta/man/translate/figs-metaphor]])
6:23 p231 rc://*/ta/man/translate/figs-metaphor ἐὰν & ὁ ὀφθαλμός σου πονηρὸς ᾖ 1 This does not refer to magic. Jewish people often used this as a metaphor for someone who is greedy. (See: [[rc://*/ta/man/translate/figs-metaphor]])
6:23 n42m εἰ & τὸ φῶς τὸ ἐν σοὶ σκότος, ἐστίν τὸ σκότος πόσον 1 “if that which is supposed to cause light in your body causes darkness, then your body is in complete darkness”
6:24 ijn3 rc://*/ta/man/translate/figs-parallelism ἢ γὰρ τὸν ἕνα μισήσει καὶ τὸν ἕτερον ἀγαπήσει, ἢ ἑνὸς ἀνθέξεται καὶ τοῦ ἑτέρου καταφρονήσει 1 Both of these phrases mean basically the same thing. They emphasize that a person cannot love and be devoted both to God and money at the same time. (See: [[rc://*/ta/man/translate/figs-parallelism]])
6:24 zt2u οὐ δύνασθε Θεῷ δουλεύειν καὶ μαμωνᾷ 1 “You cannot love God and money at the same time”
6:25 s5uy rc://*/ta/man/translate/figs-you 0 Here the instances of “you” and “your” are all plural. (See: [[rc://*/ta/man/translate/figs-you]])
6:25 wcz4 λέγω ὑμῖν 1 This adds emphasis to what Jesus says next.
6:25 xdu1 ὑμῖν 1 Jesus is talking to a group of people about what they as individuals should or should not do.
6:25 nt96 rc://*/ta/man/translate/figs-rquestion οὐχὶ ἡ ψυχὴ πλεῖόν ἐστι τῆς τροφῆς, καὶ τὸ σῶμα τοῦ ἐνδύματος? 1 Jesus uses a question to teach the people. Alternate translation: “obviously life is more than what you eat, and your body is more than what you wear.” or “clearly there are things in life that are more imortant than food, and there are things concerning the body that are more important than clothes.” (See: [[rc://*/ta/man/translate/figs-rquestion]])
6:26 p11z ἀποθήκας 1 places to store crops
6:26 a9w6 rc://*/ta/man/translate/guidelines-sonofgodprinciples ὁ Πατὴρ 1 This is an important title for God. (See: [[rc://*/ta/man/translate/guidelines-sonofgodprinciples]])
6:26 nbm5 rc://*/ta/man/translate/figs-rquestion οὐχ ὑμεῖς μᾶλλον διαφέρετε αὐτῶν? 1 Jesus uses a question to teach the people. Alternate translation: “Obviously you are more valuable than birds.” (See: [[rc://*/ta/man/translate/figs-rquestion]])
6:27 cm6a rc://*/ta/man/translate/figs-you 0 Jesus is talking to a group of people about what they as individuals should or should not do. All instances of “you” and “your” are plural. (See: [[rc://*/ta/man/translate/figs-you]])
6:27 fr8g rc://*/ta/man/translate/figs-rquestion τίς δὲ ἐξ ὑμῶν μεριμνῶν δύναται προσθεῖναι ἐπὶ τὴν ἡλικίαν αὐτοῦ πῆχυν ἕνα? 1 Jesus uses a question to teach the people. Here to “add one cubit to his lifespan” is a metaphor for adding time to how long a person will live. Alternate translation: “None of you can, just by worrying, add years to your life. You cannot add even one minute to your life! So you should not worry about things you need.” (See: [[rc://*/ta/man/translate/figs-rquestion]] and [[rc://*/ta/man/translate/figs-metaphor]])
6:27 kub4 rc://*/ta/man/translate/translate-bdistance πῆχυν ἕνα 1 A cubit is a measure of a little less than half a meter. (See: [[rc://*/ta/man/translate/translate-bdistance]])
6:28 erj8 rc://*/ta/man/translate/figs-rquestion περὶ ἐνδύματος τί μεριμνᾶτε? 1 Jesus uses a question to teach the people. Alternate translation: “You should not be worried about what you will wear.” (See: [[rc://*/ta/man/translate/figs-rquestion]])
6:28 cs99 καταμάθετε 1 “Consider”
6:28 him2 rc://*/ta/man/translate/figs-personification τὰ κρίνα & αὐξάνουσιν; οὐ κοπιῶσιν οὐδὲ νήθουσιν 1 Jesus speaks about the lilies as if they were people who wore clothes. The lilies being clothed is a metaphor for the plants having beautiful and colorful flowers. (See: [[rc://*/ta/man/translate/figs-personification]] and [[rc://*/ta/man/translate/figs-metaphor]])
6:28 t16l rc://*/ta/man/translate/translate-unknown κρίνα 1 A lily is a kind of wild flower. (See: [[rc://*/ta/man/translate/translate-unknown]])
6:29 n75l rc://*/ta/man/translate/figs-personification οὐδὲ Σολομὼν ἐν πάσῃ τῇ δόξῃ αὐτοῦ περιεβάλετο ὡς ἓν τούτων 1 Jesus speaks about the lilies as if they were people who wore clothes. The lilies being clothed is a metaphor for the plants having beautiful and colorful flowers. (See: [[rc://*/ta/man/translate/figs-personification]] and [[rc://*/ta/man/translate/figs-metaphor]])
6:29 np9e λέγω & ὑμῖν 1 This adds emphasis to what Jesus says next.
6:29 sqg8 rc://*/ta/man/translate/figs-activepassive περιεβάλετο ὡς ἓν τούτων 1 This can be stated in active form. Alternate translation: “did not wear clothes that are as beautiful as these lilies” (See: [[rc://*/ta/man/translate/figs-activepassive]])
6:30 z5lh rc://*/ta/man/translate/figs-personification τὸν χόρτον τοῦ ἀγροῦ & οὕτως 1 Jesus continues to speak about the lilies as if they were people who wore clothes. The lilies being clothed is a metaphor for the plants having beautiful and colorful flowers. (See: [[rc://*/ta/man/translate/figs-personification]] and [[rc://*/ta/man/translate/figs-metaphor]])
6:30 uf36 χόρτον 1 If your language has a word that includes “grass” and the word you used for “lilies” in the previous verse, you can use it here.
6:30 m23l rc://*/ta/man/translate/figs-activepassive εἰς κλίβανον βαλλόμενον 1 The Jews at that time used grass in their fires to cook their food. This can be stated in active form. Alternate translation: “someone throws it into a fire” or “someone burns it” (See: [[rc://*/ta/man/translate/figs-activepassive]])
6:30 cd8w rc://*/ta/man/translate/figs-rquestion ἀμφιέννυσιν, οὐ πολλῷ μᾶλλον ὑμᾶς, ὀλιγόπιστοι? 1 Jesus uses this question to teach the people that God will provide what they need. Alternate translation: “he will certainly clothe you … faith.” (See: [[rc://*/ta/man/translate/figs-rquestion]])
6:30 ic18 ὑμᾶς, ὀλιγόπιστοι 1 “you who have such little faith.” Jesus addresses the people this way because their anxiety about clothing shows they have little faith in God.
6:31 jps3 οὖν 1 “Because of all of this”
6:31 pd6x rc://*/ta/man/translate/figs-synecdoche τί περιβαλώμεθα 1 In this sentence, “clothes” is a synecdoche for material possessions. Alternate translation: “What possessions will we have” (See: [[rc://*/ta/man/translate/figs-synecdoche]])
6:32 j77y γὰρ ταῦτα τὰ ἔθνη ἐπιζητοῦσιν 1 “for the Gentiles are concerned about what they will eat, drink, and wear”
6:32 ecb9 οἶδεν & ὁ Πατὴρ ὑμῶν ὁ οὐράνιος ὅτι χρῄζετε τούτων 1 Jesus is implying that God will make sure their basic needs are met.
6:32 unz1 rc://*/ta/man/translate/guidelines-sonofgodprinciples ὁ Πατὴρ 1 This is an important title for God. (See: [[rc://*/ta/man/translate/guidelines-sonofgodprinciples]])
6:33 ep2c rc://*/ta/man/translate/figs-metonymy ζητεῖτε & πρῶτον τὴν βασιλείαν καὶ τὴν δικαιοσύνην αὐτοῦ 1 Here “kingdom” refers to Gods rule as king. Alternate translation: “concern yourselves with serving God, who is your king, and doing what is right” (See: [[rc://*/ta/man/translate/figs-metonymy]])
6:33 ak39 rc://*/ta/man/translate/figs-activepassive καὶ ταῦτα πάντα προστεθήσεται ὑμῖν 1 This can be stated in active form. Alternate translation: “God will provide all these things for you” (See: [[rc://*/ta/man/translate/figs-activepassive]])
6:34 qm2a οὖν 1 “Because of all this”
6:34 xdg7 rc://*/ta/man/translate/figs-personification ἡ & αὔριον μεριμνήσει ἑαυτῆς 1 Jesus speaks of “tomorrow” as if it were a person who could worry. Jesus means that a person will have enough to worry about when the next day comes. (See: [[rc://*/ta/man/translate/figs-personification]])
7:intro bz7e 0 # Matthew 07 General Notes\n## Structure and formatting\n\nJesus spoke about many different subjects in this sermon, so you may wish to help the reader by putting an empty line into the text whenever Jesus changed the subject.\n\n## Special concepts in this chapter\n\n### Matthew 5-7\n\nMany people call the words in Matthew 5-7 the Sermon on the Mount. This is one long lesson that Jesus taught. Bibles divide this lesson into three chapters, but this can sometimes confuse the reader. If your translation divides the text into sections, be sure that the reader understands that the whole sermon is one large section.\n\n### “By their fruits you will know them”\n\nFruit is a common image in the scriptures. It is used to describe the results of either good or bad actions. In this chapter, good fruit is the result of living as God commands. (See: [[rc://*/tw/dict/bible/other/fruit]])
7:1 jav3 rc://*/ta/man/translate/figs-you 0 Jesus is talking to a group of people about what they as individuals should and should not do. The instances of “you” and the commands are plural. (See: [[rc://*/ta/man/translate/figs-you]])
7:1 f4fe 0 Jesus continues to teach his disciples in his Sermon on the Mount, which began in [Matthew 5:3](../05/03.md).
7:1 xk6w rc://*/ta/man/translate/figs-explicit μὴ κρίνετε 1 It is implied here that “judge” has the strong meaning of “condemn harshly” or “declare guilty.” Alternate translation: “Do not condemn people harshly” (See: [[rc://*/ta/man/translate/figs-explicit]])
7:1 bk8y rc://*/ta/man/translate/figs-activepassive μὴ κριθῆτε 1 This can be stated in active form. Alternate translation: “God will not condemn you harshly” (See: [[rc://*/ta/man/translate/figs-activepassive]])
7:2 f9nb γὰρ 1 Be sure the reader understands the statement in 7:2 is based on what Jesus said in 7:1.
7:2 kj24 rc://*/ta/man/translate/figs-activepassive ἐν ᾧ & κρίματι κρίνετε, κριθήσεσθε 1 This can be stated in active form. Alternate translation: “God will condemn you in the same way you condemn others” (See: [[rc://*/ta/man/translate/figs-activepassive]])
7:2 mt3d ᾧ μέτρῳ 1 Possible meanings are (1) this is the amount of punishment given or (2) this is the standard used for judgment.
7:2 wgh2 rc://*/ta/man/translate/figs-activepassive μετρηθήσεται ὑμῖν 1 This can be stated in active form. Alternate translation: “God will measure it out to you” (See: [[rc://*/ta/man/translate/figs-activepassive]])
7:3 hzb4 0 Jesus is talking to a group of people about what they as individuals should or should not do. The instances of “you” and “your” are all singular, but in some languages they may need to be plural.
7:3 em5r rc://*/ta/man/translate/figs-rquestion τί δὲ βλέπεις τὸ κάρφος & τὴν δὲ ἐν τῷ σῷ ὀφθαλμῷ δοκὸν οὐ κατανοεῖς? 1 Jesus uses this question to rebuke the people for paying attention to other peoples sins and ignoring their own. Alternate translation: “You look … brothers eye, but you do not notice the log that is in your own eye.” or “Do not look … brothers eye and ignore the log that is in your own eye.” (See: [[rc://*/ta/man/translate/figs-rquestion]])
7:3 ctb3 rc://*/ta/man/translate/figs-metaphor τὸ κάρφος τὸ ἐν τῷ ὀφθαλμῷ τοῦ ἀδελφοῦ σου 1 This is a metaphor that refers to the less important faults of a fellow believer. (See: [[rc://*/ta/man/translate/figs-metaphor]])
7:3 r9jf κάρφος 1 “speck” or “splinter” or “bit of dust.” Use a word for the smallest thing that commonly falls into a persons eyes.
7:3 d2qc τοῦ ἀδελφοῦ 1 All occurrences of “brother” in 7:3-5 refer to a fellow believer, not to a literal brother or a neighbor.
7:3 q1z4 rc://*/ta/man/translate/figs-metaphor τὴν & ἐν τῷ σῷ ὀφθαλμῷ δοκὸν 1 This is a metaphor for a persons most important faults. A log could not literally go into a persons eye. Jesus is exaggerating to emphasize that a person should pay attention to his own more important faults before he deals with another persons less important faults. (See: [[rc://*/ta/man/translate/figs-metaphor]] and [[rc://*/ta/man/translate/figs-hyperbole]])
7:3 cgc6 δοκὸν 1 the largest part of a tree that someone has cut down
7:4 k58h rc://*/ta/man/translate/figs-rquestion ἢ πῶς ἐρεῖς & τῷ ὀφθαλμῷ σοῦ? 1 Jesus asks this question to challenge the people to pay attention to their own sins before they pay attention to another persons sins. Alternate translation: “You should not say … your own eye.” (See: [[rc://*/ta/man/translate/figs-rquestion]])
7:6 av85 0 Jesus is talking to a group of people about what they as individuals should or should not do. The instances of “you” and “your” are all plural.
7:6 arm9 rc://*/ta/man/translate/figs-metaphor τοῖς κυσίν & τῶν χοίρων 1 Jews considered these animals dirty, and God told the Jews not to eat them. They are metaphors for wicked people who do not value holy things. It would be best to translate these words literally. (See: [[rc://*/ta/man/translate/figs-metaphor]])
7:6 xy2e rc://*/ta/man/translate/figs-metaphor τοὺς μαργαρίτας 1 These are similar to round, valuable stones or beads. They are a metaphor for the knowledge of God or precious things in general. (See: [[rc://*/ta/man/translate/figs-metaphor]])
7:6 vt72 καταπατήσουσιν 1 “the pigs may trample”
7:6 y5mm καὶ στραφέντες ῥήξωσιν ὑμᾶς 1 “the dogs will then turn and tear”
7:7 j1qa rc://*/ta/man/translate/figs-you 0 Jesus is talking to a group of people about what they as individuals should or should not do. The instances of “you” and “your” are all plural. (See: [[rc://*/ta/man/translate/figs-you]])
7:7 ut6i rc://*/ta/man/translate/figs-metaphor αἰτεῖτε & ζητεῖτε & κρούετε 1 These are metaphors for praying to God. The verb form shows that we are to keep praying until he answers. If your language has a form for continuing to do something over and over, use it here. (See: [[rc://*/ta/man/translate/figs-metaphor]])
7:7 fh57 αἰτεῖτε 1 request things from someone, in this case God
7:7 tv49 rc://*/ta/man/translate/figs-activepassive δοθήσεται ὑμῖν 1 This can be stated in active form. Alternate translation: “God will give you what you need” (See: [[rc://*/ta/man/translate/figs-activepassive]])
7:7 cs5b ζητεῖτε 1 look for someone, in this case God
7:7 rt8g κρούετε 1 To knock on a door was a polite way to request that the person inside the house or room open the door. If knocking on a door is impolite or not done in your culture, use the word that describes how people politely ask for doors to be opened. Alternate translation: “Tell God you want him to open the door”
7:7 zxs3 rc://*/ta/man/translate/figs-activepassive ἀνοιγήσεται ὑμῖν 1 This can be stated in active form. Alternate translation: “God will open it for you” (See: [[rc://*/ta/man/translate/figs-activepassive]])
7:9 mq14 rc://*/ta/man/translate/figs-rquestion ἢ τίς ἐστιν ἐξ ὑμῶν ἄνθρωπος & μὴ λίθον ἐπιδώσει αὐτῷ? 1 Jesus uses a question to teach the people. Alternate translation: “There is not one person among you … a stone.” (See: [[rc://*/ta/man/translate/figs-rquestion]])
7:9 n5s1 rc://*/ta/man/translate/figs-synecdoche ἄρτον 1 This refers to food in general. Alternate translation: “some food” (See: [[rc://*/ta/man/translate/figs-synecdoche]])
7:9 cq8h λίθον 1 This noun should be translated literally.
7:10 ht1m ἰχθὺν & ὄφι 1 These nouns should be translated literally.
7:10 y9q5 rc://*/ta/man/translate/figs-rquestion ἢ καὶ ἰχθὺν αἰτήσει, μὴ ὄφιν ἐπιδώσει αὐτῷ? 1 Jesus asks another question to teach the people. It is understood that Jesus is still referring to a man and his son. Alternate translation: “And there is not one person among you, if his son asks for a fish, will give him a snake.” (See: [[rc://*/ta/man/translate/figs-rquestion]] and [[rc://*/ta/man/translate/figs-ellipsis]])
7:11 h3k6 rc://*/ta/man/translate/figs-you 0 Jesus is talking to a group of people about what they as individuals should or should not do. The instances of “you” and “your” are plural. (See: [[rc://*/ta/man/translate/figs-you]])
7:11 pk31 rc://*/ta/man/translate/figs-rquestion πόσῳ μᾶλλον ὁ Πατὴρ ὑμῶν ὁ ἐν τοῖς οὐρανοῖς δώσει & αὐτόν? 1 Jesus uses a question to teach the people. Alternate translation: “then your Father in heaven will most certainly give … him.” (See: [[rc://*/ta/man/translate/figs-rquestion]])
7:11 z8zr rc://*/ta/man/translate/guidelines-sonofgodprinciples ὁ Πατὴρ 1 This is an important title for God. (See: [[rc://*/ta/man/translate/guidelines-sonofgodprinciples]])
7:12 wr93 ὅσα ἐὰν θέλητε ἵνα ποιῶσιν ὑμῖν οἱ ἄνθρωποι 1 “whatever way you want others to act toward you”
7:12 b1x2 rc://*/ta/man/translate/figs-metonymy οὗτος γάρ ἐστιν ὁ νόμος καὶ οἱ προφῆται 1 Here “law” and “prophets” refer to what Moses and the prophets wrote. Alternate translation: “for this is what Moses and the prophets teach in the scriptures” (See: [[rc://*/ta/man/translate/figs-metonymy]])
7:13 uhb3 0 This image of walking through a wide gate to destruction or a narrow gate to life represents how people live and the results of how they live. When you translate, use appropriate words for “wide” and “broad” that are as different as possible from “narrow” in order to emphasize the differences between the two sets of gates and ways.
7:13 dgr2 rc://*/ta/man/translate/figs-metaphor εἰσέλθατε διὰ τῆς στενῆς πύλης & πολλοί εἰσιν οἱ εἰσερχόμενοι δι’ αὐτῆς 1 This is an image of people traveling on a road and going through a gate into a kingdom. One kingdom is easy to enter; the other is hard to enter. (See: [[rc://*/ta/man/translate/figs-metaphor]])
7:13 j8xn εἰσέλθατε διὰ τῆς στενῆς πύλης 1 You may need to move this to the end of verse 14: “Therefore, enter through the narrow gate.”
7:13 y9ru τῆς & πύλης & ἡ ὁδὸς 1 Possible meanings are (1) “the way” refers to the road that leads to the gate of a kingdom, or (2) the “the gate” and “the way” both refer to the entrance to the kingdom.
7:13 zv24 rc://*/ta/man/translate/figs-abstractnouns εἰς τὴν ἀπώλειαν 1 This abstract noun can be translated with a verb. Alternate translation: “to the place where people die” (See: [[rc://*/ta/man/translate/figs-abstractnouns]])
7:14 x8u9 0 Jesus continues to speak of people choosing how they are going to live as if they are choosing whether to go on one path or another.
7:14 wlr9 rc://*/ta/man/translate/figs-abstractnouns εἰς τὴν ζωήν 1 The abstract noun “life” can be translated using the verb “live.” Alternate translation: “to the place where people live” (See: [[rc://*/ta/man/translate/figs-abstractnouns]])
7:15 s91c προσέχετε ἀπὸ 1 “Be on guard against”
7:15 lj5v rc://*/ta/man/translate/figs-metaphor οἵτινες ἔρχονται πρὸς ὑμᾶς ἐν ἐνδύμασι προβάτων, ἔσωθεν δέ εἰσιν λύκοι ἅρπαγες 1 This metaphor means that false prophets will pretend they are good and want to help people, but they are really evil and will do people harm. (See: [[rc://*/ta/man/translate/figs-metaphor]])
7:16 pul5 rc://*/ta/man/translate/figs-metaphor ἀπὸ τῶν καρπῶν αὐτῶν ἐπιγνώσεσθε αὐτούς 1 This metaphor refers to a persons actions. Alternate translation: “Just as you know a tree by the fruit that grows on it, you will know false prophets by how they act” (See: [[rc://*/ta/man/translate/figs-metaphor]])
7:16 nve4 rc://*/ta/man/translate/figs-rquestion μήτι συλλέγουσιν & ἢ ἀπὸ τριβόλων σῦκα? 1 Jesus uses a question to teach the people. The people would have known that the answer is no. Alternate translation: “People do not gather … thistles.” (See: [[rc://*/ta/man/translate/figs-rquestion]])
7:17 a9tn rc://*/ta/man/translate/figs-metaphor πᾶν δένδρον ἀγαθὸν καρποὺς καλοὺς ποιεῖ 1 Jesus continues to use the metaphor of fruit to refer to good prophets who produce good works or words. (See: [[rc://*/ta/man/translate/figs-metaphor]])
7:17 f5l3 rc://*/ta/man/translate/figs-metaphor τὸ & σαπρὸν δένδρον καρποὺς πονηροὺς ποιεῖ 1 Jesus continues to use the metaphor of fruit to refer to bad prophets who produce evil works. (See: [[rc://*/ta/man/translate/figs-metaphor]])
7:19 aeg4 rc://*/ta/man/translate/figs-metaphor πᾶν δένδρον μὴ ποιοῦν καρπὸν καλὸν ἐκκόπτεται καὶ εἰς πῦρ βάλλεται 1 Jesus continues to use fruit trees as a metaphor to refer to false prophets. Here, he only states what will happen to the bad trees. It is implied that the same thing will happen to the false prophets. (See: [[rc://*/ta/man/translate/figs-metaphor]] and [[rc://*/ta/man/translate/figs-explicit]])
7:19 g7fs rc://*/ta/man/translate/figs-activepassive ἐκκόπτεται καὶ εἰς πῦρ βάλλεται 1 This can be stated in active form. Alternate translation: “people cut down and burn” (See: [[rc://*/ta/man/translate/figs-activepassive]])
7:20 x87m rc://*/ta/man/translate/figs-metaphor ἀπὸ τῶν καρπῶν αὐτῶν ἐπιγνώσεσθε αὐτούς 1 The word “their” can refer to either the prophets or the trees. This metaphor implies that the fruit of trees and the deeds of prophets both reveal whether they are good or bad. If possible, translate this in a way so that it can refer to both trees and prophets. (See: [[rc://*/ta/man/translate/figs-metaphor]])
7:21 rj2v rc://*/ta/man/translate/figs-metonymy εἰσελεύσεται εἰς τὴν Βασιλείαν τῶν Οὐρανῶν 1 Here “kingdom of heaven” refers to Gods rule as king. The phrase “kingdom of heaven” is used only in the book of Matthew. If possible, keep “heaven” in your translation. Alternate translation: “will live with God in heaven when he shows himself to be king” (See: [[rc://*/ta/man/translate/figs-metonymy]])
7:21 rq5h ὁ ποιῶν τὸ θέλημα τοῦ Πατρός μου τοῦ ἐν τοῖς οὐρανοῖς 1 “whoever does what my Father in heaven desires”
7:21 c6yz rc://*/ta/man/translate/guidelines-sonofgodprinciples τοῦ Πατρός 1 This is an important title for God. (See: [[rc://*/ta/man/translate/guidelines-sonofgodprinciples]])
7:22 mp6e rc://*/ta/man/translate/figs-explicit ἐν ἐκείνῃ τῇ ἡμέρᾳ 1 Jesus said “that day” knowing his hearers would understand he was referring to the day of judgment. You should include “the day of judgment” only if your readers would not understand otherwise. (See: [[rc://*/ta/man/translate/figs-explicit]])
7:22 m9py rc://*/ta/man/translate/figs-rquestion ἐπροφητεύσαμεν & δαιμόνια ἐξεβάλομεν & δυνάμεις πολλὰς ἐποιήσαμεν? 1 The people use a question to emphasize that they did these things. Alternate translation: “we prophesied … we drove out demons … we did many mighty deeds.” (See: [[rc://*/ta/man/translate/figs-rquestion]])
7:22 t5j7 rc://*/ta/man/translate/figs-exclusive ἐπροφητεύσαμεν 1 This “we” does not include Jesus. (See: [[rc://*/ta/man/translate/figs-exclusive]])
7:22 hg17 rc://*/ta/man/translate/figs-metonymy τῷ σῷ ὀνόματι 1 Possible meanings are (1) “by your authority” or “by your power” or (2) “because we were doing what you wanted us to do” or (3) “because we asked you for the power to do it” (See: [[rc://*/ta/man/translate/figs-metonymy]])
7:22 p67f δυνάμεις 1 “miracles”
7:23 d4y5 rc://*/ta/man/translate/figs-idiom οὐδέποτε ἔγνων ὑμᾶς 1 This means the person does not belong to Jesus. Alternate translation: “You are not my follower” or “I have nothing to do with you” (See: [[rc://*/ta/man/translate/figs-idiom]])
7:24 fg9k οὖν 1 “For that reason”
7:24 hbd7 rc://*/ta/man/translate/figs-metonymy μου τοὺς λόγους τούτους 1 Here “words” refers to what Jesus says. (See: [[rc://*/ta/man/translate/figs-metonymy]])
7:24 qjh9 rc://*/ta/man/translate/figs-simile ὁμοιωθήσεται ἀνδρὶ φρονίμῳ, ὅστις ᾠκοδόμησεν αὐτοῦ τὴν οἰκίαν ἐπὶ τὴν πέτραν 1 Jesus compares those who obey his words to a person who builds his house where nothing can harm it. (See: [[rc://*/ta/man/translate/figs-simile]])
7:24 dy1f πέτραν 1 This is the bedrock below the topsoil and clay, not a large stone or boulder above the ground.
7:25 bv81 rc://*/ta/man/translate/figs-activepassive τεθεμελίωτο 1 This can be stated in active form. Alternate translation: “he built it” (See: [[rc://*/ta/man/translate/figs-activepassive]])
7:26 asf4 0 This is the end of Jesus Sermon on the Mount, which began in [Matthew 5:3](../05/03.md).
7:26 nw97 rc://*/ta/man/translate/figs-simile ὁμοιωθήσεται ἀνδρὶ μωρῷ, ὅστις ᾠκοδόμησεν αὐτοῦ τὴν οἰκίαν ἐπὶ τὴν ἄμμον 1 Jesus continues the simile from the previous verse. He compares those who do not obey his words to foolish house-builders. Only a fool would build a house on a sandy place where rain, floods, and wind can sweep the sand away. (See: [[rc://*/ta/man/translate/figs-simile]])
7:27 a7mj ἔπεσεν 1 Use the general word in your language that describes what happens when a house falls down.
7:27 k4hi ἦν ἡ πτῶσις αὐτῆς μεγάλη 1 The rain, floods, and wind completely destroyed the house.
7:28 jrh7 rc://*/ta/man/translate/writing-endofstory 0 These verses describe how the people in the crowds reacted to Jesus teaching in the Sermon on the Mount. (See: [[rc://*/ta/man/translate/writing-endofstory]])
7:28 hu6z καὶ ἐγένετο, ὅτε 1 This phrase shifts the story from Jesus teachings to what happened next. Alternate translation: “When” or “After”
7:28 b321 ἐξεπλήσσοντο & ἐπὶ τῇ διδαχῇ αὐτοῦ 1 It is clear in 7:29 that they were amazed not just at what Jesus taught but also the way he taught it. Alternate translation: “were amazed by the way he taught”
8:intro f33a 0 # Matthew 08 General Notes\n## Structure and formatting\n\nThis chapter begins a new section.\n\n## Special concepts in this chapter\n\n### Miracles\n\nJesus performed miracles to show that he could control things that no other people could control. He also showed that it is proper to worship him because he performed miracles. (See: [[rc://*/tw/dict/bible/kt/authority]])
8:1 qb1d rc://*/ta/man/translate/writing-newevent 0 This is the beginning of a new part of the story that contains several accounts of Jesus healing people. This theme continues through [Matthew 9:35](../09/35.md). (See: [[rc://*/ta/man/translate/writing-newevent]])
8:1 clf8 καταβάντος δὲ αὐτοῦ ἀπὸ τοῦ ὄρους, ἠκολούθησαν αὐτῷ ὄχλοι πολλοί 1 “After Jesus came down from the hill, a large crowd followed him.” The crowd may have included both people who had been with him on the mountain and people who had not been with him.
8:2 vas8 ἰδοὺ 1 The word “behold” alerts us to a new person in the story. Your language may have a way of doing this.
8:2 q4x2 λεπρὸς 1 “a man who had leprosy” or “a man who had a skin disease”
8:2 n77q rc://*/ta/man/translate/translate-symaction προσεκύνει αὐτῷ 1 This is a sign of humble respect before Jesus. (See: [[rc://*/ta/man/translate/translate-symaction]])
8:2 yc3f ἐὰν θέλῃς 1 “if you want to” or “if you desire.” The leper knew that Jesus had the power to heal him, but he did not know if Jesus would want to touch him.
8:2 yjn2 rc://*/ta/man/translate/figs-idiom δύνασαί με καθαρίσαι 1 Here “clean” means to be healed and to be able to live in the community again. Alternate translation: “you can heal me” or “please heal me” (See: [[rc://*/ta/man/translate/figs-idiom]])
8:3 kg7e rc://*/ta/man/translate/figs-imperative καθαρίσθητι 1 By saying this, Jesus healed the man. (See: [[rc://*/ta/man/translate/figs-imperative]])
8:3 eht7 εὐθέως ἐκαθαρίσθη 1 “At that moment he was cleansed”
8:3 lj1x rc://*/ta/man/translate/figs-activepassive ἐκαθαρίσθη αὐτοῦ ἡ λέπρα 1 The result of Jesus saying “Be clean” was that the man was healed. This can be stated in active form. Alternate translation: “he was well” or “the leprosy left him” or “the leprosy ended” (See: [[rc://*/ta/man/translate/figs-activepassive]])
8:4 gzy6 αὐτῷ 1 This refers to the man that Jesus just healed.
8:4 gt5s ὅρα μηδενὶ εἴπῃς 1 “do not say anything to anyone” or “do not tell anyone I healed you”
8:4 zi3a rc://*/ta/man/translate/figs-explicit σεαυτὸν, δεῖξον τῷ ἱερεῖ 1 Jewish law required that the person show his healed skin to the priest, who would then allow him or her to return to the community, to be with other people. (See: [[rc://*/ta/man/translate/figs-explicit]])
8:4 tq9l rc://*/ta/man/translate/figs-explicit προσένεγκον τὸ δῶρον ὃ προσέταξεν Μωϋσῆς, εἰς μαρτύριον αὐτοῖς 1 The law of Moses required that someone healed of leprosy give a thanksgiving offering to the priest. When the priest accepted the gift, people would know that the man had been healed. Lepers were ostracized, banned from the community, until they had proof of their healing. (See: [[rc://*/ta/man/translate/figs-explicit]])
8:4 rj8u rc://*/ta/man/translate/figs-pronouns αὐτοῖς 1 This can possibly refer to (1) the priests or (2) all the people or (3) the critics of Jesus. If possible, use a pronoun that could refer to any of these groups. (See: [[rc://*/ta/man/translate/figs-pronouns]])
8:5 sxz8 0 Here the scene shifts to a different time and place and tells of Jesus healing another person.
8:5 vzb9 προσῆλθεν αὐτῷ & παρακαλῶν αὐτὸν 1 Here “him” refers to Jesus.
8:6 cr8h παραλυτικός 1 unable to move because of disease or stroke
8:7 b9br λέγει αὐτῷ 1 “Jesus said to the centurion”
8:7 r3sx ἐγὼ ἐλθὼν, θεραπεύσω αὐτόν 1 “I will come to your house and make your servant well”
8:8 p7p4 rc://*/ta/man/translate/figs-idiom μου ὑπὸ τὴν στέγην 1 This is an idiom that refers to inside the house. Alternate translation: “into my house” (See: [[rc://*/ta/man/translate/figs-idiom]])
8:8 hig7 rc://*/ta/man/translate/figs-metonymy εἰπὲ λόγῳ 1 Here “word” represents a command. Alternate translation: “give the command” (See: [[rc://*/ta/man/translate/figs-metonymy]])
8:8 rk1z rc://*/ta/man/translate/figs-activepassive ἰαθήσεται 1 This can be stated in active form. Alternate translation: “will become well” (See: [[rc://*/ta/man/translate/figs-activepassive]])
8:9 ds2m rc://*/ta/man/translate/figs-activepassive ὑπὸ ἐξουσίαν, τασσόμενος 1 This can be stated in active form. Alternate translation: “who is under the authority of someone else” (See: [[rc://*/ta/man/translate/figs-activepassive]])
8:9 da25 rc://*/ta/man/translate/figs-idiom ὑπὸ ἐξουσίαν & ὑπ’ ἐμαυτὸν 1 To be “under” someone means to be less important and to obey the commands of someone more important. (See: [[rc://*/ta/man/translate/figs-idiom]])
8:10 rc1h ἀμὴν, λέγω ὑμῖν 1 “I tell you the truth.” This phrase adds emphasis to what Jesus says next.
8:10 c7y6 rc://*/ta/man/translate/figs-explicit παρ’ οὐδενὶ τοσαύτην πίστιν ἐν τῷ Ἰσραὴλ εὗρον 1 Jesus hearers would have thought that the Jews in Israel, who claim to be children of God, would have greater faith than anyone. Jesus is saying they are wrong and that the centurions faith was greater. (See: [[rc://*/ta/man/translate/figs-explicit]])
8:11 xee4 rc://*/ta/man/translate/figs-you ὑμῖν 1 Here “you” is plural and refers to “those who were following him” in [Matthew 8:10](../08/10.md). (See: [[rc://*/ta/man/translate/figs-you]])
8:11 mt2i rc://*/ta/man/translate/figs-merism ἀπὸ ἀνατολῶν καὶ δυσμῶν 1 Using the opposites “east” and “west” is a way of saying “everywhere.” Alternate translation: “from everywhere” or “from far away in every direction” (See: [[rc://*/ta/man/translate/figs-merism]])
8:11 u4sj rc://*/ta/man/translate/figs-metonymy ἀνακλιθήσονται 1 People in that culture would lie down beside the table while eating. This phrase indicates that all those at the table are family and close friends. The joy in the kingdom of God is frequently spoken of as if the people there were feasting. Alternate translation: “live as family and friends” (See: [[rc://*/ta/man/translate/figs-metonymy]])
8:11 qmc7 rc://*/ta/man/translate/figs-metonymy ἐν τῇ Βασιλεία τῶν Οὐρανῶν 1 Here “kingdom of heaven” refers to Gods rule as king. The phrase “kingdom of heaven” is used only in the book of Matthew. If possible, keep “heaven” in your translation. Alternate translation: “when our God in heaven shows that he is king” (See: [[rc://*/ta/man/translate/figs-metonymy]])
8:12 ks3b rc://*/ta/man/translate/figs-activepassive οἱ & υἱοὶ τῆς βασιλείας ἐκβληθήσονται 1 This can be stated in active form. Alternate translation: “God will throw the sons of the kingdom” (See: [[rc://*/ta/man/translate/figs-activepassive]])
8:12 aug7 rc://*/ta/man/translate/figs-metonymy οἱ δὲ υἱοὶ τῆς βασιλείας 1 The phrase “sons of” is a metonym, referring to the unbelieving Jews of the kingdom of Judea. There is also irony here because the “sons” will be thrown out while the strangers will be welcomed. Alternate translation: “those who should have allowed God to rule over them” (See: [[rc://*/ta/man/translate/figs-metonymy]] and [[rc://*/ta/man/translate/figs-irony]])
8:12 liu4 rc://*/ta/man/translate/figs-metonymy τὸ σκότος τὸ ἐξώτερον 1 Here “outer darkness” is a metonym for the place where God sends those who reject them. This is a place that is completely separated from God forever. Alternate translation: “the dark place away from God” (See: [[rc://*/ta/man/translate/figs-metonymy]])
8:12 gww4 rc://*/ta/man/translate/translate-symaction ὁ κλαυθμὸς καὶ ὁ βρυγμὸς τῶν ὀδόντων 1 “Grinding of teeth” here is a symbolic act, representing extreme sadness and suffering. Alternate translation: “weeping and showing their extreme suffering” (See: [[rc://*/ta/man/translate/translate-symaction]])
8:13 ki92 rc://*/ta/man/translate/figs-activepassive γενηθήτω σοι 1 This can be stated in active form. Alternate translation: “so I will do it for you” (See: [[rc://*/ta/man/translate/figs-activepassive]])
8:13 sdn6 rc://*/ta/man/translate/figs-activepassive ἰάθη ὁ παῖς 1 This can be stated in active form. Alternate translation: “Jesus healed the servant” (See: [[rc://*/ta/man/translate/figs-activepassive]])
8:13 ln7p ἐν τῇ ὥρᾳ ἐκείνῃ 1 “at the exact time Jesus said he would heal the servant”
8:14 s6g4 0 Here the scene shifts to a different time and place and tells of Jesus healing another person.
8:14 ja31 ἐλθὼν ὁ Ἰησοῦς 1 The disciples were probably with Jesus, but the focus of the story is on what Jesus said and did, so introduce the disciples only if needed to avoid wrong meaning.
8:14 ynh8 τὴν πενθερὰν αὐτοῦ 1 “the mother of Peters wife”
8:15 w7nh rc://*/ta/man/translate/figs-personification ἀφῆκεν αὐτὴν ὁ πυρετός 1 If your language would understand this personification to mean that the fever could think and act on its own, this can be translated as “she became better” or “Jesus healed her.” (See: [[rc://*/ta/man/translate/figs-personification]])
8:15 r9lt ἠγέρθη 1 “got out of bed”
8:16 bpx7 0 In verse 17, Matthew quotes the prophet Isaiah to show that Jesus healing ministry was a fulfillment of prophecy.
8:16 b7cx 0 Here the scene shifts to later that evening and tells of Jesus healing more people and casting out demons.
8:16 yv9y rc://*/ta/man/translate/figs-explicit ὀψίας δὲ γενομένης 1 Because Jews did not work or travel on the Sabbath, “evening” may imply after the Sabbath. They waited until evening to bring people to Jesus. You do not need to mention the Sabbath unless you need to avoid wrong meaning. (See: [[rc://*/ta/man/translate/figs-explicit]])
8:16 pwr4 rc://*/ta/man/translate/figs-activepassive δαιμονιζομένους πολλούς 1 This can be stated in active form. Alternate translation: “many people whom demons possessed” or “many people whom demons controlled” (See: [[rc://*/ta/man/translate/figs-activepassive]])
8:16 f1cv rc://*/ta/man/translate/figs-metonymy ἐξέβαλεν τὰ πνεύματα λόγῳ 1 Here “word” stands for a command. Alternate translation: “He commanded the spirits to leave” (See: [[rc://*/ta/man/translate/figs-metonymy]])
8:17 r3dc rc://*/ta/man/translate/figs-activepassive πληρωθῇ τὸ ῥηθὲν διὰ Ἠσαΐου τοῦ προφήτου 1 This can be stated in active form. Alternate translation: “Jesus fulfilled the prophecy that the prophet Isaiah had spoken to the people of Israel” (See: [[rc://*/ta/man/translate/figs-activepassive]])
8:17 eyu9 rc://*/ta/man/translate/figs-parallelism τὰς ἀσθενείας ἡμῶν ἔλαβεν καὶ τὰς νόσους ἐβάστασεν 1 Matthew is quoting the prophet Isaiah. These two phrases mean basically the same thing and emphasize that he healed all of our diseases. Alternate translation: “healed those who were sick and made them well” (See: [[rc://*/ta/man/translate/figs-parallelism]])
8:18 h8bx 0 Here the scene shifts and tells about Jesus response to some people who wanted to follow him.
8:18 dqh1 δὲ 1 This word is used here to mark a break in the main story line. Here Matthew starts to tell a new part of the story.
8:18 a2pn ἐκέλευσεν 1 “he told his disciples”
8:19 g4rh καὶ 1 This means after Jesus “gave instructions” but before he could get into the boat.
8:19 e1b7 ὅπου ἐὰν 1 to any place
8:20 pqp6 rc://*/ta/man/translate/writing-proverbs αἱ ἀλώπεκες φωλεοὺς ἔχουσιν καὶ τὰ πετεινὰ τοῦ οὐρανοῦ κατασκηνώσεις 1 Jesus answers with this proverb. This means even wild animals have somewhere to rest. (See: [[rc://*/ta/man/translate/writing-proverbs]])
8:20 tp9s rc://*/ta/man/translate/translate-unknown αἱ ἀλώπεκες 1 Foxes are animals like dogs. They eat nesting birds and other small animals. If foxes are unknown in your area, use a general term for dog-like creatures or other furry animals. (See: [[rc://*/ta/man/translate/translate-unknown]])
8:20 rrb5 φωλεοὺς 1 Foxes make holes in the ground to live in. Use the appropriate word for the place where the animal you use for “foxes” lives.
8:20 qvm5 rc://*/ta/man/translate/figs-123person ὁ & Υἱὸς τοῦ Ἀνθρώπου 1 Jesus is speaking about himself. (See: [[rc://*/ta/man/translate/figs-123person]])
8:20 yl4s rc://*/ta/man/translate/figs-idiom οὐκ ἔχει ποῦ τὴν κεφαλὴν κλίνῃ 1 This refers to a place to sleep. Alternate translation: “no place of his own to sleep” (See: [[rc://*/ta/man/translate/figs-idiom]])
8:21 hlx9 ἐπίτρεψόν μοι πρῶτον ἀπελθεῖν καὶ θάψαι τὸν πατέρα μου 1 It is unclear whether the mans father has died and he will bury him immediately, or if the man wants to stay for a longer amount of time until his father dies so he can bury him then. The main point is that the man wants to do something else first before he follows Jesus.
8:22 h7fb rc://*/ta/man/translate/figs-metaphor ἄφες τοὺς νεκροὺς θάψαι τοὺς ἑαυτῶν νεκρούς 1 Jesus does not mean literally that dead people will bury other dead people. Possible meanings of “the dead”: (1) it is a metaphor for those who will soon die, or (2) it is a metaphor for those who do not follow Jesus and are spiritually dead. The main point is that a disciple must not let anything delay him from following Jesus. (See: [[rc://*/ta/man/translate/figs-metaphor]])
8:23 us1s 0 Here the scene shifts to the account of Jesus calming a storm as he and his disciples cross the Sea of Galilee.
8:23 e8k1 καὶ ἐμβάντι αὐτῷ εἰς πλοῖον 1 “got onto a boat”
8:23 sl7v ἠκολούθησαν αὐτῷ οἱ μαθηταὶ αὐτοῦ 1 Try to use the same words for “disciple” and “follow” that you used in ([Matthew 8:21-22](./21.md)).
8:24 j55j ἰδοὺ 1 This marks the beginning of another event in the larger story. Your language may have a way of showing this. Alternate translation: “Suddenly” or “Without warning”
8:24 x7k1 rc://*/ta/man/translate/figs-activepassive σεισμὸς μέγας ἐγένετο ἐν τῇ θαλάσσῃ 1 This can be stated in active form. Alternate translation: “a powerful storm arose on the sea” (See: [[rc://*/ta/man/translate/figs-activepassive]])
8:24 m6w8 rc://*/ta/man/translate/figs-activepassive ὥστε τὸ πλοῖον καλύπτεσθαι ὑπὸ τῶν κυμάτων 1 This can be stated in active form. Alternate translation: “so that the waves covered the boat” (See: [[rc://*/ta/man/translate/figs-activepassive]])
8:25 k2hd ἤγειραν αὐτὸν λέγοντες, Κύριε, σῶσον 1 Possible meanings are (1) they first woke Jesus and then they said, “Save us” or (2) as they were waking Jesus up, they were saying “Save us.”
8:25 b2wh rc://*/ta/man/translate/figs-exclusive σῶσον & ἀπολλύμεθα 1 If you need to translate these words as inclusive or exclusive, then inclusive is best. The disciples probably meant they wanted Jesus to save the disciples and himself from drowning. (See: [[rc://*/ta/man/translate/figs-exclusive]])
8:25 xf5d ἀπολλύμεθα 1 “we are going to die”
8:26 jmt8 αὐτοῖς 1 “to the disciples”
8:26 g8p7 rc://*/ta/man/translate/figs-rquestion τί δειλοί ἐστε, ὀλιγόπιστοι 1 Jesus was rebuking the disciples with this rhetorical question. Alternate translation: “You should not be afraid … faith!” or “There is nothing for you to be afraid of … faith!” (See: [[rc://*/ta/man/translate/figs-rquestion]])
8:26 r5ve ὀλιγόπιστοι 1 “you who have such little faith.” Jesus addresses his disciples this way because their anxiety about the storm shows they have little faith in him to control it. See how you translated this in [Matthew 6:30](../06/30.md).
8:27 u2qh rc://*/ta/man/translate/figs-rquestion ποταπός ἐστιν οὗτος, ὅτι καὶ οἱ ἄνεμοι καὶ ἡ θάλασσα αὐτῷ ὑπακούουσιν 1 “Even the winds and the sea obey him! What sort of man is this?” This rhetorical question shows that the disciples were surprised. Alternate translation: “This man is unlike any man we have ever seen! Even the wind and the waves obey him!” (See: [[rc://*/ta/man/translate/figs-rquestion]])
8:27 k5mk rc://*/ta/man/translate/figs-personification καὶ οἱ ἄνεμοι καὶ ἡ θάλασσα αὐτῷ ὑπακούουσιν 1 For people or animals to obey or disobey is not surprising, but for wind and water to obey is very surprising. This personification describes the natural elements as being able to hear and respond like people. (See: [[rc://*/ta/man/translate/figs-personification]])
8:28 g6mr 0 Here the author returns to the theme of Jesus healing people. This begins an account of Jesus healing two demon-possessed men.
8:28 iy7a εἰς τὸ πέραν 1 “to the other side of the Sea of Galilee”
8:28 yzi6 rc://*/ta/man/translate/translate-names τὴν χώραν τῶν Γαδαρηνῶν 1 The Gadarenes were named after the town of Gadara. (See: [[rc://*/ta/man/translate/translate-names]])
8:28 hz5n rc://*/ta/man/translate/figs-activepassive δύο δαιμονιζόμενοι 1 This can be stated in active form. Alternate translation: “two men whom demons possessed” or “two men whom demons were controlling” (See: [[rc://*/ta/man/translate/figs-activepassive]])
8:28 ylu6 ἐξερχόμενοι, χαλεποὶ λείαν ὥστε μὴ ἰσχύειν τινὰ παρελθεῖν διὰ τῆς ὁδοῦ ἐκείνης 1 The demons that were controlling these two men were so dangerous that no one could go through that area.
8:29 v9mp ἰδοὺ 1 This marks the beginning of another event in the larger story. Your language may have a way of showing this.
8:29 gr2p rc://*/ta/man/translate/figs-rquestion τί ἡμῖν καὶ σοί, Υἱὲ τοῦ Θεοῦ? 1 The demons use a question but they are being hostile toward Jesus. Alternate translation: “Do not bother us, Son of God!” (See: [[rc://*/ta/man/translate/figs-rquestion]])
8:29 jcq6 rc://*/ta/man/translate/guidelines-sonofgodprinciples Υἱὲ τοῦ Θεοῦ 1 This is an important title for Jesus, which describes his relationship to God. (See: [[rc://*/ta/man/translate/guidelines-sonofgodprinciples]])
8:29 u4jr rc://*/ta/man/translate/figs-rquestion ἦλθες ὧδε πρὸ καιροῦ βασανίσαι ἡμᾶς 1 Again, the demons use a question in a hostile way. Alternate translation: “You should not disobey God by punishing us before the specific time God has set when he will punish us!” (See: [[rc://*/ta/man/translate/figs-rquestion]])
8:30 v91c rc://*/ta/man/translate/writing-background δὲ 1 This word is used here to mark a break in the main story line. Here Matthew tells background information about a herd of pigs that had been there before Jesus arrived. (See: [[rc://*/ta/man/translate/writing-background]])
8:31 tf32 rc://*/ta/man/translate/figs-explicit εἰ ἐκβάλλεις ἡμᾶς 1 It is implied that the demons knew that Jesus was going to cast them out. Alternate translation: “Because you are going to cast us out” (See: [[rc://*/ta/man/translate/figs-explicit]])
8:31 cgf7 rc://*/ta/man/translate/figs-exclusive ἡμᾶς 1 This is exclusive, meaning the demons only. (See: [[rc://*/ta/man/translate/figs-exclusive]])
8:32 h86e αὐτοῖς 1 This refers to the demons inside the men.
8:32 gtx2 οἱ & ἐξελθόντες ἀπῆλθον εἰς τοὺς χοίρους 1 “The demons left the man and entered the pigs”
8:32 qa1i ἰδοὺ 1 This alerts us to pay attention to the surprising information that follows.
8:32 lhn7 ὥρμησεν & κατὰ τοῦ κρημνοῦ 1 “ran quickly down the steep slope”
8:32 zk2p ἀπέθανον ἐν τοῖς ὕδασιν 1 “they fell into the water and drowned”
8:33 qmc5 0 This concludes the account of Jesus healing two demon-possessed men.
8:33 v39w οἱ & βόσκοντες 1 “taking care of the pigs”
8:33 ev2w rc://*/ta/man/translate/figs-activepassive τὰ τῶν δαιμονιζομένων 1 This can be stated in active form. Alternate translation: “what Jesus did to help the men whom demons had controlled” (See: [[rc://*/ta/man/translate/figs-activepassive]])
8:34 b2hp ἰδοὺ 1 This marks the beginning of another event in the larger story. It may involve different people than the previous events. Your language may have a way of showing this.
8:34 j6sp rc://*/ta/man/translate/figs-metonymy πᾶσα ἡ πόλις 1 The word “city” is a metonym for the people of the city. The word “all” is probably an exaggeration to emphasize how very many people came out. Not necessarily every person came out. (See: [[rc://*/ta/man/translate/figs-metonymy]] and [[rc://*/ta/man/translate/figs-hyperbole]])
8:34 bsf4 τῶν ὁρίων αὐτῶν 1 “their area”
9:intro tg41 0 # Matthew 09 General Notes\n## Special concepts in this chapter\n\n### “Sinners”\n\nWhen the people of Jesus time spoke of “sinners,” they were talking about people who did not obey the law of Moses and instead committed sins like stealing or sexual sins. When Jesus said that he came to call “sinners,” he meant that only people who believe that they are sinners can be his followers. This is true even if they are not what most people think of as “sinners.” (See: [[rc://*/tw/dict/bible/kt/sin]])\n\n## Other possible translation difficulties in this chapter\n\n### Passive voice\n\nMany sentences in this chapter tell that a person had something happen to him without saying who caused that something to happen. You may have to translate the sentence so that it tells the reader who performed the action. (See: [[rc://*/ta/man/translate/figs-activepassive]])\n\n### Rhetorical questions\n\nSpeakers in this chapter asked questions to which they already knew the answer. They asked the questions to show that they were not happy with the hearers or to teach them or to get them to think. Your language may have another way of doing this. (See: [[rc://*/ta/man/translate/figs-rquestion]])\n\n### Proverbs\n\nProverbs are very short sentences that use words that are easy to remember to tell about something that is generally true. People who understand proverbs usually have to know much about the language and culture of the speaker. When you translate the proverbs in this chapter, you may have to use many more words than the speakers used so that you can add information that the hearers knew but your reader do not know. (See: [[rc://*/ta/man/translate/writing-proverbs]])
9:1 nl8w 0 Matthew returns to the theme, which he began in [Matthew 8:1](../08/01.md), of Jesus healing people. This begins an account of Jesus healing a paralyzed man.
9:1 ly42 rc://*/ta/man/translate/figs-activepassive ἐμβὰς εἰς πλοῖον 1 It is implied that the disciples were with Jesus. (See: [[rc://*/ta/man/translate/figs-activepassive]])
9:1 cs8l πλοῖον 1 This is probably the same boat as in [Matthew 8:23](../08/23.md). You only need to specify this if needed to avoid confusion.
9:1 lje9 εἰς τὴν ἰδίαν πόλιν 1 “to the town where he lived.” This refers to Capernaum.
9:2 i6xp ἰδοὺ 1 This marks the beginning of another event in the larger story. It may involve different people than the previous events. Your language may have a way of showing this.
9:2 szd4 προσέφερον 1 “some men from the city”
9:2 k5eh τὴν πίστιν αὐτῶν 1 This refers to the faith of the men and may also include the faith of the paralyzed man.
9:2 k9qq τέκνον 1 The man was not Jesus real son. Jesus was speaking to him politely. If this is confusing, it can also be translated “My friend” or “Young man” or even omitted.
9:2 iys2 rc://*/ta/man/translate/figs-activepassive ἀφίενταί σου αἱ ἁμαρτίαι 1 This can be stated in active form. Alternate translation: “I have forgiven your sins” (See: [[rc://*/ta/man/translate/figs-activepassive]])
9:3 a35d ἰδού 1 This marks the beginning of another event in the larger story. It may involve different people than the previous events. Your language may have a way of doing this.
9:3 f88r ἐν ἑαυτοῖς 1 Possible meanings are (1) each one was thinking to himself, or (2) they were speaking among themselves.
9:3 mq8v βλασφημεῖ 1 Jesus was claiming to be able to do things the scribes thought only God can do.
9:4 u643 ἰδὼν & τὰς ἐνθυμήσεις αὐτῶν 1 Jesus knew what they were thinking either supernaturally or because he could see them talking to each other.
9:4 n4yl rc://*/ta/man/translate/figs-rquestion ἵνα τί ἐνθυμεῖσθε πονηρὰ ἐν ταῖς καρδίαις ὑμῶν? 1 Jesus used this question to rebuke the scribes. (See: [[rc://*/ta/man/translate/figs-rquestion]])
9:4 qg52 πονηρὰ 1 This is moral evil or wickedness, not simply error in fact.
9:4 d499 rc://*/ta/man/translate/figs-metonymy ἐν ταῖς καρδίαις ὑμῶν 1 Here “hearts” refers to their minds or their thoughts. (See: [[rc://*/ta/man/translate/figs-metonymy]])
9:5 j716 rc://*/ta/man/translate/figs-rquestion τί γάρ ἐστιν εὐκοπώτερον εἰπεῖν, ἀφέωνται σου αἱ ἁμαρτίαι, ἢ εἰπεῖν, ἔγειρε καὶ περιπάτει? 1 Jesus uses this question to make the scribes think about what might prove whether or not he could really forgive sins. Alternate translation: “I just said Your sins are forgiven. You may think that it is harder to say Get up and walk, because the proof of whether or not I can heal the man will be shown by whether or not he gets up and walks.” or “You may think that it is easier to say Your sins are forgiven than it is to say Get up and walk.’” (See: [[rc://*/ta/man/translate/figs-rquestion]])
9:5 mk14 rc://*/ta/man/translate/figs-quotations τί & ἐστιν εὐκοπώτερον εἰπεῖν, ἀφέωνται σου αἱ ἁμαρτίαι, ἢ εἰπεῖν, ἔγειρε καὶ περιπάτει? 1 The quotes can be translated as indirect quotes. Alternate translation: “which is easier, to tell someone that his sins are forgiven, or to tell him to get up and walk?” or “you may think that it is easier to tell someone that his sins are forgiven than to tell him to get up and walk.” (See: [[rc://*/ta/man/translate/figs-quotations]])
9:5 g88p rc://*/ta/man/translate/figs-you ἀφέωνται σου αἱ ἁμαρτίαι 1 Here “your” is singular. This can be stated in active form. Alternate translation: “I have forgiven your sins” (See: [[rc://*/ta/man/translate/figs-you]] and [[rc://*/ta/man/translate/figs-activepassive]])
9:6 gk68 rc://*/ta/man/translate/figs-you ἵνα δὲ εἰδῆτε 1 “I will prove to you.” The “you” is plural. (See: [[rc://*/ta/man/translate/figs-you]])
9:6 n5sf rc://*/ta/man/translate/figs-you σου τὴν κλίνην & τὸν οἶκόν σου 1 Here “you” is singular. (See: [[rc://*/ta/man/translate/figs-you]])
9:6 td1z ὕπαγε εἰς τὸν οἶκόν σου 1 Jesus is not forbidding the man to go elsewhere. He is giving the man the opportunity to go home.
9:7 uwq4 0 This concludes the account of Jesus healing a paralyzed man. Jesus then calls a tax collector to be one of his disciples.
9:8 u8qu τὸν δόντα 1 “because he had given”
9:8 x71s ἐξουσίαν τοιαύτην 1 This refers to the authority to declare sins forgiven.
9:9 fkr2 καὶ παράγων ὁ Ἰησοῦς ἐκεῖθεν 1 This phrase marks the beginning of a new part of the story. If your language has a way for doing this, you could consider using it here.
9:9 g4r4 παράγων 1 “was leaving” or “was going”
9:9 jc18 Μαθθαῖον & αὐτῷ & αὐτῷ 1 Church tradition says that this Matthew is the author of this Gospel, but the text gives no reason to change the pronouns from “him” and “He” to “me” and “I.”
9:9 t5ip λέγει αὐτῷ 1 “Jesus said to Matthew”
9:9 q438 ἀναστὰς, ἠκολούθησεν αὐτῷ 1 “Matthew got up and followed Jesus.” This means Matthew became Jesus disciple.
9:10 h7u9 0 These events occur at the house of Matthew the tax collector.
9:10 ksr5 τῇ οἰκίᾳ 1 This is probably Matthews house, but it could also be Jesus house. Specify only if needed to avoid confusion.
9:10 c751 ἰδοὺ 1 This marks the beginning of another event in the larger story. It may involve different people than the previous events. Your language may have a way of doing this.
9:10 f9lh ἁμαρτωλοὶ 1 people who did not obey the law of Moses but committed what others thought were very bad sins
9:11 ge2u καὶ ἰδόντες, οἱ Φαρισαῖοι 1 “When the Pharisees saw that Jesus was eating with the tax collectors and sinful people”
9:11 z4h5 rc://*/ta/man/translate/figs-rquestion διὰ τί μετὰ τῶν τελωνῶν καὶ ἁμαρτωλῶν ἐσθίει ὁ διδάσκαλος ὑμῶν? 1 The Pharisees use this question to criticize what Jesus is doing. (See: [[rc://*/ta/man/translate/figs-rquestion]])
9:12 xz13 0 These events occur at the house of Matthew the tax collector.
9:12 m7fm ὁ δὲ ἀκούσας 1 Here “this” refers to the question the Pharisees asked about Jesus eating with tax collectors and sinners.
9:12 tl42 rc://*/ta/man/translate/writing-proverbs οὐ χρείαν ἔχουσιν οἱ ἰσχύοντες ἰατροῦ, ἀλλὰ οἱ κακῶς ἔχοντες 1 Jesus answers with a proverb. He means that he eats with these kinds of people because he has come to help sinners. (See: [[rc://*/ta/man/translate/writing-proverbs]])
9:12 uhc5 οἱ ἰσχύοντες ἰατροῦ 1 “People who are healthy”
9:12 h5pg ἰατροῦ 1 doctor
9:12 n33c rc://*/ta/man/translate/figs-ellipsis οἱ κακῶς ἔχοντες 1 The phrase “need a physician” is understood. Alternate translation: “people who are sick need a physician” (See: [[rc://*/ta/man/translate/figs-ellipsis]])
9:13 fu2r πορευθέντες δὲ, μάθετε τί ἐστιν 1 Jesus is about to quote the scriptures. Alternate translation: “You should learn the meaning of what God said in the scriptures”
9:13 is3t rc://*/ta/man/translate/figs-you πορευθέντες 1 Here “you” is plural and refers to the Pharisees. (See: [[rc://*/ta/man/translate/figs-you]])
9:13 tqr3 ἔλεος θέλω καὶ οὐ θυσίαν 1 Jesus is quoting what the prophet Hosea wrote in the scriptures. Here, “I” refers to God.
9:13 djt7 οὐ γὰρ ἦλθον 1 Here “I” refers to Jesus.
9:13 a886 rc://*/ta/man/translate/figs-irony δικαίους 1 Jesus is using irony. He does not think there are any people who are righteous and do not need to repent. Alternate translation: “those who think they are righteous” (See: [[rc://*/ta/man/translate/figs-irony]])
9:14 aa3c 0 The disciples of John the Baptist question the fact that Jesus disciples do not fast.
9:14 k8vc οὐ νηστεύουσιν 1 “continue to eat regularly”
9:15 r8if rc://*/ta/man/translate/figs-rquestion μὴ δύνανται οἱ υἱοὶ τοῦ νυμφῶνος πενθεῖν, ἐφ’ ὅσον μετ’ αὐτῶν ἐστιν ὁ νυμφίος? 1 Jesus uses a question to answer Johns disciples. They all knew that people do not mourn and fast at a wedding celebration. Jesus uses this proverb to show that his disciples do not mourn because he is still there with them. (See: [[rc://*/ta/man/translate/figs-rquestion]] and [[rc://*/ta/man/translate/writing-proverbs]])
9:15 iz9s ἐλεύσονται δὲ ἡμέραι ὅταν 1 This is a way of referring to some time in the future. Alternate translation: “the time will come when” or “someday”
9:15 p6hz rc://*/ta/man/translate/figs-activepassive ἀπαρθῇ ἀπ’ αὐτῶν ὁ νυμφίος 1 This can be stated in active form. Alternate translation: “the bridegroom will not be able to be with them any longer” or “someone will take the bridegroom away from them” (See: [[rc://*/ta/man/translate/figs-activepassive]])
9:15 u8er ἀπαρθῇ 1 Jesus is probably referring to his own death, but this should not be made explicit here in the translation. To maintain the imagery of a wedding, it is best to just state that the bridegroom will not be there any longer.
9:16 v4a1 0 Jesus continues to answer the question that the disciples of John had asked. He did this by giving two examples of old things and new things that people do not put together.
9:16 yf98 οὐδεὶς δὲ ἐπιβάλλει ἐπίβλημα ῥάκους ἀγνάφου ἐπὶ ἱματίῳ παλαιῷ 1 “No one sews a piece of new cloth on an old garment” or “People do not sew a piece of new cloth as a patch an old garment”
9:16 bk47 ἱματίῳ παλαιῷ & τοῦ ἱματίου 1 “old clothing … the clothing””
9:16 x752 αἴρει & τὸ πλήρωμα αὐτοῦ ἀπὸ τοῦ ἱματίου 1 If someone were to wash the garment, the patch of new cloth would shrink, but the old garment would not shrink. This would tear the patch off the garment and leave a bigger hole.
9:16 rem6 τὸ πλήρωμα αὐτοῦ 1 “the piece of new cloth.” This is the piece of cloth used to cover a hole in the old garment.
9:16 t71t rc://*/ta/man/translate/figs-activepassive χεῖρον σχίσμα γίνεται 1 This can be stated in active form. Alternate translation: “this will make the tear worse” (See: [[rc://*/ta/man/translate/figs-activepassive]])
9:17 q9wh 0 Jesus continues to answer the question that disciples of John had asked.
9:17 s13y οὐδὲ βάλλουσιν οἶνον νέον εἰς ἀσκοὺς παλαιούς 1 Jesus uses another proverb to answer Johns disciples. This means the same as the proverb in [Matthew 9:16](../09/16.md).
9:17 fbl3 οὐδὲ βάλλουσιν 1 “Neither does anyone pour” or “People never put”
9:17 h26e rc://*/ta/man/translate/translate-unknown οἶνον νέον 1 This refers to wine that has not fermented yet. If grapes are unknown in your area, use the general term for fruit. Alternate translation: “grape juice” (See: [[rc://*/ta/man/translate/translate-unknown]])
9:17 dpv4 ἀσκοὺς παλαιούς 1 This refers to wineskins that have stretched and dried out because they were already used for fermenting wine.
9:17 v4x2 ἀσκοὺς 1 “wine bags” or “skin bags.” These were bags made out of animal skins.
9:17 hv8f rc://*/ta/man/translate/figs-activepassive ὁ οἶνος ἐκχεῖται καὶ οἱ ἀσκοὶ ἀπόλλυνται 1 This can be stated in active form. Alternate translation: “and this will ruin the wineskins and spill the wine” (See: [[rc://*/ta/man/translate/figs-activepassive]])
9:17 tg2k ῥήγνυνται οἱ ἀσκοί 1 When the new wine ferments and expands, the skins tear open because they can no longer stretch out.
9:17 cid7 ἀσκοὺς καινούς 1 “new wineskins” or “new wine bags.” This refers to wineskins that no one has used.
9:17 i8v4 rc://*/ta/man/translate/figs-activepassive ἀμφότεροι συντηροῦνται 1 This can be stated in active form. Alternate translation: “this will keep safe both the wineskins and the wine” (See: [[rc://*/ta/man/translate/figs-activepassive]])
9:18 a7ax 0 This begins an account of Jesus bringing to life the daughter of a Jewish official after she had died.
9:18 mj4x ταῦτα 1 This refers to the answer Jesus gave Johns disciples about fasting.
9:18 eqp1 ἰδοὺ 1 The word “behold” alerts us to a new person in the story. Your language may have a way of doing this.
9:18 n1i6 rc://*/ta/man/translate/translate-symaction προσεκύνει αὐτῷ 1 This is a way someone would show respect in Jewish culture. (See: [[rc://*/ta/man/translate/translate-symaction]])
9:18 in6t ἐλθὼν ἐπίθες τὴν χεῖρά σου ἐπ’ αὐτήν καὶ ζήσεται 1 This shows that the Jewish official believed Jesus had the power to bring his daughter back to life.
9:19 z99m οἱ μαθηταὶ αὐτοῦ 1 “Jesus disciples”
9:20 ai7a 0 This describes how Jesus healed another woman while he was on the way to the Jewish officials house.
9:20 etd3 ἰδοὺ 1 The word “Behold” alerts us to a new person in the story. Your language may have a way of doing this.
9:20 gv15 rc://*/ta/man/translate/figs-euphemism αἱμορροοῦσα 1 “who had been bleeding” or “who frequently had a flow of blood.” She was probably bleeding from her womb even when it was not the normal time for it. Some cultures may have a polite way of referring to this condition. (See: [[rc://*/ta/man/translate/figs-euphemism]])
9:20 na37 rc://*/ta/man/translate/translate-numbers δώδεκα ἔτη 1 “12 years” (See: [[rc://*/ta/man/translate/translate-numbers]])
9:20 m9zq τοῦ ἱματίου αὐτοῦ 1 “his robe” or “what he was wearing”
9:21 eb6t rc://*/ta/man/translate/figs-events ἔλεγεν γὰρ ἐν ἑαυτῇ, ἐὰν μόνον ἅψωμαι τοῦ ἱματίου αὐτοῦ, σωθήσομαι. 1 She said this to herself before she touched Jesus garment. This tells why she touched Jesus garment. (See: [[rc://*/ta/man/translate/figs-events]] and [[rc://*/ta/man/translate/translate-versebridge]])
9:21 ukb8 rc://*/ta/man/translate/figs-explicit ἐὰν μόνον ἅψωμαι τοῦ ἱματίου αὐτοῦ 1 According to Jewish law, because she was bleeding she was not supposed to touch anyone. She touches his clothes so that Jesus power would heal her and yet (she thought) he would not know that she touched him. (See: [[rc://*/ta/man/translate/figs-explicit]])
9:22 vi84 ὁ δὲ Ἰησοῦς 1 “The woman was hoping she could touch him secretly, but Jesus”
9:22 x398 θύγατερ 1 The woman was not Jesus real daughter. Jesus was speaking to her politely. If this is confusing, it can also be translated “Young woman” or even omitted.
9:22 q6ca ἡ πίστις σου σέσωκέν σε 1 “because you believed in me, I will heal you”
9:22 zv2n rc://*/ta/man/translate/figs-activepassive ἐσώθη ἡ γυνὴ ἀπὸ τῆς ὥρας ἐκείνης 1 This can be stated in active form. Alternate translation: “Jesus healed her at that moment” (See: [[rc://*/ta/man/translate/figs-activepassive]])
9:23 tu2c 0 This returns to the account of Jesus bringing the daughter of the Jewish official back to life.
9:23 jae1 τοὺς αὐλητὰς καὶ τὸν ὄχλον θορυβούμενον 1 This was a common way to mourn for someone who has died.
9:23 gy7g τοὺς αὐλητὰς 1 “people who play flutes”
9:24 v1st ἀναχωρεῖτε 1 Jesus was speaking to many people, so use the plural command form if your language has one.
9:24 pc1m rc://*/ta/man/translate/figs-euphemism οὐ & ἀπέθανεν τὸ κοράσιον, ἀλλὰ καθεύδει 1 Jesus is using a play on words. It was common in Jesus day to refer to a dead person as one who “sleeps.” But here the dead girl will get up, as though she had only been sleeping. (See: [[rc://*/ta/man/translate/figs-euphemism]])
9:25 iy6x 0 Verse 26 is a summary statement that describes the result of Jesus raising this girl from the dead.
9:25 utu3 0 This completes the account of Jesus bringing the daughter of the Jewish official back to life.
9:25 nqs6 rc://*/ta/man/translate/figs-activepassive ὅτε δὲ ἐξεβλήθη ὁ ὄχλος 1 This can be stated in active form. Alternate translation: “After Jesus had sent the crowd outside” or “After the family had sent the people outside” (See: [[rc://*/ta/man/translate/figs-activepassive]])
9:25 mm3q ἠγέρθη 1 “got out of bed.” This is the same meaning as in [Matthew 8:15](../08/15.md).
9:26 rxs4 καὶ ἐξῆλθεν ἡ φήμη αὕτη εἰς ὅλην τὴν γῆν ἐκείνην 1 “The people of that whole region heard about it” or “The people who saw that the girl was alive started telling everyone in the whole area about it”
9:27 b1h6 0 This begins the account of Jesus healing two blind men.
9:27 a8nm καὶ παράγοντι ἐκεῖθεν τῷ Ἰησοῦ 1 As Jesus was leaving the region
9:27 nwe9 παράγοντι 1 “was leaving” or “was going”
9:27 suc1 ἠκολούθησαν αὐτῷ 1 This means they were walking behind Jesus, not necessarily that they had become his disciples.
9:27 d8bu rc://*/ta/man/translate/figs-explicit ἐλέησον ἡμᾶς 1 It is implied that they wanted Jesus to heal them. (See: [[rc://*/ta/man/translate/figs-explicit]])
9:27 dh5d Υἱὲ Δαυείδ 1 Jesus was not Davids literal son, so this may be translated as “Descendant of David.” However, “Son of David” is also a title for the Messiah, and the men were probably calling Jesus by this title.
9:28 yr4h ἐλθόντι δὲ εἰς τὴν οἰκίαν 1 This could be either Jesus own house or the house in [Matthew 9:10](../09/10.md).
9:28 e81f rc://*/ta/man/translate/figs-ellipsis ναί, Κύριε 1 The full content of their answer is not stated, but it is understood. Alternate translation: “Yes, Lord, we believe you can heal us” (See: [[rc://*/ta/man/translate/figs-ellipsis]])
9:29 b3rl ἥψατο τῶν ὀφθαλμῶν αὐτῶν λέγων 1 It is not clear whether he touched both mens eyes at the same time or used only his right hand to touch one then the other. As the left hand was customarily used for unclean purposes, it is most likely that he used only his right hand. It is also not clear whether he spoke as he was touching them or touched them first and then spoke to them.
9:29 w92e rc://*/ta/man/translate/figs-activepassive κατὰ τὴν πίστιν ὑμῶν γενηθήτω ὑμῖν 1 This can be stated in active form. Alternate translation: “I will do as you have believed” or “Because you believe, I will heal you” (See: [[rc://*/ta/man/translate/figs-activepassive]])
9:30 uk2a rc://*/ta/man/translate/figs-idiom ἠνεῴχθησαν αὐτῶν οἱ ὀφθαλμοί 1 This means they were able to see. This can be stated in active form. Alternate translation: “God healed their eyes” or “the two blind men were able to see” (See: [[rc://*/ta/man/translate/figs-idiom]] and [[rc://*/ta/man/translate/figs-activepassive]])
9:30 t6p8 rc://*/ta/man/translate/figs-idiom ὁρᾶτε μηδεὶς γινωσκέτω 1 Here “See” means “be sure.” Alternate translation: “Be sure no one finds out about this” or “Do not tell anyone that I healed you” (See: [[rc://*/ta/man/translate/figs-idiom]])
9:31 y574 οἱ δὲ 1 “The two men did not do what Jesus told them to do. They”
9:31 y4b2 διεφήμισαν 1 “told many people what had happened to them”
9:32 tya1 0 This is the account of Jesus healing a demon-possessed man who could not speak and how people responded.
9:32 v9tr ἰδοὺ 1 The word “behold” alerts us to a new person in the story. Your language may have a way of doing this.
9:32 kr24 rc://*/ta/man/translate/figs-activepassive προσήνεγκαν αὐτῷ ἄνθρωπον κωφὸν 1 This can be stated in active form. Alternate translation: “someone brought a mute man … to Jesus” (See: [[rc://*/ta/man/translate/figs-activepassive]])
9:32 sh32 κωφὸν 1 not able to talk
9:32 n6fs rc://*/ta/man/translate/figs-activepassive δαιμονιζόμενον 1 This can be stated in active form. Alternate translation: “whom a demon had possessed” or “whom a demon was controlling” (See: [[rc://*/ta/man/translate/figs-activepassive]])
9:33 d6zs rc://*/ta/man/translate/figs-activepassive καὶ ἐκβληθέντος τοῦ δαιμονίου 1 This can be stated in active form. Alternate translation: “After Jesus had forced the demon out” or “After Jesus had commanded the demon to leave” (See: [[rc://*/ta/man/translate/figs-activepassive]])
9:33 r8ce ἐλάλησεν ὁ κωφός 1 “the mute man began to speak” or “the man who had been mute spoke” or “the man, who was no longer mute, spoke”
9:33 d1lf καὶ ἐθαύμασαν οἱ ὄχλοι 1 “The people were amazed”
9:33 y4l5 rc://*/ta/man/translate/figs-activepassive οὐδέποτε ἐφάνη οὕτως 1 This can be stated in active form. Alternate translation: “This has never happened before” or “No one has ever done anything like this before” (See: [[rc://*/ta/man/translate/figs-activepassive]])
9:34 z2r7 ἐκβάλλει τὰ δαιμόνια 1 “he forces demons to leave”
9:34 q623 ἐκβάλλει 1 The pronoun “he” refers to Jesus.
9:35 z6ya 0 Verse 36 begins a new part of the story where Jesus teaches his disciples and sends them to preach and heal as he has done.
9:35 xpp4 rc://*/ta/man/translate/writing-endofstory 0 Verse 35 is the end of the part of the story that began in [Matthew 8:1](../08/01.md) about Jesus healing ministry in Galilee. (See: [[rc://*/ta/man/translate/writing-endofstory]])
9:35 x9ck rc://*/ta/man/translate/figs-hyperbole τὰς πόλεις πάσας 1 The word “all” is an exaggeration to emphasize how very many cities Jesus went to. He did not necessarily go to every one of them. Alternate translation: “many of the cities” (See: [[rc://*/ta/man/translate/figs-hyperbole]])
9:35 ehx5 πόλεις & κώμας 1 “large villages … small villages” or “large towns … small towns”
9:35 uz5e rc://*/ta/man/translate/figs-abstractnouns τὸ εὐαγγέλιον τῆς βασιλείας 1 Here “kingdom” refers to Gods rule as king. See how you translated this in [Matthew 4:23](../04/23.md). Alternate translation: “preaching the good news that God will show himself as king” (See: [[rc://*/ta/man/translate/figs-abstractnouns]])
9:35 e7at πᾶσαν νόσον καὶ πᾶσαν μαλακίαν 1 “every disease and every sickness.” The words “disease” and “sickness” are closely related but should be translated as two different words if possible. “Disease” is what causes a person to be sick. “Sickness” is the physical weakness or affliction that results from having a disease.
9:36 t47i rc://*/ta/man/translate/figs-simile ὡσεὶ πρόβατα μὴ ἔχοντα ποιμένα 1 This simile means they did not have a leader to take care of them. Alternate translation: “The people did not have a leader” (See: [[rc://*/ta/man/translate/figs-simile]])
9:37 q95i 0 Jesus uses a proverb about harvesting to tell his disciples how they should respond to the needs of the crowds mentioned in the previous section.
9:37 mur4 rc://*/ta/man/translate/writing-proverbs ὁ μὲν θερισμὸς πολύς, οἱ δὲ ἐργάται ὀλίγοι 1 Jesus uses a proverb to respond to what he is seeing. Jesus means there are a lot of people who are ready to believe God but only few people to teach them Gods truth. (See: [[rc://*/ta/man/translate/writing-proverbs]])
9:37 m6ke ὁ μὲν θερισμὸς πολύς 1 “There is plenty of ripe food for someone to collect”
9:37 h3a2 ἐργάται 1 “workers”
9:38 vz8y δεήθητε & τοῦ Κυρίου τοῦ θερισμοῦ 1 “pray to God, because he is in charge of the harvest”
10:intro m5iu 0 # Matthew 10 General Notes\n## Special concepts in this chapter\n\n### The sending of the twelve disciples\n\nMany verses in this chapter describe how Jesus sent the twelve disciples out. He sent them to tell his message about the kingdom of heaven. They were to tell his message only in Israel and not to share it with the Gentiles.\n\n## Other possible translation difficulties in this chapter\n\n### The twelve disciples\n\nThe following are the lists of the twelve disciples:\n\nIn Matthew:\n\nSimon (Peter), Andrew, James son of Zebedee, John son of Zebedee, Philip, Bartholomew, Thomas, Matthew, James son of Alphaeus, Thaddaeus, Simon the Zealot and Judas Iscariot.\n\nIn Mark:\n\nSimon (Peter), Andrew, James the son of Zebedee and John the son of Zebedee (to whom he gave the name Boanerges, that is, sons of thunder), Philip, Bartholomew, Matthew, Thomas, James the son of Alphaeus, Thaddaeus, Simon the Zealot, and Judas Iscariot.\n\nIn Luke:\n\nSimon (Peter), Andrew, James, John, Philip, Bartholomew, Matthew, Thomas, James the son of Alphaeus, Simon (who was called the Zealot), Judas the son of James, and Judas Iscariot.\n\nThaddaeus is probably the same person as Jude, the son of James.\n\n### “The kingdom of heaven has come near”\n\nNo one knows for sure whether the “kingdom of heaven” was present or still coming when John spoke these words. English translations often use the phrase “at hand,” but these words can be difficult to translate. Other versions use the phrases “is coming near” and “has come near.”
10:1 nhp2 0 This begins an account of Jesus sending out his twelve disciples to do his work.
10:1 gjs9 rc://*/ta/man/translate/translate-numbers καὶ προσκαλεσάμενος τοὺς δώδεκα μαθητὰς αὐτοῦ 1 “summoned his 12 disciples” (See: [[rc://*/ta/man/translate/translate-numbers]])
10:1 x1er ἔδωκεν αὐτοῖς ἐξουσίαν 1 Be sure that the text clearly communicates that this authority was (1) to drive out unclean spirits and (2) to heal disease and sickness.
10:1 pq8k ὥστε ἐκβάλλειν αὐτὰ 1 “to make the unclean spirits leave”
10:1 x29j πᾶσαν νόσον καὶ πᾶσαν μαλακίαν 1 “every disease and every sickness.” The words “disease” and “sickness” are closely related but should be translated as two different words if possible. “Disease” is what causes a person to be sick. “Sickness” is the physical weakness or affliction that results from having a disease.
10:2 yt7a 0 Here the author provides the names of the twelve apostles as background information.
10:2 t59v rc://*/ta/man/translate/writing-background δὲ 1 This word is used here to mark a break in the main story line. Here Matthew tells background information about the twelve apostles. (See: [[rc://*/ta/man/translate/writing-background]])
10:2 f1vu τῶν & δώδεκα ἀποστόλων 1 This is the same group as the “twelve disciples” in [Matthew 10:1](../10/01.md).
10:2 sc7b rc://*/ta/man/translate/translate-ordinal πρῶτος 1 This is first in order, not in rank. (See: [[rc://*/ta/man/translate/translate-ordinal]])
10:3 g6eg Μαθθαῖος ὁ τελώνης 1 “Matthew, who was a tax collector”
10:4 n4st ὁ Καναναῖος 1 Possible meanings are (1) “the Zealot” is a title that shows that he was part of the group of people who wanted to free the Jewish people from Roman rule. Alternate translation: “the patriot” or “the nationalist” or (2) “the Zealot” is a description that shows that he was zealous for God to be honored. Alternate translation: “the zealous one” or “the passionate one”
10:4 kmp2 ὁ καὶ παραδοὺς αὐτόν 1 “who would betray Jesus”
10:5 sn9v rc://*/ta/man/translate/figs-events 0 Although verse 5 begins by saying that he sent out the twelve, Jesus gave these instructions before he sent them out. (See: [[rc://*/ta/man/translate/figs-events]])
10:5 aw5h 0 Here Jesus begins to give instructions to his disciples about what they should do and expect when they go to preach.
10:5 c46d τούτους τοὺς δώδεκα ἀπέστειλεν ὁ Ἰησοῦς 1 “Jesus sent out these twelve men” or “It was these twelve men whom Jesus sent out”
10:5 yix4 ἀπέστειλεν 1 Jesus sent them out for a particular purpose.
10:5 ryl4 παραγγείλας αὐτοῖς 1 “He told them what they needed to do” or “He commanded them”
10:6 q1pb rc://*/ta/man/translate/figs-metaphor τὰ πρόβατα τὰ ἀπολωλότα οἴκου Ἰσραήλ 1 This is a metaphor comparing the entire nation of Israel to sheep who have strayed from their shepherd. (See: [[rc://*/ta/man/translate/figs-metaphor]])
10:6 b6i2 rc://*/ta/man/translate/figs-metonymy οἴκου Ἰσραήλ 1 This refers to the nation of Israel. Alternate translation: “people of Israel” or “descendants of Israel” (See: [[rc://*/ta/man/translate/figs-metonymy]])
10:7 uff2 rc://*/ta/man/translate/figs-you πορευόμενοι 1 Here “you” is plural and refers to the twelve apostles. (See: [[rc://*/ta/man/translate/figs-you]])
10:7 w59i rc://*/ta/man/translate/figs-metonymy ἤγγικεν ἡ Βασιλεία τῶν Οὐρανῶν 1 The phrase “kingdom of heaven” refers to God ruling as king. This phrase is only in the book of Matthew. If possible, use the word “heaven” in your translation. See how you translated this in [Matthew 3:2](../03/02.md). Alternate translation: “Our God in heaven will soon show himself to be king” (See: [[rc://*/ta/man/translate/figs-metonymy]])
10:8 e13x 0 Jesus continues to instruct his disciples about what they should do when they go to preach.
10:8 v5sp rc://*/ta/man/translate/figs-you θεραπεύετε & ἐγείρετε & καθαρίζετε & ἐκβάλλετε & ἐλάβετε & δότε 1 These verbs and pronouns are plural and refer to the twelve apostles. (See: [[rc://*/ta/man/translate/figs-you]])
10:8 bb4d rc://*/ta/man/translate/figs-idiom νεκροὺς ἐγείρετε 1 This is an idiom. Alternate translation: “cause the dead to live again” (See: [[rc://*/ta/man/translate/figs-idiom]])
10:8 ilj9 rc://*/ta/man/translate/figs-ellipsis δωρεὰν ἐλάβετε, δωρεὰν δότε 1 Jesus did not state what the disciples had received or were to give. Some languages may require this information in the sentence. Here “freely” means that there was no payment. Alternate translation: “Freely you have received these things, freely give them to others” or “You received these things without paying, so give them to others without making them pay” (See: [[rc://*/ta/man/translate/figs-ellipsis]])
10:8 ls6j rc://*/ta/man/translate/figs-metaphor δωρεὰν ἐλάβετε, δωρεὰν δότε 1 Here “received” is a metaphor that represents being made able to do things, and “give” is a metaphor that represents doing things for others. Alternate translation: “Freely you have received the ability to do these things, freely do them for others” or “Freely I have made you able to do these things, freely do them for others” (See: [[rc://*/ta/man/translate/figs-metaphor]])
10:9 dw4i rc://*/ta/man/translate/figs-you ὑμῶν 1 This refers to the twelve apostles and so is plural. (See: [[rc://*/ta/man/translate/figs-you]])
10:9 a4xx rc://*/ta/man/translate/figs-metonymy χρυσὸν, μηδὲ ἄργυρον, μηδὲ χαλκὸν 1 These are metals out of which coins were made. This list is a metonym for money, so if the metals are unknown in your area, translate the list as “money.” (See: [[rc://*/ta/man/translate/figs-metonymy]])
10:9 b4m7 τὰς ζώνας 1 This means “belts” or “money belts,” but it can refer to whatever might be used to carry money. A belt is a long strip of cloth or leather worn around the waist. It was often wide enough that it could be folded and used to carry money.
10:10 kia9 πήραν 1 This could either be any bag used to carry things on a journey, or a bag used by someone to collect food or money.
10:10 i2ex δύο χιτῶνας 1 Use the same word you used for “tunic” in [Matthew 5:40](../05/40.md).
10:10 ei4d ὁ ἐργάτης 1 worker
10:10 m97h rc://*/ta/man/translate/figs-synecdoche τῆς τροφῆς αὐτοῦ 1 Here “food” refers to anything a person needs. Alternate translation: “what he needs” (See: [[rc://*/ta/man/translate/figs-synecdoche]])
10:11 dk1r 0 Jesus continues to instruct his disciples about what they should do when they go out to preach.
10:11 b7ig εἰς ἣν δ’ ἂν πόλιν ἢ κώμην εἰσέλθητε 1 “Whenever you enter a city or village” or “When you go into any city or village”
10:11 p4ln πόλιν & κώμην 1 “large village … small village” or “large town … small town.” See how you translated this in [Matthew 9:35](../09/35.md).
10:11 r7kj rc://*/ta/man/translate/figs-you εἰσέλθητε 1 This is plural and refers to the twelve apostles. (See: [[rc://*/ta/man/translate/figs-you]])
10:11 c3uf ἄξιός 1 A “worthy” person is a person who is willing to welcome the disciples.
10:11 a41d rc://*/ta/man/translate/figs-explicit κἀκεῖ μείνατε ἕως ἂν ἐξέλθητε 1 The full meaning of the statement can be made explicit. Alternate translation: “stay in that persons house until you leave the town or village” (See: [[rc://*/ta/man/translate/figs-explicit]])
10:12 n6cm rc://*/ta/man/translate/figs-metonymy εἰσερχόμενοι δὲ εἰς τὴν οἰκίαν, ἀσπάσασθε αὐτήν 1 The phrase “greet it” means greet the house. A common greeting in those days was “Peace be to this house!” Here “house” represents the people who live in the house. Alternate translation: “As you enter the house, greet the people who live in it” (See: [[rc://*/ta/man/translate/figs-metonymy]])
10:12 k1xk rc://*/ta/man/translate/figs-you εἰσερχόμενοι 1 This is plural and refers to the twelve apostles. (See: [[rc://*/ta/man/translate/figs-you]])
10:13 qip2 rc://*/ta/man/translate/figs-you ὑμῶν & ὑμῶν 1 These are plural and refer to the twelve apostles. (See: [[rc://*/ta/man/translate/figs-you]])
10:13 kc9m rc://*/ta/man/translate/figs-metonymy μὲν ᾖ ἡ οἰκία ἀξία & μὴ ᾖ ἀξία 1 Here “the house” represents those who live in the house. A “worthy” person is a person who is willing to welcome the disciples. Jesus compares this person to one who is “not worthy,” a person who does not welcome the disciples. Alternate translation: “the people who live in that house receive you well” or “the people who live in that house treat you well” (See: [[rc://*/ta/man/translate/figs-metonymy]])
10:13 q75a rc://*/ta/man/translate/figs-metonymy ἐλθάτω ἡ εἰρήνη ὑμῶν ἐπ’ αὐτήν 1 The word “it” refers to the house, which represents the people who live in the house. Alternate translation: “let them receive your peace” or “let them receive the peace that you greeted them with” (See: [[rc://*/ta/man/translate/figs-metonymy]])
10:13 ha8f rc://*/ta/man/translate/figs-metonymy ἐὰν & μὴ ᾖ ἀξία 1 The word “it” means the house. Here “house” refers to the people who live in the house. Alternate translation: “if they do not receive you well” or “if they do not treat you well” (See: [[rc://*/ta/man/translate/figs-metonymy]])
10:13 my3y ἡ εἰρήνη ὑμῶν πρὸς ὑμᾶς ἐπιστραφήτω 1 Possible meanings are (1) if the household was not worthy, then God would hold back peace or blessings from that household or (2) if the household was not worthy, then the apostles were supposed to do something, such as asking God not to honor their greeting of peace. If your language has a similar meaning of taking back a greeting or its effects, that should be used here.
10:14 yn9k 0 Jesus continues to instruct his disciples about what they should do when they go to preach.
10:14 m8e9 καὶ ὃς ἂν μὴ δέξηται ὑμᾶς, μηδὲ ἀκούσῃ 1 “If no people in that house or city will receive you or listen”
10:14 w5py rc://*/ta/man/translate/figs-you ὑμᾶς & ὑμῶν 1 This is plural and refers to the twelve apostles. (See: [[rc://*/ta/man/translate/figs-you]])
10:14 z826 rc://*/ta/man/translate/figs-metonymy ἀκούσῃ τοὺς λόγους ὑμῶν 1 Here “words” refers to what the disciples say. Alternate translation: “listen to your message” or “listen to what you have to say” (See: [[rc://*/ta/man/translate/figs-metonymy]])
10:14 hi3i πόλεως 1 You should translate this the same way you did in [Matthew 10:11](../10/11.md).
10:14 i5mc rc://*/ta/man/translate/translate-symaction ἐκτινάξατε τὸν κονιορτὸν τῶν ποδῶν ὑμῶν 1 “shake the dust off your feet as you leave.” This is a sign that God has rejected the people of that house or city. (See: [[rc://*/ta/man/translate/translate-symaction]])
10:15 pk4f ἀμὴν, λέγω ὑμῖν 1 “I tell you the truth.” This phrase adds emphasis to what Jesus says next.
10:15 d6ib ἀνεκτότερον ἔσται 1 “the suffering shall be less”
10:15 sg3c rc://*/ta/man/translate/figs-metonymy γῇ Σοδόμων καὶ Γομόρρων 1 This refers to the people who lived in Sodom and Gomorrah. Alternate translation: “the people who lived in the cities of Sodom and Gomorrah” (See: [[rc://*/ta/man/translate/figs-metonymy]])
10:15 zmm2 rc://*/ta/man/translate/figs-metonymy τῇ πόλει ἐκείνῃ 1 This refers to the people in the city that does not receive the apostles or listen to their message. Alternate translation: “the people of the city that does not receive you” (See: [[rc://*/ta/man/translate/figs-metonymy]])
10:16 lf4i 0 Jesus continues to instruct his disciples. Here he begins to tell them about the persecution they will endure when they go out to preach.
10:16 ggp6 ἰδοὺ, ἐγὼ ἀποστέλλω 1 The word “See” here adds emphasis to what follows. Alternate translation: “Look, I send” or “Listen, send” or “Pay attention to what I am about to tell you. I send”
10:16 c9bi ἐγὼ ἀποστέλλω ὑμᾶς 1 Jesus is sending them out for a particular purpose.
10:16 b262 rc://*/ta/man/translate/figs-simile ὡς πρόβατα ἐν μέσῳ λύκων 1 Sheep are defenseless animals that wolves often attack. Jesus is stating that people may harm the disciples. Alternate translation: “as sheep among people who are like dangerous wolves” or “as sheep among people who act the way dangerous animals act” (See: [[rc://*/ta/man/translate/figs-simile]])
10:16 s21a rc://*/ta/man/translate/figs-simile γίνεσθε & φρόνιμοι ὡς οἱ ὄφεις καὶ ἀκέραιοι ὡς αἱ περιστεραί 1 Jesus is telling the disciples they must be cautious and harmless among the people. If comparing the disciples to serpents or doves is confusing, it might be better not to state the similes. Alternate translation: “act with understanding and caution, as well as with innocence and virtue” (See: [[rc://*/ta/man/translate/figs-simile]])
10:17 a55q rc://*/ta/man/translate/grammar-connect-words-phrases προσέχετε δὲ ἀπὸ τῶν ἀνθρώπων; παραδώσουσιν γὰρ ὑμᾶς 1 You can translate with “because” to show how these two statements relate. Alternate translation: “Watch out for people because they will” (See: [[rc://*/ta/man/translate/grammar-connect-words-phrases]])
10:17 csc4 παραδώσουσιν & ὑμᾶς εἰς 1 “will put you under the control of”
10:17 fct4 συνέδρια 1 local religious leaders or elders who together keep peace in the community
10:17 gs2d μαστιγώσουσιν ὑμᾶς 1 “beat you with a whip”
10:18 pe3d rc://*/ta/man/translate/figs-activepassive ἀχθήσεσθε 1 This can be stated in active form. Alternate translation: “they will bring you” or “they will drag you” (See: [[rc://*/ta/man/translate/figs-activepassive]])
10:18 p74k ἕνεκεν ἐμοῦ 1 “because you belong to me” or “because you follow me”
10:18 u5wc αὐτοῖς καὶ τοῖς ἔθνεσιν 1 The pronoun “them” refers either to the “governors and kings” or to the Jewish accusers.
10:19 ksi4 0 Jesus continues to instruct his disciples about the persecution they will endure when they go out to preach.
10:19 e5t6 ὅταν δὲ παραδῶσιν ὑμᾶς 1 “When people take you to the councils.” The “people” here are the same “people” as in [Matthew 10:17](../10/17.md).
10:19 qcs3 rc://*/ta/man/translate/figs-you ὑμᾶς & ὑμῖν 1 These are plural and refer to the twelve apostles. (See: [[rc://*/ta/man/translate/figs-you]])
10:19 qzd2 μὴ μεριμνήσητε 1 “do not worry”
10:19 ien3 rc://*/ta/man/translate/figs-hendiadys πῶς ἢ τί λαλήσητε 1 “how you are to speak or what you are to say.” The two ideas may be combined: “what you are to say” (See: [[rc://*/ta/man/translate/figs-hendiadys]])
10:19 l7rb rc://*/ta/man/translate/figs-activepassive δοθήσεται γὰρ ὑμῖν & τί λαλήσητε 1 This can be stated in active form. Alternate translation: “for the Holy Spirit will tell you what to say” (See: [[rc://*/ta/man/translate/figs-activepassive]])
10:19 cm7h rc://*/ta/man/translate/figs-metonymy ἐν ἐκείνῃ τῇ ὥρᾳ 1 Here “hour” means “right then.” Alternate translation: “right then” or “at that time” (See: [[rc://*/ta/man/translate/figs-metonymy]])
10:20 yuk1 rc://*/ta/man/translate/figs-you ὑμεῖς & ὑμῶν & ὑμῖν 1 These are plural and refer to the twelve apostles. (See: [[rc://*/ta/man/translate/figs-you]])
10:20 v9tm τὸ Πνεῦμα τοῦ Πατρὸς ὑμῶν 1 If necessary, this can be translated as “the Spirit of God your heavenly Father” or a footnote can be added to make it clear that this refers to God the Holy Spirit and not to the spirit of an earthly father.
10:20 k3xr rc://*/ta/man/translate/guidelines-sonofgodprinciples τοῦ Πατρὸς 1 This is an important title for God. (See: [[rc://*/ta/man/translate/guidelines-sonofgodprinciples]])
10:20 zxd8 ἐν ὑμῖν 1 “through you”
10:21 i8q5 0 Jesus continues to instruct his disciples about the persecution they will endure when they go out to preach.
10:21 p9ms παραδώσει δὲ ἀδελφὸς ἀδελφὸν εἰς θάνατον 1 “One brother will deliver up his brother to death” or “Brothers will deliver up their brothers to death.” Jesus speaks of something that will happen many times.
10:21 lh6z rc://*/ta/man/translate/figs-abstractnouns παραδώσει & ἀδελφὸν εἰς θάνατον 1 The abstract noun “death” can be translated as a verb. Alternate translation: “hand brother over to authorties who will execute him” (See: [[rc://*/ta/man/translate/figs-abstractnouns]])
10:21 p8w9 rc://*/ta/man/translate/figs-ellipsis πατὴρ τέκνον 1 These words can be translated as a complete sentence. Alternate translation: “fathers will deliver up their children to death” (See: [[rc://*/ta/man/translate/figs-ellipsis]])
10:21 xja9 ἐπαναστήσονται & ἐπὶ 1 “rebel against” or “turn against”
10:21 xf2d rc://*/ta/man/translate/figs-activepassive θανατώσουσιν αὐτούς 1 This can be translated in active form. Alternate translation: “have them put to death” or “have the authorities execute them” (See: [[rc://*/ta/man/translate/figs-activepassive]])
10:22 sp6p rc://*/ta/man/translate/figs-activepassive καὶ ἔσεσθε μισούμενοι ὑπὸ πάντων 1 This can be translated in active form. Alternate translation: “Everyone will hate you” or “All people will hate you” (See: [[rc://*/ta/man/translate/figs-activepassive]])
10:22 va6i rc://*/ta/man/translate/figs-you ἔσεσθε 1 This is plural and refers to the twelve disciples. (See: [[rc://*/ta/man/translate/figs-you]])
10:22 n3xn rc://*/ta/man/translate/figs-metonymy διὰ τὸ ὄνομά μου 1 Here “name” refers to the entire person. Alternate translation: “because of me” or “because you trust in me” (See: [[rc://*/ta/man/translate/figs-metonymy]])
10:22 k5w9 ὁ & ὑπομείνας 1 “whoever stays faithful”
10:22 j71i εἰς τέλος 1 It is not clear whether the “end” means when a person dies, when the persecution ends, or the end of the age when God shows himself to be king. The main point is that they endure as long as necessary.
10:22 qn7j rc://*/ta/man/translate/figs-activepassive οὗτος σωθήσεται 1 This can be stated in active form. Alternate translation: “God will deliver that person” (See: [[rc://*/ta/man/translate/figs-activepassive]])
10:23 m42z ἐν τῇ πόλει ταύτῃ 1 Here “this” does not refer to a specific city. Alternate translation: “in one city”
10:23 jjd4 φεύγετε εἰς τὴν ἑτέραν 1 “flee to the next city”
10:23 gk1s ἀμὴν & λέγω ὑμῖν 1 “I tell you the truth.” This phrase adds emphasis to what Jesus says next.
10:23 dk4u rc://*/ta/man/translate/figs-123person Υἱὸς τοῦ Ἀνθρώπου 1 Jesus is speaking about himself. (See: [[rc://*/ta/man/translate/figs-123person]])
10:23 tm8z ἔλθῃ 1 “arrives”
10:24 uv9r 0 Jesus continues to instruct his disciples about the persecution they will endure when they go out to preach.
10:24 p8mr rc://*/ta/man/translate/writing-proverbs οὐκ ἔστιν μαθητὴς ὑπὲρ τὸν διδάσκαλον, οὐδὲ δοῦλος ὑπὲρ τὸν κύριον αὐτοῦ 1 Jesus is using a proverb to teach his disciples a general truth. Jesus is emphasizing that the disciples should not expect people to treat them any better than the people treat Jesus. (See: [[rc://*/ta/man/translate/writing-proverbs]])
10:24 syb2 οὐκ ἔστιν μαθητὴς ὑπὲρ τὸν διδάσκαλον 1 “A disciple is always less important than his teacher” or “A teacher is always more important than his disciple”
10:24 nc3e οὐδὲ δοῦλος ὑπὲρ τὸν κύριον αὐτοῦ 1 “and a servant is always less important than his master” or “and a master is always more important than his servant”
10:25 e2ae ἀρκετὸν τῷ μαθητῇ ἵνα γένηται ὡς ὁ διδάσκαλος αὐτοῦ 1 “The disciple should be satisfied to become like his teacher”
10:25 t7jp rc://*/ta/man/translate/figs-explicit γένηται ὡς ὁ διδάσκαλος αὐτοῦ 1 If necessary, you can make explicit how the disciple becomes like the teacher. Alternate translation: “know as much as his teacher knows” (See: [[rc://*/ta/man/translate/figs-explicit]])
10:25 e6z3 rc://*/ta/man/translate/figs-explicit ὁ δοῦλος ὡς ὁ κύριος αὐτοῦ 1 If necessary, you can make explicit how the servant becomes like the master. Alternate translation: “the servant should be satisfied to become only as important as his master” (See: [[rc://*/ta/man/translate/figs-explicit]])
10:25 u355 εἰ & ἐπεκάλεσαν, πόσῳ μᾶλλον τοὺς οἰκιακοὺς αὐτοῦ 1 Again Jesus is emphasizing that since people have mistreated him, his disciples should expect people to treat them the same or worse.
10:25 bg2l πόσῳ μᾶλλον τοὺς οἰκιακοὺς αὐτοῦ 1 “the names that they call the members of his household will certainly be much worse” or “they will certainly call the members of his household much worse names”
10:25 cp96 εἰ & ἐπεκάλεσαν 1 “Since people have called”
10:25 pu5y rc://*/ta/man/translate/figs-metaphor τὸν οἰκοδεσπότην 1 Jesus is using this as a metaphor for himself. (See: [[rc://*/ta/man/translate/figs-metaphor]])
10:25 y5md Βεελζεβοὺλ 1 This name can either be (1) transcribed directly as “Beelzebul” or (2) translated with its original, intended meaning of “Satan.”
10:25 r5ll rc://*/ta/man/translate/figs-metaphor τοὺς οἰκιακοὺς αὐτοῦ 1 This is a metaphor for Jesus disciples. (See: [[rc://*/ta/man/translate/figs-metaphor]])
10:26 zb2j 0 Jesus continues to instruct his disciples about the persecution they will endure when they go out to preach.
10:26 twv2 μὴ & φοβηθῆτε αὐτούς 1 Here “them” refers to the people who mistreat followers of Jesus.
10:26 xqs4 rc://*/ta/man/translate/figs-metaphor οὐδὲν & ἐστιν κεκαλυμμένον ὃ οὐκ ἀποκαλυφθήσεται, καὶ κρυπτὸν ὃ οὐ γνωσθήσεται 1 Both of these statements mean the same thing. Being concealed or hidden represents being kept secret, and being revealed represents being made known. Jesus is emphasizing that God will make all things known. This can be stated in active form. Alternate translation: “God will reveal the things that people hide” (See: [[rc://*/ta/man/translate/figs-metaphor]] and [[rc://*/ta/man/translate/figs-activepassive]])
10:27 fa1s rc://*/ta/man/translate/figs-parallelism ὃ λέγω ὑμῖν ἐν τῇ σκοτίᾳ, εἴπατε ἐν τῷ φωτί; καὶ ὃ εἰς τὸ οὖς ἀκούετε, κηρύξατε ἐπὶ τῶν δωμάτων 1 Both of these statements mean the same thing. Jesus is emphasizing that the disciples should tell everyone what he tells the disciples in private. Alternate translation: “Tell people in the daylight what I tell you in the darkness, and proclaim upon the housetops what you hear softly in your ear” (See: [[rc://*/ta/man/translate/figs-parallelism]])
10:27 kw75 rc://*/ta/man/translate/figs-metonymy ὃ λέγω ὑμῖν ἐν τῇ σκοτίᾳ, εἴπατε ἐν τῷ φωτί 1 Here “darkness” is a metonym for “night” which is a metonym for “private.” Here “daylight” is a metonym for “public.” Alternate translation: “What I tell you privately at night, say in public in the day light” (See: [[rc://*/ta/man/translate/figs-metonymy]])
10:27 fc49 rc://*/ta/man/translate/figs-idiom ὃ εἰς τὸ οὖς ἀκούετε 1 This is a way of referring to whispering. Alternate translation: “what I whisper to you” (See: [[rc://*/ta/man/translate/figs-idiom]])
10:27 t9u9 rc://*/ta/man/translate/figs-metonymy κηρύξατε ἐπὶ τῶν δωμάτων 1 Housetops where Jesus lived were flat, and people far away could hear anyone speaking with a loud voice. Here “housetops” refers to any place where all people can hear. Alternate translation: “speak loudly in a public place for all to hear” (See: [[rc://*/ta/man/translate/figs-metonymy]])
10:28 s6wq 0 Here Jesus also begins to give reasons why his disciples should not be afraid of the persecution they might experience.
10:28 p3fn 0 Jesus continues to instruct his disciples about the persecution they will endure when they go to preach.
10:28 fb29 rc://*/ta/man/translate/figs-distinguish καὶ μὴ φοβεῖσθε ἀπὸ τῶν ἀποκτεννόντων τὸ σῶμα, τὴν δὲ ψυχὴν μὴ δυναμένων ἀποκτεῖναι 1 This is not distinguishing between people who cannot kill the soul and people who can kill the soul. No person can kill the soul. Alternate translation: “Do not be afraid of people. They can kill the body, but they cannot kill the soul” (See: [[rc://*/ta/man/translate/figs-distinguish]])
10:28 lc56 τῶν ἀποκτεννόντων τὸ σῶμα 1 This means to cause physical death. If these words are awkward, they can be translated as “kill you” or “kill other people.”
10:28 ei7y τὸ σῶμα 1 the part of a person that can be touched, as opposed to the soul or spirit
10:28 e4de τὴν & ψυχὴν & ἀποκτεῖναι 1 This means to harm people after they have physically died.
10:28 e76n τὴν & ψυχὴν 1 the part of a person that cannot be touched and that lives on after the physical body dies
10:28 pk7k rc://*/ta/man/translate/grammar-connect-words-phrases φοβεῖσθε & τὸν δυνάμενον 1 You can add “because” to clarify why people should fear God. Alternate translation: “fear God because he is able” (See: [[rc://*/ta/man/translate/grammar-connect-words-phrases]])
10:29 tm3s rc://*/ta/man/translate/writing-proverbs οὐχὶ δύο στρουθία ἀσσαρίου πωλεῖται? 1 Jesus states this proverb as a question to teach his disciples. Alternate translation: “Think about the sparrows. They have so little value that you can buy two of them for only one small coin.” (See: [[rc://*/ta/man/translate/writing-proverbs]] and [[rc://*/ta/man/translate/figs-rquestion]])
10:29 q22l rc://*/ta/man/translate/translate-unknown στρουθία 1 These are very small, seed-eating birds. Alternate translation: “small birds” (See: [[rc://*/ta/man/translate/translate-unknown]])
10:29 i399 ἀσσαρίου 1 This is often translated as the least valuable coin available in your country. It refers to a copper coin worth about one-sixteenth of a days wage for a laborer. Alternate translation: “very little money”
10:29 wxt4 rc://*/ta/man/translate/figs-doublenegatives ἓν ἐξ αὐτῶν οὐ πεσεῖται ἐπὶ τὴν γῆν, ἄνευ τοῦ Πατρὸς ὑμῶν 1 This can be stated in a positive form. Alternate translation: “your Father knows when even one sparrow dies and falls to the ground” (See: [[rc://*/ta/man/translate/figs-doublenegatives]])
10:29 fe8z rc://*/ta/man/translate/guidelines-sonofgodprinciples τοῦ Πατρὸς 1 This is an important title for God. (See: [[rc://*/ta/man/translate/guidelines-sonofgodprinciples]])
10:30 cih3 rc://*/ta/man/translate/figs-activepassive ὑμῶν & καὶ αἱ τρίχες τῆς κεφαλῆς πᾶσαι ἠριθμημέναι εἰσίν 1 This can be stated in active form. Alternate translation: “God knows even how many hairs are on your head” (See: [[rc://*/ta/man/translate/figs-activepassive]])
10:30 nb7b ἠριθμημέναι 1 “counted”
10:31 n2tz πολλῶν στρουθίων διαφέρετε ὑμεῖς 1 “God values you more than many sparrows”
10:32 jtw9 0 Jesus continues to instruct his disciples about the reasons why they should not be afraid of the persecution that they might experience.
10:32 ntt9 πᾶς & ὅστις ὁμολογήσει ἐν ἐμοὶ & κἀγὼ ἐν αὐτῷ ἔμπροσθεν τοῦ Πατρός μου 1 “whoever confesses me … I will also confess before my Father” or “if anyone confesses me … I will also confess him before my Father”
10:32 yj44 ὁμολογήσει ἐν ἐμοὶ ἔμπροσθεν τῶν ἀνθρώπων 1 “tells others that he is my disciple” or “acknowledges before other people that he is loyal to me”
10:32 j4dh rc://*/ta/man/translate/figs-ellipsis ὁμολογήσω κἀγὼ ἐν αὐτῷ ἔμπροσθεν τοῦ Πατρός μου τοῦ ἐν οὐρανοῖς 1 You can make explicit the information that is understood. Alternate translation: “I will also acknowledge before my Father who is in heaven that that person belongs to me” (See: [[rc://*/ta/man/translate/figs-ellipsis]])
10:32 kdd2 τοῦ Πατρός μου τοῦ ἐν οὐρανοῖς 1 “my heavenly Father”
10:32 n1nb rc://*/ta/man/translate/guidelines-sonofgodprinciples τοῦ Πατρός μου 1 This is an important title for God. (See: [[rc://*/ta/man/translate/guidelines-sonofgodprinciples]])
10:33 sx8g ὅστις & ἂν ἀρνήσηταί με & ἀρνήσομαι κἀγὼ αὐτὸν ἔμπροσθεν τοῦ Πατρός μου 1 “whoever denies me … I will also deny before my Father” or “if anyone denies me … I will also deny him before my Father”
10:33 d15s ἂν ἀρνήσηταί με ἔμπροσθεν τῶν ἀνθρώπων 1 “denies to other people that he is loyal to me” or “refuses to acknowledge to others that he is my disciple”
10:33 cnu3 rc://*/ta/man/translate/figs-ellipsis ἀρνήσομαι κἀγὼ αὐτὸν ἔμπροσθεν τοῦ Πατρός μου τοῦ ἐν οὐρανοῖς 1 You can make explicit the information that is understood. Alternate translation: “I will deny before my Father who is in heaven that this person belongs to me” (See: [[rc://*/ta/man/translate/figs-ellipsis]])
10:34 bx73 0 Jesus continues to instruct his disciples about the reasons why they should not be afraid of the persecution that they might experience.
10:34 rrp3 μὴ νομίσητε 1 “Do not suppose” or “You must not think”
10:34 l5ad rc://*/ta/man/translate/figs-metonymy ἐπὶ τὴν γῆν 1 This refers to the people who live on the earth. Alternate translation: “to the people of the earth” or “to people” (See: [[rc://*/ta/man/translate/figs-metonymy]])
10:34 jq6d rc://*/ta/man/translate/figs-metonymy μάχαιραν 1 This refers to division, fighting, and killing among people. (See: [[rc://*/ta/man/translate/figs-metonymy]])
10:35 xx5m διχάσαι ἄνθρωπον κατὰ 1 “to cause … to fight against”
10:35 k18y ἄνθρωπον κατὰ τοῦ πατρὸς αὐτοῦ 1 “a son against his father”
10:36 lhc2 καὶ ἐχθροὶ τοῦ ἀνθρώπου 1 “A persons enemies” or “A persons worst enemies”
10:36 g166 οἱ οἰκιακοὶ αὐτοῦ 1 “members of his own family”
10:37 ju1k 0 Jesus continues to instruct his disciples about the reasons why they should not be afraid of the persecution that they might experience.
10:37 x1xg rc://*/ta/man/translate/figs-gendernotations ὁ φιλῶν & οὐκ ἔστιν μου ἄξιος 1 Here “he” means any person in general. Alternate translation: “Those who love … are not worthy” or “If you love … you are not worthy” (See: [[rc://*/ta/man/translate/figs-gendernotations]])
10:37 az6t ὁ φιλῶν 1 The word for “love” here refers to “brotherly love” or “love from a friend.” Alternate translation: “cares for” or “is devoted to” or “is fond of”
10:37 fb3p μου ἄξιος 1 “deserve to belong to me” or “worthy to be my disciple”
10:38 ye95 rc://*/ta/man/translate/figs-metonymy λαμβάνει τὸν σταυρὸν αὐτοῦ καὶ ἀκολουθεῖ ὀπίσω μου 1 “carry his cross and follow me.” The cross represents suffering and death. Taking up the cross represents being willing to suffer and die. Alternate translation: “obey me even to the point of suffering and dying” (See: [[rc://*/ta/man/translate/figs-metonymy]] and [[rc://*/ta/man/translate/figs-metaphor]])
10:38 ai2r λαμβάνει 1 “take up” or “pick up and carry”
10:39 u4jh rc://*/ta/man/translate/writing-proverbs ὁ εὑρὼν τὴν ψυχὴν αὐτοῦ ἀπολέσει αὐτήν; καὶ ὁ ἀπολέσας & εὑρήσει αὐτήν 1 Jesus uses a proverb to teach his disciples. This should be translated with as few words as possible. Alternate translation: “Those who find their lives will lose them. But those who lose their lives … will find them” or “If you find your life you will lose it. But if you lose your life … you will find it” (See: [[rc://*/ta/man/translate/writing-proverbs]])
10:39 jwf2 rc://*/ta/man/translate/figs-metaphor ὁ εὑρὼν 1 This is a metaphor for “keeps” or “saves.” Alternate translation: “tries to keep” or “tries to save” (See: [[rc://*/ta/man/translate/figs-metaphor]])
10:39 pbf3 rc://*/ta/man/translate/figs-metaphor ἀπολέσει αὐτήν 1 This does not mean the person will die. It is a metaphor that means the person will not experience spiritual life with God. Alternate translation: “will not have true life” (See: [[rc://*/ta/man/translate/figs-metaphor]])
10:39 i3x4 rc://*/ta/man/translate/figs-metaphor ὁ ἀπολέσας τὴν ψυχὴν αὐτοῦ 1 This does not mean to die. It is a metaphor that means a person considers obeying Jesus more important than his own life. Alternate translation: “who denies himself” (See: [[rc://*/ta/man/translate/figs-metaphor]])
10:39 hz7r ἕνεκεν ἐμοῦ 1 “because he trusts me” or “on my account” or “because of me.” This is the same idea as “for my sake” in [Matthew 10:18](../10/18.md).
10:39 g2c8 rc://*/ta/man/translate/figs-metaphor εὑρήσει αὐτήν 1 This metaphor means the person will experience spiritual life with God. Alternate translation: “will find true life” (See: [[rc://*/ta/man/translate/figs-metaphor]])
10:40 u2wq 0 Jesus continues to instruct his disciples about the reasons why they should not be afraid of the persecution that they might experience.
10:40 asg3 rc://*/ta/man/translate/figs-gendernotations ὁ δεχόμενος 1 The word “He” refers to anyone in general. Alternate translation: “Whoever” or “Anyone who” or “The one who” (See: [[rc://*/ta/man/translate/figs-gendernotations]])
10:40 c77e ὁ δεχόμενος 1 This means to receive someone as a guest.
10:40 ir49 rc://*/ta/man/translate/figs-you ὑμᾶς 1 This is plural and refers to the twelve apostles to whom Jesus is speaking. (See: [[rc://*/ta/man/translate/figs-you]])
10:40 pf1j ὁ δεχόμενος ὑμᾶς ἐμὲ δέχεται 1 Jesus means that when someone welcomes you, it is like welcoming him. Alternate translation: “When someone welcomes you, it is like he is welcoming me” or “If someone welcomes you, it is as if he were welcoming me”
10:40 y9ck ὁ ἐμὲ δεχόμενος δέχεται τὸν ἀποστείλαντά με 1 This means that when someone welcomes Jesus, it is like welcoming God. Alternate translation: “When someone welcomes me, it is like he is welcoming God the Father who sent me” or “If someone welcomes me, it is as if he were welcoming God the Father who sent me”
10:41 g43d εἰς ὄνομα προφήτου 1 Here “he” does not refer to the person who is welcoming. It refers to the person being welcomed.
10:41 yj1q μισθὸν προφήτου 1 This refers to the reward that God gives the prophet, not to the reward that a prophet gives to another person.
10:41 gjf3 εἰς ὄνομα δικαίου 1 Here “he” does not refer to the person who is welcoming. It refers to the person being welcomed.
10:41 qfv7 μισθὸν δικαίου 1 This refers to the reward God gives to a righteous person, not a reward that a righteous person gives to another person.
10:42 wx4a 0 Jesus finishes instructing his disciples about what they should do and expect when they go to preach.
10:42 v6jg καὶ ὃς ἐὰν ποτίσῃ 1 “Anyone who gives”
10:42 z8tk ἕνα τῶν μικρῶν τούτων 1 “one of these lowly ones” or “the least important of these.” The phrase “one of these” here refers to one of Jesus disciples.
10:42 lza6 εἰς ὄνομα μαθητοῦ 1 “because he is my disciple.” Here “he” does not refer to the one giving but to the unimportant one.
10:42 wx29 ἀμὴν, λέγω ὑμῖν 1 “I tell you the truth.” This phrase adds emphasis to what Jesus says next.
10:42 y1ie οὐ μὴ ἀπολέσῃ τὸν μισθὸν αὐτοῦ 1 Here “he” and “his” refer to the one who is giving.
10:42 d61l οὐ μὴ ἀπολέσῃ 1 “God will not deny him.” This has nothing to do with having a possession taken away. It can be stated in positive form. Alternate translation: “God will certainly give him”
11:intro puf4 0 # Matthew 11 General Notes\n## Structure and formatting\n\nSome translations set quotations from the Old Testament farther to the right on the page than the rest of the text. The ULT does this with the quoted material in 11:10.\n\nSome scholars believe that [Matthew 11:20](../../mat/11/20.md) begins a new stage in the ministry of Christ because of Israels rejection of him.\n\n## Special concepts in this chapter\n\n### Hidden revelation\n\nAfter [Matthew 11:20](../../mat/11/20.md), Jesus begins to reveal information about himself and about the plans of God the Father, while hiding this information from those who reject him ([Matthew 11:25](../../mat/11/25.md)).\n\n## Other possible translation difficulties in this chapter\n\n### “The kingdom of heaven is near”\n\nNo one knows for sure whether the “kingdom of heaven” was present or still coming when John spoke these words. English translations often use the phrase “at hand,” but these words can be difficult to translate. Other versions use the phrases “is coming near” and “has come near.”
11:1 z2y7 rc://*/ta/man/translate/writing-newevent 0 This is the beginning of a new part of the story where Matthew tells of how Jesus responded to disciples of John the Baptist. (See: [[rc://*/ta/man/translate/writing-newevent]])
11:1 dr3u καὶ ἐγένετο ὅτε 1 This phrase shifts the story from Jesus teachings to what happened next. Alternate translation: “Then” or “After”
11:1 ki7f ἐτέλεσεν & διατάσσων 1 “had finished teaching” or “had finished commanding.”
11:1 m6h5 rc://*/ta/man/translate/translate-numbers τοῖς δώδεκα μαθηταῖς αὐτοῦ 1 This refers to the twelve chosen apostles of Jesus. (See: [[rc://*/ta/man/translate/translate-numbers]])
11:1 ju1q ἐν ταῖς πόλεσιν αὐτῶν 1 Here “their” refers to all the Jews in general.
11:2 n2dc δὲ 1 This word is used here to mark a break in the main story line. Here Matthew starts to tell a new part of the story.
11:2 f3j7 ὁ & Ἰωάννης, ἀκούσας ἐν τῷ δεσμωτηρίῳ 1 “When John, who was in prison, heard about” or “When someone told John, who was in prison, about.” Even though Matthew has not yet told the readers that King Herod put John the Baptist in jail, the original audience would have been familiar with the story and understood the implicit information here. Matthew will give more information later about John the Baptist, so it is probably best not to make it explicit here.
11:2 xre1 πέμψας διὰ τῶν μαθητῶν αὐτοῦ 1 John the Baptist sent his own disciples with a message to Jesus.
11:3 w2im εἶπεν αὐτῷ 1 The pronoun “him” refers to Jesus.
11:3 q89t σὺ εἶ ὁ ἐρχόμενος 1 “Are you the one whom we are expecting to come.” This is another way to refer to the Messiah or Christ.
11:3 hrk5 ἕτερον προσδοκῶμεν? 1 “should we be expecting someone else.” The pronoun “we” refers to all Jews, not only Johns disciples.
11:4 a66r ἀπαγγείλατε Ἰωάννῃ 1 “tell John”
11:5 sd6c rc://*/ta/man/translate/figs-activepassive λεπροὶ καθαρίζονται 1 This can be stated in active form. Alternate translation: “I am healing lepers” (See: [[rc://*/ta/man/translate/figs-activepassive]])
11:5 v274 rc://*/ta/man/translate/figs-activepassive νεκροὶ ἐγείρονται 1 Here to raise up is an idiom for causing someone who has died to become alive again. This can be stated in active form. Alternate translation: “people who have died are being caused to live again” or “I am causing those who have died to become alive again” (See: [[rc://*/ta/man/translate/figs-activepassive]] and [[rc://*/ta/man/translate/figs-idiom]])
11:5 g3k4 rc://*/ta/man/translate/figs-activepassive πτωχοὶ εὐαγγελίζονται 1 This can be stated in active form. Alternate translation: “I am preaching good news to the poor” (See: [[rc://*/ta/man/translate/figs-activepassive]])
11:5 l443 rc://*/ta/man/translate/figs-nominaladj πτωχοὶ 1 This nominalized adjective can be translated as a noun phrase. Alternate translation: “poor people” (See: [[rc://*/ta/man/translate/figs-nominaladj]])
11:7 g2q8 0 Jesus begins to talk to the crowds about John the Baptist.
11:7 ysq6 rc://*/ta/man/translate/figs-rquestion τί ἐξήλθατε εἰς τὴν ἔρημον θεάσασθαι? κάλαμον ὑπὸ ἀνέμου σαλευόμενον? 1 Jesus uses a question to cause the people to think about what kind of person John the Baptist is. Alternate translation: “Surely you did not go out to the desert to see a reed … wind!” (See: [[rc://*/ta/man/translate/figs-rquestion]])
11:7 pc6c rc://*/ta/man/translate/figs-metaphor κάλαμον ὑπὸ ἀνέμου σαλευόμενον 1 Possible meanings are (1) Jesus mean the literal plants by the Jordan River or (2) Jesus is using a metaphor to mean a kind of person. Alternate translation: “a man who easily changes his mind and is like a reed blowing back and forth in the wind” (See: [[rc://*/ta/man/translate/figs-metaphor]])
11:7 w269 rc://*/ta/man/translate/figs-activepassive ὑπὸ ἀνέμου σαλευόμενον 1 This can be translated in active form. Alternate translation: “swaying in the wind” or “blowing in the wind” (See: [[rc://*/ta/man/translate/figs-activepassive]])
11:8 n5hx rc://*/ta/man/translate/figs-rquestion ἀλλὰ τί ἐξήλθατε ἰδεῖν? ἄνθρωπον ἐν μαλακοῖς ἠμφιεσμένον? 1 Jesus uses a question to cause the people to think about what kind of person John the Baptist is. Alternate translation: And, surely you did not go out to the desert to see a man … clothing!” (See: [[rc://*/ta/man/translate/figs-rquestion]])
11:8 y24r ἐν μαλακοῖς ἠμφιεσμένον 1 “wearing expensive clothing.” Rich people wore this kind of clothing.
11:8 tmb9 ἰδοὺ 1 This word adds emphasis to what follows. Alternate translation: “Indeed”
11:8 v9k2 τοῖς οἴκοις τῶν βασιλέων 1 “kings palaces”
11:9 cgm4 0 In verse 10, Jesus quotes the prophet Malachi to show that the life and ministry of John the Baptist fulfilled prophecy.
11:9 w9su 0 Jesus continues to talk to the crowds about John the Baptist.
11:9 gm97 rc://*/ta/man/translate/figs-rquestion ἀλλὰ τί ἐξήλθατε? προφήτην ἰδεῖν 1 Jesus uses a question to make the people think about what kind of man John the Baptist is. Alternate translation: “But surely you went out to the desert to see a prophet!” (See: [[rc://*/ta/man/translate/figs-rquestion]])
11:9 nkd4 ναί, λέγω ὑμῖν 1 “I say to you yes,”
11:9 fb75 rc://*/ta/man/translate/figs-ellipsis περισσότερον προφήτου 1 This can be translated as a complete sentence. Alternate translation: “he is not an ordinary prophet” or “he is more important than a normal prophet” (See: [[rc://*/ta/man/translate/figs-ellipsis]])
11:10 de17 rc://*/ta/man/translate/figs-activepassive οὗτός ἐστιν περὶ οὗ γέγραπται 1 This can be stated in active form. Alternate translation: “This is what the prophet Malachi wrote long ago about John the Baptist” (See: [[rc://*/ta/man/translate/figs-activepassive]])
11:10 ql5h ἐγὼ ἀποστέλλω τὸν ἄγγελόν μου 1 The pronouns “I” and “my” refer to God. Malachi is quoting what God said.
11:10 fi5e rc://*/ta/man/translate/figs-you πρὸ προσώπου σου 1 Here “your” is singular, because God was speaking to the Messiah in the quotation. Also, “face” refers to the whole person. Alternate translation: “in front of you” or “to go ahead of you” (See: [[rc://*/ta/man/translate/figs-you]] and [[rc://*/ta/man/translate/figs-synecdoche]])
11:10 kva7 rc://*/ta/man/translate/figs-metaphor κατασκευάσει τὴν ὁδόν σου ἔμπροσθέν σου 1 This is a metaphor that means the messenger will prepare the people to receive the Messiahs message. (See: [[rc://*/ta/man/translate/figs-metaphor]])
11:11 c7pp 0 Jesus continues to talk to the crowds about John the Baptist.
11:11 j7gw ἀμὴν, λέγω ὑμῖν 1 “I tell you the truth.” This phrase adds emphasis to what Jesus says next.
11:11 z5yq rc://*/ta/man/translate/figs-idiom ἐν γεννητοῖς γυναικῶν 1 Even though Adam was not born of a women, this is a way of referring to all humans. Alternate translation: “out of all people who have ever lived” (See: [[rc://*/ta/man/translate/figs-idiom]])
11:11 q2kp μείζων Ἰωάννου τοῦ Βαπτιστοῦ 1 This can be stated in positive form. Alternate translation: “John the Baptist is the greatest” or “John the Baptist is the most important”
11:11 cag4 rc://*/ta/man/translate/figs-metonymy ὁ & μικρότερος ἐν τῇ Βασιλεία τῶν Οὐρανῶν 1 Here “kingdom of heaven” refers to Gods rule as king. The phrase “kingdom of heaven” is used only in Matthew. If possible, try to keep “heaven” in your translation. Alternate translation: “the least important person under the rule of our God in heaven” (See: [[rc://*/ta/man/translate/figs-metonymy]])
11:11 p5ir μείζων αὐτοῦ ἐστιν 1 “is more important than John is”
11:12 mb4v ἀπὸ δὲ τῶν ἡμερῶν Ἰωάννου τοῦ Βαπτιστοῦ 1 “From the time John began preaching his message.” The word “days” probably refers here to a period of months or even years.
11:12 inr2 ἡ Βασιλεία τῶν Οὐρανῶν βιάζεται, καὶ βιασταὶ ἁρπάζουσιν αὐτήν 1 There are various possible interpretations of this verse. The UST assumes that it means that some people want to use Gods kingdom for their own selfish purposes, and that they are willing to use force against other people to accomplish this. Other versions assume a positive interpretation, that the call to enter the kingdom of God has become so urgent, that people must act in an extreme manner in order to answer that call and to resist the temptation to sin further. A third interpretation is that violent people are harming Gods people and trying to stop God from ruling.
11:13 v3el 0 Jesus continues to talk to the crowds about John the Baptist.
11:13 g1i6 rc://*/ta/man/translate/figs-metonymy πάντες & οἱ προφῆται καὶ ὁ νόμος ἕως Ἰωάννου ἐπροφήτευσαν 1 Here “prophets and the law” refer to the things that the prophets and Moses wrote in scripture. Alternate translation: “for these are the things that the prophets and Moses have prophesied through the scriptures until the time of John the Baptist” (See: [[rc://*/ta/man/translate/figs-metonymy]])
11:14 yg2f rc://*/ta/man/translate/figs-you εἰ θέλετε 1 Here “you” is plural and refers to the crowd. (See: [[rc://*/ta/man/translate/figs-you]])
11:14 e68u αὐτός ἐστιν Ἠλείας, ὁ μέλλων ἔρχεσθαι 1 The word “he” refers to John the Baptist. This does not mean John the Baptist is literally Elijah. Jesus means John the Baptist fulfills the prophecy about “Elijah, who is to come” or the next Elijah. Alternate translation: “when the prophet Malachi said that Elijah would return, he was speaking about John the Baptist”
11:15 z97x rc://*/ta/man/translate/figs-metonymy ὁ ἔχων ὦτα ἀκούειν, ἀκουέτω 1 Jesus is emphasizing that what he has just said is important and may take some effort to understand and put into practice. The phrase “ears to hear” here is a metonym for the willingness to understand and obey. Alternate translation: “Let the one who is willing to listen, listen” or “The one who is willing to understand, let him understand and obey” (See: [[rc://*/ta/man/translate/figs-metonymy]])
11:15 w4cc rc://*/ta/man/translate/figs-123person ὁ ἔχων & ἀκουέτω 1 Since Jesus is speaking directly to his audience, you may prefer to use the second person here. Alternate translation: “If you are willing to listen, listen” or “If you are willing to understand, then understand and obey” (See: [[rc://*/ta/man/translate/figs-123person]])
11:16 q1s5 0 Jesus continues to talk to the crowds about John the Baptist.
11:16 mp8g rc://*/ta/man/translate/figs-rquestion τίνι δὲ ὁμοιώσω τὴν γενεὰν ταύτην? 1 Jesus uses a question to introduce a comparison between the people of that day and what children might say in the marketplace. Alternate translation: “This is what this generation is like” (See: [[rc://*/ta/man/translate/figs-rquestion]])
11:16 yat1 τὴν γενεὰν ταύτην 1 “the people living now” or “these people” or “you people of this generation”
11:16 l7km ταῖς ἀγοραῖς 1 a large, open-air area where people buy and sell items
11:17 wn37 0 Jesus continues the parable that begins with the words “It is like” in verse 16.
11:17 ai4e rc://*/ta/man/translate/figs-parables λέγουσιν & καὶ οὐκ ἐκόψασθε 1 Jesus uses a parable to describe the people who were alive at that time. He compares them to a group of children who are trying to get the other children to play with them. However, no matter way they do, the other children will not join them. Jesus means that it does not matter if God sends someone like John the Baptist, who lives in the desert and fasts, or someone like Jesus, who celebrates with sinners and does not fast. The people, most specifically the Pharisees and religious leaders, still remain stubborn and refuse to accept Gods truth. (See: [[rc://*/ta/man/translate/figs-parables]] and [[rc://*/ta/man/translate/figs-simile]])
11:17 d916 rc://*/ta/man/translate/figs-you ηὐλήσαμεν ὑμῖν 1 “We” refers to the children sitting in the marketplace. Here “you” is plural and refers to the other group of children. (See: [[rc://*/ta/man/translate/figs-you]])
11:17 j5jd καὶ οὐκ ὠρχήσασθε 1 “but you did not dance to the happy music”
11:17 t723 rc://*/ta/man/translate/figs-explicit ἐθρηνήσαμεν 1 This means they sang sad songs like women did at funerals. (See: [[rc://*/ta/man/translate/figs-explicit]])
11:17 f87l καὶ οὐκ ἐκόψασθε 1 “but you did not cry with us”
11:18 svc9 0 Jesus concludes talking to the crowds about John the Baptist.
11:18 qe7y rc://*/ta/man/translate/figs-synecdoche μήτε ἐσθίων μήτε πίνων 1 Here “bread” refers to food. It does not mean that John never ate food. It means he fasted often, and when he ate, he did not eat good, expensive food. Alternate translation: “frequently fasting and not drinking alcohol” or “not eating fancy food and not drinking wine” (See: [[rc://*/ta/man/translate/figs-synecdoche]] and [[rc://*/ta/man/translate/figs-explicit]])
11:18 p4ql rc://*/ta/man/translate/figs-quotations λέγουσιν, δαιμόνιον ἔχει. 1 This can be translated as an indirect quote. Alternate translation: “they say that he has a demon” or “they accuse him of having a demon” (See: [[rc://*/ta/man/translate/figs-quotations]])
11:18 kd4q λέγουσιν 1 All occurrences of “they” refer to the people of that generation, and most specifically to the Pharisees and religious leaders.
11:19 iwk8 rc://*/ta/man/translate/figs-123person ἦλθεν ὁ Υἱὸς τοῦ Ἀνθρώπου 1 Jesus is referring to himself. Alternate translation: “I, the Son of Man, came” (See: [[rc://*/ta/man/translate/figs-123person]])
11:19 gs6z ἦλθεν & ἐσθίων καὶ πίνων 1 This is the opposite of Johns behavior. This means more than just consuming the normal amount of food and drink. It means Jesus celebrated and enjoyed good food and drink like other people did.
11:19 x4ec rc://*/ta/man/translate/figs-quotations λέγουσιν, ἰδοὺ, ἄνθρωπος, φάγος καὶ οἰνοπότης & ἁμαρτωλῶν! 1 This can be translated as an indirect quote. Alternate translation: “they say that he is a gluttonous man and a drunkard … sinners.” or “they accuse him of eating and drinking too much and of being … sinners.” If you translated “The Son of Man” as “I, the Son of man,” you can state this as an indirect statement and use the first person. Alternate translation: “they say that I am a gluttonous man and a drunkard … sinners.” (See: [[rc://*/ta/man/translate/figs-quotations]] and [[rc://*/ta/man/translate/figs-123person]])
11:19 d6gu ἄνθρωπος, φάγος 1 “he is a greedy eater” or “he continually eats too much food”
11:19 pv4n οἰνοπότης 1 “a drunk” or “he continually drinks too much alcohol”
11:19 vwk4 rc://*/ta/man/translate/writing-proverbs καὶ ἐδικαιώθη ἡ σοφία ἀπὸ τῶν τέκνων αὐτῆς 1 This is a proverb that Jesus applies to this situation, because the people who rejected both him and John were not being wise. Jesus and John the Baptist are the wise ones, and the results of their deeds prove it. (See: [[rc://*/ta/man/translate/writing-proverbs]])
11:19 dz3c rc://*/ta/man/translate/figs-personification ἐδικαιώθη ἡ σοφία ἀπὸ τῶν τέκνων αὐτῆς 1 Here “wisdom” is described as a woman who is proven to be right by what she does. Jesus means that the results of a wise persons actions prove that he is truly wise. This can be stated in active form. Alternate translation: “the results of a wise persons deeds prove that he is wise” (See: [[rc://*/ta/man/translate/figs-personification]] and [[rc://*/ta/man/translate/figs-activepassive]])
11:20 bwq8 0 Jesus begins to rebuke the people of the cities where he previously did miracles.
11:20 w4g8 rc://*/ta/man/translate/figs-metonymy ὀνειδίζειν τὰς πόλεις 1 Here “the cities” refers to the people who live there. Alternate translation: “rebuke the people of the cities” (See: [[rc://*/ta/man/translate/figs-metonymy]])
11:20 fxs4 πόλεις 1 “towns”
11:20 t51a rc://*/ta/man/translate/figs-activepassive ἐν αἷς ἐγένοντο αἱ πλεῖσται δυνάμεις αὐτοῦ 1 This can be translated in active form. Alternate translation: “in which he did most of his mighty deeds” (See: [[rc://*/ta/man/translate/figs-activepassive]])
11:20 wh1g αἱ πλεῖσται δυνάμεις αὐτοῦ 1 “mighty works” or “works of power” or “miracles”
11:21 xxb3 rc://*/ta/man/translate/figs-apostrophe οὐαί σοι, Χοραζείν! οὐαί σοι, Βηθσαϊδάν! 1 Jesus speaks as if the people of the cities of Chorazin and Bethsaida were there listening to him, but they were not. (See: [[rc://*/ta/man/translate/figs-apostrophe]])
11:21 tv81 rc://*/ta/man/translate/figs-you οὐαί σοι 1 “How terrible it will be for you.” Here “you” is singular and refers to the city. If it is more natural to refer to the people instead of a city, you could translate with a plural “you.” (See: [[rc://*/ta/man/translate/figs-you]])
11:21 y9d3 rc://*/ta/man/translate/figs-metonymy Χοραζείν & Βηθσαϊδάν & Τύρῳ & Σιδῶνι 1 The names of these cities are used as metonyms for the people living in these cities. (See: [[rc://*/ta/man/translate/figs-metonymy]] and [[rc://*/ta/man/translate/translate-names]])
11:21 lh46 rc://*/ta/man/translate/figs-hypo εἰ & αἱ δυνάμεις & ἂν ἐν σάκκῳ καὶ σποδῷ 1 Jesus is describing a hypothetical situation that could have happened in the past, but it did not. (See: [[rc://*/ta/man/translate/figs-hypo]])
11:21 tm59 rc://*/ta/man/translate/figs-activepassive εἰ ἐν Τύρῳ καὶ Σιδῶνι ἐγένοντο αἱ δυνάμεις αἱ γενόμεναι ἐν ὑμῖν 1 This can be translated with active forms. Alternate translation: “If I had done the mighty deeds among the people of Tyre and Sidon that I have done among you” (See: [[rc://*/ta/man/translate/figs-activepassive]])
11:21 k3in rc://*/ta/man/translate/figs-you αἱ γενόμεναι ἐν ὑμῖν 1 Here the “you” is plural and refers to Chorazin and Bethsaida. If it is more natural for your language, you could use a dual “you” to refer to the two cities, or a plural “you” to refer to the people of the cities. (See: [[rc://*/ta/man/translate/figs-you]])
11:21 bqi8 πάλαι & μετενόησαν 1 The pronoun “they” refers to the people of Tyre and Sidon.
11:21 qx9m μετενόησαν 1 “would have shown they were sorry for their sins”
11:22 mr18 rc://*/ta/man/translate/figs-metonymy Τύρῳ καὶ Σιδῶνι ἀνεκτότερον ἔσται ἐν ἡμέρᾳ κρίσεως ἢ ὑμῖν 1 Here “Tyre and Sidon” refers to the people who live there. Alternate translation: “God will show more mercy to the people of Tyre and Sidon in the day of judgment than to you” or “God will punish you more severely at the day of judgment than the people of Tyre and Sidon” (See: [[rc://*/ta/man/translate/figs-metonymy]])
11:22 ab14 rc://*/ta/man/translate/figs-you ἢ ὑμῖν 1 Here the “you” is plural and refers to Chorazin and Bethsaida. If it is more natural for your language, you could use a dual “you” to refer to the two cities, or a plural “you” to refer to the people of the cities. The implied information can be made explicit. AT “than for you, because you did not repent and believe in me, even though you saw me do miracles” (See: [[rc://*/ta/man/translate/figs-you]] and [[rc://*/ta/man/translate/figs-explicit]])
11:23 udw1 0 Jesus continues to rebuke the people of the cities where he previously did miracles.
11:23 vpz6 rc://*/ta/man/translate/figs-apostrophe σύ, Καφαρναούμ 1 Jesus now speaks to the people in the city of Capernaum as if they were listening to him, but they were not. The pronoun “you” is singular and refers to Capernaum throughout these two verses. (See: [[rc://*/ta/man/translate/figs-apostrophe]])
11:23 h8av rc://*/ta/man/translate/figs-you σύ 1 All occurrences of “you” are singular. If it is more natural to refer to the people of the city, you could translate with a plural “you.” (See: [[rc://*/ta/man/translate/figs-you]])
11:23 fj7d rc://*/ta/man/translate/figs-metonymy Καφαρναούμ & Σοδόμοις 1 The names of these cities refer to the people living in Capernaum and in Sodom. (See: [[rc://*/ta/man/translate/figs-metonymy]])
11:23 aa7t rc://*/ta/man/translate/figs-rquestion μὴ ἕως οὐρανοῦ ὑψωθήσῃ? 1 “do you think you will be raised up to heaven?” Jesus uses a rhetorical question to rebuke the people of Capernaum for their pride. It can be stated in active form: Alternate translation: “you cannot raise yourself up to heaven!” or “the praise of other people will not raise you up to heaven!” or “God will not bring you up to heaven like you think he will!” (See: [[rc://*/ta/man/translate/figs-rquestion]] and [[rc://*/ta/man/translate/figs-activepassive]])
11:23 d54d rc://*/ta/man/translate/figs-activepassive ἕως ᾍδου καταβήσῃ 1 This can be stated in active form. Alternate translation: “God will send you down to Hades” (See: [[rc://*/ta/man/translate/figs-activepassive]])
11:23 vk57 rc://*/ta/man/translate/figs-hypo ὅτι εἰ ἐν Σοδόμοις & ἔμεινεν ἂν μέχρι τῆς σήμερον 1 Jesus is describing a hypothetical situation that could have happened in the past, but it did not. (See: [[rc://*/ta/man/translate/figs-hypo]])
11:23 z279 rc://*/ta/man/translate/figs-activepassive εἰ ἐν Σοδόμοις ἐγενήθησαν αἱ δυνάμεις αἱ γενόμεναι ἐν σοί 1 This can be stated in active form. Alternate translation: “if I had done the mighty deeds among the people of Sodom that I have done among you” (See: [[rc://*/ta/man/translate/figs-activepassive]])
11:23 e2t7 δυνάμεις 1 “mighty works” or “works of power” or “miracles”
11:23 yih1 ἔμεινεν 1 The pronoun “it” refers to the city of Sodom.
11:24 y1e3 λέγω ὑμῖν 1 This phrase adds emphasis to what Jesus says next.
11:24 e3pa rc://*/ta/man/translate/figs-metonymy γῇ Σοδόμων ἀνεκτότερον ἔσται ἐν ἡμέρᾳ κρίσεως ἢ σοί 1 Here “land of Sodom” refer to the people who lived there. Alternate translation: “God will show more mercy to the people of Sodom in the day of judgment than to you” or “God will punish you more severely in the day of judgment than the people of Sodom” (See: [[rc://*/ta/man/translate/figs-metonymy]])
11:24 yk3z rc://*/ta/man/translate/figs-explicit ἢ σοί 1 The implicit information can be made explicit. Alternate translation: “than for you, because you did not repent and believe in me, even though you saw me do miracles” (See: [[rc://*/ta/man/translate/figs-explicit]])
11:25 f57a 0 In verses 25 and 26, Jesus prays to his heavenly Father while still in the presence of the crowd. In verse 27, he begins to address the people again.
11:25 h5x4 rc://*/ta/man/translate/guidelines-sonofgodprinciples Πάτερ 1 This is an important title for God. (See: [[rc://*/ta/man/translate/guidelines-sonofgodprinciples]])
11:25 u9cy rc://*/ta/man/translate/figs-merism Κύριε τοῦ οὐρανοῦ καὶ τῆς γῆς 1 “Lord who rules over heaven and earth.” The phrase “heaven and earth” is a merism that refers to all people and things in the universe. Alternate translation: “Lord who rules over the whole universe” (See: [[rc://*/ta/man/translate/figs-merism]])
11:25 p1gl ἔκρυψας ταῦτα & καὶ ἀπεκάλυψας αὐτὰ 1 It is not clear what is meant by “these things.” If your language needs to specify what is meant, an alternative translation might be best. Alternate translation: “you concealed these truths … and revealed them”
11:25 lk8f ἔκρυψας ταῦτα ἀπὸ 1 “you hid these things from” or “you have not made these things known to.” This verb is the opposite of “revealed.”
11:25 qw5c rc://*/ta/man/translate/figs-nominaladj ἀπὸ σοφῶν καὶ συνετῶν 1 These nominal adjectives can be translated as adjectives. Alternate translation: “from people who are wise and understanding” (See: [[rc://*/ta/man/translate/figs-nominaladj]])
11:25 las9 rc://*/ta/man/translate/figs-irony σοφῶν καὶ συνετῶν 1 Jesus is using irony. He does not think these people are really wise. Alternate translation: “people who think they are wise and understanding” (See: [[rc://*/ta/man/translate/figs-irony]])
11:25 uwu5 ἀπεκάλυψας αὐτὰ 1 “made them known.” The pronoun “them” refers to “these things” earlier in this verse.
11:25 b6w5 rc://*/ta/man/translate/figs-metaphor νηπίοις 1 Jesus compares ignorant people to little children. Jesus is emphasizing that many of those who believe him either are not well educated or do not think of themselves as wise. (See: [[rc://*/ta/man/translate/figs-metaphor]])
11:26 qp7t rc://*/ta/man/translate/figs-metonymy ὅτι οὕτως εὐδοκία ἐγένετο ἔμπροσθέν σου 1 The phrase “in your sight” is a metonym that stands for how a person considers something. Alternate translation: “for you considered it good to do this” (See: [[rc://*/ta/man/translate/figs-metonymy]])
11:27 yk5w rc://*/ta/man/translate/figs-activepassive πάντα μοι παρεδόθη ὑπὸ τοῦ Πατρός μου 1 This can be stated in active form. Alternate translation: “My Father has entrusted all things to me” or “My Father has given everything over to me” (See: [[rc://*/ta/man/translate/figs-activepassive]])
11:27 gd67 πάντα 1 Possible meanings are (1) God the Father has revealed everything about himself and his kingdom to Jesus or (2) God has given all authority to Jesus.
11:27 j3vk rc://*/ta/man/translate/guidelines-sonofgodprinciples τοῦ Πατρός μου 1 This is an important title for God that describes the relationship between God and Jesus. (See: [[rc://*/ta/man/translate/guidelines-sonofgodprinciples]])
11:27 s1as οὐδεὶς ἐπιγινώσκει τὸν Υἱὸν, εἰ μὴ ὁ Πατήρ 1 “only the Father knows the Son”
11:27 rt5b οὐδεὶς ἐπιγινώσκει 1 The word “knows” here means more than just being acquainted with someone. It means knowing somoene intimately because of having a special relationship with him.
11:27 esp4 rc://*/ta/man/translate/figs-123person τὸν Υἱὸν 1 Jesus was referring to himself in the third person. (See: [[rc://*/ta/man/translate/figs-123person]])
11:27 l8xe rc://*/ta/man/translate/guidelines-sonofgodprinciples τὸν Υἱὸν 1 This is an important title for Jesus, the Son of God. (See: [[rc://*/ta/man/translate/guidelines-sonofgodprinciples]])
11:27 w6yq οὐδὲ τὸν Πατέρα τις ἐπιγινώσκει, εἰ μὴ ὁ Υἱὸς 1 “only the Son knows the Father”
11:28 q9x1 0 Jesus finishes speaking to the crowd.
11:28 x978 rc://*/ta/man/translate/figs-you πάντες 1 All occurrences of “you” are plural. (See: [[rc://*/ta/man/translate/figs-you]])
11:28 t2jj rc://*/ta/man/translate/figs-metaphor οἱ κοπιῶντες καὶ πεφορτισμένοι 1 Jesus speaks of people being discouraged in their attempts to obey all the laws as if those laws were heavy burdens and the people were laboring to carry them. Alternate translation: “who are discouraged from trying so hard” or “Who are discouraged from trying so hard to obey the laws perfectly” (See: [[rc://*/ta/man/translate/figs-metaphor]])
11:28 f1w4 κἀγὼ ἀναπαύσω ὑμᾶς 1 “I will allow you to rest from your labor and burden”
11:29 q1ya rc://*/ta/man/translate/figs-metaphor ἄρατε τὸν ζυγόν μου ἐφ’ ὑμᾶς 1 Jesus continues the metaphor. Jesus is inviting the people to become his disciples and follow him. (See: [[rc://*/ta/man/translate/figs-metaphor]])
11:29 t1rh rc://*/ta/man/translate/figs-doublet πραΰς εἰμι καὶ ταπεινὸς τῇ καρδίᾳ 1 Here “meek” and “lowly in heart” mean basically the same thing. Jesus combines them to emphasize that he will be much kinder than the religious leaders. Alternate translation: “I am gentle and humble” or “I am very gentle” (See: [[rc://*/ta/man/translate/figs-doublet]])
11:29 i3qs rc://*/ta/man/translate/figs-metonymy ταπεινὸς τῇ καρδίᾳ 1 Here “heart” is a metonym for a persons inner being. The phrase “lowly in heart” is an idiom that means “humble.” Alternate translation: “humble” (See: [[rc://*/ta/man/translate/figs-metonymy]] and [[rc://*/ta/man/translate/figs-idiom]])
11:29 i3ls rc://*/ta/man/translate/figs-synecdoche εὑρήσετε ἀνάπαυσιν ταῖς ψυχαῖς ὑμῶν 1 Here “soul” refers to the entire person. Alternate translation: “you will find rest for yourselves” or “you will be able to rest” (See: [[rc://*/ta/man/translate/figs-synecdoche]])
11:30 ynf1 rc://*/ta/man/translate/figs-parallelism ὁ γὰρ ζυγός μου χρηστὸς καὶ τὸ φορτίον μου ἐλαφρόν ἐστιν 1 Both of these phrases mean the same thing. Jesus is emphasizing that it is easier to obey him than it is the Jewish law. Alternate translation: “For what I place on you, you will be able to carry because it is light” (See: [[rc://*/ta/man/translate/figs-parallelism]])
11:30 tc2g τὸ φορτίον μου ἐλαφρόν ἐστιν 1 The word “light” here is the opposite of heavy, not the opposite of dark.
12:intro y7z6 0 # Matthew 12 General Notes\n## Structure and formatting\n\nSome translations set each line of poetry farther to the right than the rest of the text to make it easier to read. The ULT does this with the poetry in 12:18-21, which are words from the Old Testament.\n\n## Special concepts in this chapter\n\n### The Sabbath\n\nThis chapter has much to say about how Gods people are to obey the Sabbath. Jesus said that the rules that the Pharisees made up did not help people obey the Sabbath the way God wanted them to. (See: [[rc://*/tw/dict/bible/kt/sabbath]])\n\n### “Blasphemy against the Spirit”\n\nNo one knows for sure what actions people perform or what words they say when they commit this sin. However, they probably insult the Holy Spirit and his work. Part of the Holy Spirits work is to make people understand that they are sinners and that they need to have God forgive them. Therefore, anyone who does not try to stop sinning is probably committing blasphemy against the Spirit. (See: [[rc://*/tw/dict/bible/kt/blasphemy]] and [[rc://*/tw/dict/bible/kt/holyspirit]])\n\n## Other possible translation difficulties in this chapter\n\n### Brothers and sisters\n\nMost people call those who have the same parents “brother” and “sister” and think of them as the most important people in their lives. Many people also call those with the same grandparents “brother” and “sister.” In this chapter Jesus says that the most important people to him are those who obey his Father in heaven. (See: [[rc://*/tw/dict/bible/kt/brother]])
12:1 u1f2 0 This is the beginning of a new part of the story where Matthew tells of growing opposition to Jesus ministry. Here, the Pharisees criticize his disciples for picking grain on the Sabbath.
12:1 m2n1 ἐν ἐκείνῳ τῷ καιρῷ 1 This marks a new part of the story. Alternate translation: “A little later”
12:1 tvt9 rc://*/ta/man/translate/translate-unknown τῶν σπορίμων 1 a place to plant grain. If wheat is unknown and “grain” is too general, then you can use “fields of the plant they made bread from.” (See: [[rc://*/ta/man/translate/translate-unknown]])
12:1 yrf8 τίλλειν στάχυας καὶ ἐσθίειν 1 Picking grain in others fields and eating it was not considered stealing. The question was whether one could do this otherwise lawful activity on the Sabbath.
12:1 zz4r τίλλειν στάχυας καὶ ἐσθίειν 1 “to pick some of the wheat and eat it” or “to pick some of the grain and eat it”
12:1 y5vr στάχυας 1 This is the topmost part of the wheat plant. It holds the mature grain or seeds of the plant.
12:2 swl7 ποιοῦσιν ὃ οὐκ ἔξεστιν ποιεῖν ἐν Σαββάτῳ 1 Picking grain in others fields and eating it was not considered stealing. The question was whether one could do this otherwise lawful activity on the Sabbath.
12:2 mch7 οἱ & Φαρισαῖοι 1 This does not mean all of the Pharisees. Alternate translation: “some Pharisees”
12:2 nh12 ἰδοὺ, οἱ μαθηταί σου 1 “Look, your disciples.” The Pharisees use this word to draw attention to what the disciples are doing.
12:3 mzn1 0 Jesus responds to the Pharisees criticism.
12:3 et11 αὐτοῖς 1 “to the Pharisees”
12:3 d712 rc://*/ta/man/translate/figs-rquestion οὐκ ἀνέγνωτε & μετ’ αὐτοῦ? 1 Jesus uses a question to respond to the criticism of the Pharisees. Jesus is challenging them to think about the meaning of the scriptures they have read. Alternate translation: “I know you have read about … with him” (See: [[rc://*/ta/man/translate/figs-rquestion]])
12:4 blm5 τὸν οἶκον τοῦ Θεοῦ 1 During the time of David there was no temple yet. Alternate translation: “the tabernacle” or “the place for worshiping God”
12:4 ue7l rc://*/ta/man/translate/figs-explicit τοὺς ἄρτους τῆς Προθέσεως 1 This is sacred bread that priests placed before God in the tabernacle. Alternate translation: “bread that the priest placed before God” or “the sacred bread” (See: [[rc://*/ta/man/translate/figs-explicit]])
12:4 c6a8 τοῖς μετ’ αὐτοῦ 1 “the men who were with David”
12:4 lkx9 εἰ μὴ τοῖς ἱερεῦσιν μόνοις 1 “but, according to the law, only the priest could eat it”
12:5 tjh3 0 Jesus continues to respond to the Pharisees.
12:5 f79q rc://*/ta/man/translate/figs-rquestion οὐκ ἀνέγνωτε ἐν τῷ νόμῳ, ὅτι & ἀναίτιοί εἰσιν? 1 Jesus uses a question to respond to the criticism of the Pharisees. Jesus is challenging them to think about the meaning of what they have read in the scriptures. Alternate translation: “Surely you have read in the law of Moses that … but are guiltless.” or “You should know that the law teaches that … but are guiltless.” (See: [[rc://*/ta/man/translate/figs-rquestion]])
12:5 dqe9 τὸ Σάββατον βεβηλοῦσιν 1 “do on the Sabbath what they would do on any other day”
12:5 i6y9 ἀναίτιοί εἰσιν 1 “God will not punish them” or “God does not consider them guilty”
12:6 ji7a λέγω & ὑμῖν 1 This adds emphasis to what Jesus says next.
12:6 k4mn rc://*/ta/man/translate/figs-123person τοῦ ἱεροῦ μεῖζόν ἐστιν 1 “someone who is more important than the temple.” Jesus was referring to himself as the one greater. (See: [[rc://*/ta/man/translate/figs-123person]])
12:7 rh53 0 In verse 7, Jesus quotes the prophet Hosea to rebuke the Pharisees.
12:7 vye2 0 Jesus continues to respond to the Pharisees.
12:7 ypj7 rc://*/ta/man/translate/figs-explicit εἰ δὲ ἐγνώκειτε τί ἐστιν, ἔλεος θέλω καὶ οὐ θυσίαν, οὐκ ἂν κατεδικάσατε τοὺς ἀναιτίους 1 Here Jesus quotes scripture. Alternate translation: “The prophet Hosea wrote this long ago: I desire mercy and not sacrifice. If you had understood what this meant, you would not have condemned the guiltless” (See: [[rc://*/ta/man/translate/figs-explicit]])
12:7 e1ju ἔλεος θέλω καὶ οὐ θυσίαν 1 In the law of Moses, God did command the Israelites to offer sacrifices. This means God considers mercy more important than the sacrifices.
12:7 jw57 θέλω 1 The pronoun “I” refers to God.
12:7 s23l rc://*/ta/man/translate/figs-nominaladj τοὺς ἀναιτίους 1 This can be translated as an adjective. Alternate translation: “those who are not guilty” (See: [[rc://*/ta/man/translate/figs-nominaladj]])
12:8 l7g3 rc://*/ta/man/translate/figs-123person ὁ Υἱὸς τοῦ Ἀνθρώπου 1 Jesus is referring to himself. (See: [[rc://*/ta/man/translate/figs-123person]])
12:8 jx98 Κύριος & ἐστιν τοῦ Σαββάτου 1 “rules over the Sabbath” or “makes the laws about what people can do on the Sabbath”
12:9 i489 0 Here the scene shifts to a later time when the Pharisees criticize Jesus for healing a man on the Sabbath.
12:9 hns8 καὶ μεταβὰς ἐκεῖθεν 1 “Jesus left the grainfields” or “Then Jesus left”
12:9 y4me τὴν συναγωγὴν αὐτῶν 1 Possible meanings are (1) the word “their” refers to the Jews of that town. Alternate translation: “the synogogue” or (2) the word “their” refers to the Pharisees that Jesus had just spoken to, and this was the synagogue that they and other Jews in that town attended. The word “their” does not mean that the Pharisees owned the synagogue. Alternate translation: “the synagogue that they attended”
12:10 kjf6 ἰδοὺ 1 The word “Behold” alerts us to a new person in the story. Your language may have a way of doing this.
12:10 xb13 ἄνθρωπος χεῖρα ἔχων ξηράν 1 “a man who had a paralyzed hand” or “a man with a crippled hand”
12:10 t948 καὶ ἐπηρώτησαν αὐτὸν λέγοντες, εἰ ἔξεστι τοῖς Σάββασιν θεραπεύειν? ἵνα κατηγορήσωσιν αὐτοῦ 1 “The Pharisees wanted to accuse Jesus of sinning, so they asked him, Is it lawful to heal on the Sabbath?’”
12:10 gdj6 εἰ ἔξεστι τοῖς Σάββασιν θεραπεύειν? 1 “According to the law of Moses, may a person heal another person on the Sabbath”
12:10 c1cc rc://*/ta/man/translate/figs-explicit ἵνα κατηγορήσωσιν αὐτοῦ 1 They did not just want to accuse Jesus in front of the people. The Pharisees wanted Jesus to give an answer that contradicted the law of Moses so they could take him before a judge and legally charge him with breaking the law. (See: [[rc://*/ta/man/translate/figs-explicit]])
12:11 g98l 0 Jesus responds to the Pharisees criticism.
12:11 ng4j rc://*/ta/man/translate/figs-rquestion τίς ἔσται ἐξ ὑμῶν ἄνθρωπος, ὃς ἕξει πρόβατον ἕν & οὐχὶ κρατήσει αὐτὸ καὶ ἐγερεῖ? 1 Jesus uses a question to respond to the Pharisees. He is challenging them to think about what kind of work they do on the Sabbath. Alternate translation: “Every one of you, if you only had one sheep … would grab the sheep and lift it out.” (See: [[rc://*/ta/man/translate/figs-rquestion]])
12:12 s2tu πόσῳ οὖν διαφέρει ἄνθρωπος προβάτου? 1 The phrase “how much more” adds emphasis to the statement. Alternate translation: “Obviously, a man is much more valuable than a sheep!” or “Just think about how much more important a man is than a sheep”
12:12 a9ld ἔξεστιν τοῖς Σάββασιν καλῶς ποιεῖν 1 “those who do good on the Sabbath are obeying the law”
12:13 be8u rc://*/ta/man/translate/figs-quotations τότε λέγει τῷ ἀνθρώπῳ, ἔκτεινόν σου τὴν χεῖρα. 1 This can be translated as an indirect quotation. Alternate translation: “Then Jesus commanded the man to stretch out his hand” (See: [[rc://*/ta/man/translate/figs-quotations]])
12:13 ljl6 τῷ ἀνθρώπῳ 1 “to the man with the paralyzed hand” or “to the man with the crippled hand”
12:13 fm9r ἔκτεινόν σου τὴν χεῖρα 1 “Hold out your hand” or “Extend your hand”
12:13 s5ep ἐξέτεινεν 1 “The man stretched”
12:13 jry3 rc://*/ta/man/translate/figs-activepassive ἀπεκατεστάθη, ὑγιὴς 1 This can be stated in active form. Alternate translation: “it was healthy again” or “it became well again” (See: [[rc://*/ta/man/translate/figs-activepassive]])
12:14 w4zl συμβούλιον ἔλαβον κατ’ αὐτοῦ 1 “planned to harm Jesus”
12:14 jdn2 ὅπως αὐτὸν ἀπολέσωσιν 1 “were discussing how they might kill Jesus”
12:15 d4lk 0 This account explains how the actions of Jesus fulfilled one of the prophecies of Isaiah.
12:15 d5l9 ὁ δὲ Ἰησοῦς γνοὺς, ἀνεχώρησεν 1 “Jesus was aware of what the Pharisees were planning, so he”
12:15 hw22 ἀνεχώρησεν ἐκεῖθεν 1 “departed from” or “left”
12:16 bk1n μὴ φανερὸν αὐτὸν ποιήσωσιν 1 “not to tell anyone else about him”
12:17 dc7z ἵνα πληρωθῇ τὸ ῥηθὲν 1 The phrase “that it might come true” can be translated as the beginning of a new sentence. Alternate translation: “This was to fulfill what”
12:17 mcd7 τὸ ῥηθὲν διὰ Ἠσαΐου τοῦ προφήτου λέγοντος 1 This can be stated in active form. Alternate translation: “what God had said long ago through the prophet Isaiah”
12:18 zkt7 0 Here Matthew quotes the prophet Isaiah to show that Jesus ministry fulfilled scripture.
12:18 f5kz ἰδοὺ 1 “Look” or “Listen” or “Pay attention to what I am about to tell you”
12:18 fjw6 μου & ᾑρέτισα & θήσω 1 All occurrences of these words refer to God. Isaiah is quoting what God said to him.
12:18 yv4f ὁ ἀγαπητός μου εἰς ὃν εὐδόκησεν ἡ ψυχή μου 1 “he is my beloved one, and I am very pleased with him”
12:18 s6a4 rc://*/ta/man/translate/figs-synecdoche εἰς ὃν εὐδόκησεν ἡ ψυχή μου 1 Here “soul” refers to the whole person. Alternate translation: “with whom I am very pleased” (See: [[rc://*/ta/man/translate/figs-synecdoche]])
12:18 jh8p rc://*/ta/man/translate/figs-explicit κρίσιν τοῖς ἔθνεσιν ἀπαγγελεῖ 1 The means that Gods servant will tell the Gentiles that there will be justice. It can be stated clearly that God is the one who will bring about justice, and the abstract noun “justice” can be expressed as “what is right.” Alternate translation: “he will announce to the nations that God will do for them what is right” (See: [[rc://*/ta/man/translate/figs-explicit]] and [[rc://*/ta/man/translate/figs-abstractnouns]])
12:19 me7p 0 Matthew continues to quote the prophet Isaiah.
12:19 hb2m rc://*/ta/man/translate/figs-metonymy οὐδὲ ἀκούσει τις & τὴν φωνὴν αὐτοῦ 1 Here people not hearing his voice represents him not speaking loudly. Alternate translation: “he will not speak loudly” (See: [[rc://*/ta/man/translate/figs-metonymy]])
12:19 gj1p οὐκ ἐρίσει & αὐτοῦ 1 All occurrences of these words refer to Gods chosen servant.
12:19 jr87 rc://*/ta/man/translate/figs-idiom ἐν ταῖς πλατείαις 1 This is an idiom that means “publicly.” Alternate translation: “in the cities and towns” (See: [[rc://*/ta/man/translate/figs-idiom]])
12:20 ii4c οὐ κατεάξει 1 All occurrences of “he” refer to Gods chosen servant.
12:20 cdk2 rc://*/ta/man/translate/figs-parallelism κάλαμον συντετριμμένον οὐ κατεάξει, καὶ λίνον τυφόμενον οὐ σβέσει 1 Both of these statements mean the same thing. They are metaphors emphasizing that Gods servant will be gentle and kind. Both “bruised reed” and “smoking flax” represent weak and hurting people. If the metaphor is confusing, you could translate the literal meaning. Alternate translation: “He will be kind to weak people, and he will be gentle to those who are hurting” (See: [[rc://*/ta/man/translate/figs-parallelism]] and [[rc://*/ta/man/translate/figs-metaphor]])
12:20 m4uz κάλαμον συντετριμμένον 1 “damaged plant”
12:20 y8mn λίνον τυφόμενον οὐ σβέσει 1 “he will not put out any smoking flax” or “he will not stop any smoking flax from burning”
12:20 bjg2 λίνον τυφόμενον 1 This refers to a lamp wick after the flame has gone out and when it is only smoking.
12:20 rer7 λίνον & ἕως 1 This can be translated with a new sentence: “flax. This is what he will do until”
12:20 b6tw rc://*/ta/man/translate/figs-abstractnouns ἂν ἐκβάλῃ εἰς νῖκος τὴν κρίσιν 1 Leading someone to victory represents causing him to be victorious. Causing justice to be victorious represents making things right that had been wrong. Alternate translation: “he makes everything right” (See: [[rc://*/ta/man/translate/figs-abstractnouns]])
12:21 w3rq rc://*/ta/man/translate/figs-synecdoche τῷ ὀνόματι αὐτοῦ 1 Here “name” refers to the whole person. Alternate translation: “in him” (See: [[rc://*/ta/man/translate/figs-synecdoche]])
12:22 nba2 0 Here the scene shifts to a later time when the Pharisees accuse Jesus of healing a man by the power of Satan.
12:22 e1g4 rc://*/ta/man/translate/figs-activepassive τότε προσηνέχθη αὐτῷ δαιμονιζόμενος, τυφλὸς καὶ κωφός 1 This can be stated in active form. Alternate translation: “Then someone brought to Jesus a man who was blind and mute because a demon was controlling him” (See: [[rc://*/ta/man/translate/figs-activepassive]])
12:22 k2vt προσηνέχθη & τυφλὸς καὶ κωφός 1 “someone who could not see and could not talk”
12:23 gy5z καὶ ἐξίσταντο πάντες οἱ ὄχλοι 1 “All the people who had seen Jesus heal the man were greatly surprised”
12:23 ink7 ὁ υἱὸς Δαυείδ 1 This is a title for the Christ or Messiah.
12:23 h8kf υἱὸς 1 Here this means “descendant of.”
12:24 m2jr 0 In verse 25, Jesus begins to respond to the Pharisees accusation that he healed the man by the power of Satan.
12:24 wmi1 ἀκούσαντες 1 This refers to the miracle of the healing of a blind, deaf, and demon-possessed man.
12:24 p1mi rc://*/ta/man/translate/figs-doublenegatives οὗτος οὐκ ἐκβάλλει τὰ δαιμόνια, εἰ μὴ ἐν τῷ Βεελζεβοὺλ 1 This can be stated in a positive form. “This man is only able to cast out the demon because he is a servant of Beelzebul” (See: [[rc://*/ta/man/translate/figs-doublenegatives]])
12:24 wj1y οὗτος 1 The Pharisees avoid calling Jesus by name to show they reject him.
12:24 cii4 ἄρχοντι τῶν δαιμονίων 1 “the chief of the demons”
12:25 i1sd rc://*/ta/man/translate/writing-proverbs πᾶσα βασιλεία μερισθεῖσα καθ’ ἑαυτῆς ἐρημοῦται, καὶ πᾶσα πόλις ἢ οἰκία μερισθεῖσα καθ’ ἑαυτῆς οὐ σταθήσεται 1 Jesus uses a proverb to respond to the Pharisees. Both of these statements mean the same thing. They emphasize that it would not make sense for Beelzebul to use his power to fight other demons. (See: [[rc://*/ta/man/translate/writing-proverbs]] and [[rc://*/ta/man/translate/figs-parallelism]])
12:25 g9ec rc://*/ta/man/translate/figs-metonymy πᾶσα βασιλεία μερισθεῖσα καθ’ ἑαυτῆς ἐρημοῦται 1 Here “kingdom” refers to those who live in the kingdom. This can be translated in active form. Alternate translation: “A kingdom will not last when its people fight among themselves” (See: [[rc://*/ta/man/translate/figs-metonymy]] and [[rc://*/ta/man/translate/figs-activepassive]])
12:25 kn8c rc://*/ta/man/translate/figs-metonymy πᾶσα πόλις ἢ οἰκία μερισθεῖσα καθ’ ἑαυτῆς οὐ σταθήσεται 1 Here “city” refers to the people who live there, and “house” refers to a family. Being “divided against itself” represents its people fighting each other. Alternate translation: “it ruins a city or a family when the people fight each other” (See: [[rc://*/ta/man/translate/figs-metonymy]] and [[rc://*/ta/man/translate/figs-metaphor]])
12:26 gm6j 0 Jesus continues to respond to the Pharisees accusation that he healed the man by the power of Satan.
12:26 i42r rc://*/ta/man/translate/figs-metonymy καὶ εἰ ὁ Σατανᾶς τὸν Σατανᾶν ἐκβάλλει 1 The second use of Satan refers to the demons that serve Satan. Alternate translation: “If Satan works against his own demons” (See: [[rc://*/ta/man/translate/figs-metonymy]])
12:26 ah7t rc://*/ta/man/translate/figs-rquestion πῶς οὖν σταθήσεται ἡ βασιλεία αὐτοῦ? 1 Jesus uses this question to show the Pharisees that what they were saying was illogical. Alternate translation: “If Satan were divided against himself, his kingdom would not be able to stand!” or “If Satan were to fight against his own demons, his kingdom would not last!” (See: [[rc://*/ta/man/translate/figs-rquestion]])
12:27 nvv9 Βεελζεβοὺλ 1 This name refers to the same person as “Satan” (verse 26).
12:27 gee9 rc://*/ta/man/translate/figs-rquestion οἱ υἱοὶ ὑμῶν ἐν τίνι ἐκβάλλουσιν? 1 Jesus uses another question to challenge the Pharisees. Alternate translation: “then you must say your followers also drive out demons by the power of Beelzebul. But, you know this is not true.” (See: [[rc://*/ta/man/translate/figs-rquestion]])
12:27 x9je rc://*/ta/man/translate/figs-metaphor οἱ υἱοὶ ὑμῶν 1 Jesus was speaking to the Pharisees. The phrase “your sons” refers to their followers. This was a common way of referring to those who follow teachers or leaders. Alternate translation: “your followers” (See: [[rc://*/ta/man/translate/figs-metaphor]])
12:27 jja2 διὰ τοῦτο, αὐτοὶ κριταὶ ἔσονται ὑμῶν 1 “Because your followers cast out demons by the power of God, they prove that you are wrong about me.”
12:28 f3n7 0 Jesus continues to respond to the Pharisees.
12:28 zb4d εἰ δὲ & ἐγὼ 1 Here “if” does not mean Jesus is questioning how he drives out demons. Here Jesus uses the word to introduce a true statement. Alternate translation: “But because I”
12:28 r5dg rc://*/ta/man/translate/figs-metonymy ἄρα ἔφθασεν ἐφ’ ὑμᾶς ἡ Βασιλεία τοῦ Θεοῦ 1 “then the kingdom of God has arrived among you.” Here “kingdom” refers to Gods rule as king. Alternate translation: “this means God is establishing his rule among you” (See: [[rc://*/ta/man/translate/figs-metonymy]])
12:28 f1wj rc://*/ta/man/translate/figs-you ἔφθασεν ἐφ’ ὑμᾶς 1 Here “you” is plural and refers to the people of Israel. (See: [[rc://*/ta/man/translate/figs-you]])
12:29 t4vu rc://*/ta/man/translate/figs-parables πῶς δύναταί τις εἰσελθεῖν εἰς τὴν οἰκίαν & τὴν οἰκίαν αὐτοῦ διαρπάσει. 1 Jesus uses a parable to continue his response to the Pharisees. Jesus means he can drive out demons because he is more powerful than Satan. (See: [[rc://*/ta/man/translate/figs-parables]])
12:29 w54c rc://*/ta/man/translate/figs-rquestion πῶς δύναταί τις εἰσελθεῖν & ἐὰν μὴ πρῶτον δήσῃ τὸν ἰσχυρόν? 1 Jesus uses a question to teach the Pharisees and the crowd. Alternate translation: “No one can enter … without tying up the strong man first.” or “If a person wants to enter … he must first tie up the strong man.” (See: [[rc://*/ta/man/translate/figs-rquestion]])
12:29 jb6x ἐὰν μὴ πρῶτον δήσῃ τὸν ἰσχυρόν? 1 “without taking control of the strong man first”
12:29 u6vu τότε τὴν οἰκίαν αὐτοῦ διαρπάσει 1 “The he can steal” or “Then he will be able to steal”
12:30 ivp9 ὁ μὴ ὢν μετ’ ἐμοῦ 1 “who does not support me” or “who does not work with me”
12:30 gyk8 κατ’ ἐμοῦ ἐστιν 1 “opposes me” or “works against me”
12:30 ek1h rc://*/ta/man/translate/figs-metaphor ὁ μὴ συνάγων μετ’ ἐμοῦ σκορπίζει 1 Jesus is using a metaphor that refers to a person either gathering the flock of sheep to a shepherd or making them scatter away from the shepherd. Jesus means that a person is either helping to make people become disciples of Jesus or he is making people reject Jesus. (See: [[rc://*/ta/man/translate/figs-metaphor]])
12:31 qwg4 0 Jesus continues to respond to the Pharisees.
12:31 iy8l λέγω ὑμῖν 1 This adds emphasis to what Jesus says next.
12:31 q5hk rc://*/ta/man/translate/figs-you λέγω ὑμῖν 1 Here “you” is plural. Jesus is speaking directly to the Pharisees, but he is also teaching the crowd. (See: [[rc://*/ta/man/translate/figs-you]])
12:31 hy38 rc://*/ta/man/translate/figs-activepassive πᾶσα ἁμαρτία καὶ βλασφημία ἀφεθήσεται τοῖς ἀνθρώποις 1 This can be stated in active form. Alternate translation: “God will forgive every sin that people commit and every evil thing they say” or “God will forgive every person who sins or says evil things” (See: [[rc://*/ta/man/translate/figs-activepassive]])
12:31 ezx8 rc://*/ta/man/translate/figs-activepassive ἡ & τοῦ Πνεύματος, βλασφημία οὐκ ἀφεθήσεται 1 This can be stated in active form. Alternate translation: “God will not forgive the person who speaks evil things about the Holy Spirit” (See: [[rc://*/ta/man/translate/figs-activepassive]])
12:32 gwx2 rc://*/ta/man/translate/figs-metonymy καὶ ὃς ἐὰν εἴπῃ λόγον κατὰ τοῦ Υἱοῦ τοῦ Ἀνθρώπου 1 Here “word” refers to what someone says. Alternate translation: “If a person says anything bad about the Son of Man” (See: [[rc://*/ta/man/translate/figs-metonymy]])
12:32 h79z rc://*/ta/man/translate/figs-123person τοῦ Υἱοῦ τοῦ Ἀνθρώπου 1 Jesus is speaking about himself. (See: [[rc://*/ta/man/translate/figs-123person]])
12:32 z3ma rc://*/ta/man/translate/figs-activepassive ἀφεθήσεται αὐτῷ 1 This can be stated in active form. Alternate translation: “God will forgive a person for that” (See: [[rc://*/ta/man/translate/figs-activepassive]])
12:32 hfs4 οὐκ ἀφεθήσεται αὐτῷ 1 This can be stated in active form. Alternate translation: “God will not forgive that person”
12:32 lw5j rc://*/ta/man/translate/figs-metonymy οὔτε ἐν τούτῳ τῷ αἰῶνι οὔτε ἐν τῷ μέλλοντι 1 Here “this world” and “that which is to come” refer to the present life and the next life. Alternate translation: “in this life or in the next life” or “now or ever” (See: [[rc://*/ta/man/translate/figs-metonymy]])
12:33 d73d 0 Jesus continues to respond to the Pharisees.
12:33 bi8z ἢ ποιήσατε τὸ δένδρον καλὸν καὶ τὸν καρπὸν αὐτοῦ καλόν, ἢ ποιήσατε τὸ δένδρον σαπρὸν καὶ τὸν καρπὸν αὐτοῦ σαπρόν 1 Possible meanings are (1) “If you make a tree good, its fruit will be good, and if you make the tree bad, its fruit will be bad” or (2) “If you consider a tree to be good, it will be because its fruit is good, and if you consider it tree to be bad, it will be because its fruit is bad.” This was a proverb. People were to apply its truth to how they can know whether a person is good or bad.
12:33 kl16 καλὸν & σαπρὸν 1 “healthy … diseased”
12:33 kz12 rc://*/ta/man/translate/figs-activepassive ἐκ γὰρ τοῦ καρποῦ, τὸ δένδρον γινώσκεται 1 “Fruit” here is a metaphor for what a person does. This can be stated in active form. Alternate translation: “people know whether a tree is good or bad by looking at its fruit” or “people know whether a person is good or bad by looking at the results of that persons activities” (See: [[rc://*/ta/man/translate/figs-activepassive]] and [[rc://*/ta/man/translate/figs-metaphor]])
12:34 r1uv rc://*/ta/man/translate/figs-metaphor γεννήματα ἐχιδνῶν 1 Here “offspring” means “having the characteristic of.” Vipers are poisonous snakes that are dangerous and represent evil. See how you translated a similar phrase in [Matthew 3:7](../03/07.md). (See: [[rc://*/ta/man/translate/figs-metaphor]])
12:34 pl4g rc://*/ta/man/translate/figs-you γεννήματα & λαλεῖν & ὄντες 1 These are plural and refer to the Pharisees. (See: [[rc://*/ta/man/translate/figs-you]])
12:34 e7x3 rc://*/ta/man/translate/figs-rquestion πῶς δύνασθε ἀγαθὰ λαλεῖν 1 Jesus uses a question to rebuke the Pharisees. Alternate translation: “you cannot say good things.” or “you can only say evil things.” (See: [[rc://*/ta/man/translate/figs-rquestion]])
12:34 e9bg rc://*/ta/man/translate/figs-metonymy ἐκ & τοῦ περισσεύματος τῆς καρδίας, τὸ στόμα λαλεῖ 1 Here “heart” is a metonym for the thoughts in a persons mind. Here “mouth” is a synecdoche that represents a person as a whole. Alternate translation: “what a person says with his mouth reveals what is in his mind” (See: [[rc://*/ta/man/translate/figs-metonymy]] and [[rc://*/ta/man/translate/figs-synecdoche]])
12:35 r3uw rc://*/ta/man/translate/figs-metaphor ὁ ἀγαθὸς ἄνθρωπος ἐκ τοῦ ἀγαθοῦ θησαυροῦ ἐκβάλλει ἀγαθά; καὶ ὁ πονηρὸς ἄνθρωπος ἐκ τοῦ πονηροῦ θησαυροῦ ἐκβάλλει πονηρά 1 Jesus speaks about the “heart” as if it were a container that a person fills with good or evil things. This is a metaphor that means what a person says reveals what the person is truly like. If you want to keep this imagery, see the UST. You can also translate the literal meaning. Alternate translation: “A man who is truly good will speak good things, and the man who is truly evil will speak evil things” (See: [[rc://*/ta/man/translate/figs-metaphor]])
12:36 jvg6 0 Jesus concludes his response to the Pharisees accusation that he healed the man by the power of Satan.
12:36 era6 λέγω & ὑμῖν 1 This adds emphasis to what Jesus says next.
12:36 t2pj οἱ ἄνθρωποι, ἀποδώσουσιν περὶ 1 “God will ask people about” or “people will have to explain to God”
12:36 f1wh rc://*/ta/man/translate/figs-metonymy πᾶν ῥῆμα ἀργὸν ὃ λαλήσουσιν 1 Here “word” refers to something that someone says. Alternate translation: “every harmful thing they will have said” (See: [[rc://*/ta/man/translate/figs-metonymy]])
12:37 qw5e rc://*/ta/man/translate/figs-activepassive δικαιωθήσῃ & καταδικασθήσῃ 1 This can be stated in active form. Alternate translation: “God will justify you … God will condemn you” (See: [[rc://*/ta/man/translate/figs-activepassive]])
12:38 x4le 0 In verse 39, Jesus begins to rebuke the scribes and Pharisees.
12:38 mec3 0 The dialogue in these verses happens immediately after Jesus responded to the Pharisees accusation that he healed a man by the power of Satan.
12:38 aiu6 θέλομεν 1 “we want”
12:38 ikg2 rc://*/ta/man/translate/figs-explicit ἀπὸ σοῦ σημεῖον ἰδεῖν 1 You can make explicit why they want to see a sign. Alternate translation: “to see a sign from you that proves what you say is true” (See: [[rc://*/ta/man/translate/figs-explicit]])
12:39 d8b9 rc://*/ta/man/translate/figs-123person γενεὰ πονηρὰ καὶ μοιχαλὶς σημεῖον ἐπιζητεῖ & δοθήσεται αὐτῇ 1 Jesus is speaking to his present generation. Alternate translation: “You are an evil and adulterous generation who demands signs from me … given to you” (See: [[rc://*/ta/man/translate/figs-123person]])
12:39 a5di rc://*/ta/man/translate/figs-metaphor γενεὰ & μοιχαλὶς 1 Here “adulterous” is a metaphor for people who are not faithful to God. Alternate translation: “unfaithful generation” or “godless generation” (See: [[rc://*/ta/man/translate/figs-metaphor]])
12:39 c6hy rc://*/ta/man/translate/figs-activepassive σημεῖον οὐ δοθήσεται αὐτῇ 1 Jesus would not give them a sign because, though he had already performed many miracles, they refused to believe him. This can be stated in active form. Alternate translation: “I will not give it a sign” or “God will not give you a sign” (See: [[rc://*/ta/man/translate/figs-activepassive]])
12:39 j21p εἰ μὴ τὸ σημεῖον Ἰωνᾶ τοῦ προφήτου 1 “except the same sign God gave to Jonah the prophet”
12:40 vh9i rc://*/ta/man/translate/figs-merism τρεῖς ἡμέρας καὶ τρεῖς νύκτας 1 Here “day” and “night” mean complete 24-hour periods. Alternate translation: “three complete days” (See: [[rc://*/ta/man/translate/figs-merism]])
12:40 iuv8 rc://*/ta/man/translate/figs-123person ὁ Υἱὸς τοῦ Ἀνθρώπου 1 Jesus is speaking about himself. (See: [[rc://*/ta/man/translate/figs-123person]])
12:40 gg65 rc://*/ta/man/translate/figs-idiom ἐν τῇ καρδίᾳ τῆς γῆς 1 This means inside a physical grave. (See: [[rc://*/ta/man/translate/figs-idiom]])
12:41 k3q6 0 Jesus continues to rebuke the scribes and Pharisees.
12:41 gnh1 ἄνδρες Νινευεῖται 1 “The citizens of Nineveh”
12:41 b94i ἐν τῇ κρίσει 1 “on judgment day” or “when God judges people”
12:41 x8gm τῆς γενεᾶς ταύτης 1 This refers to the people living during the time Jesus was preaching.
12:41 duz2 rc://*/ta/man/translate/figs-metonymy καὶ κατακρινοῦσιν αὐτήν 1 Possible meanings are (1) “condemn” here represents accusing. Alternate translation: “and will accuse this generation of people” or (2) God will condemn this generation of people because they did not repent as the people of Nineveh had. Alternate translation: “and God will condemn this generation” (See: [[rc://*/ta/man/translate/figs-metonymy]])
12:41 qg29 καὶ ἰδοὺ 1 “and look.” This emphasizes what Jesus says next.
12:41 dbs3 πλεῖον 1 “someone more important”
12:41 zb6a rc://*/ta/man/translate/figs-123person πλεῖον 1 Jesus is speaking about himself. (See: [[rc://*/ta/man/translate/figs-123person]])
12:41 a5p8 rc://*/ta/man/translate/figs-explicit Ἰωνᾶ ὧδε 1 You can make explicit the implicit meaning of Jesus statement. Alternate translation: “than Jonah is here, yet you still have not repented, which is why God will condemn you” (See: [[rc://*/ta/man/translate/figs-explicit]])
12:42 q8tb 0 Jesus continues to rebuke the scribes and Pharisees.
12:42 zwv7 rc://*/ta/man/translate/translate-names βασίλισσα νότου 1 This refers to the Queen of Sheba. Sheba is a land south of Israel. (See: [[rc://*/ta/man/translate/translate-names]])
12:42 kku7 ἐγερθήσεται ἐν τῇ κρίσει 1 “will stand up at the judgment”
12:42 z46e ἐν τῇ κρίσει 1 “on judgment day” or “when God judges people.” See how you translated this in [Matthew 12:41](../12/41.md).
12:42 zc72 τῆς γενεᾶς ταύτης 1 This refers to the people living during the time Jesus was preaching.
12:42 k4ls rc://*/ta/man/translate/figs-metonymy καὶ κατακρινεῖ αὐτήν 1 See how you translated a similar statement in [Matthew 12:41](../12/41.md). Possible meanings are (1) “condemn” here represents accusing. Alternate translation: “and will accuse this generation of people” or (2) God will condemn this generation of people because they did not listen to wisdom as the Queen of the South had. Alternate translation: “and God will condemn this generation” (See: [[rc://*/ta/man/translate/figs-metonymy]])
12:42 q8q8 rc://*/ta/man/translate/figs-idiom ἦλθεν ἐκ τῶν περάτων τῆς γῆς 1 Here “ends of the earth” is an idiom that means “far away.” Alternate translation: “She came from very far away” (See: [[rc://*/ta/man/translate/figs-idiom]])
12:42 t521 rc://*/ta/man/translate/grammar-connect-words-phrases ἦλθεν ἐκ τῶν περάτων τῆς γῆς ἀκοῦσαι τὴν σοφίαν Σολομῶνος 1 This statement explains why the Queen of the South will condemn the people of Jesus generation. Alternate translation: “For she came” (See: [[rc://*/ta/man/translate/grammar-connect-words-phrases]])
12:42 n99z καὶ ἰδοὺ 1 “and look.” This adds emphasis to what Jesus says next.
12:42 aj1x πλεῖον 1 “someone more important”
12:42 uf5k rc://*/ta/man/translate/figs-123person πλεῖον 1 Jesus is speaking about himself. (See: [[rc://*/ta/man/translate/figs-123person]])
12:42 yra5 rc://*/ta/man/translate/figs-explicit Σολομῶνος ὧδε 1 You can make explicit the implicit meaning of Jesus statement. Alternate translation: “than Solomon is here, yet you do not listen. That is why God will condemn you” (See: [[rc://*/ta/man/translate/figs-explicit]])
12:43 ve5x 0 Jesus continues to rebuke the scribes and Pharisees. He begins to tell a parable.
12:43 f5jr ἀνύδρων τόπων 1 “dry places” or “places where no people live”
12:43 x2ur οὐχ εὑρίσκει 1 Here “it” refers to rest.
12:44 gey7 τότε λέγει, εἰς τὸν οἶκόν μου ἐπιστρέψω ὅθεν ἐξῆλθον. 1 This can be translated as a statement rather than a quotation. Alternate translation: “So, the unclean spirit decides to return to the house from which it came”
12:44 ty9b rc://*/ta/man/translate/figs-metaphor εἰς τὸν οἶκόν μου & ὅθεν ἐξῆλθον 1 This is a metaphor for the person in whom the unclean spirit was living. Alternate translation: “to the place I left” (See: [[rc://*/ta/man/translate/figs-metaphor]])
12:44 cd4f rc://*/ta/man/translate/figs-activepassive εὑρίσκει σχολάζοντα σεσαρωμένον καὶ κεκοσμημένον 1 This can be stated in active form. Alternate translation: “the unclean spirit finds that someone has swept the house clean and has put everything in the house where it belongs” (See: [[rc://*/ta/man/translate/figs-activepassive]])
12:44 s6jf rc://*/ta/man/translate/figs-metaphor σχολάζοντα σεσαρωμένον καὶ κεκοσμημένον 1 Again, “house” is a metaphor for the person in whom the unclean spirit was living. Here, “swept out and put in order” suggests that no one is living in the house. Jesus means when an unclean spirit leaves a person, the person must invite the Holy Spirit to live in him or else the demon will come back. (See: [[rc://*/ta/man/translate/figs-metaphor]])
12:45 nh6q 0 Jesus finishes the parable that he began with the words “When an unclean spirit” in verse 43.
12:45 bhb4 rc://*/ta/man/translate/figs-parables τότε πορεύεται & καὶ τῇ γενεᾷ ταύτῃ τῇ πονηρᾷ 1 Jesus tells a parable to warn the people of the danger of not believing him. (See: [[rc://*/ta/man/translate/figs-parables]])
12:45 jw1h οὕτως ἔσται καὶ τῇ γενεᾷ ταύτῃ τῇ πονηρᾷ 1 This means that if the people of Jesus generation do not believe him and become his disciples, they will be in a worse situation than they were before he came.
12:46 qj8w 0 The arrival of Jesus mother and brothers becomes an opportunity for him to describe his spiritual family.
12:46 ahx7 ἰδοὺ 1 The word “behold” alerts us to a new people in the story. Your language may have a way of doing this.
12:46 mh5f ἡ μήτηρ 1 This is Mary, Jesus human mother.
12:46 dq8m οἱ ἀδελφοὶ αὐτοῦ 1 These are probably other children born to Mary, but it is possible that the word “brothers” here refers to Jesus cousins.
12:46 z97j ζητοῦντες & λαλῆσαι 1 “wanting to speak”
12:47 qd32 rc://*/ta/man/translate/figs-quotations εἶπεν δέ τις αὐτῷ, ἰδοὺ, ἡ μήτηρ σου καὶ οἱ ἀδελφοί σου ἔξω ἑστήκασιν ζητοῦντές σοι λαλῆσαι. 1 This can be translated as an indirect quotation. Alternate translation: “Someone told Jesus that his mother and brothers were outside and wanted to speak to him” (See: [[rc://*/ta/man/translate/figs-quotations]])
12:48 q1cd 0 This is the end of the part of the story that began in [Matthew 12:1](../12/01.md), where Matthew tells of growing opposition to Jesus ministry.
12:48 jm1y rc://*/ta/man/translate/figs-ellipsis τῷ λέγοντι αὐτῷ 1 The details of the message the person told Jesus are understood and not repeated here. Alternate translation: “who told Jesus that his mother and brothers wanted to speak to him” (See: [[rc://*/ta/man/translate/figs-ellipsis]])
12:48 e535 rc://*/ta/man/translate/figs-rquestion τίς ἐστιν ἡ μήτηρ μου καὶ τίνες εἰσὶν οἱ ἀδελφοί μου? 1 Jesus uses these questions to teach the people. Alternate translation: “I will tell you who are really my mother and brothers” (See: [[rc://*/ta/man/translate/figs-rquestion]])
12:49 gk62 ἰδοὺ 1 “Look” or “Listen” or “Pay attention to what I am about to tell you”
12:49 rxe8 rc://*/ta/man/translate/figs-metaphor ἡ μήτηρ μου καὶ οἱ ἀδελφοί μου 1 This is a metaphor that means Jesus disciples belong to Jesus spiritual family. This is more important than belonging to his physical family. (See: [[rc://*/ta/man/translate/figs-metaphor]])
12:50 e25c ὅστις & ἂν ποιήσῃ 1 “anyone who does”
12:50 mq9r rc://*/ta/man/translate/guidelines-sonofgodprinciples τοῦ Πατρός 1 This is an important title for God. (See: [[rc://*/ta/man/translate/guidelines-sonofgodprinciples]])
12:50 gn31 rc://*/ta/man/translate/figs-metaphor αὐτός μου ἀδελφὸς, καὶ ἀδελφὴ, καὶ μήτηρ ἐστίν 1 This is a metaphor meaning that those who obey God belong to Jesus spiritual family. This is more important than belonging to his physical family. (See: [[rc://*/ta/man/translate/figs-metaphor]])
13:intro s3lu 0 # Matthew 13 General Notes\n## Structure and formatting\n\nSome translations set each line of poetry farther to the right than the rest of the text to make it easier to read. The ULT does this with the poetry in 13:14-15, which are words from the Old Testament.\n\nThis chapter begins a new section. It contains some of Jesus parables about the kingdom of heaven.\n\n## Important figures of speech in this chapter\n\n### Metonymy\n\nJesus often says the word “heaven” when he wants his hearers to think of God, who lives in heaven ([Matthew 13:11](../../mat/13/11.md)).\n\n### Implicit information\n\nSpeakers usually do not say things that they think their hearers already understand. When Matthew wrote that Jesus “sat beside the sea” ([Matthew 13:1](../../mat/13/01.md)), he probably expected his hearers to know that Jesus was about to teach the people. (See: [[rc://*/ta/man/translate/figs-explicit]])\n\n### Metaphor\n\nSpeakers often use words for things that can be touched to speak of things that cannot be touched. Jesus spoke of a bird eating a seed to describe how Satan kept people from understanding Jesus message ([Matthew 13:19](../../mat/13/19.md)).\n\n## Other possible translation difficulties in this chapter\n\n### Passive voice\n\nMany sentences in this chapter tell that a person had something happen to him without saying who caused that something to happen. For example, “they were scorched” ([Matthew 13:6](../../mat/13/06.md)). You may have to translate the sentence so that it tells the reader who performed the action. (See: [[rc://*/ta/man/translate/figs-activepassive]])\n\n### Parables\n\nThe parables were short stories that Jesus told so that people would easily understand the lesson he was trying to teach them. He also told the stories so that those who did not want to believe in him would not understand the truth ([Matthew 13:11-13](./11.md)).
13:1 r4xv 0 This is the beginning of a new part of the story where Jesus begins to teach the crowds, using parables, about the kingdom of heaven.
13:1 vx5y ἐν τῇ ἡμέρᾳ ἐκείνῃ 1 These events happened on the same day as those in the previous chapter.
13:1 cy1t ἐξελθὼν & τῆς οἰκίας 1 It is not mentioned at whose house Jesus was staying.
13:1 zjb3 rc://*/ta/man/translate/figs-explicit ἐκάθητο παρὰ τὴν θάλασσαν 1 It is implied that he sat down to teach the people. (See: [[rc://*/ta/man/translate/figs-explicit]])
13:2 d16z rc://*/ta/man/translate/figs-explicit ὥστε αὐτὸν εἰς πλοῖον ἐμβάντα 1 It is implied that Jesus got into a boat because it would make it easier to teach the people. (See: [[rc://*/ta/man/translate/figs-explicit]])
13:2 jge7 rc://*/ta/man/translate/translate-unknown πλοῖον 1 This was probably an open, wooden fishing boat with a sail. (See: [[rc://*/ta/man/translate/translate-unknown]])
13:3 e99p 0 Jesus describes the kingdom of heaven by telling a parable about a person who sows seeds.
13:3 f5mv καὶ ἐλάλησεν αὐτοῖς πολλὰ ἐν παραβολαῖς 1 “Jesus told them many things in parables”
13:3 w5p3 αὐτοῖς 1 “to the people in the crowd”
13:3 m97r ἰδοὺ 1 “Look” or “Listen.” This word calls attention to what is to be said next. Alternate translation: “Pay attention to what I am about to tell you”
13:3 ur64 ἐξῆλθεν ὁ σπείρων τοῦ σπείρειν 1 “a farmer went out to scatter seeds in a field”
13:4 c6g6 καὶ ἐν τῷ σπείρειν αὐτὸν 1 “As the farmer scattered the seed”
13:4 v7r8 παρὰ τὴν ὁδόν 1 This refers to a “path” next to the field. The ground there would have been hard from people walking on it.
13:4 qr2d κατέφαγεν αὐτά 1 “ate all the seeds”
13:5 l2g6 τὰ πετρώδη 1 This is ground full of rocks with just a thin layer of soil on top of the rocks.
13:5 ql87 καὶ εὐθέως ἐξανέτειλεν 1 “The seeds quickly sprouted and grew”
13:6 qq5x rc://*/ta/man/translate/figs-activepassive ἐκαυματίσθη 1 This can be stated in active form. Alternate translation: “the sun scorched the plants, and they became too hot” (See: [[rc://*/ta/man/translate/figs-activepassive]])
13:6 az8l ἐξηράνθη 1 “the plants became dry and died”
13:7 dnm8 0 Jesus finishes telling a parable about a person who sows seeds.
13:7 ugc9 ἔπεσεν ἐπὶ τὰς ἀκάνθας 1 “fell where plants with thorns grew”
13:7 vt8z ἀπέπνιξαν αὐτά 1 “choked the new sprouts.” Use your word for the way weeds prevent other plants from growing well.
13:8 iwv2 ἐδίδου καρπόν 1 “grew more seeds” or “gave fruit”
13:8 e91e rc://*/ta/man/translate/figs-ellipsis ὃ μὲν ἑκατὸν, ὃ δὲ ἑξήκοντα, ὃ δὲ τριάκοντα 1 The words “seeds,” “produced,” and “crop” are understood from the previous phrase. These can be expressed clearly. Alternate translation: “some seeds produced one hundred times as much crop, some seeds produced sixty times as much crop, and some seeds produced thirty times as much crop” (See: [[rc://*/ta/man/translate/figs-ellipsis]])
13:8 ph2p rc://*/ta/man/translate/translate-numbers ἑκατὸν & ἑξήκοντα & τριάκοντα 1 “100 … 60 … 30” (See: [[rc://*/ta/man/translate/translate-numbers]])
13:9 q2e2 rc://*/ta/man/translate/figs-metonymy ὁ ἔχων ὦτα, ἀκουέτω 1 Jesus is emphasizing that what he has just said is important and may take some effort to understand and put into practice. The phrase “has ears” here is a metonym for the willingness to understand and obey. See how you translated a similar phrase in [Matthew 11:15](../11/15.md). Alternate translation: “Let the one who is willing to listen, listen” or “The one who is willing to understand, let him understand and obey” (See: [[rc://*/ta/man/translate/figs-metonymy]])
13:9 gkv1 rc://*/ta/man/translate/figs-123person ὁ ἔχων ὦτα, ἀκουέτω 1 Since Jesus is speaking directly to his audience, you may prefer to use the second person here. See how you translated a similar phrase in [Matthew 11:15](../11/15.md). Alternate translation: “If you are willing to listen, listen” or “If you are willing to understand, then understand and obey” (See: [[rc://*/ta/man/translate/figs-123person]])
13:10 p8yc 0 Jesus explains to his disciples why he teaches with parables.
13:11 fc5n rc://*/ta/man/translate/figs-activepassive ὑμῖν δέδοται γνῶναι τὰ μυστήρια τῆς Βασιλείας τῶν Οὐρανῶν, ἐκείνοις δὲ οὐ δέδοται 1 This can be translated with the active form and with implied information expressed clearly. Alternate translation: “God has given you the privilege of understanding mysteries of the kingdom of heaven, but God has not given it to these people” or “God has made you able to understand mysteries of the kingdom of heaven, but he has not enabled these people to understand” (See: [[rc://*/ta/man/translate/figs-activepassive]] and [[rc://*/ta/man/translate/figs-explicit]])
13:11 rcd3 rc://*/ta/man/translate/figs-you ὑμῖν δέδοται γνῶναι 1 The word “You” is plural here and refers to the disciples. (See: [[rc://*/ta/man/translate/figs-you]])
13:11 ah6u rc://*/ta/man/translate/figs-metonymy τὰ μυστήρια τῆς Βασιλείας τῶν Οὐρανῶν 1 Here “kingdom of heaven” refers to Gods rule. The phrase “kingdom of heaven” occurs only in the book of Matthew. If possible, try to keep it in your translation. Alternate translation: “the secrets about our God in heaven and his rule” (See: [[rc://*/ta/man/translate/figs-metonymy]])
13:12 j3rl ὅστις & ἔχει 1 “whoever has understanding” or “whoever receives what I teach”
13:12 v61y rc://*/ta/man/translate/figs-activepassive δοθήσεται 1 This can be translated in active form. Alternate translation: “God will give him more understanding” (See: [[rc://*/ta/man/translate/figs-activepassive]])
13:12 xsr5 ὅστις & οὐκ ἔχει 1 “whoever does not have understanding” or “whoever does not receive what I teach”
13:12 bl5s rc://*/ta/man/translate/figs-activepassive καὶ ὃ ἔχει ἀρθήσεται ἀπ’ αὐτοῦ 1 This can be stated in active form. Alternate translation: “God will take away even what he has” (See: [[rc://*/ta/man/translate/figs-activepassive]])
13:13 wc3u 0 In verse 14, Jesus quotes the prophet Isaiah to show that the peoples failure to understand Jesus teaching is a fulfillment of prophecy.
13:13 hm4t 0 Jesus continues to explain to his disciples why he teaches in parables.
13:13 v6pb αὐτοῖς & βλέπουσιν 1 All occurrences of “them” and “they” refer to the people in the crowd.
13:13 uk7j rc://*/ta/man/translate/figs-parallelism 1 Jesus uses this parallelism to tell and emphasize to the disciples that the crowd refuses to understand Gods truth. (See: [[rc://*/ta/man/translate/figs-parallelism]])
13:13 ae8k βλέποντες 1 Possible meanings are (1) this refers to them seeing what Jesus does. Alternate translation: “Though they see what I do” or (2) this refers to their ability to see. Alternate translation: “Though they are able to see”
13:13 nbi3 rc://*/ta/man/translate/figs-metaphor οὐ βλέπουσιν 1 Here “see” represents understanding. Alternate translation: “they do not understand” (See: [[rc://*/ta/man/translate/figs-metaphor]])
13:13 j4bg ἀκούοντες 1 Possible meanings are (1) this refers to them hearing what Jesus teaches. Alternate translation: “Though they hear what I say” or (2) this refers to their ability to hear. Alternate translation: “Though they are able to hear”
13:13 gq65 rc://*/ta/man/translate/figs-metaphor οὐκ ἀκούουσιν 1 Here “hear” represents listening well. Alternate translation: “they do not listen well” or “they do not pay attention” (See: [[rc://*/ta/man/translate/figs-metaphor]])
13:14 jz9n καὶ ἀναπληροῦται αὐτοῖς ἡ προφητεία Ἠσαΐου ἡ λέγουσα 1 This can be stated in active form. Alternate translation: “They are fulfilling what God said long ago through the prophet Isaiah”
13:14 z2es rc://*/ta/man/translate/figs-parallelism ἀκοῇ ἀκούσετε καὶ οὐ μὴ συνῆτε; καὶ βλέποντες βλέψετε καὶ οὐ μὴ ἴδητε 1 This begins a quote from the prophet Isaiah about the unbelieving people of Isaiahs day. Jesus uses this quote to describe the very crowd that was listening to him. These statements are again parallel and emphasize that the people refused to understand Gods truth. (See: [[rc://*/ta/man/translate/figs-parallelism]])
13:14 a1im rc://*/ta/man/translate/figs-explicit ἀκοῇ ἀκούσετε καὶ οὐ μὴ συνῆτε 1 “You will hear things, but you will not understand them.” You can make explicit what the people will hear. Alternate translation: “You will hear what God says through the prophets, but you will not understand its true meaning” (See: [[rc://*/ta/man/translate/figs-explicit]])
13:14 emu1 rc://*/ta/man/translate/figs-explicit βλέποντες βλέψετε καὶ οὐ μὴ ἴδητε 1 You can make explicit what the people will see. Alternate translation: “you will see what God does through the prophets, but you will not understand it” (See: [[rc://*/ta/man/translate/figs-explicit]])
13:15 e8r5 0 Jesus finishes quoting the prophet Isaiah.
13:15 lu8u rc://*/ta/man/translate/figs-metaphor ἐπαχύνθη γὰρ ἡ καρδία τοῦ λαοῦ τούτου & ἰάσομαι αὐτούς 1 In 13:15 God describes the people of Israel as if they have physical diseases that cause them to be unable to learn, to see, and to hear. God wants them to come to him so he will heal them. This is all a metaphor describing the peoples spiritual condition. It means the people are stubborn and refuse to receive and understand Gods truth. If they would, then they would repent and God would forgive them and welcome them back as his people. If the meaning is clear, keep the metaphor in your translation. (See: [[rc://*/ta/man/translate/figs-metaphor]])
13:15 fy7m rc://*/ta/man/translate/figs-metonymy ἐπαχύνθη γὰρ ἡ καρδία τοῦ λαοῦ τούτου 1 Here “heart” refers to the mind. Alternate translation: “these peoples minds are slow to learn” or “these people can no longer learn” (See: [[rc://*/ta/man/translate/figs-metonymy]])
13:15 q87m rc://*/ta/man/translate/figs-metonymy τοῖς ὠσὶν βαρέως ἤκουσαν 1 They are not physically deaf. Here “hard of hearing” means they refuse to listen and learn Gods truth. Alternate translation: “they refuse to use their ears to listen” (See: [[rc://*/ta/man/translate/figs-metonymy]])
13:15 y7t7 rc://*/ta/man/translate/figs-metonymy τοὺς ὀφθαλμοὺς αὐτῶν ἐκάμμυσαν 1 They have not literally closed their eyes. This means they refuse to understand. Alternate translation: “they refuse to use their eyes to see” (See: [[rc://*/ta/man/translate/figs-metonymy]])
13:15 fl93 μήποτε ἴδωσιν τοῖς ὀφθαλμοῖς, καὶ τοῖς ὠσὶν ἀκούσωσιν, καὶ τῇ καρδίᾳ συνῶσιν, καὶ ἐπιστρέψωσιν 1 “so that they are not able to see with their eyes, hear with their ears, or understand with their heart, and as a result turn again”
13:15 sr25 rc://*/ta/man/translate/figs-metonymy τῇ καρδίᾳ συνῶσιν 1 The word “hearts” here is a metonym for peoples innermost being. You may need to use the word in your language for the source of peoples thinking and feelings. Alternate translation: “understand with their minds” (See: [[rc://*/ta/man/translate/figs-metonymy]])
13:15 ps56 ἐπιστρέψωσιν 1 “turn back to me” or “repent”
13:15 q1h9 rc://*/ta/man/translate/figs-metaphor ἰάσομαι αὐτούς 1 “have me heal them.” This means God would heal them spiritually by forgiving their sins and receiving them again as his people. Alternate translation: “have me receive them again” (See: [[rc://*/ta/man/translate/figs-metaphor]])
13:16 dc9t 0 Jesus finishes explaining to his disciples why he teaches with parables.
13:16 yhe4 rc://*/ta/man/translate/figs-parallelism ὑμῶν δὲ μακάριοι οἱ ὀφθαλμοὶ ὅτι βλέπουσιν, καὶ τὰ ὦτα ὑμῶν ὅτι ἀκούουσιν 1 Both of these statements mean the same thing. Jesus is emphasizing that they have pleased God because they have believed what Jesus has said and done. (See: [[rc://*/ta/man/translate/figs-parallelism]])
13:16 glp8 rc://*/ta/man/translate/figs-synecdoche ὑμῶν δὲ μακάριοι οἱ ὀφθαλμοὶ ὅτι βλέπουσιν 1 Here “eyes” refers to the whole person. Alternate translation: “You are blessed because your eyes are able to see” (See: [[rc://*/ta/man/translate/figs-synecdoche]])
13:16 rlt3 rc://*/ta/man/translate/figs-you ὑμῶν & ὑμῶν 1 All occurrences of these words are plural and refer to the disciples. (See: [[rc://*/ta/man/translate/figs-you]])
13:16 jp32 rc://*/ta/man/translate/figs-synecdoche τὰ ὦτα ὑμῶν ὅτι ἀκούουσιν 1 Here “ears” refer to the whole person. You can also make clear the understood information. Alternate translation: “you are blessed because your ears are able to hear” (See: [[rc://*/ta/man/translate/figs-synecdoche]] and [[rc://*/ta/man/translate/figs-ellipsis]])
13:17 mg58 ἀμὴν, γὰρ λέγω ὑμῖν 1 “I tell you the truth.” This adds emphasis to what Jesus says next.
13:17 bsj7 rc://*/ta/man/translate/figs-you ὑμῖν 1 All occurrences of this word are plural and refer to the disciples. (See: [[rc://*/ta/man/translate/figs-you]])
13:17 e6ci rc://*/ta/man/translate/figs-explicit ἃ βλέπετε 1 You can make explicit what they have seen. Alternate translation: “the things you have seen me do” (See: [[rc://*/ta/man/translate/figs-explicit]])
13:17 q14w rc://*/ta/man/translate/figs-explicit ἃ ἀκούετε 1 You can make explicit what they have heard. Alternate translation: “the things you have heard me say” (See: [[rc://*/ta/man/translate/figs-explicit]])
13:18 w35t 0 Here Jesus begins to explain to his disciples the parable about a person who sows seeds, which he began in [Matthew 13:3](../13/03.md).
13:19 v2d7 τὸν λόγον τῆς βασιλείας 1 “the message about Gods rule as king”
13:19 a8nu rc://*/ta/man/translate/figs-metaphor ἔρχεται ὁ πονηρὸς καὶ ἁρπάζει τὸ ἐσπαρμένον ἐν τῇ καρδίᾳ αὐτοῦ 1 Jesus speaks of Satan causing the person to forget what he has heard as if Satan were a bird snatching the seed from the ground. Alternate translation: “The evil one causes him to forget the message that he has heard just as a bird snatches away seed from the ground” (See: [[rc://*/ta/man/translate/figs-metaphor]])
13:19 sb7u rc://*/ta/man/translate/figs-explicit ὁ πονηρὸς 1 This refers to Satan. (See: [[rc://*/ta/man/translate/figs-explicit]])
13:19 pt4d ἁρπάζει 1 Try to use a word that means to grab something away from someone who is the rightful owner.
13:19 r9u6 rc://*/ta/man/translate/figs-activepassive τὸ ἐσπαρμένον ἐν τῇ καρδίᾳ αὐτοῦ 1 This can be translated in active form: Alternate translation: “the message that God sowed in his heart” or “the message that he heard” (See: [[rc://*/ta/man/translate/figs-activepassive]])
13:19 xi8f rc://*/ta/man/translate/figs-metonymy ἐν τῇ καρδίᾳ αὐτοῦ 1 Here “heart” refers to the mind of the hearer. (See: [[rc://*/ta/man/translate/figs-metonymy]])
13:19 wfd3 οὗτός ἐστιν ὁ παρὰ τὴν ὁδὸν σπαρείς 1 “This is the meaning of the seed that was sown beside the road” or “The road where seed was sown represents this person”
13:19 xgz5 παρὰ τὴν ὁδὸν 1 See how you translated this in [Matthew 13:4](../13/04.md).
13:20 q3fp 0 Jesus continues to explain to his disciples the parable about a person who sows seeds.
13:20 l5iv rc://*/ta/man/translate/figs-explicit ὁ δὲ ἐπὶ τὰ πετρώδη σπαρείς 1 The phrase “what was sown” refers to seed that fell. Alternate translation: “The seed that fell on rocky ground” (See: [[rc://*/ta/man/translate/figs-explicit]])
13:20 w4f9 ὁ δὲ ἐπὶ τὰ πετρώδη σπαρείς, οὗτός ἐστιν 1 “The rocky ground where seed was sown represents” or “The rocky ground where seed fell represents”
13:20 e3hm ὁ τὸν λόγον ἀκούων 1 In the parable, the seed represents the word.
13:20 cl6g rc://*/ta/man/translate/figs-metonymy τὸν λόγον 1 This represents Gods message. Alternate translation: “the message” or “Gods teaching” (See: [[rc://*/ta/man/translate/figs-metonymy]])
13:20 z76f rc://*/ta/man/translate/figs-metaphor μετὰ χαρᾶς λαμβάνων αὐτόν 1 Believing the word is spoken of as receiving it. Alternate translation: “joyfully believes it” (See: [[rc://*/ta/man/translate/figs-metaphor]])
13:21 zg9q rc://*/ta/man/translate/figs-metaphor οὐκ ἔχει δὲ ῥίζαν ἐν ἑαυτῷ, ἀλλὰ πρόσκαιρός ἐστιν 1 “Yet he has shallow roots and only lasts for a little while.” The root represents what makes a person continue to believe Gods message. Alternate translation: “But like a plant that does not grow deep roots, he only endures for a little while” (See: [[rc://*/ta/man/translate/figs-metaphor]])
13:21 lim9 rc://*/ta/man/translate/figs-metaphor εὐθὺς σκανδαλίζεται 1 Here “falls away” means stops believing. Alternate translation: “immediately he falls away” or “he quickly stops believing the message” (See: [[rc://*/ta/man/translate/figs-metaphor]])
13:22 sis7 0 Jesus continues to explain to his disciples the parable about a person who sows seeds.
13:22 d4h5 rc://*/ta/man/translate/figs-explicit ὁ & σπαρείς 1 This refers to seed that was sown or that fell. Alternate translation: “The seed that was sown” or “The seed that fell” (See: [[rc://*/ta/man/translate/figs-explicit]])
13:22 rcj8 ὁ δὲ εἰς τὰς ἀκάνθας σπαρείς 1 “The ground with the thorn plants where seed was sown”
13:22 anm5 οὗτός ἐστιν ὁ 1 “this represents the person”
13:22 a3u1 τὸν λόγον 1 “the message” or “Gods teaching”
13:22 q2nh rc://*/ta/man/translate/figs-metaphor ἡ μέριμνα τοῦ αἰῶνος τούτου καὶ ἡ ἀπάτη τοῦ πλούτου συνπνίγει τὸν λόγον 1 Jesus speaks about the cares of the world and the deceitfulness of riches distracting a person from obeying Gods word as if they were weeds that could wind around a plant and keep it from growing. Alternate translation: “as weeds prevent good plants from growing, the cares of the world and the deceitfulness of riches keep this person from listening to Gods word” (See: [[rc://*/ta/man/translate/figs-metaphor]])
13:22 xa8r μέριμνα τοῦ αἰῶνος τούτου 1 “the things in this world that people worry about”
13:22 wwf5 rc://*/ta/man/translate/figs-personification ἡ ἀπάτη τοῦ πλούτου 1 Jesus describes “riches” as if it were a person who could deceive someone. This means people think having more money will make them happy, but it will not. Alternate translation: “the love of money” (See: [[rc://*/ta/man/translate/figs-personification]])
13:22 gn6z rc://*/ta/man/translate/figs-metaphor ἄκαρπος γίνεται 1 The person is spoken of as if he were a plant. Being unfruitful represents being unproductive. Alternate translation: “he becomes unproductive” or “he does not do what God wants” (See: [[rc://*/ta/man/translate/figs-metaphor]])
13:23 xw4b ὁ & ἐπὶ τὴν καλὴν γῆν σπαρείς 1 “The good soil where seeds were sown”
13:23 ptb8 rc://*/ta/man/translate/figs-metaphor δὴ καρποφορεῖ καὶ ποιεῖ 1 The person is spoken of as if he were a plant. Alternate translation: “Like a healthy plant that bears a crop of fruit, he is productive” (See: [[rc://*/ta/man/translate/figs-metaphor]])
13:23 wm3p rc://*/ta/man/translate/figs-ellipsis ὃ μὲν ἑκατὸν, ὃ δὲ ἑξήκοντα, ὃ δὲ τριάκοντα 1 The phrase “as much as was planted” is understood following each of these numbers. See how you translated this in [Matthew 13:8](../13/08.md). Alternate translation: “Some people produce 100 times as much as was planted, some produce 60 times as much, and some produce 30 times as much” (See: [[rc://*/ta/man/translate/figs-ellipsis]] and [[rc://*/ta/man/translate/translate-numbers]])
13:24 l5yx rc://*/ta/man/translate/figs-parables 0 Here Jesus describes the kingdom of heaven by telling a parable about a field with both wheat and weeds growing in it. (See: [[rc://*/ta/man/translate/figs-parables]])
13:24 k8pu rc://*/ta/man/translate/figs-simile ὡμοιώθη ἡ Βασιλεία τῶν Οὐρανῶν, ἀνθρώπῳ 1 The translation should not equate the kingdom of heaven to a man, but rather the kingdom of heaven is like the situation described in the parable. (See: [[rc://*/ta/man/translate/figs-simile]])
13:24 f8j5 rc://*/ta/man/translate/figs-metonymy ὡμοιώθη ἡ Βασιλεία τῶν Οὐρανῶν 1 Here “kingdom of heaven” refers to Gods rule as king. The phrase “kingdom of heaven” is used only in Matthew. If possible, use “heaven” in your translation. Alternate translation: “When our God in heaven shows himself to be king, it will be like” (See: [[rc://*/ta/man/translate/figs-metonymy]])
13:24 u21k rc://*/ta/man/translate/figs-explicit καλὸν σπέρμα 1 “good food seeds” or “good grain seeds.” The audience probably thought that Jesus was talking about wheat. (See: [[rc://*/ta/man/translate/figs-explicit]])
13:25 zn8v ἦλθεν αὐτοῦ ὁ ἐχθρὸς 1 “his enemy came to the field”
13:25 q4tv ζιζάνια 1 These weeds look like food plants when they are young, but their grain is poison. Alternate translation: “bad seed” or “weed seeds”
13:26 lea1 ὅτε δὲ ἐβλάστησεν ὁ χόρτος 1 “When the wheat seeds sprouted” or “When the plants came up”
13:26 jgv9 καρπὸν ἐποίησεν 1 “produced grain” or “produced the wheat crop”
13:26 tu4q τότε ἐφάνη καὶ τὰ ζιζάνια 1 “then people could see there were weeds in the field also”
13:27 hz3q 0 Jesus continues to tell a parable about a field with both wheat and weeds growing in it.
13:27 h51x τοῦ οἰκοδεσπότου 1 This is the same person who sowed good seed in his field.
13:27 gr7d rc://*/ta/man/translate/figs-rquestion οὐχὶ καλὸν σπέρμα ἔσπειρας ἐν τῷ σῷ ἀγρῷ? 1 The servants used a question to emphasize their surprise. Alternate translation: “you sowed good seed in your field!” (See: [[rc://*/ta/man/translate/figs-rquestion]])
13:27 fb86 rc://*/ta/man/translate/figs-metonymy οὐχὶ & ἔσπειρας 1 The landowner probably had his servants plant the seeds. Alternate translation: “did we not sow” (See: [[rc://*/ta/man/translate/figs-metonymy]])
13:28 r83z ὁ δὲ ἔφη αὐτοῖς 1 “The landowner said to the servants”
13:28 num8 θέλεις οὖν ἀπελθόντες 1 The word “us” refers to the servants.
13:29 shs3 0 Jesus concludes the parable about a field with both wheat and weeds growing in it.
13:29 c9jc ὁ δέ φησιν 1 “The landowner said to his servants”
13:30 z36a rc://*/ta/man/translate/figs-quotations ἐρῶ τοῖς θερισταῖς, συλλέξατε πρῶτον τὰ ζιζάνια καὶ δήσατε αὐτὰ εἰς δέσμας πρὸς τὸ κατακαῦσαι αὐτά; τὸν δὲ σῖτον συναγάγετε εἰς τὴν ἀποθήκην μου. 1 You can translate this as an indirect quote (AT): “I will tell the reapers to first gather up the weeds and tie them in bundles to burn them, and then gather the wheat into my barn” (See: [[rc://*/ta/man/translate/figs-quotations]])
13:30 ll14 τὴν ἀποθήκην 1 a farm building that can be used for storing grain
13:31 tdf4 rc://*/ta/man/translate/figs-parables 0 Jesus describes the kingdom of heaven by telling a parable about a very small seed that grows into a very big plant. (See: [[rc://*/ta/man/translate/figs-parables]])
13:31 jw7u rc://*/ta/man/translate/figs-metonymy ὁμοία ἐστὶν ἡ Βασιλεία τῶν Οὐρανῶν 1 Here “kingdom of heaven” refers to Gods rule as king. The phrase “kingdom of heaven” is used only in Matthew. If possible, use “heaven” in your translation. See how you translated this in [Matthew 13:24](../13/24.md). Alternate translation: “When our God in heaven shows himself to be king, it will be like” (See: [[rc://*/ta/man/translate/figs-metonymy]])
13:31 qby8 rc://*/ta/man/translate/translate-unknown κόκκῳ σινάπεως 1 a very small seed that grows into a large plant (See: [[rc://*/ta/man/translate/translate-unknown]])
13:32 gyi1 rc://*/ta/man/translate/figs-explicit ὃ μικρότερον μέν ἐστιν πάντων τῶν σπερμάτων 1 Mustard seeds were the smallest seeds known to the original hearers. (See: [[rc://*/ta/man/translate/figs-explicit]])
13:32 x65d ὅταν δὲ αὐξηθῇ 1 “But when the plant has grown”
13:32 um9k μεῖζον & ἐστὶν 1 “it is larger than”
13:32 g6v8 γίνεται δένδρον 1 A mustard plant can grow about 2 to 4 meters tall.
13:32 c9te τὰ πετεινὰ τοῦ οὐρανοῦ 1 “birds”
13:33 a1th rc://*/ta/man/translate/figs-parables 0 Jesus describes the kingdom of heaven by telling a parable about the effect that yeast has on flour. (See: [[rc://*/ta/man/translate/figs-parables]])
13:33 z94k rc://*/ta/man/translate/figs-simile ὁμοία ἐστὶν ἡ Βασιλεία τῶν Οὐρανῶν ζύμῃ 1 The kingdom is not like the yeast, but the spread of the kingdom is like the spreading of the yeast. (See: [[rc://*/ta/man/translate/figs-simile]])
13:33 w8sb rc://*/ta/man/translate/figs-metonymy ὁμοία ἐστὶν ἡ Βασιλεία τῶν Οὐρανῶν 1 Here “kingdom of heaven” refers to Gods rule as king. The phrase “kingdom of heaven” is used only in Matthew. If possible, use “heaven” in your translation. See how you translated this in [Matthew 13:24](../13/24.md). Alternate translation: “When our God in heaven shows himself to be king, it will be like” (See: [[rc://*/ta/man/translate/figs-metonymy]])
13:33 r88g rc://*/ta/man/translate/translate-bvolume ἀλεύρου σάτα τρία 1 Say “a large amount of flour” or use a term that your culture uses for measuring large amounts of flour. (See: [[rc://*/ta/man/translate/translate-bvolume]])
13:33 c35r rc://*/ta/man/translate/figs-explicit ἕως οὗ ἐζυμώθη ὅλον 1 The implied information is that the yeast and the three measures of flour were made into dough for baking. (See: [[rc://*/ta/man/translate/figs-explicit]])
13:34 f9gl 0 Here the author quotes from the Psalms to show that Jesus teaching in parables fulfilled prophecy.
13:34 nt7u rc://*/ta/man/translate/figs-parallelism ταῦτα πάντα ἐλάλησεν ὁ Ἰησοῦς ἐν παραβολαῖς τοῖς ὄχλοις, καὶ χωρὶς παραβολῆς οὐδὲν ἐλάλει αὐτοῖς 1 Both sentences mean the same thing. They are combined to emphasize that Jesus taught the crowds only with parables. (See: [[rc://*/ta/man/translate/figs-parallelism]])
13:34 n54e ταῦτα πάντα 1 This refers to what Jesus taught beginning at [Matthew 13:1](../13/01.md).
13:34 a5c7 rc://*/ta/man/translate/figs-doublenegatives χωρὶς παραβολῆς οὐδὲν ἐλάλει αὐτοῖς 1 “he taught them nothing except by parables.” The double negative can be expressed in a positive way. Alternate translation: “everything he taught them he said in parables” (See: [[rc://*/ta/man/translate/figs-doublenegatives]])
13:35 ybq5 rc://*/ta/man/translate/figs-activepassive πληρωθῇ τὸ ῥηθὲν διὰ τοῦ προφήτου λέγοντος 1 This can be stated in active form. Alternate translation: “what God told one of the prophets to write long ago might come true” (See: [[rc://*/ta/man/translate/figs-activepassive]])
13:35 p3tb λέγοντος 1 “when the prophet said”
13:35 n1pa rc://*/ta/man/translate/figs-idiom ἀνοίξω & τὸ στόμα μου 1 This is an idiom that means to speak. Alternate translation: “I will speak” (See: [[rc://*/ta/man/translate/figs-idiom]])
13:35 yx6y rc://*/ta/man/translate/figs-activepassive κεκρυμμένα 1 This can be stated in active form. Alternate translation: “things that God has kept hidden” (See: [[rc://*/ta/man/translate/figs-activepassive]])
13:35 th8t ἀπὸ καταβολῆς κόσμου 1 “since the beginning of the world” or “since God created the world”
13:36 pq2h 0 Here the scene shifts to the house where Jesus and his disciples were staying. Jesus begins to explain to them the parable of the field that had both wheat and weeds, which he told beginning in [Matthew 13:24](../13/24.md).
13:36 x5w7 ἦλθεν εἰς τὴν οἰκίαν 1 “went indoors” or “went into the house where he was staying”
13:37 aj8f ὁ σπείρων τὸ καλὸν σπέρμα 1 “The one who sows the good seed” or “The sower of the good seed”
13:37 xj4s rc://*/ta/man/translate/figs-123person ὁ Υἱὸς τοῦ Ἀνθρώπου 1 Jesus is referring to himself. (See: [[rc://*/ta/man/translate/figs-123person]])
13:38 h9iz rc://*/ta/man/translate/figs-idiom οἱ υἱοὶ τῆς βασιλείας 1 The idiom “sons of” refers to those who belong to or to have the same character as someone or something. Alternate translation: “the people who belong to the kingdom” (See: [[rc://*/ta/man/translate/figs-idiom]])
13:38 eni3 rc://*/ta/man/translate/figs-metonymy τῆς βασιλείας 1 Here “kingdom” refers to God the king. Alternate translation: “of God” (See: [[rc://*/ta/man/translate/figs-metonymy]])
13:38 edu7 rc://*/ta/man/translate/figs-idiom οἱ υἱοὶ τοῦ πονηροῦ 1 The idiom “sons of” refers those who belong to or to have the same character as someone or something. Alternate translation: “the people who belong to the evil one” (See: [[rc://*/ta/man/translate/figs-idiom]])
13:39 sgx2 ὁ & ἐχθρὸς, ὁ σπείρας αὐτά 1 “the enemy who sowed the weeds”
13:40 ei3v 0 Jesus finishes explaining to his disciples the parable of the field with both wheat and weeds.
13:40 rn64 rc://*/ta/man/translate/figs-activepassive ὥσπερ οὖν συλλέγεται τὰ ζιζάνια καὶ πυρὶ κατακαίεται 1 This can be translated in active form. Alternate translation: “Therefore, as people gather up weeds and burn them in the fire” (See: [[rc://*/ta/man/translate/figs-activepassive]])
13:41 fiy4 rc://*/ta/man/translate/figs-123person ἀποστελεῖ ὁ Υἱὸς τοῦ Ἀνθρώπου τοὺς ἀγγέλους αὐτοῦ 1 Here Jesus is speaking of himself. Alternate translation: “I, the Son of Man, will send out my angels” (See: [[rc://*/ta/man/translate/figs-123person]])
13:41 ptw9 τοὺς ποιοῦντας τὴν ἀνομίαν 1 “those who are lawless” or “evil people”
13:42 d9md rc://*/ta/man/translate/figs-metaphor τὴν κάμινον τοῦ πυρός 1 This is a metaphor for the fires of hell. If the term “furnace” is not known, “oven” can be used. Alternate translation: “fiery furnace” (See: [[rc://*/ta/man/translate/figs-metaphor]])
13:42 zu3j rc://*/ta/man/translate/translate-symaction ὁ κλαυθμὸς καὶ ὁ βρυγμὸς τῶν ὀδόντων 1 “Grinding of teeth” here is a symbolic act, representing extreme sadness and suffering. See how you translated this in [Matthew 8:12](../08/12.md). Alternate translation: “weeping and showing that they are suffering very much” (See: [[rc://*/ta/man/translate/translate-symaction]])
13:43 u6sm rc://*/ta/man/translate/figs-simile ἐκλάμψουσιν ὡς ὁ ἥλιος 1 If this simile is not understandable in your language, you can use: “be as easy to see as the sun.” (See: [[rc://*/ta/man/translate/figs-simile]])
13:43 sea2 rc://*/ta/man/translate/guidelines-sonofgodprinciples τοῦ Πατρὸς 1 This is an important title for God. (See: [[rc://*/ta/man/translate/guidelines-sonofgodprinciples]])
13:43 zxh2 rc://*/ta/man/translate/figs-metonymy ὁ ἔχων ὦτα, ἀκουέτω 1 Jesus is emphasizing that what he has just said is important and may take some effort to understand and put into practice. The phrase “has ears” here is a metonym for the willingness to understand and obey. See how you translated a similar phrase in [Matthew 11:15](../11/15.md). Alternate translation: “Let the one who is willing to listen, listen” or “The one who is willing to understand, let him understand and obey” (See: [[rc://*/ta/man/translate/figs-metonymy]])
13:43 sak5 rc://*/ta/man/translate/figs-123person ὁ & ἀκουέτω 1 Since Jesus is speaking directly to his audience, you may prefer to use the second person here. See how you translated this in [Matthew 11:15](../11/15.md). Alternate translation: “If you are willing to listen, listen” or “If you are willing to understand, then understand and obey” (See: [[rc://*/ta/man/translate/figs-123person]])
13:44 n7nz rc://*/ta/man/translate/figs-simile 0 In these two parables, Jesus uses two similes to teach his disciples what the kingdom of heaven is like. (See: [[rc://*/ta/man/translate/figs-simile]])
13:44 fjm1 rc://*/ta/man/translate/figs-parables 0 Jesus describes the kingdom of heaven by telling two parables about people who sold their possessions to purchase something of great value. (See: [[rc://*/ta/man/translate/figs-parables]])
13:44 e9cv rc://*/ta/man/translate/figs-metonymy ὁμοία ἐστὶν ἡ Βασιλεία τῶν Οὐρανῶν 1 Here “kingdom of heaven” refers to Gods rule as king. The phrase “kingdom of heaven” is used only in Matthew. If possible, use “heaven” in your translation. See how you translated this in [Matthew 13:24](../13/24.md). Alternate translation: “When our God in heaven shows himself to be king, it will be like” (See: [[rc://*/ta/man/translate/figs-metonymy]])
13:44 u9jq rc://*/ta/man/translate/figs-activepassive ὁμοία ἐστὶν & θησαυρῷ κεκρυμμένῳ ἐν τῷ ἀγρῷ 1 This can be stated in active form. Alternate translation: “a treasure that someone had hidden in a field” (See: [[rc://*/ta/man/translate/figs-activepassive]])
13:44 k9rh θησαυρῷ 1 a very valuable and precious thing or collection of things
13:44 hu7f ἔκρυψεν 1 “covered it up”
13:44 jtv2 rc://*/ta/man/translate/figs-explicit πωλεῖ πάντα ὅσα ἔχει, καὶ ἀγοράζει τὸν ἀγρὸν ἐκεῖνον 1 The implied information is that the person buys the field to take possession of the hidden treasure. (See: [[rc://*/ta/man/translate/figs-explicit]])
13:45 c633 rc://*/ta/man/translate/figs-simile ὁμοία & ἀνθρώπῳ ἐμπόρῳ ζητοῦντι καλοὺς μαργαρίτας 1 The implied information is that the man was looking for valuable pearls that he could buy. (See: [[rc://*/ta/man/translate/figs-simile]] and [[rc://*/ta/man/translate/figs-explicit]])
13:45 khy6 ἀνθρώπῳ ἐμπόρῳ 1 a trader or wholesale dealer who often obtains merchandise from distant places
13:45 b88q rc://*/ta/man/translate/translate-unknown καλοὺς μαργαρίτας 1 A “pearl” is a smooth, hard, shiny, white or light-colored bead formed inside mollusks in the sea and highly prized as a gem or to make into valuable jewelry. Alternate translation: “fine pearls” or “beautiful pearls” (See: [[rc://*/ta/man/translate/translate-unknown]])
13:47 vw24 rc://*/ta/man/translate/figs-parables 0 Jesus describes the kingdom of heaven by telling a parable about fishermen who use a large net to catch fish. (See: [[rc://*/ta/man/translate/figs-parables]])
13:47 g79n rc://*/ta/man/translate/figs-simile ὁμοία ἐστὶν ἡ Βασιλεία τῶν Οὐρανῶν σαγήνῃ 1 The kingdom is not like the net, but the kingdom draws all kinds of people like a net catches all kinds of fish. (See: [[rc://*/ta/man/translate/figs-simile]])
13:47 rjm4 rc://*/ta/man/translate/figs-metonymy ὁμοία ἐστὶν ἡ Βασιλεία τῶν Οὐρανῶν 1 Here “kingdom of heaven” refers to Gods rule as king. The phrase “kingdom of heaven” is used only in Matthew. If possible, use “heaven” in your translation. See how you translated this in [Matthew 13:24](../13/24.md). Alternate translation: “When our God in heaven shows himself to be king, it will be like” (See: [[rc://*/ta/man/translate/figs-metonymy]])
13:47 vrp4 rc://*/ta/man/translate/figs-activepassive ὁμοία & σαγήνῃ βληθείσῃ εἰς τὴν θάλασσαν 1 This can be stated in active form. Alternate translation: “like a net that some fishermen cast into the sea” (See: [[rc://*/ta/man/translate/figs-activepassive]])
13:47 kbz2 βληθείσῃ εἰς τὴν θάλασσαν 1 “was thrown into the sea”
13:47 t9v6 ἐκ παντὸς γένους συναγαγούσῃ 1 “caught all kinds of fish”
13:48 kf47 ἀναβιβάσαντες ἐπὶ τὸν αἰγιαλὸν 1 “pulled the net up onto the beach” or “pulled the net ashore”
13:48 cnp7 τὰ καλὰ 1 “the good ones”
13:48 qi2z τὰ & σαπρὰ 1 “the bad fish” or “the inedible fish”
13:48 aqu2 ἔβαλον 1 “did not keep”
13:49 nql6 0 Jesus explains the parable about fishermen who use a large net to catch fish.
13:49 q1ms ἐξελεύσονται 1 “will come out” or “will go out” or “will come from heaven”
13:49 ah2k rc://*/ta/man/translate/figs-nominaladj τοὺς πονηροὺς ἐκ μέσου τῶν δικαίων 1 These nominal adjectives can be stated as adjectives. Alternate translation: “the wicked people from the righteous people” (See: [[rc://*/ta/man/translate/figs-nominaladj]])
13:50 hwv1 βαλοῦσιν αὐτοὺς 1 “The angels will throw the wicked people”
13:50 j8nf rc://*/ta/man/translate/figs-metaphor τὴν κάμινον τοῦ πυρός 1 This is a metaphor for the fires of hell. If the term “furnace” is not known, “oven” can be used. See how you translated this in [Matthew 13:42](../13/42.md). Alternate translation: “fiery furnace” (See: [[rc://*/ta/man/translate/figs-metaphor]])
13:50 mc8t rc://*/ta/man/translate/translate-symaction ὁ κλαυθμὸς καὶ ὁ βρυγμὸς τῶν ὀδόντων 1 “Grinding of teeth” here is a symbolic act, representing extreme sadness and suffering. See how you translated this in [Matthew 8:12](../08/12.md). Alternate translation: weeping and expressing their extreme suffering.” (See: [[rc://*/ta/man/translate/translate-symaction]])
13:51 d3wg 0 Jesus describes the kingdom of heaven by telling a parable about a person who manages a household. This is the end of the part of the story about Jesus teaching the crowds about the kingdom of heaven through using parables.
13:51 p5ej rc://*/ta/man/translate/figs-quotations συνήκατε ταῦτα πάντα? λέγουσιν αὐτῷ, ναί. 1 If necessary, both direct quotations can be translated as indirect quotations. Alternate translation: “Jesus asked them if they had understood all this, and they said that they did understand.” (See: [[rc://*/ta/man/translate/figs-quotations]])
13:52 g4dd rc://*/ta/man/translate/figs-metonymy μαθητευθεὶς τῇ Βασιλεία τῶν Οὐρανῶν 1 Here “kingdom of heaven” refers to Gods rule as king. The phrase “kingdom of heaven” is used only in the book of Matthew. If possible, keep “heaven” in your translation. Alternate translation: “has learned the truth about our God in heaven, who is king” or “has submitted himself to Gods rule” (See: [[rc://*/ta/man/translate/figs-metonymy]])
13:52 gr36 rc://*/ta/man/translate/figs-parables ὅμοιός ἐστιν ἀνθρώπῳ οἰκοδεσπότῃ, ὅστις ἐκβάλλει ἐκ τοῦ θησαυροῦ αὐτοῦ καινὰ καὶ παλαιά 1 Jesus speaks another parable. He compares scribes, who know very well the scriptures that Moses and the prophets wrote, and who also now accept Jesus teachings, to a house owner who uses both old and new treasures. (See: [[rc://*/ta/man/translate/figs-parables]])
13:52 g59c τοῦ θησαυροῦ αὐτοῦ 1 A treasure is a very valuable and precious thing or a collection of things. Here it may refer to the place where these things are stored, the “treasury” or “storeroom.”
13:53 jwv2 καὶ ἐγένετο ὅτε 1 This phrase shifts the story from Jesus teachings to what happened next. Alternate translation: “Then” or “After”
13:54 qnh9 0 This is the beginning of a new part of the story that runs through [Matthew 17:27](../17/27.md), where Matthew tells of continued opposition to Jesus ministry and teaching about the kingdom of heaven. Here, the people of Jesus home town reject him.
13:54 q3ml rc://*/ta/man/translate/figs-explicit τὴν πατρίδα αὐτοῦ 1 “his hometown.” This refers to the town of Nazareth, where Jesus grew up. (See: [[rc://*/ta/man/translate/figs-explicit]])
13:54 j6vb ἐν τῇ συναγωγῇ αὐτῶν 1 The pronoun “their” is referring to the people of the region.
13:54 it1f ἐκπλήσσεσθαι αὐτοὺς 1 “they were amazed”
13:54 b3d2 rc://*/ta/man/translate/figs-explicit πόθεν τούτῳ ἡ σοφία αὕτη καὶ αἱ δυνάμεις? 1 The people believed that Jesus was just an ordinary man. They use this question to express their amazement that he was so wise and was able to do miracles. Alternate translation: “How can an ordinary man like this be so wise and do such great miracles?” or “It is strange that he is able to speak with such wisdom and do these miracles!” (See: [[rc://*/ta/man/translate/figs-explicit]] and [[rc://*/ta/man/translate/figs-rquestion]])
13:55 rk5e rc://*/ta/man/translate/figs-rquestion οὐχ οὗτός ἐστιν ὁ τοῦ τέκτονος υἱός? οὐχ ἡ μήτηρ αὐτοῦ λέγεται Μαριὰμ, καὶ οἱ ἀδελφοὶ αὐτοῦ, Ἰάκωβος, καὶ Ἰωσὴφ, καὶ Σίμων, καὶ Ἰούδας? 1 The crowd uses these questions to express their belief that they know who Jesus is and that he is just an ordinary man. Alternate translation: “He is just the son of a carpenter. We know his mother Mary, and his brothers James, Joseph, Simon, and Judas.” (See: [[rc://*/ta/man/translate/figs-rquestion]])
13:55 rpj9 ὁ τοῦ τέκτονος υἱός 1 A carpenter is someone who makes things with wood or stone. If “carpenter” is not known, “builder” can be used.
13:56 m9pn rc://*/ta/man/translate/figs-rquestion αἱ ἀδελφαὶ αὐτοῦ οὐχὶ πᾶσαι πρὸς ἡμᾶς εἰσιν? 1 The crowd uses these questions to express their belief that they know who Jesus is and that he is just an ordinary man. Alternate translation: “And all his sisters are with us, too.” (See: [[rc://*/ta/man/translate/figs-rquestion]])
13:56 bnv1 rc://*/ta/man/translate/figs-rquestion πόθεν οὖν τούτῳ ταῦτα πάντα? 1 The crowd uses this question to show their understanding that Jesus must have gotten his abilities from somewhere. They were probably expressing their doubt that he got his abilities from God. Alternate translation: “He must have gotten his ability to do these things from somewhere!” or “We do not know where he got these abilities!” (See: [[rc://*/ta/man/translate/figs-rquestion]])
13:56 pqf1 ταῦτα πάντα 1 This refers to Jesus wisdom and ability to do miracles.
13:57 f5md rc://*/ta/man/translate/figs-activepassive ἐσκανδαλίζοντο ἐν αὐτῷ 1 This can be stated in active form. Alternate translation: “The people of Jesus hometown took offense at him” or “The people rejected Jesus” (See: [[rc://*/ta/man/translate/figs-activepassive]])
13:57 azn4 rc://*/ta/man/translate/figs-doublenegatives οὐκ ἔστιν προφήτης ἄτιμος 1 This can be stated in positive form. Alternate translation: “A prophet receives honor everywhere” or “People everywhere honor a prophet” (See: [[rc://*/ta/man/translate/figs-doublenegatives]])
13:57 sq8j τῇ πατρίδι 1 “his own region” or “his own hometown”
13:57 w4x8 ἐν τῇ οἰκίᾳ αὐτοῦ 1 “in his own home”
13:58 e2cp οὐκ ἐποίησεν ἐκεῖ δυνάμεις πολλὰς 1 “Jesus did not do many miracles in his own hometown”
14:intro g5mc 0 # Matthew 14 General Notes\n## Structure and formatting\n\nVerses 1 and 2 continue the account from chapter 13. Verses 3-12 stop the account and speak of things that happened earlier, possibly soon after Satan tempted Jesus (see [Matthew 4:12](../../mat/04/12.md)). Verse 13 continues the account from verse 2. Be sure to have words in verses 3-12 that tell the reader that Matthew has stopped his account to give new information before he continues. (See: [[rc://*/ta/man/translate/writing-background]])\n\n## Possible translation difficulties in this chapter\n\n### Passive voice\n\nMany sentences in this chapter tell that a person had something happen to him without saying who caused that something to happen. For example, the writer does not tell who brought Johns head to Herodiass daughter ([Matthew 14:11](../../mat/14/11.md)). You may have to translate the sentence so that it tells the reader who performed the action. (See: [[rc://*/ta/man/translate/figs-activepassive]])
14:1 zl7x rc://*/ta/man/translate/figs-events 0 These verses explain Herods reaction when he heard about Jesus. This event happens some time after the events that follow in the narrative. (See: [[rc://*/ta/man/translate/figs-events]])
14:1 q8h5 ἐν ἐκείνῳ τῷ καιρῷ 1 “In those days” or “While Jesus was ministering in Galilee”
14:1 l9ur ἤκουσεν & τὴν ἀκοὴν Ἰησοῦ 1 “heard reports about Jesus” or “heard about the fame of Jesus”
14:2 pd1b εἶπεν 1 “Herod said”
14:2 nx7x ἠγέρθη ἀπὸ τῶν νεκρῶν 1 The words “from the dead” speak of all dead people together in the underworld. To rise from the dead speaks of coming alive again.
14:2 vve7 διὰ τοῦτο αἱ δυνάμεις ἐνεργοῦσιν ἐν αὐτῷ 1 Some Jews at that time believed if a person came back from the dead he would have powers to do mighty things.
14:3 y57m 0 Matthew recounts the story of John the Baptists death in order to show why Herod reacted the way he did when he heard about Jesus.
14:3 zgp9 rc://*/ta/man/translate/figs-events 0 Here the author begins to tell about how Herod had executed John the Baptist. These events occur some time before the event in the previous verses. (See: [[rc://*/ta/man/translate/figs-events]])
14:3 h466 rc://*/ta/man/translate/figs-metonymy ὁ γὰρ Ἡρῴδης κρατήσας τὸν Ἰωάννην, ἔδησεν αὐτὸν καὶ ἐν φυλακῇ ἀπέθετο 1 It says that Herod did these things because he ordered others to do them for him. Alternate translation: “Herod ordered his soldiers to arrest and bind John the Baptist and put him in prison” (See: [[rc://*/ta/man/translate/figs-metonymy]])
14:3 lr92 rc://*/ta/man/translate/translate-names τὴν γυναῖκα Φιλίππου 1 Philip was Herods brother. Herod had taken Philips wife to be his own wife. (See: [[rc://*/ta/man/translate/translate-names]])
14:4 d3gp rc://*/ta/man/translate/figs-events ἔλεγεν γὰρ & ὁ Ἰωάννης & ἔχειν αὐτήν 1 If needed, you can present the events of 14:3-4 in the order that they happened, as in the UST. (See: [[rc://*/ta/man/translate/figs-events]])
14:4 n1t6 rc://*/ta/man/translate/figs-quotations ἔλεγεν γὰρ αὐτῷ ὁ Ἰωάννης, οὐκ ἔξεστίν σοι ἔχειν αὐτήν. 1 This can be expressed as an indirect quote, if needed. Alternate translation: “For John had said to Herod that it was not lawful for Herod to have Herodias as his wife.” (See: [[rc://*/ta/man/translate/figs-quotations]])
14:4 r8lh ἔλεγεν γὰρ αὐτῷ ὁ Ἰωάννης 1 “For John had kept saying to Herod”
14:4 nb2j rc://*/ta/man/translate/figs-explicit οὐκ ἔξεστίν 1 Philip was still alive when Herod married Herodias. (See: [[rc://*/ta/man/translate/figs-explicit]])
14:5 hg9f ἐφοβήθη 1 “Herod feared”
14:5 w7uv αὐτὸν εἶχον 1 “they regarded John”
14:6 fvs5 rc://*/ta/man/translate/figs-explicit ἐν τῷ μέσῳ 1 You can make explicit the implicit information. Alternate translation: “in the midst of the guests attending the birthday celebration” (See: [[rc://*/ta/man/translate/figs-explicit]])
14:8 rhk5 rc://*/ta/man/translate/figs-activepassive ἡ δὲ προβιβασθεῖσα ὑπὸ τῆς μητρὸς αὐτῆς 1 This can be stated in active form. Alternate translation: “After her mother instructed her” (See: [[rc://*/ta/man/translate/figs-activepassive]])
14:8 wi8s ἡ δὲ προβιβασθεῖσα 1 “coached” or “told”
14:8 ya5z φησίν 1 “the daughter of Herodias said to Herod”
14:8 ruy4 πίνακι 1 a very large plate
14:9 s8zp rc://*/ta/man/translate/figs-activepassive καὶ ἐλυπήθη ὁ βασιλεὺς 1 This can be stated in active form. Alternate translation: “Her request made the king very upset” (See: [[rc://*/ta/man/translate/figs-activepassive]])
14:9 a1er ὁ βασιλεὺς 1 “King Herod”
14:9 j6nu rc://*/ta/man/translate/figs-activepassive ἐκέλευσεν δοθῆναι 1 This can be stated in active form. Alternate translation: “he ordered his men to do what she said” (See: [[rc://*/ta/man/translate/figs-activepassive]])
14:10 nes5 0 This concludes the account of how Herod executed John the Baptist.
14:11 nd5r rc://*/ta/man/translate/figs-activepassive ἠνέχθη ἡ κεφαλὴ αὐτοῦ ἐπὶ πίνακι, καὶ ἐδόθη τῷ κορασίῳ 1 This can be stated in active form. Alternate translation: “someone brought his head on a platter and gave it to the girl” (See: [[rc://*/ta/man/translate/figs-activepassive]])
14:11 pba6 πίνακι 1 a very large plate
14:11 lqb6 τῷ κορασίῳ 1 Use the word for a young, unmarried girl.
14:12 fl47 οἱ μαθηταὶ αὐτοῦ 1 “the disciples of John”
14:12 ni1q τὸ πτῶμα 1 “the dead body”
14:12 mq89 rc://*/ta/man/translate/figs-explicit ἐλθόντες, ἀπήγγειλαν τῷ Ἰησοῦ 1 The full meaning of this statement can be made explicit. Alternate translation: “the disciples of John went and told Jesus what had happened to John the Baptist” (See: [[rc://*/ta/man/translate/figs-explicit]])
14:13 id97 rc://*/ta/man/translate/writing-background 0 These verses give background information about the miracle that Jesus is about to perform by feeding five thousand people. (See: [[rc://*/ta/man/translate/writing-background]])
14:13 ql1f 0 These verses describe how Jesus reacted when he heard that Herod had executed John the Baptist.
14:13 ds5w δὲ 1 This word is used here to mark a break in the main story line. Here Matthew starts to tell a new part of the story.
14:13 dvq4 ἀκούσας 1 “heard what happened to John” or “heard the news about John”
14:13 ia39 rc://*/ta/man/translate/figs-explicit ἀνεχώρησεν 1 “he left” or “he went away from the crowd.” It is implied that Jesus disciples went with him. Alternate translation: “Jesus and his disciples left” (See: [[rc://*/ta/man/translate/figs-explicit]])
14:13 zlh8 ἐκεῖθεν 1 “from that place”
14:13 i7uu καὶ ἀκούσαντες, οἱ ὄχλοι 1 “When the crowds heard where Jesus had gone” or “When the crowds heard that he had left”
14:13 u6nr οἱ ὄχλοι 1 “the crowds of people” or “the huge group of people” or “the people”
14:13 ipm9 rc://*/ta/man/translate/figs-idiom πεζῇ 1 This means that the people in the crowd were walking. (See: [[rc://*/ta/man/translate/figs-idiom]])
14:14 d8n3 καὶ ἐξελθὼν, εἶδεν πολὺν ὄχλον 1 “When Jesus came ashore, he saw a large crowd”
14:15 gcu9 0 This begins the account of Jesus feeding five thousand people with only five small loaves of bread and two small fish.
14:15 xa7n προσῆλθον αὐτῷ οἱ μαθηταὶ 1 “Jesus disciples came to him”
14:16 qwk1 οὐ χρείαν ἔχουσιν 1 “The people in the crowd have no need”
14:16 r5gd rc://*/ta/man/translate/figs-you δότε αὐτοῖς ὑμεῖς 1 The word “You” is plural, referring to the disciples. (See: [[rc://*/ta/man/translate/figs-you]])
14:17 tm5t οἱ δὲ λέγουσιν αὐτῷ 1 “The disciples said to Jesus”
14:17 ih48 πέντε ἄρτους 1 A loaf of bread is a lump of dough that is shaped and baked.
14:18 szx6 φέρετέ μοι ὧδε αὐτούς 1 “Bring the loaves and fish to me”
14:19 yne5 0 This concludes the account of Jesus feeding five thousand people.
14:19 vp7r ἀνακλιθῆναι 1 “lie down.” Use the verb for the position people in your culture usually are in when they eat.
14:19 u613 rc://*/ta/man/translate/figs-idiom λαβὼν 1 “He held in his hands.” He did not steal them. (See: [[rc://*/ta/man/translate/figs-idiom]])
14:19 i34u κλάσας & τοὺς ἄρτους 1 “tore the loaves”
14:19 bf1a τοὺς ἄρτους 1 “loaves of bread” or “whole breads”
14:19 t7ei ἀναβλέψας 1 Possible meanings are (1) “While looking up” or (2) “After looking up.”
14:20 l2h8 rc://*/ta/man/translate/figs-activepassive καὶ ἐχορτάσθησαν 1 This can be translated in active form. Alternate translation: “until they were full” or “until they were no longer hungry” (See: [[rc://*/ta/man/translate/figs-activepassive]])
14:20 p73g ἦραν 1 “the disciples gathered up” or “some people gathered up”
14:20 czj4 rc://*/ta/man/translate/translate-numbers δώδεκα κοφίνους πλήρεις 1 “12 baskets full” (See: [[rc://*/ta/man/translate/translate-numbers]])
14:21 wv59 οἱ δὲ ἐσθίοντες 1 “Those who ate the bread and the fish”
14:21 als7 rc://*/ta/man/translate/translate-numbers ἄνδρες & πεντακισχίλιοι 1 “5,000 men” (See: [[rc://*/ta/man/translate/translate-numbers]])
14:22 yp8l 0 These verses give background information about the miracle that Jesus is about to perform of walking on water.
14:22 eaa8 0 The following verses describe events that happened right after Jesus fed the five thousand people.
14:22 wt1t καὶ εὐθέως ἠνάγκασεν 1 “As soon as Jesus had finished feeding all the people, he”
14:23 d27u ὀψίας δὲ γενομένης 1 “Late in the evening” or “When it became dark”
14:24 vzd1 βασανιζόμενον ὑπὸ τῶν κυμάτων 1 “and the disciples could not control the boat because of the large waves”
14:25 pmw8 τετάρτῃ δὲ φυλακῇ τῆς νυκτὸς 1 The fourth watch is between 3 a.m. and sunrise. Alternate translation: “Just before dawn”
14:25 t1vp περιπατῶν ἐπὶ τὴν θάλασσαν 1 “walking on top of the water”
14:26 q9qs ἐταράχθησαν 1 “they were very afraid”
14:26 h7df φάντασμά 1 a spirit that has left the body of a person who has died
14:28 w2pl ἀποκριθεὶς δὲ αὐτῷ, ὁ Πέτρος 1 “Peter answered Jesus”
14:30 sk3j rc://*/ta/man/translate/figs-idiom βλέπων & τὸν ἄνεμον ἰσχυρὸν 1 Here “saw the wind” means he became aware of the wind. Alternate translation: “when Peter saw that the wind was tossing the waves back and forth” or “when he realized how strong the wind was” (See: [[rc://*/ta/man/translate/figs-idiom]])
14:31 bd2v ὀλιγόπιστε, εἰς τί 1 “You who have such little faith.” Jesus addressed Peter this way because Peter became afraid. It can also be translated as an exclamation. Alternate translation: “You have so little faith! Why”
14:31 cr9i rc://*/ta/man/translate/figs-rquestion εἰς τί ἐδίστασας 1 Jesus uses a question to tell Peter than he should not have doubted. You can make explicit what Peter should not have doubted. Alternate translation: “you should not have doubted that I could keep you from sinking.” (See: [[rc://*/ta/man/translate/figs-rquestion]] and [[rc://*/ta/man/translate/figs-explicit]])
14:33 u8pu rc://*/ta/man/translate/guidelines-sonofgodprinciples Θεοῦ Υἱὸς 1 This is an important title for Jesus that describes his relationship to God. (See: [[rc://*/ta/man/translate/guidelines-sonofgodprinciples]])
14:34 r5lm 0 These verses describe what happened after Jesus walked on the water. They summarize how the people were responding to Jesus ministry.
14:34 cv3f καὶ διαπεράσαντες 1 “When Jesus and his disciples had crossed over the lake”
14:34 x9nu rc://*/ta/man/translate/translate-names Γεννησαρέτ 1 This is a small town on the northwest shore of the Sea of Galilee. (See: [[rc://*/ta/man/translate/translate-names]])
14:35 xd7c ἀπέστειλαν 1 “the men of that area sent messages”
14:36 ql3y καὶ παρεκάλουν αὐτὸν 1 “The sick people begged him”
14:36 x8jv τοῦ ἱματίου αὐτοῦ 1 “his robe” or “what he was wearing”
14:36 mw8n rc://*/ta/man/translate/figs-activepassive διεσώθησαν 1 This can be stated in active form. Alternate translation: “became well” (See: [[rc://*/ta/man/translate/figs-activepassive]])
15:intro i9a5 0 # Matthew 15 General Notes\n## Structure and formatting\n\nSome translations set each line of poetry farther to the right than the rest of the text to make it easier to read. The ULT does this with the poetry in 15:8-9, which are words from the Old Testament.\n\n## Special concepts in this chapter\n\n### The “traditions of the elders”\n\nThe “traditions of the elders” were oral laws that the Jewish religious leaders developed because they wanted to make sure that everyone obeyed the law of Moses. However, they often worked harder to obey these rules than to obey the law of Moses itself. Jesus rebuked the religious leaders for this, and they became angry as a result. (See: [[rc://*/tw/dict/bible/kt/lawofmoses]])\n\n### Jews and Gentiles\n\nThe Jews of Jesus time thought that only Jews could please God by the way they lived. Jesus healed a Canaanite Gentile womans daughter to show his followers that he would accept both Jews and Gentiles as his people.\n\n## Other possible translation difficulties in this chapter\n\n### Sheep\n\nThe Bible often speaks of people as if they were sheep because sheep need someone to take care of them. This is because they do not see well and they often go to where other animals can kill them easily. (See: [[rc://*/ta/man/translate/figs-metaphor]])
15:1 q6af rc://*/ta/man/translate/writing-newevent 0 The scene shifts to events that occurred some time after events of the previous chapter. Here Jesus responds to the criticisms of the Pharisees. (See: [[rc://*/ta/man/translate/writing-newevent]])
15:2 j1b8 rc://*/ta/man/translate/figs-rquestion διὰ τί οἱ μαθηταί σου παραβαίνουσιν τὴν παράδοσιν τῶν πρεσβυτέρων? 1 The Pharisees and scribes use this question to criticize Jesus and his disciples. Alternate translation: “Your disciples do not respect the rules that our ancestors have given us.” (See: [[rc://*/ta/man/translate/figs-rquestion]])
15:2 yn6l τὴν παράδοσιν τῶν πρεσβυτέρων 1 This is not the same as the law of Moses. This refers to later teachings and interpretations of the law given by religious leaders after Moses.
15:2 gfn6 rc://*/ta/man/translate/figs-explicit οὐ & νίπτονται τὰς χεῖρας 1 This washing is not only to clean hands. This refers to a ceremonial washing according to the tradition of the elders. Alternate translation: “they do not wash their hands properly” (See: [[rc://*/ta/man/translate/figs-explicit]])
15:3 ia1e rc://*/ta/man/translate/figs-rquestion διὰ τί καὶ ὑμεῖς παραβαίνετε τὴν ἐντολὴν τοῦ Θεοῦ διὰ τὴν παράδοσιν ὑμῶν? 1 Jesus answers with a question to criticize what the religious leaders do. Alternate translation: “And I see that you refuse to obey Gods commands just so that you can follow what your ancestors taught you!” (See: [[rc://*/ta/man/translate/figs-rquestion]])
15:4 srz6 0 In verse 4, Jesus quotes twice from Exodus to show how God expects people to treat their parents.
15:4 cz1q 0 Jesus continues to respond to the Pharisees.
15:4 qmm7 θανάτῳ τελευτάτω 1 “the people will surely execute him”
15:5 ql75 rc://*/ta/man/translate/figs-you ὑμεῖς δὲ λέγετε 1 Here “you” is plural and refers to the Pharisees and scribes. (See: [[rc://*/ta/man/translate/figs-you]])
15:6 b81c 0 Jesus continues to rebuke the Pharisees.
15:6 vr6y rc://*/ta/man/translate/figs-quotesinquotes οὐ μὴ τιμήσει τὸν πατέρα αὐτοῦ 1 The words beginning with “But you say” (verse 5) have a quotation within a quotation. If necessary you can translate them as indirect quotations. “But you teach that a person does not need to honor his parents by giving them something that may help them if the person tells his parents that he has already given it as a gift to God” (See: [[rc://*/ta/man/translate/figs-quotesinquotes]] and [[rc://*/ta/man/translate/figs-quotations]])
15:6 q3kt rc://*/ta/man/translate/figs-explicit οὐ μὴ τιμήσει τὸν πατέρα αὐτοῦ 1 It is implied that “his father” means “his parents.” This means the religious leaders taught that a person does not need to show respect to his parents by taking care of them. (See: [[rc://*/ta/man/translate/figs-explicit]])
15:6 znt9 ἠκυρώσατε τὸν λόγον τοῦ Θεοῦ 1 Here “word of God” refers specifically to his commands. Alternate translation: “you have treated the word of God as if it were invalid” or “you have ignored Gods commands”
15:6 yq5a διὰ τὴν παράδοσιν ὑμῶν 1 “because you want to follow your traditions”
15:7 t4fq 0 In verses 8 and 9, Jesus quotes the prophet Isaiah to rebuke the Pharisees and scribes.
15:7 tn3b 0 Jesus concludes his response to the Pharisees and scribes.
15:7 wv77 καλῶς ἐπροφήτευσεν περὶ ὑμῶν Ἠσαΐας 1 “Isaiah told the truth in this prophecy about you”
15:7 n4ti rc://*/ta/man/translate/figs-explicit λέγων 1 It is implied that Isaiah is speaking what God told him. Alternate translation: “when he told what God said” (See: [[rc://*/ta/man/translate/figs-explicit]])
15:8 qw69 rc://*/ta/man/translate/figs-metonymy ὁ λαὸς οὗτος τοῖς χείλεσίν με τιμᾷ 1 Here “lips” refers to speaking. Alternate translation: “These people say all the right things to me” (See: [[rc://*/ta/man/translate/figs-metonymy]])
15:8 bz91 με 1 All occurrences of this word refer to God.
15:8 wuw3 rc://*/ta/man/translate/figs-metonymy ἡ δὲ καρδία αὐτῶν πόρρω ἀπέχει ἀπ’ ἐμοῦ 1 Here “heart” refers to a persons thoughts or emotions. This phrase is a way of saying the people are not truly devoted to God. Alternate translation: “but they do not really love me” (See: [[rc://*/ta/man/translate/figs-metonymy]] and [[rc://*/ta/man/translate/figs-idiom]])
15:9 jf93 μάτην δὲ σέβονταί με 1 “Their worship means nothing to me” or “They only pretend to worship me”
15:9 vvb9 ἐντάλματα ἀνθρώπων 1 “the rules that people make up”
15:10 ti4w 0 Jesus begins to teach the crowd and his disciples about what defiles a person and why the Pharisees and scribes were wrong to criticize him.
15:11 s28y rc://*/ta/man/translate/figs-metonymy εἰσερχόμενον εἰς τὸ στόμα & ἐκπορευόμενον ἐκ τοῦ στόματος 1 Jesus is contrasting what a person eats to what a person says. Jesus means that God is concerned with what a person says rather than what a person eats. (See: [[rc://*/ta/man/translate/figs-metonymy]])
15:12 l2uj rc://*/ta/man/translate/figs-activepassive οἱ Φαρισαῖοι ἀκούσαντες τὸν λόγον ἐσκανδαλίσθησαν 1 This can be stated in active form. Alternate translation: “this statement made the Pharisees angry” or “this statement offended the Pharisees” (See: [[rc://*/ta/man/translate/figs-activepassive]])
15:13 n5ij rc://*/ta/man/translate/figs-metaphor πᾶσα φυτεία ἣν οὐκ ἐφύτευσεν ὁ Πατήρ μου ὁ οὐράνιος ἐκριζωθήσεται 1 This is a metaphor. Jesus means that the Pharisees do not actually belong to God, so God will remove them. (See: [[rc://*/ta/man/translate/figs-metaphor]])
15:13 j49e rc://*/ta/man/translate/guidelines-sonofgodprinciples ὁ Πατήρ μου ὁ οὐράνιος 1 This is an important title for God that describes the relationship between God and Jesus. (See: [[rc://*/ta/man/translate/guidelines-sonofgodprinciples]])
15:13 hs4t rc://*/ta/man/translate/figs-activepassive ἐκριζωθήσεται 1 This can be stated in active form. Alternate translation: “my Father will uproot” or “he will take out of the ground” or “he will remove” (See: [[rc://*/ta/man/translate/figs-activepassive]])
15:14 r167 ἄφετε αὐτούς 1 The word “them” refers to the Pharisees.
15:14 ai9x rc://*/ta/man/translate/figs-metaphor ὁδηγοί εἰσιν τυφλοί & ἀμφότεροι εἰς βόθυνον πεσοῦνται 1 Jesus uses another metaphor to describe the Pharisees. Jesus means that the Pharisees do not understand Gods commands or how to please him. Therefore, they cannot teach others how to please God. (See: [[rc://*/ta/man/translate/figs-metaphor]])
15:15 cje4 0 Peter asks Jesus to explain the parable that Jesus told in [Matthew 15:13-14](./13.md).
15:15 shg6 ἡμῖν 1 “to us disciples”
15:16 xr78 0 Jesus explains the parable that he told in [Matthew 15:13-14](./13.md).
15:16 al9z rc://*/ta/man/translate/figs-rquestion ἀκμὴν καὶ ὑμεῖς ἀσύνετοί ἐστε? 1 Jesus uses a question to rebuke the disciples for not understanding the parable. Also, the word “you” is emphasized. Jesus cannot believe his own disciples do not understand. Alternate translation: “I am disappointed that you, my disciples, still do not understand what I teach!” (See: [[rc://*/ta/man/translate/figs-rquestion]])
15:17 l5nt rc://*/ta/man/translate/figs-rquestion οὔπω νοεῖτε & εἰς ἀφεδρῶνα 1 Jesus uses a question to rebuke the disciples for not understanding the parable. Alternate translation: “Surely you understand … into the latrine” (See: [[rc://*/ta/man/translate/figs-rquestion]])
15:17 s833 εἰς τὴν κοιλίαν χωρεῖ 1 “goes into the stomach”
15:17 s9z6 ἀφεδρῶνα 1 This a polite term for the place where people bury body waste.
15:18 e7mu 0 Jesus continues to explain the parable that he told in [Matthew 15:13-14](./13.md).
15:18 ca1w rc://*/ta/man/translate/figs-metonymy τὰ & ἐκπορευόμενα ἐκ τοῦ στόματος 1 This refers to what a person says. Alternate translation: “words that a person says” (See: [[rc://*/ta/man/translate/figs-metonymy]])
15:18 x14k rc://*/ta/man/translate/figs-metonymy ἐκ τῆς καρδίας 1 Here “heart” refers to a persons mind or innermost being. Alternate translation: “from inside the person” or “from a persons mind” (See: [[rc://*/ta/man/translate/figs-metonymy]])
15:19 rg59 φόνοι 1 the act of killing innocent people
15:20 bme7 ἀνίπτοις χερσὶν φαγεῖν 1 This refers to eating without first ceremonially washing ones hands according to the traditions of the elders. Alternate translation: “eating without first washing ones hands”
15:21 e5gv 0 This begins an account of Jesus healing the daughter of a Canaanite woman.
15:21 t81u rc://*/ta/man/translate/figs-explicit ἐξελθὼν & ὁ Ἰησοῦς 1 It is implied that the disciples went with Jesus. Alternate translation: “Jesus and his disciples went away” (See: [[rc://*/ta/man/translate/figs-explicit]])
15:22 x1wm ἰδοὺ, γυνὴ Χαναναία & ἐξελθοῦσα 1 The word “behold” alerts us to a new person in the story. Your language may have a way of doing this. Alternate translation: “There was a Canaanite woman who came”
15:22 jt94 γυνὴ Χαναναία ἀπὸ τῶν ὁρίων ἐκείνων ἐξελθοῦσα 1 “a woman who was from that region and who belonged to the group of people called Canaanites came.” The country of Canaan no longer existed by this time. She was a part of a people group that lived near the cities of Tyre and Sidon.
15:22 f4k2 rc://*/ta/man/translate/figs-explicit ἐλέησόν με 1 This phrase implies that she is requesting that Jesus heal her daughter. Alternate translation: “Have mercy and heal my daughter” (See: [[rc://*/ta/man/translate/figs-explicit]])
15:22 xs64 Υἱὸς Δαυείδ 1 Jesus was not Davids literal son, so this may be translated as “Descendant of David.” However, “Son of David” is also a title for the Messiah, and the woman may have been calling Jesus by this title.
15:22 j6rt rc://*/ta/man/translate/figs-activepassive ἡ θυγάτηρ μου κακῶς δαιμονίζεται 1 This can be stated in active form. Alternate translation: “A demon is controlling my daughter terribly” or “A demon is tormenting my daughter severely” (See: [[rc://*/ta/man/translate/figs-activepassive]])
15:23 hd2i rc://*/ta/man/translate/figs-metonymy οὐκ ἀπεκρίθη αὐτῇ λόγον 1 Here “word” refers to what a person says. Alternate translation: “said nothing” (See: [[rc://*/ta/man/translate/figs-metonymy]])
15:24 t9ga rc://*/ta/man/translate/figs-activepassive οὐκ ἀπεστάλην 1 This can be stated in active form. Alternate translation: “God did not send me to anyone” (See: [[rc://*/ta/man/translate/figs-activepassive]])
15:24 u9t4 rc://*/ta/man/translate/figs-metaphor εἰς τὰ πρόβατα τὰ ἀπολωλότα οἴκου Ἰσραήλ 1 This is a metaphor comparing the entire nation of Israel to sheep who have gone away from their shepherd. See how you translated this in [Matthew 10:6](../10/06.md). (See: [[rc://*/ta/man/translate/figs-metaphor]])
15:25 ch7c ἡ & ἐλθοῦσα 1 “the Canaanite woman came”
15:25 u3jj rc://*/ta/man/translate/translate-symaction προσεκύνει αὐτῷ 1 This shows that the woman humbled herself before Jesus. (See: [[rc://*/ta/man/translate/translate-symaction]])
15:26 ihz4 rc://*/ta/man/translate/writing-proverbs οὐκ ἔστιν καλὸν λαβεῖν τὸν ἄρτον τῶν τέκνων καὶ βαλεῖν τοῖς κυναρίοις 1 Jesus responds to the woman with a proverb. The basic meaning is that it is not right to take what is supposed to belong to Jews and give it to non-Jews. (See: [[rc://*/ta/man/translate/writing-proverbs]])
15:26 a5bc rc://*/ta/man/translate/figs-synecdoche τὸν ἄρτον τῶν τέκνων 1 Here “bread” refers to food in general. Alternate translation: “the childrens food” (See: [[rc://*/ta/man/translate/figs-synecdoche]])
15:26 fe7n τοῖς κυναρίοις 1 The Jews considered dogs to be unclean animals. Here they are used as an image for non-Jews.
15:27 yvw1 rc://*/ta/man/translate/figs-metaphor καὶ & τὰ κυνάρια ἐσθίει ἀπὸ τῶν ψιχίων τῶν πιπτόντων ἀπὸ τῆς τραπέζης τῶν κυρίων αὐτῶν 1 The woman responds by using the same imagery as Jesus used in the proverb he just spoke. She means non-Jews should be able to have a small amount of the good things Jews are throwing away. (See: [[rc://*/ta/man/translate/figs-metaphor]])
15:27 i5tt τὰ κυνάρια 1 Use words here for dogs of any size that people keep as pets. See how you translated this in [Matthew 15:26](../15/26.md).
15:28 tea2 rc://*/ta/man/translate/figs-activepassive γενηθήτω 1 This can be stated in active form. Alternate translation: “I will do” (See: [[rc://*/ta/man/translate/figs-activepassive]])
15:28 n229 rc://*/ta/man/translate/figs-activepassive ἰάθη ἡ θυγάτηρ αὐτῆς 1 This can be stated in active form. Alternate translation: “Jesus healed her daughter” or “Her daughter became well” (See: [[rc://*/ta/man/translate/figs-activepassive]])
15:28 wwq3 rc://*/ta/man/translate/figs-idiom ἀπὸ τῆς ὥρας ἐκείνης 1 This is an idiom. Alternate translation: “at exactly the same time” or “immediately” (See: [[rc://*/ta/man/translate/figs-idiom]])
15:29 np6e rc://*/ta/man/translate/writing-background 0 These verses give background information about the miracle that Jesus is about to perform by feeding four thousand people. (See: [[rc://*/ta/man/translate/writing-background]])
15:30 c8td χωλούς, τυφλούς, κυλλούς, κωφούς 1 “those who could not walk, those who could not see, those who could not talk, and those whose arms or legs did not function”
15:30 yf7i ἔρριψαν αὐτοὺς παρὰ τοὺς πόδας αὐτοῦ 1 Apparently some of these sick or crippled people were unable to stand up, so when their friends brought them to Jesus, they placed them on the ground in front of him. Alternate translation: “The crowds placed the sick people on the ground in front of Jesus”
15:31 pi52 rc://*/ta/man/translate/figs-activepassive κυλλοὺς ὑγιεῖς 1 This can be stated in active form. Alternate translation: “the crippled become well” (See: [[rc://*/ta/man/translate/figs-activepassive]])
15:31 be52 rc://*/ta/man/translate/figs-nominaladj κυλλοὺς & χωλοὺς & τυφλοὺς 1 These nominal adjectives can be stated as adjectives. Alternate translation: “the crippled persons … the lame persons … the blind persons” (See: [[rc://*/ta/man/translate/figs-nominaladj]])
15:32 z28i 0 This begins the account of Jesus feeding four thousand people with seven loaves of bread and a few small fish.
15:32 efc2 νήστεις & μήποτε ἐκλυθῶσιν ἐν τῇ ὁδῷ 1 “without eating because they might faint on the way”
15:33 uhi3 rc://*/ta/man/translate/figs-rquestion πόθεν ἡμῖν ἐν ἐρημίᾳ, ἄρτοι τοσοῦτοι ὥστε χορτάσαι ὄχλον τοσοῦτον? 1 The disciples use a question to state that there is nowhere to get food for the crowd. Alternate translation: “There is nowhere nearby that we can get enough bread for such a large crowd.” (See: [[rc://*/ta/man/translate/figs-rquestion]])
15:34 k86l rc://*/ta/man/translate/figs-ellipsis ἑπτά, καὶ ὀλίγα ἰχθύδια 1 The understood information can be made clear. Alternate translation: “Seven loaves of bread, and a few small fish” (See: [[rc://*/ta/man/translate/figs-ellipsis]])
15:35 x13q ἀναπεσεῖν ἐπὶ τὴν 1 Use your languages word for how people customarily eat when there is no table, whether sitting or lying down.
15:36 x7kc ἔλαβεν τοὺς ἑπτὰ ἄρτους καὶ τοὺς ἰχθύας 1 “Jesus held the seven loaves and the fish in his hands”
15:36 dcr4 ἔκλασεν 1 “he tore the loaves”
15:36 a9s4 ἐδίδου 1 “gave the bread and the fish”
15:37 fc8g ἦραν 1 “the disciples gathered” or “some people gathered”
15:38 udk7 οἱ & ἐσθίοντες 1 “The people who ate”
15:38 z66m rc://*/ta/man/translate/translate-numbers τετρακισχίλιοι ἄνδρες 1 “4,000 men” (See: [[rc://*/ta/man/translate/translate-numbers]])
15:39 be43 τὰ ὅρια 1 “the area”
15:39 m8dp rc://*/ta/man/translate/translate-names Μαγαδάν 1 This region is sometimes called “Magdala.” (See: [[rc://*/ta/man/translate/translate-names]])
16:intro za2k 0 # Matthew 16 General Notes\n## Special concepts in this chapter\n\n### Yeast\n\nJesus spoke of the way people thought about God as if it were bread, and he spoke of what people taught about God as if it were the yeast that makes bread dough become larger and the baked bread taste good. He did not want his followers to listen to what the Pharisees and Sadducees taught. This was because if they did listen, they would not understand who God is and how he wants his people to live. (See: [[rc://*/ta/man/translate/figs-metaphor]])\n\n## Important figures of speech in this chapter\n\n### Metaphor\n\nJesus told his people to obey his commands. He did this by telling them to “follow” him. It is as if he were walking on a path and they were walking after him. (See: [[rc://*/ta/man/translate/figs-metaphor]])\n\n## Other possible translation difficulties in this chapter\n\n### Background information\n\nMatthew continues his account from chapter 15 in verses 1-20. The account stops in verse 21 so Matthew can tell the reader that Jesus told his disciples again and again that people would kill him after he arrived in Jerusalem. Then the account continues in verses 22-27 with what happened the first time Jesus told the disciples that he would die.\n\n### Paradox\n\nA paradox is a true statement that appears to describe something impossible. Jesus uses a paradox when he says, “Whoever wants to save his life will lose it, and whoever loses his life for my sake will find it” ([Matthew 16:25](../../mat/16/25.md)).
16:1 t249 0 This begins an encounter between Jesus and the Pharisees and Sadducees.
16:1 t7p5 πειράζοντες 1 Here “tested” is used in a negative sense. Alternate translation: “challenged him” or “wanted to trap him”
16:4 jl3e rc://*/ta/man/translate/figs-123person γενεὰ πονηρὰ καὶ μοιχαλὶς σημεῖον ἐπιζητεῖ & δοθήσεται αὐτῇ 1 Jesus is speaking to his present generation. Alternate translation: “You are an evil and adulterous generation who demands signs from me … given to you” See how you translated this in [Matthew 12:39](../12/39.md). (See: [[rc://*/ta/man/translate/figs-123person]])
16:4 fhx6 rc://*/ta/man/translate/figs-metaphor γενεὰ πονηρὰ καὶ μοιχαλὶς 1 Here “adulterous” is a metaphor for people who are not faithful to God. See how you translated this in [Matthew 12:39](../12/39.md). Alternate translation: “An unfaithful generation” or “A godless generation” (See: [[rc://*/ta/man/translate/figs-metaphor]])
16:4 d9eq rc://*/ta/man/translate/figs-activepassive σημεῖον & οὐ δοθήσεται αὐτῇ 1 Jesus would not give them a sign because, though he had already performed many miracles, they refused to believe him. This can be stated in active form. See how you translated this in [Matthew 12:39](../12/39.md). Alternate translation: “I will not give it a sign” or “God will not give you a sign” (See: [[rc://*/ta/man/translate/figs-activepassive]])
16:4 dep2 εἰ μὴ τὸ σημεῖον Ἰωνᾶ 1 “except the same sign God gave to Jonah the prophet.” See how you translated this in [Matthew 12:39](../12/39.md).
16:5 ii6j 0 Here the scene shifts to a later time. Jesus uses an opportunity to warn his disciples about the Pharisees and Sadducees.
16:5 si9k rc://*/ta/man/translate/figs-ellipsis τὸ πέραν 1 You can make clear the understood information. Alternate translation: “the other side of the lake” or “the other side of the Sea of Galilee” (See: [[rc://*/ta/man/translate/figs-ellipsis]])
16:6 hfz2 rc://*/ta/man/translate/figs-metaphor τῆς ζύμης τῶν Φαρισαίων καὶ Σαδδουκαίων 1 Here “yeast” is a metaphor that refers to evil ideas and wrong teaching. Translate as “yeast” here and do not explain its meaning in your translation. This meaning will be made clear in 16:12. (See: [[rc://*/ta/man/translate/figs-metaphor]])
16:7 huw7 διελογίζοντο ἐν ἑαυτοῖς 1 “discussed this with each other” or “thought about this”
16:8 mg8s ὀλιγόπιστοι 1 “You who have such little faith.” Jesus addresses his disciples this way because their concern about not bringing bread shows they have little faith in Jesus to provide for them. See how you translated this in [Matthew 6:30](../06/30.md).
16:8 zz4i rc://*/ta/man/translate/figs-rquestion τί διαλογίζεσθε & ἄρτους οὐκ ἔχετε? 1 Jesus uses a question to rebuke his disciples for not understanding what he just said. Alternate translation: “I am disappointed that you think it was because you forgot to bring bread that I talked about the yeast of the Pharisees and Sadducees.” (See: [[rc://*/ta/man/translate/figs-rquestion]])
16:9 k8lk 0 Jesus continues to warn his disciples about the Pharisees and Sadducees.
16:9 h5bg rc://*/ta/man/translate/figs-rquestion οὔπω νοεῖτε, οὐδὲ μνημονεύετε & ἐλάβετε? 1 Jesus uses a question to rebuke the disciples. Alternate translation: “Surely you remember … you gathered up!” (See: [[rc://*/ta/man/translate/figs-rquestion]])
16:9 ux51 rc://*/ta/man/translate/translate-numbers τῶν πεντακισχιλίων 1 “5,000” (See: [[rc://*/ta/man/translate/translate-numbers]])
16:10 b11x rc://*/ta/man/translate/translate-numbers τῶν τετρακισχιλίων 1 “4,000” (See: [[rc://*/ta/man/translate/translate-numbers]])
16:10 ejm5 rc://*/ta/man/translate/figs-rquestion οὐδὲ τοὺς ἑπτὰ ἄρτους & ἐλάβετε? 1 “Do you also not remember the seven loaves … you took up?” Jesus uses a question to rebuke his disciples. Alternate translation: “Surely you also remember the seven loaves … you took up!” (See: [[rc://*/ta/man/translate/figs-rquestion]])
16:11 f42k 0 Jesus continues to warn his disciples about the Pharisees and Sadducees.
16:11 mb2z rc://*/ta/man/translate/figs-rquestion πῶς οὐ νοεῖτε, ὅτι οὐ περὶ ἄρτων εἶπον ὑμῖν? 1 Jesus uses this question to rebuke the disciples. Alternate translation: “You should have understood that I was not really speaking about bread.” (See: [[rc://*/ta/man/translate/figs-rquestion]])
16:11 i7x6 rc://*/ta/man/translate/figs-metaphor τῆς ζύμης τῶν Φαρισαίων καὶ Σαδδουκαίων 1 Here “yeast” represents evil ideas and wrong teaching. Translate as “yeast” and do not explain the meaning in your translation. In 16:12 the disciples will understand the meaning. (See: [[rc://*/ta/man/translate/figs-metaphor]])
16:12 f73l συνῆκαν 1 These refer to the disciples.
16:13 e5cm 0 Here the scene shifts to a later time. Jesus asks his disciples if they understand who he is.
16:13 pye3 δὲ 1 This word is used here to mark a break in the main story line or to introduce a new person. Here Matthew starts to tell a new part of the story.
16:13 e1jh rc://*/ta/man/translate/figs-123person τὸν Υἱὸν τοῦ Ἀνθρώπου 1 Jesus is referring to himself. (See: [[rc://*/ta/man/translate/figs-123person]])
16:16 n5wi rc://*/ta/man/translate/guidelines-sonofgodprinciples ὁ Υἱὸς τοῦ Θεοῦ τοῦ ζῶντος 1 This is an important title for Jesus that shows his relationship to God. (See: [[rc://*/ta/man/translate/guidelines-sonofgodprinciples]])
16:16 r1h7 τοῦ Θεοῦ τοῦ ζῶντος 1 Here “living” contrasts the God of Israel to all the false gods and idols that people worshiped. Only the God of Israel is alive and has power to act.
16:17 le6a rc://*/ta/man/translate/translate-names Σίμων Βαριωνᾶ 1 “Simon son of Jonah” (See: [[rc://*/ta/man/translate/translate-names]])
16:17 dfw5 rc://*/ta/man/translate/figs-synecdoche σὰρξ καὶ αἷμα οὐκ ἀπεκάλυψέν 1 Here “flesh and blood” refers to a human being. Alternate translation: “a human did not reveal” (See: [[rc://*/ta/man/translate/figs-synecdoche]])
16:17 wix3 σοι 1 Here “this” refers to Peters statement that Jesus is the Christ and the Son of the Living God.
16:17 v5lw rc://*/ta/man/translate/figs-ellipsis ἀλλ’ ὁ Πατήρ μου, ὁ ἐν τοῖς οὐρανοῖς 1 The understood information can be made clear. Alternate translation: “but it was my Father in heaven who revealed this to you” (See: [[rc://*/ta/man/translate/figs-ellipsis]])
16:17 gi3l rc://*/ta/man/translate/guidelines-sonofgodprinciples ὁ Πατήρ μου 1 This is an important title for God that describes the relationship between God and Jesus. (See: [[rc://*/ta/man/translate/guidelines-sonofgodprinciples]])
16:18 z897 κἀγὼ & σοι λέγω 1 This adds emphasis to what Jesus says next.
16:18 th3d rc://*/ta/man/translate/figs-explicit σὺ εἶ Πέτρος 1 The name Peter means “rock.” (See: [[rc://*/ta/man/translate/figs-explicit]])
16:18 x43d rc://*/ta/man/translate/figs-metaphor ἐπὶ ταύτῃ τῇ πέτρᾳ οἰκοδομήσω μου τὴν ἐκκλησίαν 1 Here “build my church” is a metaphor for uniting the people who believe in Jesus into a community. Possible meanings are (1) “this rock” represents Peter, or (2) “this rock” represents the truth that Peter had just said in [Matthew 16:16](../16/16.md). (See: [[rc://*/ta/man/translate/figs-metaphor]])
16:18 vu9u rc://*/ta/man/translate/figs-metaphor πύλαι ᾍδου οὐ κατισχύσουσιν αὐτῆς 1 Here “Hades” is spoken of as if it were a city surrounded by walls with gates that keep dead people in and other people out. Here “Hades” represents death, and its “gates” represent its power. Possible meanings are (1) “the powers of death will not overcome my church” or (2) “my church will break down the power of death the way an army breaks into a city.” (See: [[rc://*/ta/man/translate/figs-metaphor]] and [[rc://*/ta/man/translate/figs-metonymy]])
16:19 ysk8 rc://*/ta/man/translate/figs-you δώσω σοι 1 Here “you” is singular and refers to Peter. (See: [[rc://*/ta/man/translate/figs-you]])
16:19 pp5d rc://*/ta/man/translate/figs-metaphor τὰς κλεῖδας τῆς Βασιλείας τῶν Οὐρανῶν 1 Keys are objects that are used to lock or unlock doors. Here they represent authority. (See: [[rc://*/ta/man/translate/figs-metaphor]])
16:19 kc3k rc://*/ta/man/translate/figs-metonymy τῆς Βασιλείας τῶν Οὐρανῶν 1 This refers to Gods rule as king. The phrase “kingdom of heaven” is used only in the book of Matthew. If possible, use “heaven” in your translation. (See: [[rc://*/ta/man/translate/figs-metonymy]])
16:19 ef9c rc://*/ta/man/translate/figs-metaphor ὃ ἐὰν δήσῃς ἐπὶ τῆς γῆς, ἔσται δεδεμένον ἐν τοῖς οὐρανοῖς; καὶ ὃ ἐὰν λύσῃς ἐπὶ τῆς γῆς, ἔσται λελυμένον ἐν τοῖς οὐρανοῖς 1 Here “bind” is a metaphor meaning to forbid something, and “loose” is a metaphor meaning to allow something. Also, “in heaven” is a metonym that represents God himself. Alternate translation: “God in heaven will approve whatever you forbid or allow on earth” (See: [[rc://*/ta/man/translate/figs-metaphor]] and [[rc://*/ta/man/translate/figs-metonymy]])
16:21 wl33 0 Jesus tells his disciples for the first time that he will die soon.
16:21 xql7 rc://*/ta/man/translate/figs-metonymy πολλὰ παθεῖν ἀπὸ τῶν πρεσβυτέρων, καὶ ἀρχιερέων, καὶ γραμματέων 1 Here “hand” refers to power. Alternate translation: “where the elders, chief priests, and scribes will cause him to suffer” (See: [[rc://*/ta/man/translate/figs-metonymy]])
16:21 es1l rc://*/ta/man/translate/figs-activepassive γραμματέων, καὶ ἀποκτανθῆναι καὶ τῇ τρίτῃ ἡμέρᾳ ἐγερθῆναι 1 Here to raise back to life is an idiom for causing someone who has died to become alive again. This can be stated in active form. The elders and chief priests would accuse Jesus so that others would kill him. Alternate translation: “scribes. People will then kill him , and on the third day God will make him become alive again” (See: [[rc://*/ta/man/translate/figs-activepassive]])
16:21 jjx5 rc://*/ta/man/translate/translate-ordinal τῇ τρίτῃ ἡμέρᾳ 1 “Third” is the ordinal form of “three.” (See: [[rc://*/ta/man/translate/translate-ordinal]])
16:22 jie2 rc://*/ta/man/translate/writing-background καὶ προσλαβόμενος αὐτὸν, ὁ Πέτρος 1 Jesus tells them for the first time that he will die soon (verse 21). He will tell them the same thing many times after this first time. It is after this first time that Peter takes Jesus aside. (See: [[rc://*/ta/man/translate/writing-background]])
16:22 q31h προσλαβόμενος αὐτὸν, ὁ Πέτρος 1 “Peter spoke to Jesus when no one else could hear them”
16:22 guz8 rc://*/ta/man/translate/figs-idiom ἵλεώς σοι 1 This is an idiom that means “may this never happen.” Alternate translation: “No” or “Never” or “May God forbid this” (See: [[rc://*/ta/man/translate/figs-idiom]])
16:23 f28i rc://*/ta/man/translate/figs-metaphor ὕπαγε ὀπίσω μου, Σατανᾶ! σκάνδαλον εἶ ἐμοῦ 1 Jesus means that Peter is acting like Satan because Peter is trying to prevent Jesus from accomplishing what God sent him to do. Alternate translation: “Get behind me, because you are acting like Satan! You are a stumbling block to me” or “Get behind me, Satan! I call you Satan because you are a stumbling block to me” (See: [[rc://*/ta/man/translate/figs-metaphor]])
16:23 ax7x ὕπαγε ὀπίσω μου 1 “Get away from me”
16:24 ck1a rc://*/ta/man/translate/figs-metaphor ὀπίσω μου ἐλθεῖν 1 Following Jesus here represents being one of his disciples. Alternate translation: “be my disciple” or “be one of my disciples” (See: [[rc://*/ta/man/translate/figs-metaphor]])
16:24 pg9h ἀπαρνησάσθω ἑαυτὸν 1 “must not give in to his own desires” or “must forsake his own desires”
16:24 h7ug rc://*/ta/man/translate/figs-metonymy ἀράτω τὸν σταυρὸν αὐτοῦ, καὶ ἀκολουθείτω μοι 1 “carry his cross, and follow me.” The cross represents suffering and death. Taking up the cross represents being willing to suffer and die. Alternate translation: “and obey me even to the point of suffering and dying” or “and he must obey me even to the point of suffering and dying” (See: [[rc://*/ta/man/translate/figs-metonymy]] and [[rc://*/ta/man/translate/figs-metaphor]])
16:24 x13v rc://*/ta/man/translate/figs-metaphor καὶ ἀκολουθείτω μοι 1 Following Jesus here represents obeying him. Alternate translation: “and obey me” (See: [[rc://*/ta/man/translate/figs-metaphor]])
16:25 pk8h ὃς γὰρ ἐὰν θέλῃ 1 “For anyone who wants”
16:25 y9kc rc://*/ta/man/translate/figs-metaphor ἀπολέσει αὐτήν 1 This does not mean the person must necessarily die. It is a metaphor that means the person will consider obeying Jesus as being more important than his own life. (See: [[rc://*/ta/man/translate/figs-metaphor]])
16:25 ie7t ἕνεκεν ἐμοῦ 1 “because he trusts me” or “on my account” or “because of me”
16:25 xz98 rc://*/ta/man/translate/figs-metaphor εὑρήσει αὐτήν 1 This metaphor means the person will experience spiritual life with God. Alternate translation: “will find true life” (See: [[rc://*/ta/man/translate/figs-metaphor]])
16:26 eqe8 rc://*/ta/man/translate/figs-rquestion τί γὰρ ὠφεληθήσεται ἄνθρωπος & τῆς ψυχῆς αὐτοῦ? 1 Jesus uses a question to teach his disciples. Alternate translation: “It does not profit a person … his life.” (See: [[rc://*/ta/man/translate/figs-rquestion]])
16:26 q7x1 rc://*/ta/man/translate/figs-hyperbole ἐὰν τὸν κόσμον ὅλον κερδήσῃ 1 The words “the whole world” are an exaggeration for great riches. Alternate translation: “if he gains everything he desires” (See: [[rc://*/ta/man/translate/figs-hyperbole]])
16:26 b34q τὴν δὲ ψυχὴν αὐτοῦ ζημιωθῇ 1 “but he loses his life”
16:26 eck5 rc://*/ta/man/translate/figs-rquestion ἢ τί δώσει ἄνθρωπος ἀντάλλαγμα τῆς ψυχῆς αὐτοῦ? 1 Jesus uses a question to teach his disciples. Alternate translation: “There is nothing that a person can give to regain his life.” (See: [[rc://*/ta/man/translate/figs-rquestion]])
16:27 iyu1 rc://*/ta/man/translate/figs-123person ὁ Υἱὸς τοῦ Ἀνθρώπου & τοῦ Πατρὸς αὐτοῦ & τότε ἀποδώσει 1 Here Jesus refers to himself in the third person. Alternate translation: “I, the Son of man … my Father … Then I” (See: [[rc://*/ta/man/translate/figs-123person]])
16:27 ie16 μέλλει & ἔρχεσθαι ἐν τῇ δόξῃ τοῦ Πατρὸς αὐτοῦ 1 “will come, having the same glory as his Father”
16:27 k4q4 rc://*/ta/man/translate/figs-123person μετὰ τῶν ἀγγέλων αὐτοῦ 1 “and the angels will be with him.” If you translate the first part of the sentence with Jesus speaking in the first person, you can translate this as “and my Fathers angels will be with me.” (See: [[rc://*/ta/man/translate/figs-123person]])
16:27 vk5y rc://*/ta/man/translate/guidelines-sonofgodprinciples τοῦ Πατρὸς αὐτοῦ 1 This is an important title for God that describes the relationship between God and the Son of Man, Jesus. (See: [[rc://*/ta/man/translate/guidelines-sonofgodprinciples]])
16:27 i7rs κατὰ τὴν πρᾶξιν αὐτοῦ 1 “according to what each person has done”
16:28 ytr3 ἀμὴν, λέγω ὑμῖν 1 “I tell you the truth.” This phrase adds emphasis to what Jesus says next.
16:28 k2d1 rc://*/ta/man/translate/figs-you ὑμῖν 1 All occurrences of this word are plural and refer to the disciples. (See: [[rc://*/ta/man/translate/figs-you]])
16:28 wq13 rc://*/ta/man/translate/figs-idiom οὐ μὴ γεύσωνται θανάτου 1 Here “taste” means to experience. Alternate translation: “will not experience death” or” will not die” (See: [[rc://*/ta/man/translate/figs-idiom]])
16:28 b2pb rc://*/ta/man/translate/figs-metonymy ἕως ἂν ἴδωσιν τὸν Υἱὸν τοῦ Ἀνθρώπου ἐρχόμενον ἐν τῇ βασιλείᾳ αὐτοῦ 1 Here “his kingdom” represents him being King. Alternate translation: “until they see the Son of Man coming as King” or “until they see the evidence that the Son of Man is King” (See: [[rc://*/ta/man/translate/figs-metonymy]])
17:intro yb4k 0 # Matthew 17 General Notes\n## Special concepts in this chapter\n\n### Elijah\n\nThe Old Testament prophet Malachi lived many years before Jesus was born. Malachi had said that before the Messiah came a prophet named Elijah would return. Jesus explained that Malachi had been talking about John the Baptist. Jesus said this because John the Baptist had done what Malachi had said that Elijah would do. (See: [[rc://*/tw/dict/bible/kt/prophet]] and [[rc://*/tw/dict/bible/kt/christ]])\n\n### “transfigured”\n\nScripture often speaks of Gods glory as a great, brilliant light. When people see this light, they are afraid. Matthew says in this chapter that Jesus body shone with this glorious light so that his followers could see that Jesus truly was Gods Son. At the same time, God told them that Jesus was his Son. (See: [[rc://*/tw/dict/bible/kt/glory]] and [[rc://*/tw/dict/bible/kt/fear]])
17:1 u6dw 0 This begins the account of Jesus transfiguration.
17:1 nva7 τὸν Πέτρον, καὶ Ἰάκωβον, καὶ Ἰωάννην, τὸν ἀδελφὸν αὐτοῦ 1 “Peter, James, and Jamess brother John”
17:2 xx8e μετεμορφώθη ἔμπροσθεν αὐτῶν 1 When they looked at him, his appearance was different from what it had been.
17:2 kq4l rc://*/ta/man/translate/figs-activepassive μετεμορφώθη 1 This can be stated in active form. Alternate translation: “his appearance had changed” or “he appeared very different” (See: [[rc://*/ta/man/translate/figs-activepassive]])
17:2 uxg3 ἔμπροσθεν αὐτῶν 1 “in front of them” or “so they could clearly him”
17:2 i1mp rc://*/ta/man/translate/figs-simile ἔλαμψεν τὸ πρόσωπον αὐτοῦ ὡς ὁ ἥλιος, τὰ δὲ ἱμάτια αὐτοῦ ἐγένετο λευκὰ ὡς τὸ φῶς 1 These are similes that emphasize how bright Jesus appearance became. (See: [[rc://*/ta/man/translate/figs-simile]])
17:2 te1s τὰ & ἱμάτια αὐτοῦ 1 “what he was wearing”
17:3 axr5 ἰδοὺ 1 This word alerts us to pay attention to the surprising information that follows.
17:3 n63y αὐτοῖς 1 This refers to Peter, James, and John.
17:3 sde3 μετ’ αὐτοῦ 1 “with Jesus”
17:4 r41c ἀποκριθεὶς & εἶπεν 1 “said.” Peter is not responding to a question.
17:4 d231 rc://*/ta/man/translate/figs-exclusive καλόν ἐστιν ἡμᾶς ὧδε εἶναι 1 It is not clear whether “us” refers only to Peter, James, and John, or if it refers to everyone there, including Jesus, Elijah, and Moses. If you can translate so that both options are possible, do so. (See: [[rc://*/ta/man/translate/figs-exclusive]] and [[rc://*/ta/man/translate/figs-exclusive]])
17:5 cek4 ἰδοὺ 1 This alerts the reader to pay attention to the surprising information that follows.
17:5 an8j ἐπεσκίασεν αὐτούς 1 “came over them”
17:5 kc8t rc://*/ta/man/translate/figs-metonymy φωνὴ ἐκ τῆς νεφέλης 1 Here “voice” refers to God speaking. Alternate translation: “God spoke to them from out of the cloud” (See: [[rc://*/ta/man/translate/figs-metonymy]])
17:6 wd76 καὶ ἀκούσαντες, οἱ μαθηταὶ 1 “the disciples heard God speak”
17:6 a87e rc://*/ta/man/translate/figs-idiom ἔπεσαν ἐπὶ πρόσωπον αὐτῶν 1 Here “fell on their face” here is an idiom. Alternate translation: “they fell forward, with their faces to the ground” (See: [[rc://*/ta/man/translate/figs-idiom]])
17:9 w4w9 0 The following events happen immediately after the three disciples witness Jesus transfiguration.
17:9 jz51 καὶ καταβαινόντων αὐτῶν 1 “As Jesus and the disciples”
17:9 y9rq rc://*/ta/man/translate/figs-123person ὁ Υἱὸς τοῦ Ἀνθρώπου 1 Jesus is speaking about himself. (See: [[rc://*/ta/man/translate/figs-123person]])
17:10 nwt5 rc://*/ta/man/translate/figs-explicit τί οὖν οἱ γραμματεῖς λέγουσιν ὅτι Ἠλείαν δεῖ ἐλθεῖν πρῶτον? 1 The disciples are referring to the belief that Elijah will come back to life and return to the people of Israel before the Messiah comes. (See: [[rc://*/ta/man/translate/figs-explicit]])
17:11 xbs2 ἀποκαταστήσει πάντα 1 “put things in order” or “get the people ready to receive the Messiah”
17:12 whp9 λέγω δὲ ὑμῖν 1 This adds emphasis to what Jesus says next.
17:12 a4h7 ἐποίησαν & αὐτῶν 1 All occurrences of these words may mean either (1) the Jewish leaders or (2) all the Jewish people.
17:12 tyw4 rc://*/ta/man/translate/figs-metonymy καὶ ὁ Υἱὸς τοῦ Ἀνθρώπου μέλλει πάσχειν ὑπ’ αὐτῶν 1 Here “hands” refers to power. Alternate translation: “they will make the Son of Man suffer” (See: [[rc://*/ta/man/translate/figs-metonymy]])
17:12 i74i rc://*/ta/man/translate/figs-123person ὁ Υἱὸς τοῦ Ἀνθρώπου 1 Jesus is referring to himself. (See: [[rc://*/ta/man/translate/figs-123person]])
17:14 t687 0 This begins an account of Jesus healing a boy who had an evil spirit. These events happen immediately after Jesus and his disciples descend from the mountain.
17:15 ufb4 rc://*/ta/man/translate/figs-explicit ἐλέησόν μου τὸν υἱόν 1 It is implied that the man wants Jesus to heal his son. Alternate translation: “have mercy on my son and heal him” (See: [[rc://*/ta/man/translate/figs-explicit]])
17:15 hs55 σεληνιάζεται 1 This means that he sometimes had seizures. He would become unconscious and move uncontrollably. Alternate translation: “has seizures”
17:17 lyu5 γενεὰ ἄπιστος καὶ διεστραμμένη, ἕως πότε 1 “This generation does not believe in God and does not know what is right or wrong. How”
17:17 su3r rc://*/ta/man/translate/figs-rquestion ἕως πότε μεθ’ ὑμῶν ἔσομαι? ἕως πότε ἀνέξομαι ὑμῶν? 1 These questions show Jesus is unhappy with the people. Alternate translation: “I am tired of being with you! I am tired of your unbelief and corruption!” (See: [[rc://*/ta/man/translate/figs-rquestion]])
17:18 i8kd rc://*/ta/man/translate/figs-activepassive ἐθεραπεύθη ὁ παῖς 1 This can be stated in active form. Alternate translation: “the boy became well” (See: [[rc://*/ta/man/translate/figs-activepassive]])
17:18 h2gc rc://*/ta/man/translate/figs-idiom ἀπὸ τῆς ὥρας ἐκείνης 1 This is an idiom. Alternate translation: “immediately” or “at that moment” (See: [[rc://*/ta/man/translate/figs-idiom]])
17:19 pz9f rc://*/ta/man/translate/figs-exclusive ἡμεῖς 1 Here “we” refers to the speakers but not the hearers and so is exclusive. (See: [[rc://*/ta/man/translate/figs-exclusive]])
17:19 r9j7 διὰ τί ἡμεῖς οὐκ ἠδυνήθημεν ἐκβαλεῖν αὐτό? 1 “Why could we not make the demon come out of the boy?”
17:20 u5ll ἀμὴν, γὰρ λέγω ὑμῖν 1 “I tell you the truth.” This adds emphasis to what Jesus says next.
17:20 uy78 rc://*/ta/man/translate/figs-simile ἐὰν ἔχητε πίστιν ὡς κόκκον σινάπεως 1 Jesus compares the size of a mustard seed to the amount of faith needed to do a miracle. A mustard seed is very small, but it grows into a large plant. Jesus means it only takes a small amount of faith to do a great miracle. (See: [[rc://*/ta/man/translate/figs-simile]])
17:20 x48i rc://*/ta/man/translate/figs-litotes οὐδὲν ἀδυνατήσει ὑμῖν 1 This can be stated in a positive form. Alternate translation: “you will be able to do anything” (See: [[rc://*/ta/man/translate/figs-litotes]])
17:22 r2cu 0 Here the scene shifts momentarily, and Jesus foretells his death and resurrection a second time.
17:22 n2xs συστρεφομένων & αὐτῶν 1 “Jesus and his disciples stayed”
17:22 ff8x rc://*/ta/man/translate/figs-activepassive μέλλει ὁ Υἱὸς τοῦ Ἀνθρώπου παραδίδοσθαι 1 This can be stated in active form. Alternate translation: “Someone will deliver the Son of Man” (See: [[rc://*/ta/man/translate/figs-activepassive]])
17:22 mmk2 rc://*/ta/man/translate/figs-metonymy παραδίδοσθαι εἰς χεῖρας ἀνθρώπων 1 The word “hands” here is a metonym for the power that people use hands to exercise. Alternate translation: “taken and put under the power of people” or “taken and given to people who will control him” (See: [[rc://*/ta/man/translate/figs-metonymy]])
17:22 i5rb rc://*/ta/man/translate/figs-123person ὁ Υἱὸς τοῦ Ἀνθρώπου 1 Jesus is referring to himself in the third person. (See: [[rc://*/ta/man/translate/figs-123person]])
17:22 jne3 rc://*/ta/man/translate/figs-metonymy εἰς χεῖρας ἀνθρώπων 1 Here “hands” refers to power or control. Alternate translation: “to the control of the people” or “to the people” (See: [[rc://*/ta/man/translate/figs-metonymy]])
17:23 hl6j rc://*/ta/man/translate/figs-123person αὐτόν & ἐγερθήσεται 1 Jesus is referring to himself in the third person. (See: [[rc://*/ta/man/translate/figs-123person]])
17:23 b6g3 rc://*/ta/man/translate/translate-ordinal τῇ τρίτῃ ἡμέρᾳ 1 “Third” is the ordinal form of “three.” (See: [[rc://*/ta/man/translate/translate-ordinal]])
17:23 fni4 rc://*/ta/man/translate/figs-activepassive ἐγερθήσεται 1 Here to raise up is an idiom for causing someone who has died to become alive again. This can be stated in active form. Alternate translation: “God will raise him up” or “God will cause him to become alive again” (See: [[rc://*/ta/man/translate/figs-activepassive]] and [[rc://*/ta/man/translate/figs-idiom]])
17:24 jli6 0 Here the scene shifts again to a later time when Jesus teaches Peter about paying the temple tax.
17:24 t8qt ἐλθόντων & αὐτῶν 1 “When Jesus and his disciples”
17:24 b953 rc://*/ta/man/translate/translate-bmoney τὰ δίδραχμα 1 This was a tax that Jewish men paid to support the temple in Jerusalem. Alternate translation: “the temple tax” (See: [[rc://*/ta/man/translate/translate-bmoney]] and [[rc://*/ta/man/translate/figs-explicit]])
17:25 y26n τὴν οἰκίαν 1 “the place where Jesus was staying”
17:25 yp5h rc://*/ta/man/translate/figs-rquestion τί σοι δοκεῖ, Σίμων? οἱ βασιλεῖς τῆς γῆς, ἀπὸ τίνων λαμβάνουσιν τέλη ἢ κῆνσον? ἀπὸ τῶν υἱῶν αὐτῶν ἢ ἀπὸ τῶν ἀλλοτρίων? 1 Jesus asks these questions to teach Simon, not to gain information for himself. Alternate translation: “Listen, Simon. We know that when kings collect taxes, they collect it from people who are not members of their own family” (See: [[rc://*/ta/man/translate/figs-rquestion]])
17:26 fb1c 0 This is the end of the part of the story that began in [Matthew 13:54](../13/54.md), where Matthew tells of continued opposition to Jesus ministry and teaching about the kingdom of heaven.
17:26 j3g4 0 Jesus continues to teach Peter about paying the temple tax.
17:26 w75w rc://*/ta/man/translate/figs-quotations εἰπόντος δέ, ἀπὸ τῶν ἀλλοτρίων, ἔφη αὐτῷ ὁ Ἰησοῦς 1 If you translated Jesus questions as statements in [Matthew 17:25](../17/25.md), you may need to give an alternate response here. You could also state it as an indirect quotation. Alternate translation: “When Peter said, Yes, that is true. Kings collect taxes from foreigners, Jesus said” or “After Peter agreed with Jesus, Jesus said” (See: [[rc://*/ta/man/translate/figs-quotations]])
17:26 uh6y ἀπὸ τῶν ἀλλοτρίων 1 In modern times, leaders usually tax their own citizens. But, in ancient times, the leaders often taxed the people they had conquered rather than their own citizens.
17:26 u6xx οἱ υἱοί 1 people over whom a ruler or king rules
17:27 mwa6 ἵνα δὲ μὴ σκανδαλίσωμεν αὐτούς, πορευθεὶς 1 “But we do not want to make the tax collectors angry. So, go.”
17:27 uhk5 rc://*/ta/man/translate/figs-explicit βάλε ἄγκιστρον 1 Fishermen tied hooks to the end of a line, then threw it in the water to catch fish. (See: [[rc://*/ta/man/translate/figs-explicit]])
17:27 ebj4 τὸ στόμα αὐτοῦ 1 “the fishs mouth”
17:27 t9t8 rc://*/ta/man/translate/translate-bmoney στατῆρα 1 a silver coin worth four days wages (See: [[rc://*/ta/man/translate/translate-bmoney]])
17:27 ej3l ἐκεῖνον λαβὼν 1 “Take the shekel”
17:27 km3v rc://*/ta/man/translate/figs-you ἀντὶ ἐμοῦ καὶ σοῦ 1 Here “you” is singular and refers to Peter. Each man had to pay a half shekel tax. So one shekel would be enough for Jesus and Peter to pay their taxes. (See: [[rc://*/ta/man/translate/figs-you]])
18:intro m4y6 0 # Matthew 18 General Notes\n## Special concepts in this chapter\n\n### What should Jesus followers do when other followers sin against them?\n\nJesus taught that his followers must treat each other well and not be angry with each other. They should forgive anyone who is sorry for his sin, even if he has committed the same sin before. If he is not sorry for his sin, Jesus followers should speak with him alone or in a small group. If he is still not sorry after that, then Jesus followers can treat him as guilty. (See: [[rc://*/tw/dict/bible/kt/repent]] and [[rc://*/tw/dict/bible/kt/sin]])
18:1 f7zv 0 This is the beginning of a new part of the story that runs through [Matthew 18:35](../18/35.md), where Jesus teaches about life in the kingdom of heaven. Here, Jesus uses a little child to teach the disciples.
18:1 iri5 τίς ἄρα μείζων ἐστὶν 1 “Who is the most important” or “Who among us will be the most important”
18:1 pp31 rc://*/ta/man/translate/figs-metonymy ἐν τῇ Βασιλεία τῶν Οὐρανῶν 1 The phrase “kingdom of heaven” refers to Gods rule as king. This phrase is used only in the book of Matthew. If possible, keep “heaven” in your translation. Alternate translation: “in Gods kingdom” or “when our God in heaven establishes his rule on earth” (See: [[rc://*/ta/man/translate/figs-metonymy]])
18:3 qb44 ἀμὴν, λέγω ὑμῖν 1 “I tell you the truth.” This adds emphasis to what Jesus says next.
18:3 fs1e rc://*/ta/man/translate/figs-doublenegatives ἐὰν μὴ στραφῆτε & τὰ παιδία, οὐ μὴ εἰσέλθητε 1 This can be stated in positive form. Alternate translation: “you must change … children in order to enter” (See: [[rc://*/ta/man/translate/figs-doublenegatives]])
18:3 ewj5 rc://*/ta/man/translate/figs-simile γένησθε ὡς τὰ παιδία 1 Jesus uses a simile to teach the disciples that they should not be concerned with who is most important. They should be concerned with becoming humble like a child. (See: [[rc://*/ta/man/translate/figs-simile]])
18:3 ch9p rc://*/ta/man/translate/figs-metonymy εἰσέλθητε εἰς τὴν Βασιλείαν τῶν Οὐρανῶν 1 The phrase “kingdom of heaven” refers to Gods rule as king. This phrase is used only in the book of Matthew. If possible, keep “heaven” in your translation. Alternate translation: “enter Gods kingdom” or “belong to our God in heaven when he establishes his rule on earth” (See: [[rc://*/ta/man/translate/figs-metonymy]])
18:4 ta7z rc://*/ta/man/translate/figs-simile 0 Jesus continues teaching the disciples that they need to be humble like a child if they want to be important in Gods kingdom. (See: [[rc://*/ta/man/translate/figs-simile]])
18:4 f9t5 ἐστιν ὁ μείζων 1 “is the most important” or “will be the most important”
18:4 gf8l rc://*/ta/man/translate/figs-metonymy ἐν τῇ Βασιλεία τῶν Οὐρανῶν 1 The phrase “kingdom of heaven” refers to Gods rule as king. This phrase is used only in the book of Matthew. If possible, keep “heaven” in your translation. Alternate translation: “in Gods kingdom” or “when our God in heaven establishes his rule on earth” (See: [[rc://*/ta/man/translate/figs-metonymy]])
18:5 dz1i rc://*/ta/man/translate/figs-metonymy ἐπὶ τῷ ὀνόματί μου 1 Here “my name” refers to the entire person. Alternate translation: “because of me” or “because he is my disciple” (See: [[rc://*/ta/man/translate/figs-metonymy]])
18:5 ik3r καὶ ὃς ἐὰν & ἐπὶ τῷ ὀνόματί μου, ἐμὲ δέχεται 1 Jesus means that it is the same as welcoming him. Alternate translation: “When someone … in my name, it is like he is welcoming me” or “When someone … in my name, it is as if he were welcoming me”
18:6 ghp3 rc://*/ta/man/translate/figs-activepassive κρεμασθῇ μύλος ὀνικὸς περὶ τὸν τράχηλον αὐτοῦ, καὶ καταποντισθῇ ἐν τῷ πελάγει τῆς θαλάσσης 1 This can be stated in active form. Alternate translation: “if someone put a great millstone around his neck and threw him into the deep sea” (See: [[rc://*/ta/man/translate/figs-activepassive]])
18:6 w3uz μύλος 1 This is a large, heavy, circular stone used for grinding wheat grain into flour. Alternate translation: “a heavy stone”
18:7 cl5i 0 Jesus continues to use a little child to teach the disciples and warns against the terrible consequences of causing children to sin.
18:7 ees6 rc://*/ta/man/translate/figs-metonymy τῷ κόσμῳ 1 Here “world” refers to people. Alternate translation: “to the people of the world” (See: [[rc://*/ta/man/translate/figs-metonymy]])
18:7 y7vh rc://*/ta/man/translate/figs-metaphor τῶν σκανδάλων & ἐλθεῖν τὰ σκάνδαλα & τῷ ἀνθρώπῳ δι’ οὗ τὸ σκάνδαλον ἔρχεται 1 Here “stumbling” is a metaphor for sin. Alternate translation: “things that cause people to sin … things come that cause people to sin … any person who causes others to sin” (See: [[rc://*/ta/man/translate/figs-metaphor]])
18:8 vad7 rc://*/ta/man/translate/figs-hyperbole εἰ δὲ ἡ χείρ σου ἢ ὁ πούς σου σκανδαλίζει σε, ἔκκοψον αὐτὸν καὶ βάλε ἀπὸ σοῦ 1 Jesus exaggerates here to emphasize that people must do anything necessary to remove from their lives what causes them to sin. (See: [[rc://*/ta/man/translate/figs-hyperbole]])
18:8 gqi3 rc://*/ta/man/translate/figs-you σου & σε 1 All occurrences of these words are singular. Jesus is speaking to all people in general. It may be more natural for your language to translate with a plural “you.” (See: [[rc://*/ta/man/translate/figs-you]])
18:8 pc4d εἰς τὴν ζωὴν 1 “into eternal life”
18:8 lhk9 rc://*/ta/man/translate/figs-activepassive ἢ δύο χεῖρας ἢ δύο πόδας ἔχοντα, βληθῆναι εἰς τὸ πῦρ τὸ αἰώνιον 1 This can be stated in active form. Alternate translation: “than to have both hands and feet when God throws you into the eternal fire” (See: [[rc://*/ta/man/translate/figs-activepassive]])
18:9 xad4 rc://*/ta/man/translate/figs-hyperbole καὶ εἰ ὁ ὀφθαλμός σου σκανδαλίζει σε, ἔξελε αὐτὸν καὶ βάλε ἀπὸ σοῦ 1 The command to destroy the eye, perhaps the most important part of the body, is probably an exaggeration for his hearers to do anything necessary to remove from their lives anything that causes them to sin. (See: [[rc://*/ta/man/translate/figs-hyperbole]])
18:9 q7tw rc://*/ta/man/translate/figs-metaphor σκανδαλίζει σε 1 Here “stumble” is a metaphor for sin. Alternate translation: “causes you to sin” (See: [[rc://*/ta/man/translate/figs-metaphor]])
18:9 eii2 rc://*/ta/man/translate/figs-you σου & σοῦ 1 All occurrences of these words are singular. Jesus is speaking to all people in general. It may be more natural for your language to translate with a plural “you.” (See: [[rc://*/ta/man/translate/figs-you]])
18:9 m8as εἰς τὴν ζωὴν 1 “into eternal life”
18:9 r1ie rc://*/ta/man/translate/figs-activepassive ἢ δύο ὀφθαλμοὺς ἔχοντα βληθῆναι εἰς τὴν Γέενναν τοῦ πυρός 1 This can be stated in active form. Alternate translation: “than to have both eyes when God throws you into the eternal fire” (See: [[rc://*/ta/man/translate/figs-activepassive]])
18:10 qnc6 ὁρᾶτε 1 “Be careful that” or “Be sure that”
18:10 e9uf μὴ καταφρονήσητε ἑνὸς τῶν μικρῶν τούτων 1 “you do not think of these little ones as being unimportant.” This can be stated in positive form. Alternate translation: “you show respect to these little ones”
18:10 j4l5 λέγω γὰρ ὑμῖν 1 This add emphasis to what Jesus says next.
18:10 xdl9 rc://*/ta/man/translate/figs-explicit ὅτι οἱ ἄγγελοι αὐτῶν ἐν οὐρανοῖς, διὰ παντὸς βλέπουσι τὸ πρόσωπον τοῦ Πατρός μου, τοῦ ἐν οὐρανοῖς 1 Jewish teachers taught that only the most important angels could be in Gods presence. Jesus means that the most important angels speak to God about these little ones. (See: [[rc://*/ta/man/translate/figs-explicit]])
18:10 y6n9 rc://*/ta/man/translate/figs-idiom διὰ παντὸς βλέπουσι τὸ πρόσωπον τοῦ Πατρός μου 1 This is an idiom that means they are in Gods presence. Alternate translation: “are always close to my Father” or “are always in the presence of my Father” (See: [[rc://*/ta/man/translate/figs-idiom]])
18:10 iq8j rc://*/ta/man/translate/guidelines-sonofgodprinciples τοῦ Πατρός μου 1 This is an important title for God that describes the relationship between God and Jesus. (See: [[rc://*/ta/man/translate/guidelines-sonofgodprinciples]])
18:12 xhq2 0 Jesus continues to use a little child to teach the disciples and tells a parable to explain Gods care for people.
18:12 idl5 rc://*/ta/man/translate/figs-rquestion τί ὑμῖν δοκεῖ? 1 Jesus uses this question to get peoples attention. Alternate translation: “Think about how people act.” or “Think about this.” (See: [[rc://*/ta/man/translate/figs-rquestion]])
18:12 dm8u rc://*/ta/man/translate/figs-you ὑμῖν 1 This word is plural. (See: [[rc://*/ta/man/translate/figs-you]])
18:12 cv92 rc://*/ta/man/translate/translate-numbers ἑκατὸν & ἐνενήκοντα ἐννέα 1 “100 … 99” (See: [[rc://*/ta/man/translate/translate-numbers]])
18:12 t5h4 rc://*/ta/man/translate/figs-rquestion οὐχὶ ἀφείς & τὸ πλανώμενον? 1 Jesus uses a question to teach his disciples. Alternate translation: “he will always leave … astray.” (See: [[rc://*/ta/man/translate/figs-rquestion]])
18:13 j5d8 rc://*/ta/man/translate/figs-parables καὶ ἐὰν γένηται εὑρεῖν αὐτό & τοῖς μὴ πεπλανημένοις 1 This is the end of the parable that begins with the words “If anyone” in verse 12. (See: [[rc://*/ta/man/translate/figs-parables]])
18:13 at4s rc://*/ta/man/translate/figs-you αὐτό, ἀμὴν, λέγω ὑμῖν 1 “I tell you the truth.” This adds emphasis to what Jesus says next. The word “you” is plural. (See: [[rc://*/ta/man/translate/figs-you]])
18:14 kcy2 οὐκ ἔστιν θέλημα ἔμπροσθεν τοῦ Πατρὸς ὑμῶν, τοῦ ἐν οὐρανοῖς, ἵνα ἀπόληται ἓν τῶν μικρῶν τούτων 1 “your Father in heaven does not want any of these little ones to die” or “your Father in heaven does not want even one of these little ones to die”
18:14 usa4 rc://*/ta/man/translate/figs-you ὑμῶν 1 This word is plural. (See: [[rc://*/ta/man/translate/figs-you]])
18:14 fmm2 rc://*/ta/man/translate/guidelines-sonofgodprinciples τοῦ Πατρὸς 1 This is an important title for God. (See: [[rc://*/ta/man/translate/guidelines-sonofgodprinciples]])
18:15 k6t7 0 Jesus begins to teach his disciples about forgiveness and reconciliation.
18:15 kpe2 ὁ ἀδελφός σου 1 This refers to a fellow believer in God, not a physical brother. Alternate translation: “your fellow believer”
18:15 yh3t ἐκέρδησας τὸν ἀδελφόν σου 1 “you will have made your relationship with your brother good again”
18:16 i25x rc://*/ta/man/translate/figs-metonymy ἵνα ἐπὶ στόματος δύο μαρτύρων ἢ τριῶν, σταθῇ πᾶν ῥῆμα 1 Here “mouth” and “word” refer to what a person says. This can be stated in active form. Alternate translation: “so that two or three witnesses may verify that what you say about your brother is true” (See: [[rc://*/ta/man/translate/figs-metonymy]] and [[rc://*/ta/man/translate/figs-activepassive]])
18:17 g3aj ἐὰν & παρακούσῃ αὐτῶν 1 “if your fellow believer refuses to listen to the witnesses who came with you”
18:17 kx28 τῆς ἐκκλησίας 1 “to the whole community of believers”
18:17 xf1a rc://*/ta/man/translate/figs-explicit ἔστω σοι ὥσπερ ὁ ἐθνικὸς καὶ ὁ τελώνης 1 “treat him as you would treat a Gentile or tax collector.” This implies that they should remove him from the community of believers. (See: [[rc://*/ta/man/translate/figs-explicit]])
18:18 u2kl ἀμὴν, λέγω ὑμῖν 1 “I tell you the truth.” This adds emphasis to what Jesus says next.
18:18 qzq7 rc://*/ta/man/translate/figs-you ὑμῖν 1 All occurrences of this word are plural. (See: [[rc://*/ta/man/translate/figs-you]])
18:18 bu6i rc://*/ta/man/translate/figs-metaphor ὅσα ἐὰν δήσητε ἐπὶ τῆς γῆς, ἔσται δεδεμένα ἐν οὐρανῷ, καὶ ὅσα ἐὰν λύσητε ἐπὶ τῆς γῆς, ἔσται λελυμένα ἐν οὐρανῷ 1 Here “bind” is a metaphor meaning to forbid something, and “release” is a metaphor meaning to allow something. Also, “in heaven” is a metonym that represents God himself. See how you translated similar phrases in [Matthew 16:19](../16/19.md). Alternate translation: “God in heaven will approve whatever you forbid or allow on earth” (See: [[rc://*/ta/man/translate/figs-metaphor]] and [[rc://*/ta/man/translate/figs-metonymy]])
18:18 l7na λέγω ὑμῖν 1 This adds emphasis to what Jesus says next.
18:19 cal4 rc://*/ta/man/translate/figs-explicit ἐὰν δύο & ἐξ ὑμῶν 1 It is implied that Jesus means “if at least two of you” or “if two or more of you.” (See: [[rc://*/ta/man/translate/figs-explicit]])
18:19 c3lf ἐὰν αἰτήσωνται & αὐτοῖς 1 These refer to the “two of you.” Alternate translation: “you … you”
18:19 gs8w rc://*/ta/man/translate/guidelines-sonofgodprinciples τοῦ Πατρός μου 1 This is an important title for God that describes the relationship between God and Jesus. (See: [[rc://*/ta/man/translate/guidelines-sonofgodprinciples]])
18:20 kv9z rc://*/ta/man/translate/figs-explicit δύο ἢ τρεῖς 1 It is implied that Jesus means “two or more” or “at least two.” (See: [[rc://*/ta/man/translate/figs-explicit]])
18:20 s5rx συνηγμένοι 1 “meet”
18:20 l7vu rc://*/ta/man/translate/figs-metonymy εἰς τὸ ἐμὸν ὄνομα 1 Here “name” refers to the entire person. Alternate translation: “because of me” or “because they are my disciples” (See: [[rc://*/ta/man/translate/figs-metonymy]])
18:21 cys4 rc://*/ta/man/translate/translate-numbers ἑπτάκις 1 “7 times” (See: [[rc://*/ta/man/translate/translate-numbers]])
18:22 b19x rc://*/ta/man/translate/translate-numbers ἑβδομηκοντάκις ἑπτά 1 Possible meanings are (1) “70 times 7” or (2) “77 times.” If using a number would be confusing, you can translate it as “more times than you can count” or “you must always forgive him.” (See: [[rc://*/ta/man/translate/translate-numbers]])
18:23 n44s 0 Jesus uses a parable to teach about forgiveness and reconciliation.
18:23 rqp1 rc://*/ta/man/translate/figs-parables ὡμοιώθη ἡ Βασιλεία τῶν Οὐρανῶν 1 This introduces a parable. See how you translated a similar parable introduction in [Matthew 13:24](../13/24.md). (See: [[rc://*/ta/man/translate/figs-parables]])
18:23 bp72 συνᾶραι λόγον μετὰ τῶν δούλων αὐτοῦ 1 “his servants to pay him what they owed”
18:24 d6ne rc://*/ta/man/translate/figs-activepassive προσηνέχθη εἷς αὐτῷ 1 This can be stated in active form. Alternate translation: “someone brought one of the kings servant” (See: [[rc://*/ta/man/translate/figs-activepassive]])
18:24 w3nr rc://*/ta/man/translate/translate-bmoney μυρίων ταλάντων 1 “10,000 talents” or “more money than the servant could ever repay” (See: [[rc://*/ta/man/translate/translate-bmoney]] and [[rc://*/ta/man/translate/translate-numbers]])
18:25 nmz8 rc://*/ta/man/translate/figs-activepassive ἐκέλευσεν αὐτὸν ὁ κύριος πραθῆναι & καὶ ἀποδοθῆναι 1 This can be stated in active form. Alternate translation: “the king commanded his servants to sell the man … and to pay the debt with the money from the sale” (See: [[rc://*/ta/man/translate/figs-activepassive]])
18:26 thl3 rc://*/ta/man/translate/translate-symaction πεσὼν οὖν & προσεκύνει 1 This shows that the servant approached the king in the most humble way possible. (See: [[rc://*/ta/man/translate/translate-symaction]])
18:26 cx5z προσεκύνει αὐτῷ 1 “before the king”
18:27 j5vp σπλαγχνισθεὶς 1 “he felt compassion for the servant”
18:27 vn7l ἀπέλυσεν αὐτόν 1 “let him go”
18:28 d2tb rc://*/ta/man/translate/figs-parables 0 Jesus continues telling a parable to his disciples. (See: [[rc://*/ta/man/translate/figs-parables]])
18:28 a7jb rc://*/ta/man/translate/translate-bmoney ἑκατὸν δηνάρια 1 “100 denarii” or “one hundred days wages” (See: [[rc://*/ta/man/translate/translate-bmoney]] and [[rc://*/ta/man/translate/translate-numbers]])
18:28 uy32 κρατήσας αὐτὸν 1 “The first servant grasped his fellow servant”
18:28 b7u9 κρατήσας 1 “took hold of” or “grabbed”
18:29 i21c rc://*/ta/man/translate/translate-symaction πεσὼν 1 This shows that the fellow servant approached the first servant in the most humble way possible. See how you translated this in [Matthew 18:26](../18/26.md). (See: [[rc://*/ta/man/translate/translate-symaction]])
18:29 iv8y παρεκάλει αὐτὸν 1 “and begged him”
18:30 fn3t rc://*/ta/man/translate/figs-parables 0 Jesus continues telling a parable to his disciples. (See: [[rc://*/ta/man/translate/figs-parables]])
18:30 t8wb ἀπελθὼν, ἔβαλεν αὐτὸν εἰς φυλακὴν 1 “the first servant went and threw his fellow servant into prison”
18:31 w9n2 οἱ σύνδουλοι αὐτοῦ 1 “other servants”
18:31 nx9k διεσάφησαν τῷ κυρίῳ ἑαυτῶν 1 “told the king”
18:32 pfc2 rc://*/ta/man/translate/figs-parables 0 Jesus continues telling a parable to his disciple. (See: [[rc://*/ta/man/translate/figs-parables]])
18:32 txr7 τότε προσκαλεσάμενος αὐτὸν ὁ κύριος αὐτοῦ 1 “Then the king called the first servant”
18:32 wgs1 παρεκάλεσάς με 1 “you begged me”
18:33 jw37 rc://*/ta/man/translate/figs-rquestion οὐκ ἔδει καὶ σὲ ἐλεῆσαι & σὲ ἠλέησα? 1 The king uses a question to scold the first servant. Alternate translation: “You should have … you!” (See: [[rc://*/ta/man/translate/figs-rquestion]])
18:34 l7ks 0 This is the end of the part of the story that began in [Matthew 18:1](../18/01.md), where Jesus teaches about life in the kingdom of heaven.
18:34 mkm7 0 Jesus concludes his parable about forgiveness and reconciliation.
18:34 big9 ὁ κύριος αὐτοῦ 1 “The king”
18:34 e95u rc://*/ta/man/translate/figs-explicit παρέδωκεν αὐτὸν 1 “gave him over.” Most likely the king himself did not take the first servant to the torturers. Alternate translation: “he ordered his servants to give him over” (See: [[rc://*/ta/man/translate/figs-explicit]])
18:34 j7s3 τοῖς βασανισταῖς 1 “to those who would torture him”
18:34 e14m rc://*/ta/man/translate/figs-activepassive τὸ ὀφειλόμενον 1 This can be stated in active form. Alternate translation: “that the first servant owed the king” (See: [[rc://*/ta/man/translate/figs-activepassive]])
18:35 pm1d rc://*/ta/man/translate/guidelines-sonofgodprinciples ὁ Πατήρ μου ὁ οὐράνιος 1 This is an important title for God that describes the relationship between God and Jesus. (See: [[rc://*/ta/man/translate/guidelines-sonofgodprinciples]])
18:35 q8p9 rc://*/ta/man/translate/figs-you ὑμῖν & ὑμῶν 1 All occurrences of these words are plural. Jesus is speaking to his disciples, but this parable teaches a general truth that applies to all believers. (See: [[rc://*/ta/man/translate/figs-you]])
18:35 c4fw rc://*/ta/man/translate/figs-metonymy ἀπὸ τῶν καρδιῶν ὑμῶν 1 Here “heart” is a metonym for a persons inner being. The phrase “from your heart” is an idiom that means “sincerely.” Alternate translation: “sincerely” or “completely” (See: [[rc://*/ta/man/translate/figs-metonymy]] and [[rc://*/ta/man/translate/figs-idiom]])
19:intro ewl5 0 # Matthew 19 General Notes\n## Special concepts in this chapter\n\n### Divorce\n\nJesus taught about divorce because the Pharisees wanted people to think Jesus teachings about divorce were wrong ([Matthew 19:3-12](./03.md)). Jesus talked about what God had first said about marriage when he created it.\n\n## Important figures of speech in this chapter\n\n### Metonymy\n\nJesus often says the word “heaven” when he wants his hearers to think of God, who lives in heaven ([Matthew 1:12](../../mat/01/12.md)).
19:1 nj6t rc://*/ta/man/translate/writing-background 0 This is the beginning of a new part of the story that runs through [Matthew 22:46](../22/46.md), which tells of Jesus ministering in Judea. These verses provide background information of how Jesus came to be in Judea. (See: [[rc://*/ta/man/translate/writing-background]])
19:1 ap4g ἐγένετο, ὅτε 1 This phrase shifts the story from Jesus teachings to what happened next. Alternate translation: “When” or “After”
19:1 c5j9 rc://*/ta/man/translate/figs-metonymy ἐτέλεσεν & τοὺς λόγους τούτους 1 Here “words” refers to what Jesus taught starting in [Matthew 18:1](../18/01.md). Alternate translation: “had finished teaching these things” (See: [[rc://*/ta/man/translate/figs-metonymy]])
19:1 d83m ἀπὸ 1 “walked away from” or “left”
19:3 kg12 0 Jesus begins to teach about marriage and divorce.
19:3 gl85 προσῆλθον αὐτῷ 1 “came to Jesus”
19:3 s8jq πειράζοντες αὐτὸν καὶ λέγοντες 1 Here “tested” is used in a negative sense. Alternate translation: “and challenged him by asking him” or “and wanted to trap him by asking him”
19:4 ncb6 rc://*/ta/man/translate/figs-rquestion οὐκ ἀνέγνωτε, ὅτι ὁ ποιήσας ἀπ’ ἀρχῆς, ἄρσεν καὶ θῆλυ, ἐποίησεν αὐτοὺς? 1 Jesus uses this question to remind the Pharisees of what the scripture says about men, women, and marriage. Alternate translation: “Surely you have read that in the beginning when God created people he made them male and female.” (See: [[rc://*/ta/man/translate/figs-rquestion]])
19:5 n8zn 0 In verse 5, Jesus quotes from Genesis to show that a husband and wife should not divorce.
19:5 q71w rc://*/ta/man/translate/figs-explicit καὶ εἶπεν, ἕνεκα τούτου & εἰς σάρκα μίαν? 1 This is part of what Jesus expected the Pharisees to have understood from the scripture. The direct quotation can be expressed as an indirect quotation. Alternate translation: “And surely you know that God also said that for this reason … flesh” (See: [[rc://*/ta/man/translate/figs-explicit]] and [[rc://*/ta/man/translate/figs-quotations]])
19:5 phz3 ἕνεκα τούτου 1 This is a part of the quotation from Genesis story about Adam and Eve. In that context the reason a man will leave his father and mother is because God created a woman to be the mans companion.
19:5 af1r κολληθήσεται τῇ γυναικὶ αὐτοῦ 1 “stay close to his wife” or “live with his wife”
19:5 m83j rc://*/ta/man/translate/figs-metaphor ἔσονται οἱ δύο εἰς σάρκα μίαν 1 This is a metaphor that emphasizes the unity of a husband and a wife. Alternate translation: “they will become like one person” (See: [[rc://*/ta/man/translate/figs-metaphor]])
19:6 m4b7 rc://*/ta/man/translate/figs-metaphor ὥστε οὐκέτι εἰσὶν δύο, ἀλλὰ σὰρξ μία 1 This is a metaphor that emphasizes the unity of a husband and a wife. Alternate translation: “So a husband and wife are no longer like two persons, but they are like one person” (See: [[rc://*/ta/man/translate/figs-metaphor]])
19:7 jxs2 λέγουσιν αὐτῷ 1 “The Pharisees said to Jesus”
19:7 ugf4 ἐνετείλατο 1 “command us Jews”
19:7 xml9 βιβλίον ἀποστασίου 1 This is a document that legally ends the marriage.
19:8 zu87 rc://*/ta/man/translate/figs-metaphor πρὸς τὴν σκληροκαρδίαν ὑμῶν 1 The phrase “hardness of heart” is a metaphor that means “stubbornness.” Alternate translation: “Because of your stubbornness” or “Because you are stubborn” (See: [[rc://*/ta/man/translate/figs-metaphor]])
19:8 ve9e rc://*/ta/man/translate/figs-you τὴν σκληροκαρδίαν ὑμῶν & ἐπέτρεψεν ὑμῖν & τὰς γυναῖκας ὑμῶν 1 Here “you” and “your” are plural. Jesus is speaking to the Pharisees, but Moses gave this command many years earlier to their ancestors. Moses command applied to all Jewish men in general. (See: [[rc://*/ta/man/translate/figs-you]])
19:8 mgx9 rc://*/ta/man/translate/figs-metonymy ἀπ’ ἀρχῆς δὲ 1 Here “beginning” refers to when God first created man and woman. (See: [[rc://*/ta/man/translate/figs-metonymy]])
19:9 eq8z λέγω & ὑμῖν 1 This adds emphasis to what Jesus says next.
19:9 yl3x rc://*/ta/man/translate/figs-ellipsis γαμήσῃ ἄλλην 1 You can make clear the understood information. Alternate translation: “marries another woman” (See: [[rc://*/ta/man/translate/figs-ellipsis]])
19:9 ps45 rc://*/ta/man/translate/translate-textvariants καὶ ὁ ἀπολελυμένην γαμήσας μοιχᾶται 1 Many early texts do not include these words. (See: [[rc://*/ta/man/translate/translate-textvariants]])
19:11 h3a3 rc://*/ta/man/translate/figs-activepassive δέδοται 1 This can be stated in active form. Alternate translation: “whom God allows” or “whom God enables” (See: [[rc://*/ta/man/translate/figs-activepassive]])
19:12 yvb8 rc://*/ta/man/translate/figs-explicit εἰσὶν γὰρ εὐνοῦχοι, οἵτινες ἐκ κοιλίας μητρὸς ἐγεννήθησαν οὕτως 1 You can make explicit the implicit information. Alternate translation: “For there are different reasons that men do not marry. For instance, there are men who were born eunuchs” (See: [[rc://*/ta/man/translate/figs-explicit]])
19:12 m1r9 rc://*/ta/man/translate/figs-activepassive εἰσὶν εὐνοῦχοι οἵτινες εὐνουχίσθησαν ὑπὸ τῶν ἀνθρώπων 1 This can be stated in active form. Alternate translation: “there are men whom other men have made eunuchs” (See: [[rc://*/ta/man/translate/figs-activepassive]])
19:12 g4bw rc://*/ta/man/translate/figs-metaphor εὐνοῦχοι οἵτινες εὐνούχισαν ἑαυτοὺς 1 Possible meanings are (1) “men who have made themselves eunuchs by removing their private parts” or (2) “men who choose to remain unmarried and sexually pure.” (See: [[rc://*/ta/man/translate/figs-metaphor]])
19:12 r78n rc://*/ta/man/translate/figs-metonymy διὰ τὴν Βασιλείαν τῶν Οὐρανῶν 1 Here “kingdom of heaven” refers to Gods rule as king. This phrase is found only in the book of Matthew. If possible, keep “heaven” in your translation. Alternate translation: “so they can better serve our God in heaven” (See: [[rc://*/ta/man/translate/figs-metonymy]])
19:12 hqu1 χωρεῖν, χωρείτω 1 “accept this teaching … accept it”
19:13 wjb5 0 Jesus receives and blesses little children.
19:13 wu52 rc://*/ta/man/translate/figs-activepassive προσηνέχθησαν αὐτῷ παιδία 1 This can be stated in active form. Alternate translation: “some people brought little children to Jesus” (See: [[rc://*/ta/man/translate/figs-activepassive]])
19:14 t6cm ἄφετε 1 allow
19:14 m219 μὴ κωλύετε αὐτὰ ἐλθεῖν πρός με 1 “do not stop them from coming to me”
19:14 l1bq rc://*/ta/man/translate/figs-metonymy τῶν γὰρ τοιούτων ἐστὶν ἡ Βασιλεία τῶν Οὐρανῶν 1 Here “kingdom of heaven” refers to Gods rule as king. This phrase is found only in the book of Matthew. If possible, keep “heaven” in your translation. Alternate translation: “for when our God in heaven establishes his rule on earth, he will be king over such as these” or “for God will allow such as these into his kingdom” (See: [[rc://*/ta/man/translate/figs-metonymy]])
19:14 za2g rc://*/ta/man/translate/figs-simile τῶν & τοιούτων ἐστὶν ἡ Βασιλεία τῶν Οὐρανῶν 1 “belongs to those who are like children.” This is a simile that means those who are humble like children will enter Gods kingdom. (See: [[rc://*/ta/man/translate/figs-simile]])
19:16 g9us 0 Here the scene shifts to a different time when Jesus explains to a rich man what it will cost to follow him.
19:16 vj7t ἰδοὺ 1 The word “behold” alerts us to a new person in the story. Your language may have a way of doing this.
19:16 bw9n ἀγαθὸν 1 This means a thing that pleases God.
19:17 sce3 rc://*/ta/man/translate/figs-rquestion τί με ἐρωτᾷς περὶ τοῦ ἀγαθοῦ? 1 Jesus uses this rhetorical question to encourage the man to think about his reason for asking Jesus about what is good. Alternate translation: “You ask me about what is good” or “Think about why you ask me about what is good.” (See: [[rc://*/ta/man/translate/figs-rquestion]])
19:17 d4sh εἷς ἐστιν ὁ ἀγαθός 1 “God alone is completely good”
19:17 d7fd εἰς τὴν ζωὴν εἰσελθεῖν 1 “to receive eternal life”
19:19 zv5n ἀγαπήσεις τὸν πλησίον σου 1 The Jewish people believed that their neighbors were only other Jews. Jesus is extending that definition to include all people.
19:21 m57c εἰ θέλεις 1 “If you want”
19:21 zic9 rc://*/ta/man/translate/figs-nominaladj πτωχοῖς 1 This nominal adjective can be stated as an adjective. Alternate translation: “to those who are poor” (See: [[rc://*/ta/man/translate/figs-nominaladj]])
19:21 e4vs rc://*/ta/man/translate/figs-metaphor ἕξεις θησαυρὸν ἐν οὐρανοῖς 1 The phrase “treasure in heaven” is a metaphor that refers to a reward from God. Alternate translation: “God will reward you in heaven” (See: [[rc://*/ta/man/translate/figs-metaphor]])
19:23 ass2 0 Jesus explains to his disciples the rewards of giving up material possessions and relationships to follow him.
19:23 r93j ἀμὴν, λέγω ὑμῖν 1 “I tell you the truth.” This phrase adds emphasis to what Jesus says next.
19:23 ean2 rc://*/ta/man/translate/figs-metonymy εἰσελεύσεται εἰς τὴν Βασιλείαν τῶν Οὐρανῶν 1 Here “kingdom of heaven” refers to Gods rule as king. This phrase is found only in the book of Matthew. If possible, keep “heaven” in your translation. Alternate translation: “to accept our God in heaven as their king” or “to enter Gods kingdom” (See: [[rc://*/ta/man/translate/figs-metonymy]])
19:24 c8l5 rc://*/ta/man/translate/figs-hyperbole ὐκοπώτερόν ἐστιν & τὴν Βασιλείαν Θεοῦ 1 Jesus uses an exaggeration to illustrate how very difficult it is for rich people to enter the kingdom of God. (See: [[rc://*/ta/man/translate/figs-hyperbole]])
19:24 dip3 τρήματος ῥαφίδος 1 the hole near one end of a needle, through which thread is passed
19:25 sl38 rc://*/ta/man/translate/figs-explicit ἐξεπλήσσοντο 1 “the disciples were amazed.” It is implied that they were astonished because they believed having riches was proof that God approved of someone. (See: [[rc://*/ta/man/translate/figs-explicit]])
19:25 d389 rc://*/ta/man/translate/figs-rquestion τίς ἄρα δύναται σωθῆναι? 1 The disciples use a question to emphasize their surprise. This can be stated in active form. Alternate translation: “Then there is no one whom God will save!” or “Then there is no one who will receive eternal life!” (See: [[rc://*/ta/man/translate/figs-rquestion]] and [[rc://*/ta/man/translate/figs-activepassive]])
19:27 yp3h ἡμεῖς ἀφήκαμεν πάντα 1 “we have left all our wealth” or “we have given up all our possessions”
19:27 sp61 τί ἄρα ἔσται ἡμῖν? 1 “What good thing will God give us?”
19:28 pm6v ἀμὴν, λέγω ὑμῖν 1 “I tell you the truth.” This phrase adds emphasis to what Jesus says next.
19:28 j89c rc://*/ta/man/translate/figs-metonymy ἐν τῇ παλιγγενεσίᾳ 1 “in the new time.” This refers to when God restores all things. Alternate translation: “at the time when God makes all things new” (See: [[rc://*/ta/man/translate/figs-metonymy]])
19:28 gey2 rc://*/ta/man/translate/figs-123person ὁ Υἱὸς τοῦ Ἀνθρώπου 1 Jesus is speaking about himself. (See: [[rc://*/ta/man/translate/figs-123person]])
19:28 sx2j rc://*/ta/man/translate/figs-metonymy καθίσῃ & ἐπὶ θρόνου δόξης αὐτοῦ 1 Sitting on his throne represents ruling as a king. His throne being glorious represents his rule being glorious. Alternate translation: “sits as king on his glorious throne” or “rules gloriously as king” (See: [[rc://*/ta/man/translate/figs-metonymy]])
19:28 rx2u rc://*/ta/man/translate/figs-metonymy καθήσεσθε & ἐπὶ δώδεκα θρόνους 1 Here sitting on thrones refers to ruling as kings. The disciples will not be equal to Jesus who is also on a throne. They will receive authority from him. Alternate translation: “sit as kings on 12 thrones” (See: [[rc://*/ta/man/translate/figs-metonymy]])
19:28 ci3t rc://*/ta/man/translate/figs-metonymy τὰς δώδεκα φυλὰς τοῦ Ἰσραήλ 1 Here “tribes” refers to people from those tribes. Alternate translation: “the people of the 12 tribes of Israel” (See: [[rc://*/ta/man/translate/figs-metonymy]])
19:29 gq8p rc://*/ta/man/translate/figs-metonymy ἕνεκεν τοῦ ἐμοῦ ὀνόματός 1 Here “name” refers to the entire person. Alternate translation: “because of me” or “because he believes in me” (See: [[rc://*/ta/man/translate/figs-metonymy]])
19:29 bzt3 rc://*/ta/man/translate/translate-numbers ἑκατονταπλασίονα λήμψεται 1 “receive from God 100 times as many good things as they gave up” (See: [[rc://*/ta/man/translate/translate-numbers]])
19:29 z8wb rc://*/ta/man/translate/figs-idiom ζωὴν αἰώνιον κληρονομήσει 1 This is an idiom that means “God will bless them with eternal life” or “God will cause them to live forever.” (See: [[rc://*/ta/man/translate/figs-idiom]])
19:30 u8p3 πολλοὶ δὲ ἔσονται πρῶτοι ἔσχατοι, καὶ ἔσχατοι πρῶτοι 1 Here “first” and “last” refer to peoples status or importance. Jesus is contrasting peoples status now with their status in the kingdom of heaven. Alternate translation: “But many who seem to be important now will be the least important, and many who seem to be unimportant now will be very important”
20:intro z39h 0 # Matthew 20 General Notes\n## Special concepts in this chapter\n\n### The parable of the landowner and his vineyard\n\nJesus tells this parable ([Matthew 20:1-16](./01.md)) to teach his disciples that what God says is right is different from what people say is right.
20:1 k7sw 0 Jesus tells a parable about a landowner who hires workers, to illustrate how God will reward those who belong to the kingdom of heaven.
20:1 q9qc rc://*/ta/man/translate/figs-parables ὁμοία γάρ ἐστιν ἡ Βασιλεία τῶν Οὐρανῶν 1 This is the beginning of a parable. See how you translated the introduction to the parable in [Matthew 13:24](../13/24.md). (See: [[rc://*/ta/man/translate/figs-parables]])
20:2 wd43 συμφωνήσας 1 “After the landowner had agreed”
20:2 iwk5 rc://*/ta/man/translate/translate-bmoney δηναρίου 1 This was the daily wage at that time. Alternate translation: “one days wages” (See: [[rc://*/ta/man/translate/translate-bmoney]])
20:2 w9hq ἀπέστειλεν αὐτοὺς εἰς τὸν ἀμπελῶνα αὐτοῦ 1 “he sent them to work in his vineyard”
20:3 w9m2 rc://*/ta/man/translate/figs-parables 0 Jesus continues telling a parable. (See: [[rc://*/ta/man/translate/figs-parables]])
20:3 s8ha καὶ ἐξελθὼν 1 “The landowner went out again”
20:3 bki1 rc://*/ta/man/translate/translate-ordinal τρίτην ὥραν 1 The third hour is around nine in the morning. (See: [[rc://*/ta/man/translate/translate-ordinal]])
20:3 xk4i ἑστῶτας ἐν τῇ ἀγορᾷ ἀργούς 1 “standing in the marketplace not doing anything” or “standing in the marketplace with no work to do”
20:3 q3b7 τῇ ἀγορᾷ 1 a large, open-air area where people buy and sell food and other items
20:5 g1s7 rc://*/ta/man/translate/figs-parables 0 Jesus continues telling a parable. (See: [[rc://*/ta/man/translate/figs-parables]])
20:5 j3zh πάλιν ἐξελθὼν 1 “Again the landowner went out”
20:5 pip4 rc://*/ta/man/translate/translate-ordinal περὶ ἕκτην καὶ ἐνάτην ὥραν 1 The sixth hour is around noon. The ninth hour is around three in the afternoon. (See: [[rc://*/ta/man/translate/translate-ordinal]])
20:5 y513 ἐποίησεν ὡσαύτως 1 This means the landowner went to the marketplace and hired workers.
20:6 t8uu rc://*/ta/man/translate/translate-ordinal τὴν ἑνδεκάτην 1 This is about five in the afternoon. (See: [[rc://*/ta/man/translate/translate-ordinal]])
20:6 up1w ἑστῶτας 1 “not doing anything” or “not having any work”
20:8 hg2p rc://*/ta/man/translate/figs-parables 0 Jesus continues telling a parable. (See: [[rc://*/ta/man/translate/figs-parables]])
20:8 x6iv ἀρξάμενος ἀπὸ τῶν ἐσχάτων ἕως τῶν πρώτων 1 You can make clear the understood information. Alternate translation: “beginning with the workers who started working last, then the workers who started working earlier, and finally the workers who started working first” or “first paying the workers I hired last, then paying the workers I hired earlier in the day, and finally paying the workers I hired first”
20:9 p7q1 rc://*/ta/man/translate/figs-activepassive οἱ 1 This can be stated in active form. Alternate translation: “whom the landowner hired” (See: [[rc://*/ta/man/translate/figs-activepassive]])
20:10 d2bn rc://*/ta/man/translate/translate-bmoney δηνάριον 1 This was the daily wage at that time. Alternate translation: “one days wages” (See: [[rc://*/ta/man/translate/translate-bmoney]])
20:11 z2h5 rc://*/ta/man/translate/figs-parables 0 Jesus continues telling a parable. (See: [[rc://*/ta/man/translate/figs-parables]])
20:11 z9sz λαβόντες 1 “When the workers who had worked the longest received”
20:11 d6sy τοῦ οἰκοδεσπότου 1 “the vineyard owner”
20:12 qpz4 ἴσους ἡμῖν αὐτοὺς ἐποίησας 1 “you have paid them the same amount of money as you paid us”
20:12 vy87 rc://*/ta/man/translate/figs-idiom τοῖς βαστάσασι τὸ βάρος τῆς ἡμέρας καὶ τὸν καύσωνα 1 The phrase “borne the burden of the day” is an idiom that means “worked the entire day.” Alternate translation: “we who have worked the entire day, even during the hottest part” (See: [[rc://*/ta/man/translate/figs-idiom]])
20:13 w17c rc://*/ta/man/translate/figs-parables 0 Jesus continues telling a parable. (See: [[rc://*/ta/man/translate/figs-parables]])
20:13 r9f3 ἑνὶ αὐτῶν 1 “one of the workers who had worked the longest”
20:13 f5mb ἑταῖρε 1 Use a word that one man would use to address another man whom he is politely rebuking.
20:13 qbu1 rc://*/ta/man/translate/figs-rquestion οὐχὶ δηναρίου συνεφώνησάς μοι 1 The landowner uses a question to rebuke the workers who were complaining. Alternate translation: “We already agreed that I would give you one denarius.” (See: [[rc://*/ta/man/translate/figs-rquestion]])
20:13 qxn3 rc://*/ta/man/translate/translate-bmoney δηναρίου 1 This was the daily wage at that time. Alternate translation: “one days wages” (See: [[rc://*/ta/man/translate/translate-bmoney]])
20:15 g5ii rc://*/ta/man/translate/figs-parables 0 Jesus concludes his parable about a landowner who hires workers. (See: [[rc://*/ta/man/translate/figs-parables]])
20:15 h3uh rc://*/ta/man/translate/figs-rquestion ἢ οὐκ ἔξεστίν μοι, ὃ θέλω ποιῆσαι ἐν τοῖς ἐμοῖς? 1 The landowner uses a question to correct the workers who were complaining. Alternate translation: “I can do what I want with my own possessions.” (See: [[rc://*/ta/man/translate/figs-rquestion]])
20:15 dus3 rc://*/ta/man/translate/figs-rquestion ἢ ὁ ὀφθαλμός σου πονηρός ἐστιν, ὅτι ἐγὼ ἀγαθός εἰμι? 1 The landowner uses a question to rebuke the workers who were complaining. Alternate translation: “Do not be jealous when I am generous to other people.” (See: [[rc://*/ta/man/translate/figs-rquestion]])
20:16 k5fe οὕτως ἔσονται οἱ ἔσχατοι πρῶτοι, καὶ οἱ πρῶτοι ἔσχατοι 1 Here “first” and “last” refer to peoples status or importance. Jesus is contrasting peoples status now with their status in the kingdom of heaven. See how you translated a similar statement in [Matthew 19:30](../19/30.md). Alternate translation: “So those who seem to be unimportant now will be the most important, and those who seem to be the most important now will be the least important”
20:16 bhr5 οὕτως ἔσονται οἱ ἔσχατοι πρῶτοι 1 Here the parable has ended and Jesus is speaking. Alternate translation: “Then Jesus said, So the last will be first
20:17 iu9d 0 Jesus foretells his death and resurrection a third time as he and his disciples travel to Jerusalem.
20:17 b6ia ἀναβαίνων ὁ Ἰησοῦς εἰς Ἱεροσόλυμα 1 Jerusalem was on top of a hill, so people had to travel up to get there.
20:18 d3ig ἰδοὺ, ἀναβαίνομεν 1 Jesus uses the word “See” to tell the disciples the must pay attention to what he is about to tell them.
20:18 nf34 rc://*/ta/man/translate/figs-exclusive ἀναβαίνομεν 1 Here “we” refers to Jesus and the disciples. (See: [[rc://*/ta/man/translate/figs-exclusive]])
20:18 b2f2 rc://*/ta/man/translate/figs-activepassive ὁ Υἱὸς τοῦ Ἀνθρώπου παραδοθήσεται 1 This can be stated in active form. Alternate translation: “someone will deliver the Son of Man” (See: [[rc://*/ta/man/translate/figs-activepassive]])
20:18 rbl4 rc://*/ta/man/translate/figs-123person ὁ Υἱὸς τοῦ Ἀνθρώπου & αὐτὸν 1 Jesus is referring to himself in the third person. If necessary, you can translate these in the first person. (See: [[rc://*/ta/man/translate/figs-123person]])
20:18 s8uh κατακρινοῦσιν 1 The chief priests and scribes will condemn Jesus.
20:19 rjq7 καὶ παραδώσουσιν αὐτὸν τοῖς ἔθνεσιν, εἰς τὸ ἐμπαῖξαι 1 The chief priests and scribes will deliver Jesus to the Gentiles, and the Gentiles will mock him.
20:19 a9k5 μαστιγῶσαι 1 “to whip him” or “to beat him with whips”
20:19 pn84 rc://*/ta/man/translate/translate-ordinal τῇ τρίτῃ ἡμέρᾳ 1 “Third” is the ordinal form of “three.” (See: [[rc://*/ta/man/translate/translate-ordinal]])
20:19 c6q1 rc://*/ta/man/translate/figs-123person αὐτὸν & σταυρῶσαι & ἀναστήσεται 1 Jesus is referring to himself in the third person. If necessary, you can translate these in the first person. (See: [[rc://*/ta/man/translate/figs-123person]])
20:19 kr7a rc://*/ta/man/translate/figs-activepassive ἀναστήσεται 1 The words “be raised up” are an idiom for “be made alive again.” This can be stated in active form. Alternate translation: “God will raise him up” or “God will make him alive again” (See: [[rc://*/ta/man/translate/figs-activepassive]])
20:20 u67i 0 In response to the question that the mother of two of the disciples asks, Jesus teaches his disciples about authority and serving others in the kingdom of heaven.
20:20 sx75 τῶν υἱῶν Ζεβεδαίου 1 This refers James and John.
20:21 b8xs rc://*/ta/man/translate/figs-metonymy ἐκ δεξιῶν & ἐξ εὐωνύμων σου 1 These refer to having positions of power, authority, and honor. (See: [[rc://*/ta/man/translate/figs-metonymy]])
20:21 i9n6 rc://*/ta/man/translate/figs-metonymy ἐν τῇ βασιλείᾳ σου 1 Here “kingdom” refers to Jesus ruling as king. Alternate translation: “when you are king” (See: [[rc://*/ta/man/translate/figs-metonymy]])
20:22 gx17 rc://*/ta/man/translate/figs-you οὐκ οἴδατε 1 Here “you” is plural and refers to the mother and the sons. (See: [[rc://*/ta/man/translate/figs-you]])
20:22 i8nx rc://*/ta/man/translate/figs-you δύνασθε 1 Here “you” is plural, but Jesus is only talking to the two sons. (See: [[rc://*/ta/man/translate/figs-you]])
20:22 f9cy rc://*/ta/man/translate/figs-idiom πιεῖν τὸ ποτήριον ὃ ἐγὼ μέλλω πίνειν 1 To “drink the cup” or “drink from the cup” is an idiom that means to experience suffering. Alternate translation: “suffer what I am about to suffer” (See: [[rc://*/ta/man/translate/figs-idiom]])
20:22 d4rf λέγουσιν 1 “The sons of Zebedee said” or “James and John said”
20:23 m4d2 rc://*/ta/man/translate/figs-idiom τὸ μὲν ποτήριόν μου πίεσθε 1 To “drink a cup” or “drink from a cup” is an idiom that means to experience suffering. Alternate translation: “You will indeed suffer as I will suffer” (See: [[rc://*/ta/man/translate/figs-idiom]])
20:23 aq1v rc://*/ta/man/translate/figs-metonymy δεξιῶν & εὐωνύμων 1 These refer to having positions of power, authority, and honor. See how you translated this in [Matthew 20:21](../20/21.md). (See: [[rc://*/ta/man/translate/figs-metonymy]])
20:23 sj51 rc://*/ta/man/translate/figs-activepassive οἷς ἡτοίμασται ὑπὸ τοῦ Πατρός μου 1 This can be stated in active form. Alternate translation: “my Father has prepared those places, and he will give them to whom he chooses” (See: [[rc://*/ta/man/translate/figs-activepassive]])
20:23 x5f4 rc://*/ta/man/translate/guidelines-sonofgodprinciples τοῦ Πατρός μου 1 This is an important title for God that describes the relationship between God and Jesus. (See: [[rc://*/ta/man/translate/guidelines-sonofgodprinciples]])
20:24 qxl4 ἀκούσαντες 1 “heard what James and John had asked Jesus”
20:24 la38 rc://*/ta/man/translate/figs-explicit ἠγανάκτησαν περὶ τῶν δύο ἀδελφῶν 1 If necessary, you can make explicit why the ten disciples were angry. Alternate translation: “they were very angry with the two brothers because each of them also wanted to sit in a place of honor next to Jesus” (See: [[rc://*/ta/man/translate/figs-explicit]])
20:25 uu67 0 Jesus finishes teaching his disciples about authority and serving others.
20:25 v2xq προσκαλεσάμενος αὐτοὺς 1 “called the twelve disciples”
20:25 x2ul οἱ ἄρχοντες τῶν ἐθνῶν κατακυριεύουσιν αὐτῶν 1 “the Gentile kings forcefully rule over their people”
20:25 gu83 οἱ μεγάλοι 1 “the important men among the Gentiles”
20:25 nb3r κατεξουσιάζουσιν αὐτῶν 1 “have control over the people”
20:26 y4qw ὃς ἐὰν θέλῃ 1 “whoever wants” or “whoever desires”
20:27 j3ms εἶναι πρῶτος 1 “to be important”
20:28 m27d rc://*/ta/man/translate/figs-123person ὁ Υἱὸς τοῦ Ἀνθρώπου & τὴν ψυχὴν αὐτοῦ 1 Jesus is speaking about himself in the third person. If necessary, you can translate this in the first person. (See: [[rc://*/ta/man/translate/figs-123person]])
20:28 iz71 rc://*/ta/man/translate/figs-activepassive οὐκ ἦλθεν διακονηθῆναι 1 This can be stated in active form. Alternate translation: “did not come so that other people would serve him” or “did not come so that other people would serve me” (See: [[rc://*/ta/man/translate/figs-activepassive]])
20:28 c7r9 rc://*/ta/man/translate/figs-ellipsis ἀλλὰ διακονῆσαι 1 You can make clear the understood information. Alternate translation: “but to serve other people” (See: [[rc://*/ta/man/translate/figs-ellipsis]])
20:28 zh3k rc://*/ta/man/translate/figs-metaphor καὶ δοῦναι τὴν ψυχὴν αὐτοῦ λύτρον ἀντὶ πολλῶν 1 Jesus life being a “ransom” is a metaphor for his being punished in order to set people free from being punished for their own sins. Alternate translation: “to give his life as a substitute for many” or “to give his life as a substitute to set many free” (See: [[rc://*/ta/man/translate/figs-metaphor]])
20:28 zv1p rc://*/ta/man/translate/figs-idiom καὶ δοῦναι τὴν ψυχὴν αὐτοῦ 1 To give ones live is an idiom meaning to die voluntarily, usually in order to help others. Alternate translation: “to die” (See: [[rc://*/ta/man/translate/figs-idiom]])
20:28 hgv7 rc://*/ta/man/translate/figs-ellipsis ἀντὶ πολλῶν 1 You can make clear the understood information. Alternate translation: “for many people” (See: [[rc://*/ta/man/translate/figs-ellipsis]])
20:29 u6ad 0 This begins an account of Jesus healing two blind men.
20:29 ev2t ἐκπορευομένων αὐτῶν 1 This refers to the disciples and Jesus.
20:29 b4tr ἠκολούθησεν αὐτῷ 1 “followed Jesus”
20:30 zz5f ἀκούσαντες 1 “When the two blind men heard”
20:30 stz8 παράγει 1 “was walking by them”
20:30 t577 Υἱὸς Δαυείδ 1 Jesus was not Davids literal son, so this may be translated as “Descendant of King David.” However, “Son of David” is also a title for the Messiah, and the men were probably calling Jesus by this title.
20:32 f5mw ἐφώνησεν αὐτοὺς 1 “called to the blind men”
20:32 fd9x τί θέλετε 1 “do you want”
20:33 yb39 rc://*/ta/man/translate/figs-metaphor ἵνα ἀνοιγῶσιν οἱ ὀφθαλμοὶ ἡμῶν 1 The men speak of becoming able to see as if there eyes were to be opened. Because of Jesus previous question, we understand that they were expressing their desire. Alternate translation: “we want you to open our eyes” or “we want to be able to see” (See: [[rc://*/ta/man/translate/figs-metaphor]] and [[rc://*/ta/man/translate/figs-ellipsis]])
20:34 q9iq σπλαγχνισθεὶς 1 “having compassion” or “feeling compassion for them”
21:intro ni1x 0 # Matthew 21 General Notes\n## Structure and formatting\n\nSome translations set each line of poetry farther to the right than the rest of the text to make it easier to read. The ULT does this with the poetry in 21:5,16 and 42, which are words from the Old Testament.\n\n## Special concepts in this chapter\n\n### The donkey and the colt\n\nJesus rode into Jerusalem on an animal. In this way he was like a king who came into a city after he had won an important battle. Also, the kings of Israel in the Old Testament rode on a donkeys. Other kings rode on horses. So Jesus was showing that he was the king of Israel and that he was not like other kings.\n\nMatthew, Mark, Luke, and John all wrote about this event. Matthew and Mark wrote that the disciples brought Jesus a donkey. John wrote that Jesus found a donkey. Luke wrote that they brought him a colt. Only Matthew wrote that there were both a donkey had a colt. No one knows for sure whether Jesus rode the donkey or the colt. It is best to translate each of these accounts as it appears in the ULT without trying to make them all say exactly the same thing. (See: [Matthew 21:1-7](../../mat/21/01.md) and [Mark 11:1-7](../../mrk/11/01.md) and [Luke 19:29-36](../../luk/19/29.md) and [John 12:14-15](../../jhn/12/14.md))\n\n### Hosanna\n\nThis is what the people shouted to welcome Jesus into Jerusalem. This word meant “Save us,” but people used it to praise God.\n\n## Other possible translation difficulties in this chapter\n\n### “The kingdom of God will be taken away from you”\n\nNo one knows for sure what this phrase means. No one knows if Jesus meant that God would someday give the kingdom back or not.
21:1 f8fs 0 This begins the account of Jesus entry into Jerusalem. Here he gives his disciples instructions about what they are to do.
21:1 p3g6 rc://*/ta/man/translate/translate-names Βηθφαγὴ 1 This is a village near Jerusalem. (See: [[rc://*/ta/man/translate/translate-names]])
21:2 wen2 rc://*/ta/man/translate/figs-activepassive ὄνον δεδεμένην 1 You can state this in active form. Alternate translation: “a donkey that someone has tied up” (See: [[rc://*/ta/man/translate/figs-activepassive]])
21:2 pq2e rc://*/ta/man/translate/figs-explicit δεδεμένην 1 You can make explicit how the donkey is tied. Alternate translation: “tied up there to a post” or “tied up there to a tree” (See: [[rc://*/ta/man/translate/figs-explicit]])
21:2 ure7 πῶλον 1 young male donkey
21:4 lk67 0 Here the author quotes the prophet Zechariah to show that Jesus fulfilled prophecy by riding a donkey into Jerusalem.
21:4 irw1 δὲ 1 This word is used here to mark a break in the main story line. Here Matthew explains how Jesus actions fulfill scripture.
21:4 n979 rc://*/ta/man/translate/figs-activepassive τοῦτο & γέγονεν, ἵνα πληρωθῇ τὸ ῥηθὲν διὰ τοῦ προφήτου 1 This can be stated in active form. Alternate translation: “this happened so that Jesus would fulfill what God spoke through the prophet long ago” (See: [[rc://*/ta/man/translate/figs-activepassive]])
21:4 x3up rc://*/ta/man/translate/figs-explicit διὰ τοῦ προφήτου 1 There were many prophets. Matthew was speaking of Zechariah. Alternate translation: “the prophet Zechariah” (See: [[rc://*/ta/man/translate/figs-explicit]])
21:5 whn7 τῇ θυγατρὶ Σιών 1 The “daughter” of a city means the people of the city. Alternate translation: “the people of Zion” or “the people who live in Zion”
21:5 jzz6 Σιών 1 This is another name for Jerusalem.
21:5 fx3v ἐπὶ ὄνον καὶ ἐπὶ πῶλον, υἱὸν ὑποζυγίου 1 The phrase “on a colt, the foal of a donkey” is explaining that the donkey is a young animal. Alternate translation: “on a young, male donkey”
21:7 y6en τὰ ἱμάτια 1 These were outer clothing or long coats.
21:8 t29s rc://*/ta/man/translate/figs-explicit ὄχλος ἔστρωσαν ἑαυτῶν τὰ ἱμάτια ἐν τῇ ὁδῷ; ἄλλοι δὲ ἔκοπτον κλάδους ἀπὸ τῶν δένδρων, καὶ ἐστρώννυον ἐν τῇ ὁδῷ 1 These are ways to show honor to Jesus as he was entering Jerusalem. (See: [[rc://*/ta/man/translate/figs-explicit]] and [[rc://*/ta/man/translate/translate-symaction]])
21:9 ky4c ὡσαννὰ 1 This word means “save us,” but it can also mean “praise God!”
21:9 ysb9 τῷ Υἱῷ Δαυείδ 1 Jesus was not Davids literal son, so this may be translated as “descendant of king David.” However, “Son of David” is also a title for the Messiah, and the crowd was probably calling Jesus by this title.
21:9 q52t rc://*/ta/man/translate/figs-metonymy ἐν ὀνόματι Κυρίου 1 Here “in the name” means “in the power” or “as a representative.” Alternate translation: “in the power of the Lord” or “as the representative of the Lord” (See: [[rc://*/ta/man/translate/figs-metonymy]])
21:9 g73z rc://*/ta/man/translate/figs-metonymy ὡσαννὰ ἐν τοῖς ὑψίστοις 1 Here “highest” refers to God who rules from the highest heaven. Alternate translation: “Praise God, who is in the highest heaven” or “Praise be to God” (See: [[rc://*/ta/man/translate/figs-metonymy]])
21:10 cb4h rc://*/ta/man/translate/figs-metonymy ἐσείσθη πᾶσα ἡ πόλις 1 Here “city” refers to the people living there. Alternate translation: “many people from all over the city were stirred” (See: [[rc://*/ta/man/translate/figs-metonymy]])
21:10 nqb2 ἐσείσθη 1 “excited”
21:12 q41c 0 In verse 13, Jesus quotes the prophet Isaiah to rebuke the vendors and money changers.
21:12 mc5v 0 This begins the account of Jesus entering into the temple.
21:12 y9j4 rc://*/ta/man/translate/figs-explicit εἰσῆλθεν Ἰησοῦς εἰς τὸ ἱερόν 1 Jesus did not enter the actual temple. He entered the courtyard around the temple. (See: [[rc://*/ta/man/translate/figs-explicit]])
21:12 w7ac τοὺς πωλοῦντας καὶ ἀγοράζοντας 1 Merchants were selling animals and other items that travelers bought to offer the proper sacrifices at the temple.
21:13 guy7 λέγει αὐτοῖς 1 “Jesus said to those who were changing money and buying and selling things”
21:13 m1jl rc://*/ta/man/translate/figs-activepassive γέγραπται 1 This can be stated in active form. Alternate translation: “The prophets wrote long ago” or “God said long ago” (See: [[rc://*/ta/man/translate/figs-activepassive]])
21:13 z8gr rc://*/ta/man/translate/figs-activepassive ὁ οἶκός μου & κληθήσεται 1 This can be stated in active form. Alternate translation: “My house will be” (See: [[rc://*/ta/man/translate/figs-activepassive]])
21:13 n9v8 ὁ οἶκός μου 1 Here “My” refers to God and “house” refers to the temple.
21:13 bd8x rc://*/ta/man/translate/figs-idiom οἶκος προσευχῆς 1 This is an idiom. Alternate translation: “a place where people pray” (See: [[rc://*/ta/man/translate/figs-idiom]])
21:13 c7l3 rc://*/ta/man/translate/figs-metaphor σπήλαιον λῃστῶν 1 Jesus uses a metaphor to scold the people for buying and selling items in the temple. Alternate translation: “like a place where robbers hide” (See: [[rc://*/ta/man/translate/figs-metaphor]])
21:14 rpp3 rc://*/ta/man/translate/figs-nominaladj τυφλοὶ καὶ χωλοὶ 1 These nominal adjectives can be stated as adjectives. Alternate translation: “those who were blind and those who were lame” (See: [[rc://*/ta/man/translate/figs-nominaladj]])
21:14 aku3 χωλοὶ 1 those who have an injured foot or leg that makes walking difficult
21:15 p7x2 0 In verse 16, Jesus quotes from the Psalms to justify how the people had responded to him.
21:15 hft8 τὰ θαυμάσια 1 “the wonderful things” or “the miracles.” This refers to Jesus healing the blind and lame people in [Matthew 21:14](../21/14.md).
21:15 fqr9 ὡσαννὰ 1 This word means “save us” but can also mean “praise God!” See how you translated this in [Matthew 21:9](../21/09.md).
21:15 c6k8 τῷ Υἱῷ Δαυείδ 1 Jesus was not Davids literal son, so this may be translated as “descendant of king David.” However, “Son of David” is also a title for the Messiah, and the children were probably calling Jesus by this title. See how you translated this in [Matthew 21:9](../21/09.md).
21:15 r3bs rc://*/ta/man/translate/figs-explicit ἠγανάκτησαν 1 It is implied that they were angry because they did not believe Jesus was the Christ and they did not want other people praising him. Alternate translation: “they became very angry because people were praising him” (See: [[rc://*/ta/man/translate/figs-explicit]])
21:16 zx4a rc://*/ta/man/translate/figs-rquestion ἀκούεις τί οὗτοι λέγουσιν? 1 The chief priests and scribes ask this question to rebuke Jesus because they are angry with him. Alternate translation: “You should not allow them to say these things about you!” (See: [[rc://*/ta/man/translate/figs-rquestion]])
21:16 luy1 rc://*/ta/man/translate/figs-rquestion οὐδέποτε ἀνέγνωτε & αἶνον? 1 Jesus asks this question to remind the chief priests and scribes of what they have studied in the scriptures. Alternate translation: “Yes, I hear them, but you should remember what you read in the scriptures … praise.’” (See: [[rc://*/ta/man/translate/figs-rquestion]])
21:16 qa9u rc://*/ta/man/translate/figs-metonymy ἐκ στόματος νηπίων καὶ θηλαζόντων, κατηρτίσω αἶνον 1 The phrase “out of the mouths” refers to speaking. Alternate translation: “You caused little children and nursing infants to prepare to give praise to God” (See: [[rc://*/ta/man/translate/figs-metonymy]])
21:17 kag5 καταλιπὼν αὐτοὺς 1 “Jesus left the chief priests and scribes”
21:18 l3bi 0 Jesus uses a fig tree to teach his disciples about faith and prayer.
21:18 q488 δὲ 1 This word is used here to mark a break in the main story line. Here Matthew explains that Jesus is hungry and that is why he stops at the fig tree.
21:19 h2la ἐξηράνθη 1 died and dried up
21:20 q81g rc://*/ta/man/translate/figs-rquestion πῶς παραχρῆμα ἐξηράνθη ἡ συκῆ? 1 The disciples use a question to emphasize how surprised they are. Alternate translation: “We are astonished that the fig tree has dried up so quickly!” (See: [[rc://*/ta/man/translate/figs-rquestion]])
21:20 sk1g ἐξηράνθη 1 “dry up and die”
21:21 nd3y ἀμὴν, λέγω ὑμῖν 1 “I tell you the truth.” This phrase adds emphasis to what Jesus says next.
21:21 mwl5 rc://*/ta/man/translate/figs-doublet ἐὰν ἔχητε πίστιν καὶ μὴ διακριθῆτε 1 Jesus expresses the same idea both positively and negatively to emphasize that this faith must be genuine. Alternate translation: “if you truly believe” (See: [[rc://*/ta/man/translate/figs-doublet]])
21:21 jf9h rc://*/ta/man/translate/figs-quotations κἂν τῷ ὄρει τούτῳ εἴπητε, ἄρθητι καὶ βλήθητι εἰς τὴν θάλασσαν 1 You can translate this direct quotation as an indirect quotation. This can also be stated in active form. Alternate translation: “you will even be able to tell this mountain to get up and throw itself into the sea” (See: [[rc://*/ta/man/translate/figs-quotations]] and [[rc://*/ta/man/translate/figs-activepassive]])
21:21 nxi3 rc://*/ta/man/translate/figs-activepassive γενήσεται 1 This can be stated in active form. Alternate translation: “it will happen” (See: [[rc://*/ta/man/translate/figs-activepassive]])
21:23 yi7j 0 This begins the account of the religious leaders questioning Jesus authority.
21:23 uge9 rc://*/ta/man/translate/figs-explicit ἐλθόντος αὐτοῦ εἰς τὸ ἱερὸν 1 It is implied that Jesus did not enter the actual temple. He entered the courtyard around the temple. (See: [[rc://*/ta/man/translate/figs-explicit]])
21:23 s1w6 ταῦτα 1 This refers to Jesus teaching and healing in the temple. It probably also refers to Jesus driving out the buyers and sellers the previous day.
21:25 dau4 0 Jesus continues to respond to the religious leaders.
21:25 k1a7 πόθεν ἦν? 1 “where did he get the authority to do that?”
21:25 vvt5 rc://*/ta/man/translate/figs-quotesinquotes ἐὰν εἴπωμεν, ἐξ οὐρανοῦ, ἐρεῖ ἡμῖν, διὰ τί οὖν οὐκ ἐπιστεύσατε αὐτῷ? 1 This has quotes within a quote. You could translate the direct quotations as an indirect quotations. Alternate translation: “If we say that we believe John received his authority from heaven, then Jesus will ask us why we did not believe John.” (See: [[rc://*/ta/man/translate/figs-quotesinquotes]] and [[rc://*/ta/man/translate/figs-quotations]])
21:25 xx3b rc://*/ta/man/translate/figs-metonymy ἐξ οὐρανοῦ 1 Here “heaven” refers to God. Alternate translation: “from God in heaven” (See: [[rc://*/ta/man/translate/figs-metonymy]])
21:25 jmg7 rc://*/ta/man/translate/figs-rquestion διὰ τί οὖν οὐκ ἐπιστεύσατε αὐτῷ? 1 The religious leaders know that Jesus could scold them with this rhetorical question. Alternate translation: “Then you should have believed John the Baptist” (See: [[rc://*/ta/man/translate/figs-rquestion]])
21:26 zxn4 rc://*/ta/man/translate/figs-quotesinquotes ἐὰν δὲ εἴπωμεν, ἐξ ἀνθρώπων, 1 This is a quote within a quote. You could translate the direct quotation as an indirect quotation. Alternate translation: “But if we say that we believe John received his authority from men” (See: [[rc://*/ta/man/translate/figs-quotesinquotes]] and [[rc://*/ta/man/translate/figs-quotations]])
21:26 vn6j φοβούμεθα τὸν ὄχλον 1 “we fear what the crowd would think or even do to us”
21:26 q1r1 πάντες & ὡς προφήτην ἔχουσιν τὸν Ἰωάννην 1 “they believe John is a prophet”
21:28 u56n rc://*/ta/man/translate/figs-parables 0 Jesus tells a parable about two sons to rebuke the religious leaders and to illustrate their unbelief. (See: [[rc://*/ta/man/translate/figs-parables]])
21:28 iem2 rc://*/ta/man/translate/figs-rquestion τί δὲ ὑμῖν δοκεῖ 1 Jesus uses a question to challenge the religious leaders to think deeply about the parable he will tell them. Alternate translation: “Tell me what you think about what I am about to tell you.” (See: [[rc://*/ta/man/translate/figs-rquestion]])
21:29 b96z rc://*/ta/man/translate/figs-metaphor μεταμεληθεὶς 1 This refers to the son reconsidering his thoughts and deciding to act differently from how he had said he would act. (See: [[rc://*/ta/man/translate/figs-metaphor]])
21:31 hl72 λέγουσιν 1 “The chief priests and elders said”
21:31 au13 λέγει αὐτοῖς ὁ Ἰησοῦς 1 “Jesus said to the chief priests and elders”
21:31 er5s ἀμὴν, λέγω ὑμῖν 1 “I tell you the truth.” This phrase adds emphasis to what Jesus says next.
21:31 ec9f rc://*/ta/man/translate/figs-metonymy οἱ τελῶναι καὶ αἱ πόρναι προάγουσιν ὑμᾶς εἰς τὴν Βασιλείαν Θεοῦ 1 Here “kingdom of God” refers to Gods rule as king. Alternate translation: “when God establishes his rule on earth, he will agree to bless the tax collectors and prostitutes by ruling over them before he agrees to do that for you” (See: [[rc://*/ta/man/translate/figs-metonymy]])
21:31 pd34 προάγουσιν ὑμᾶς 1 Possible meanings are (1) God will accept the tax collectors and prostitutes sooner than he will accept the Jewish religious leaders, or (2) God will accept the tax collectors and prostitutes instead of the Jewish religious leaders.
21:32 a8z8 rc://*/ta/man/translate/figs-you ἦλθεν & Ἰωάννης πρὸς ὑμᾶς 1 Here “you” is plural and refers to all the people of Israel not just the religious leaders. Alternate translation: “John came to the people of Israel” (See: [[rc://*/ta/man/translate/figs-you]])
21:32 n2ve rc://*/ta/man/translate/figs-idiom ἐν ὁδῷ δικαιοσύνης 1 This is an idiom that means John showed the people the right way to live. Alternate translation: “and told you the way God wants you to live” (See: [[rc://*/ta/man/translate/figs-idiom]])
21:32 c5t4 rc://*/ta/man/translate/figs-you οὐκ ἐπιστεύσατε αὐτῷ 1 Here “you” is plural and refers to the religious leaders. (See: [[rc://*/ta/man/translate/figs-you]])
21:33 nn9y rc://*/ta/man/translate/figs-parables 0 To rebuke the religious leaders and illustrate their unbelief, Jesus tells a parable about rebellious servants. (See: [[rc://*/ta/man/translate/figs-parables]])
21:33 sx2y οἰκοδεσπότης 1 “a person who owned a piece of property”
21:33 v39u φραγμὸν 1 “a wall” or “a fence”
21:33 lg79 ὤρυξεν ἐν αὐτῷ ληνὸν 1 “dug a hole in the vineyard in which to press the grapes”
21:33 eu7x ἐξέδετο αὐτὸν γεωργοῖς 1 The owner still owned the vineyard, but he allowed the vine growers to take care of it. When the grapes became ripe, they were to give some of them to the owner and keep the rest.
21:33 vp8k γεωργοῖς 1 These were people who knew how to take care of vines and grapes.
21:35 hn3c rc://*/ta/man/translate/figs-parables 0 Jesus continues telling a parable. (See: [[rc://*/ta/man/translate/figs-parables]])
21:35 n1cq τοὺς δούλους αὐτοῦ 1 “the landowners servants”
21:38 a55y rc://*/ta/man/translate/figs-parables 0 Jesus continues telling a parable. (See: [[rc://*/ta/man/translate/figs-parables]])
21:40 x1ll οὖν 1 The word “now” does not mean “at this moment,” but it is used to draw attention to the important point that follows.
21:41 ss2m λέγουσιν αὐτῷ 1 Matthew does not make clear who answered Jesus. If you need to specify an audience you can translate as “The people said to Jesus.”
21:42 z9tm 0 Jesus quotes the prophet Isaiah to show that God will honor the one whom the religious leaders reject.
21:42 x8zh 0 Here Jesus begins to explain the parable of the rebellious servants.
21:42 kk7e λέγει αὐτοῖς ὁ Ἰησοῦς 1 It is unclear to whom Jesus asks the following question. If you need to make “them” specific, use the same audience as you did in [Matthew 21:41](../21/41.md).
21:42 me7g rc://*/ta/man/translate/figs-rquestion οὐδέποτε ἀνέγνωτε & ὀφθαλμοῖς ἡμῶν? 1 Jesus uses a question to make his audience think deeply about what this scripture means. Alternate translation: “Think about what you have read … eyes.’” (See: [[rc://*/ta/man/translate/figs-rquestion]])
21:42 mcm8 rc://*/ta/man/translate/figs-metaphor λίθον ὃν ἀπεδοκίμασαν οἱ οἰκοδομοῦντες, οὗτος ἐγενήθη εἰς κεφαλὴν γωνίας 1 Jesus is quoting from the Psalms. This is a metaphor that means the religious leaders, like builders, will reject Jesus, but God will make him the most important in his kingdom, like the cornerstone in a building. (See: [[rc://*/ta/man/translate/figs-metaphor]])
21:42 uid2 rc://*/ta/man/translate/figs-activepassive ἐγενήθη εἰς κεφαλὴν γωνίας 1 This can be stated in active form. Alternate translation: “has become the cornerstone” (See: [[rc://*/ta/man/translate/figs-activepassive]])
21:42 b1sr παρὰ Κυρίου ἐγένετο αὕτη 1 “The Lord has caused this great change”
21:42 el83 rc://*/ta/man/translate/figs-metonymy ἔστιν θαυμαστὴ ἐν ὀφθαλμοῖς ἡμῶν 1 Here “in our eyes” refers to seeing. Alternate translation: “it is wonderful to see” (See: [[rc://*/ta/man/translate/figs-metonymy]])
21:43 s93a λέγω ὑμῖν 1 This adds emphasis to what Jesus says next.
21:43 c7pb rc://*/ta/man/translate/figs-you ὑμῖν 1 Here “you” is plural. Jesus was speaking to the religious leaders who had rejected him. (See: [[rc://*/ta/man/translate/figs-you]])
21:43 v89z rc://*/ta/man/translate/figs-metonymy ἀρθήσεται ἀφ’ ὑμῶν ἡ Βασιλεία τοῦ Θεοῦ, καὶ δοθήσεται ἔθνει 1 Here “kingdom of God” refers to Gods rule as king. This can be stated in active form. Alternate translation: “God will take his kingdom away from you and will give it to a nation” or “God will reject you and he will be king over people from other nations” (See: [[rc://*/ta/man/translate/figs-metonymy]] and [[rc://*/ta/man/translate/figs-activepassive]])
21:43 cm2i rc://*/ta/man/translate/figs-metaphor ποιοῦντι τοὺς καρποὺς αὐτῆς 1 “Fruits” here is a metaphor for “results” or outcome.” Alternate translation: “that produces good results” (See: [[rc://*/ta/man/translate/figs-metaphor]])
21:44 r7up rc://*/ta/man/translate/figs-metaphor ὁ πεσὼν ἐπὶ τὸν λίθον τοῦτον, συνθλασθήσεται 1 Here, “this stone” is the same stone as in [Matthew 21:42](../21/42.md). This is a metaphor that means the Christ will destroy anyone who rebels against him. This can be stated in active form. Alternate translation: “The stone will break into pieces anyone who falls on it” (See: [[rc://*/ta/man/translate/figs-metaphor]] and [[rc://*/ta/man/translate/figs-activepassive]])
21:44 ghz2 rc://*/ta/man/translate/figs-parallelism ὃν δ’ ἂν πέσῃ, λικμήσει αὐτόν 1 This means basically the same thing as the previous sentence. It is a metaphor that means the Christ will have the final judgment and will destroy everyone who rebels against him. (See: [[rc://*/ta/man/translate/figs-parallelism]] and [[rc://*/ta/man/translate/figs-metaphor]])
21:45 gh8w 0 The religious leaders react to the parable that Jesus told.
21:45 qpy9 τὰς παραβολὰς αὐτοῦ 1 “Jesus parables”
22:intro k5ze 0 # Matthew 22 General Notes\n## Structure and formatting\n\nSome translations set each line of poetry farther to the right than the rest of the text to make it easier to read. The ULT does this with the poetry in verse 44, which are words from the Old Testament.\n\n## Special concepts in this chapter\n\n### Wedding Feast\n\nIn the parable of the wedding feast ([Matthew 22:1-14](./01.md)), Jesus taught that when God offers to save a person, that person needs to accept the offer. Jesus spoke of life with God as a feast that a king prepares for his son, who has just gotten married. In addition, Jesus emphasized that not everyone whom God invites will properly prepare themselves to come to the feast. God will throw these people out from the feast.\n\n## Other possible translation difficulties in this chapter\n\n### Implicit information\n\nSpeakers usually do not say things that they think their hearers already understand. When the king in the parable said, “My oxen and fattened calves have been killed” ([Matthew 22:4](../../mat/22/04.md)), he assumed that the hearers would understand that those who had killed the animals had also cooked them.\n\n### Paradox\n\nA paradox is a true statement that appears to describe something impossible. To the Jews, the ancestors were the masters of the descendants, but in one psalm David calls one of his descendants “Lord.” Jesus tells the Jewish leaders that this is a paradox, saying, “If David then calls the Christ Lord, how is he Davids son?” ([Matthew 22:45](../../mat/22/45.md)).
22:1 z8vz rc://*/ta/man/translate/figs-parables 0 To rebuke the religious leaders and to illustrate their unbelief, Jesus tells a parable about a marriage feast. (See: [[rc://*/ta/man/translate/figs-parables]])
22:1 bc6y αὐτοῖς 1 “to the people”
22:2 xps3 ὡμοιώθη ἡ Βασιλεία τῶν Οὐρανῶν 1 This is the beginning of a parable. See how you translated this in [Matthew 13:24](../13/24.md).
22:3 wur1 rc://*/ta/man/translate/figs-activepassive τοὺς κεκλημένους 1 This can be stated in active form. Alternate translation: “the people the king had invited” (See: [[rc://*/ta/man/translate/figs-activepassive]])
22:4 l896 rc://*/ta/man/translate/figs-parables 0 Jesus continues telling a parable. (See: [[rc://*/ta/man/translate/figs-parables]])
22:4 c7x4 rc://*/ta/man/translate/figs-quotations δούλους λέγων, εἴπατε τοῖς κεκλημένοις 1 This direct quotation can be stated as an indirect quotation. Also, this can be stated in active form. Alternate translation: “servants, ordering them to tell those whom he invited” (See: [[rc://*/ta/man/translate/figs-quotations]] and [[rc://*/ta/man/translate/figs-activepassive]])
22:4 iq6y ἰδοὺ 1 “Look” or “Listen” or “Pay attention to what I am about to tell you”
22:4 xu4t rc://*/ta/man/translate/figs-explicit οἱ ταῦροί μου καὶ τὰ σιτιστὰ τεθυμένα 1 It is implied that the animals are cooked and ready to eat. This can be stated in active form. Alternate translation: “My servants have killed and cooked my oxen and my fattened calves” (See: [[rc://*/ta/man/translate/figs-explicit]] and [[rc://*/ta/man/translate/figs-activepassive]])
22:4 c48a οἱ ταῦροί μου καὶ τὰ σιτιστὰ 1 “My best oxen and calves for eating”
22:5 e4fl rc://*/ta/man/translate/figs-parables 0 Jesus continues telling a parable. (See: [[rc://*/ta/man/translate/figs-parables]])
22:5 zu4c οἱ δὲ ἀμελήσαντες 1 “But the guests the king invited ignored the invitation”
22:7 la7s rc://*/ta/man/translate/figs-explicit ἀπώλεσεν τοὺς φονεῖς ἐκείνους 1 It is implied that the kings soldiers killed the murderers. (See: [[rc://*/ta/man/translate/figs-explicit]])
22:8 u2ax rc://*/ta/man/translate/figs-parables 0 Jesus continues telling a parable. (See: [[rc://*/ta/man/translate/figs-parables]])
22:8 k98u rc://*/ta/man/translate/figs-activepassive οἱ & κεκλημένοι 1 This can be stated in active form. Alternate translation: “those whom I invited” (See: [[rc://*/ta/man/translate/figs-activepassive]])
22:9 p48s τὰς διεξόδους τῶν ὁδῶν 1 “where the main roads of the city cross.” The king is sending the servants to the place where they are most likely to find people.
22:10 uva7 πονηρούς τε καὶ ἀγαθούς 1 “both the good people and the bad people”
22:10 c6ph rc://*/ta/man/translate/figs-activepassive καὶ ἐπλήσθη ὁ γάμος ἀνακειμένων 1 This can be stated in active form. Alternate translation: “So the guests filled the wedding hall” (See: [[rc://*/ta/man/translate/figs-activepassive]])
22:10 fy3a ὁ γάμος 1 a large room
22:11 s8ga rc://*/ta/man/translate/figs-parables 0 Jesus continues telling a parable. (See: [[rc://*/ta/man/translate/figs-parables]])
22:12 c7iy rc://*/ta/man/translate/figs-rquestion πῶς εἰσῆλθες ὧδε μὴ ἔχων ἔνδυμα γάμου? 1 The king uses a question to scold the guest. Alternate translation: “you are not wearing proper clothes for a wedding. You should not be here.” (See: [[rc://*/ta/man/translate/figs-rquestion]])
22:12 w7vb ὁ & ἐφιμώθη 1 “the man was silent”
22:13 wt88 0 Jesus concludes his parable about a marriage feast.
22:13 jmp4 διακόνοις, δήσαντες αὐτοῦ πόδας καὶ χεῖρας 1 “Tie him up so that he cannot move his hands or feet”
22:13 rpy8 rc://*/ta/man/translate/figs-metonymy τὸ σκότος τὸ ἐξώτερον 1 Here “outer darkness” is a metonym for the place where God sends those who reject them. This is a place that is completely separated from God forever. See how you translated this in [Matthew 8:12](../08/12.md). Alternate translation: “the dark place away from God” (See: [[rc://*/ta/man/translate/figs-metonymy]])
22:13 s9ge rc://*/ta/man/translate/translate-symaction ὁ κλαυθμὸς καὶ ὁ βρυγμὸς τῶν ὀδόντων 1 “Grinding of teeth” is symbolic action, representing extreme sadness and suffering. See how you translated this in [Matthew 8:12](../08/12.md). Alternate translation: “weeping and expressing their extreme suffering” (See: [[rc://*/ta/man/translate/translate-symaction]])
22:14 hy3a rc://*/ta/man/translate/figs-activepassive πολλοὶ γάρ εἰσιν κλητοὶ, ὀλίγοι δὲ ἐκλεκτοί 1 This can be stated in active form. Alternate translation: “For God invites many people, but he only chooses a few” (See: [[rc://*/ta/man/translate/figs-activepassive]])
22:14 yz5f γάρ 1 This marks a transition. Jesus has ended the parable and will now explain the point of the parable.
22:15 y826 0 This begins an account of the religious leaders trying to trap Jesus with several difficult questions. Here the Pharisees ask him about paying taxes to Caesar.
22:15 u2mj ὅπως αὐτὸν παγιδεύσωσιν ἐν λόγῳ 1 “how they could cause Jesus to say something wrong so they could arrest him”
22:16 eae4 rc://*/ta/man/translate/figs-explicit τοὺς μαθητὰς αὐτῶν & τῶν Ἡρῳδιανῶν 1 The disciples of the Pharisees supported paying taxes only to Jewish authorities. The Herodians supported paying taxes to the Roman authorities. It is implied that the Pharisees believed that no matter what Jesus said, he would offend one of these groups. (See: [[rc://*/ta/man/translate/figs-explicit]])
22:16 rf66 rc://*/ta/man/translate/translate-names Ἡρῳδιανῶν 1 These were officials and followers of the Jewish king Herod. He was friends with Roman authorities. (See: [[rc://*/ta/man/translate/translate-names]])
22:16 t2qa οὐ γὰρ βλέπεις εἰς πρόσωπον ἀνθρώπων 1 “you do not show special honor to anyone” or “you do not consider anyone more important than anyone else”
22:17 a9by rc://*/ta/man/translate/figs-explicit δοῦναι κῆνσον Καίσαρι 1 People did not pay taxes directly to Caesar but to one of his tax collectors. Alternate translation: “to pay the taxes that Caesar requires” (See: [[rc://*/ta/man/translate/figs-explicit]])
22:18 a2ti rc://*/ta/man/translate/figs-rquestion τί με πειράζετε, ὑποκριταί? 1 Jesus uses a question to scold those who were trying to trap him. Alternate translation: “Do not test me, you hypocrites!” or “I know that you hypocrites are only trying to test me!” (See: [[rc://*/ta/man/translate/figs-rquestion]])
22:19 cie7 rc://*/ta/man/translate/translate-bmoney δηνάριον 1 This was a Roman coin worth one days wages. (See: [[rc://*/ta/man/translate/translate-bmoney]])
22:20 ue7j αὐτοῖς 1 Here “them” refers to the Herodians and the disciples of the Pharisees.
22:20 dr3d rc://*/ta/man/translate/figs-rquestion τίνος ἡ εἰκὼν αὕτη καὶ ἡ ἐπιγραφή? 1 Jesus uses a question to get the people to think deeply about what he is saying. Alternate translation: “Tell me whose image and name you see on this coin.” (See: [[rc://*/ta/man/translate/figs-rquestion]])
22:21 yd84 rc://*/ta/man/translate/figs-ellipsis Καίσαρος 1 You can make clear the understood information in their response. Alternate translation: “The coin has Caesars image and name on it” (See: [[rc://*/ta/man/translate/figs-ellipsis]])
22:21 i6g5 τὰ Καίσαρος 1 “things that belong to Caesar”
22:21 l3dh τὰ τοῦ Θεοῦ 1 “things that belong to God”
22:23 wqg2 0 The Sadducees try to trap Jesus by asking him a difficult question about marriage and the resurrection of the dead.
22:24 xl5f rc://*/ta/man/translate/figs-quotesinquotes Διδάσκαλε, Μωϋσῆς εἶπεν, ἐάν τις ἀποθάνῃ 1 The religious leaders were asking Jesus about what Moses had written in the scriptures. If your language does not allow quotes within quotes, this could be stated as an indirect quote. Alternate translation: “Teacher, Moses said that if a man dies” (See: [[rc://*/ta/man/translate/figs-quotesinquotes]] and [[rc://*/ta/man/translate/figs-quotations]])
22:24 u7dm τῷ ἀδελφῷ αὐτοῦ & τὴν γυναῖκα αὐτοῦ & τῷ ἀδελφῷ αὐτοῦ 1 Here “his” refers to the dead man.
22:25 kjf5 0 The Sadducees continue asking Jesus a question.
22:25 ag5z rc://*/ta/man/translate/translate-ordinal ὁ πρῶτος 1 “The oldest” (See: [[rc://*/ta/man/translate/translate-ordinal]])
22:26 r6bq rc://*/ta/man/translate/translate-ordinal ὁ δεύτερος & ὁ τρίτος & τῶν ἑπτά 1 “the next oldest … the next oldest … the youngest” or “his oldest younger brother … that brothers oldest younger brother … the youngest” (See: [[rc://*/ta/man/translate/translate-ordinal]])
22:27 t7md ὕστερον & πάντων 1 “After every brother had died”
22:28 wbd1 οὖν 1 Here the Sadducees shift from the story about the seven brothers to their actual question.
22:28 s743 ἐν τῇ ἀναστάσει 1 “when dead people come back to life”
22:29 p1ae rc://*/ta/man/translate/figs-explicit πλανᾶσθε 1 It is implied that Jesus means that they are mistaken about what they think about the resurrection. Alternate translation: “You are mistaken about the resurrection” (See: [[rc://*/ta/man/translate/figs-explicit]])
22:29 dax6 τὴν δύναμιν τοῦ Θεοῦ 1 “what God is able to do”
22:30 ygr1 ἐν & τῇ ἀναστάσει 1 “when dead people rise back to life”
22:30 uaj9 οὔτε γαμοῦσιν 1 “people will not marry”
22:30 qkv1 rc://*/ta/man/translate/figs-activepassive οὔτε γαμίζονται 1 This can be stated in active form. Alternate translation: “nor will people give their children in marriage” (See: [[rc://*/ta/man/translate/figs-activepassive]])
22:31 nx66 0 Jesus begins asking a question to show that people who have died will live again.
22:31 b9sy rc://*/ta/man/translate/figs-rquestion οὐκ ἀνέγνωτε & τοῦ Θεοῦ λέγοντος 1 Jesus scolds the Sadducees by asking a question. He is not looking for an answer. Alternate translation: “I know you have read … God. You know that he said,” (See: [[rc://*/ta/man/translate/figs-rquestion]])
22:31 ljj7 rc://*/ta/man/translate/figs-activepassive τὸ ῥηθὲν ὑμῖν ὑπὸ τοῦ Θεοῦ 1 This can be stated in active form. Alternate translation: “what God spoke to you” (See: [[rc://*/ta/man/translate/figs-activepassive]])
22:32 zb7a 0 Jesus finishes asking the question he began in verse 31.
22:32 qcq3 rc://*/ta/man/translate/figs-quotations ἐγώ εἰμι ὁ Θεὸς & Ἰακώβ? 1 This is the end of the question that begins with the words “have you not read” in verse 31. Jesus asks this question to remind the religious leaders of what they know from scripture. “I know you have read it, but you do not seem to understand what … Jacob.’” You can translate this direct quotation as an indirect quotation. “God, who said to Moses that he is the God of Abraham, the God of Isaac, and the God of Jacob.” (See: [[rc://*/ta/man/translate/figs-quotations]] and [[rc://*/ta/man/translate/figs-rquestion]])
22:32 t7lv rc://*/ta/man/translate/figs-nominaladj νεκρῶν, ἀλλὰ ζώντων 1 These nominal adjectives can be stated as adjectives. Alternate translation: “of dead people, but he is the God of living people” (See: [[rc://*/ta/man/translate/figs-nominaladj]])
22:34 jnd7 0 A Pharisee who was an expert in the law tries to trap Jesus by asking him a difficult question about the greatest commandment.
22:35 ud5r νομικὸς 1 “an expert in the law.” This is a Pharisee who had special skill in understanding the law of Moses.
22:37 vng8 0 Jesus quotes a verse from Deuteronomy as the greatest commandment.
22:37 xl3e rc://*/ta/man/translate/figs-metonymy ἐν ὅλῃ τῇ καρδίᾳ σου, καὶ ἐν ὅλῃ τῇ ψυχῇ σου, καὶ ἐν ὅλῃ τῇ διανοίᾳ σου 1 These three phrases are used together to mean “completely” or “earnestly.” Here “heart” and “soul” are metonyms for a persons inner being. (See: [[rc://*/ta/man/translate/figs-metonymy]] and [[rc://*/ta/man/translate/figs-doublet]])
22:38 q8j3 rc://*/ta/man/translate/figs-doublet ἡ μεγάλη καὶ πρώτη ἐντολή 1 Here “great” and “first” mean the same thing. They emphasize that this is the most important commandment. (See: [[rc://*/ta/man/translate/figs-doublet]])
22:39 xk1k 0 Jesus quotes a verse from Leviticus as the second greatest commandment.
22:39 yx7v τὸν πλησίον σου 1 Here “neighbor” means more than just those who live nearby. Jesus means a person must love all people.
22:40 wpr8 rc://*/ta/man/translate/figs-metonymy ἐν ταύταις ταῖς δυσὶν ἐντολαῖς, ὅλος ὁ νόμος κρέμαται καὶ οἱ προφῆται 1 Here the phrase “the whole law and the prophets” refers to all of scripture. Alternate translation: “Everything that Moses and the prophets wrote in the scriptures is based on these two commandments” (See: [[rc://*/ta/man/translate/figs-metonymy]])
22:41 r9ca 0 Jesus asks the Pharisees a difficult question in order to stop their attempts to trap him.
22:41 pj4a δὲ 1 This word is used here to mark a break in the main story line. Here Matthew starts to tell a new part of the story when Jesus asks the religious leaders a question.
22:42 xlf8 υἱός & τοῦ Δαυείδ 1 In both of these “son” means “descendant.”
22:43 dpp5 0 Jesus quotes from the Psalms to show that the Christ is more than just “the son of David.”
22:43 cu3h rc://*/ta/man/translate/figs-rquestion πῶς οὖν Δαυεὶδ ἐν Πνεύματι καλεῖ Κύριον αὐτὸν 1 Jesus uses a question to make the religious leaders think deeply about the Psalm he is about to quote. Alternate translation: “Then, tell me why David in the Spirit calls him Lord” (See: [[rc://*/ta/man/translate/figs-rquestion]])
22:43 yu5m Δαυεὶδ ἐν Πνεύματι 1 “David, whom the Holy Spirit is inspiring.” This means the Holy Spirit is influencing what David says.
22:43 dn9y καλεῖ & αὐτὸν 1 Here “him” refers to the Christ, who is also the descendant of David.
22:44 wy85 εἶπεν Κύριος 1 Here “Lord” refers to God the Father.
22:44 k3f7 τῷ Κυρίῳ μου 1 Here “Lord” refers to the Christ. Also, “my” refers to David. This means the Christ is superior to David.
22:44 dz2a rc://*/ta/man/translate/translate-symaction κάθου ἐκ δεξιῶν μου 1 To sit at the “right hand of God” is a symbolic action of receiving great honor and authority from God. Alternate translation: “Sit in the place of honor beside me” (See: [[rc://*/ta/man/translate/translate-symaction]])
22:44 e59n rc://*/ta/man/translate/figs-idiom ἕως ἂν θῶ τοὺς ἐχθρούς σου ὑποκάτω τῶν ποδῶν σου 1 This is an idiom. Alternate translation: “until I conquer your enemies” or “until I make your enemies bow down before you” (See: [[rc://*/ta/man/translate/figs-idiom]])
22:45 l962 0 This is the end of the part of the story that began in [Matthew 19:1](../19/01.md), that tells of Jesus ministering in Judea.
22:45 e2wd 0 This is the end of the account of the religious leaders trying to trap Jesus with several difficult questions.
22:45 d8gl rc://*/ta/man/translate/figs-rquestion εἰ οὖν Δαυεὶδ καλεῖ αὐτὸν, Κύριον, πῶς υἱὸς αὐτοῦ ἐστιν? 1 Jesus uses a question to make the religious leaders think deeply about what he is saying. Alternate translation: “David calls him Lord, so the Christ has to be more than just a descendant of David.” (See: [[rc://*/ta/man/translate/figs-rquestion]])
22:45 x9uh εἰ οὖν Δαυεὶδ καλεῖ αὐτὸν, Κύριον, πῶς υἱὸς αὐτοῦ ἐστιν? 1 David referred to Jesus as “Lord” because Jesus was not only a descendant of David, but he was also superior to him.
22:46 n3hw rc://*/ta/man/translate/figs-metonymy ἀποκριθῆναι αὐτῷ λόγον 1 Here “word” refers to what people say. Alternate translation: “to answer him anything” or “to answer him” (See: [[rc://*/ta/man/translate/figs-metonymy]])
22:46 c1f2 rc://*/ta/man/translate/figs-explicit ἐπερωτῆσαι αὐτὸν οὐκέτι 1 It is implied that no one asked him the kind of questions that were intended to make him say something wrong so the religious leaders could arrest him. (See: [[rc://*/ta/man/translate/figs-explicit]])
23:intro m99i 0 # Matthew 23 General Notes\n## Special concepts in this chapter\n\n### Hypocrites\n\nJesus calls the Pharisees hypocrites many times ([Matthew 23:13](../../mat/23/13.md)) and carefully tells what he means by doing that. The Pharisees made rules that no one could actually obey, and then they persuaded the ordinary people that they were guilty because they could not obey the rules. Also, the Pharisees obeyed their own rules instead of obeying Gods original commands in the law of Moses.\n\n## Other possible translation difficulties in this chapter\n\n### Name calling\n\nIn most cultures, it is wrong to insult people. The Pharisees took many of the words in this chapter as insults. Jesus called them “hypocrites,” “blind guides,” “fools,” and “serpents” ([Matthew 23:16-17](./16.md)). Jesus uses these words say that God would surely punish them because they were doing wrong.\n\n### Paradox\n\nA paradox is a true statement that appears to describe something impossible. Jesus uses a paradox when he says, “He who is greatest among you will be your servant” ([Matthew 23:11-12](./11.md)).
23:1 skq4 0 This is the beginning of a new part of the story that runs through [Matthew 25:46](../25/46.md), where Jesus teaches about salvation and the final judgment. Here he begins to warn the people about the scribes and Pharisees.
23:2 dnu3 rc://*/ta/man/translate/figs-metonymy ἐπὶ τῆς Μωϋσέως καθέδρας ἐκάθισαν 1 Here “seat” represents the authority to rule and make judgments. Alternate translation: “have authority as Moses had” or “have authority to say what the law of Moses means” (See: [[rc://*/ta/man/translate/figs-metonymy]])
23:3 q336 πάντα οὖν ὅσα ἐὰν & ποιήσατε, καὶ τηρεῖτε 1 “all the things … do them and observe them” or “everything … do it and observe it”
23:4 xce6 rc://*/ta/man/translate/figs-metaphor δεσμεύουσιν δὲ φορτία βαρέα καὶ δυσβάστακτα, καὶ ἐπιτιθέασιν ἐπὶ τοὺς ὤμους τῶν ἀνθρώπων; αὐτοὶ δὲ τῷ δακτύλῳ αὐτῶν οὐ θέλουσιν κινῆσαι αὐτά 1 Here “bind heavy burdens … put them on peoples shoulders” is a metaphor for the religious leaders making many difficult rules and making the people obey them. And “will not move a finger” is an idiom that means the religious leaders will not help the people. Alternate translation: “they make you obey many rules that are difficult to follow. But they do nothing at all to help the people follow the rules” (See: [[rc://*/ta/man/translate/figs-metaphor]] and [[rc://*/ta/man/translate/figs-idiom]])
23:5 nw4y rc://*/ta/man/translate/figs-activepassive πάντα δὲ τὰ ἔργα αὐτῶν, ποιοῦσιν πρὸς τὸ θεαθῆναι τοῖς ἀνθρώποις 1 This can be stated in active form. Alternate translation: “They do all their deeds so that people can see what they do” (See: [[rc://*/ta/man/translate/figs-activepassive]])
23:5 ln6j rc://*/ta/man/translate/figs-explicit πλατύνουσι γὰρ τὰ φυλακτήρια αὐτῶν καὶ μεγαλύνουσι τὰ κράσπεδα 1 Both of these are things the Pharisees do to appear as if they honor God more than other people. (See: [[rc://*/ta/man/translate/figs-explicit]])
23:5 gcv7 φυλακτήρια 1 small leather boxes containing paper with scripture written on it
23:5 h2qj μεγαλύνουσι τὰ κράσπεδα 1 The Pharisees made the tassels on the bottom of their robes especially long to show their devotion to God.
23:6 i6ec 0 Jesus continues speaking to the crowds and disciples about the Pharisees.
23:6 arf1 τὴν πρωτοκλισίαν & τὰς πρωτοκαθεδρίας 1 Both of these are the places where the most important people sit.
23:7 cp2m ταῖς ἀγοραῖς 1 large, open-air areas where people buy and sell items
23:7 cbe8 rc://*/ta/man/translate/figs-activepassive καλεῖσθαι ὑπὸ τῶν ἀνθρώπων, Ῥαββεί 1 This can be stated in active form. Alternate translation: “for people to call them Rabbi.’” (See: [[rc://*/ta/man/translate/figs-activepassive]])
23:8 uk5v rc://*/ta/man/translate/figs-activepassive ὑμεῖς δὲ μὴ κληθῆτε 1 This can be stated in active form. Alternate translation: “But you must not let anyone call you” (See: [[rc://*/ta/man/translate/figs-activepassive]])
23:8 ru2b rc://*/ta/man/translate/figs-you ὑμεῖς 1 All occurrences of “you” are plural and refer to all of Jesus followers. (See: [[rc://*/ta/man/translate/figs-you]])
23:8 s5du ὑμεῖς ἀδελφοί ἐστε 1 Here “brothers” means “fellow believers.”
23:9 l33f rc://*/ta/man/translate/figs-hyperbole Πατέρα μὴ καλέσητε ὑμῶν ἐπὶ τῆς γῆς 1 Jesus is using hyperbole to tell his hearers that they must not allow even the most important people to be more important to them than God is. Alternate translation: “do not call any man on earth your father” or “do not say that any man on earth is your father” (See: [[rc://*/ta/man/translate/figs-hyperbole]])
23:9 any8 rc://*/ta/man/translate/guidelines-sonofgodprinciples εἷς γάρ ἐστιν ὑμῶν ὁ Πατὴρ 1 “Father” here is an important title for God. (See: [[rc://*/ta/man/translate/guidelines-sonofgodprinciples]])
23:10 b8ua rc://*/ta/man/translate/figs-activepassive μηδὲ κληθῆτε 1 This can be stated in active form. Alternate translation: “Also, do not let anyone call you” (See: [[rc://*/ta/man/translate/figs-activepassive]])
23:10 lp5f rc://*/ta/man/translate/figs-123person ὅτι καθηγητὴς ὑμῶν ἐστιν εἷς, ὁ Χριστός 1 When Jesus said “the Christ,” he was speaking about himself in the third person. Alternate translation: “I, the Christ, am your only teacher” (See: [[rc://*/ta/man/translate/figs-123person]])
23:11 d62b ὁ & μείζων ὑμῶν 1 “the person who is most important among you”
23:11 d9xw rc://*/ta/man/translate/figs-you ὑμῶν 1 Here “you” is plural and refers to Jesus followers. (See: [[rc://*/ta/man/translate/figs-you]])
23:12 x187 ὑψώσει ἑαυτὸν 1 “makes himself important”
23:12 e81r rc://*/ta/man/translate/figs-activepassive ταπεινωθήσεται 1 This can be stated in active form. Alternate translation: “God will humble” (See: [[rc://*/ta/man/translate/figs-activepassive]])
23:12 uz88 rc://*/ta/man/translate/figs-activepassive ὑψωθήσεται 1 This can be stated in active form. Alternate translation: “God will make important” or “God will honor” (See: [[rc://*/ta/man/translate/figs-activepassive]])
23:13 ts6z rc://*/ta/man/translate/figs-metaphor 0 Jesus speaks of the kingdom of heaven as if it were a house, the door into which the Pharisees have shut from the outside so that neither they nor anyone else can enter the house. If you do not keep the metaphor of the house, be sure to change all instances of “shut” and “enter.” Also, since the words “kingdom of heaven,” which refer to God, who lives in heaven, occur only in Matthew, try to use your languages word for “heaven” in your translation. (See: [[rc://*/ta/man/translate/figs-metaphor]] and [[rc://*/ta/man/translate/figs-metonymy]])
23:13 aw49 0 Jesus begins to rebuke the religious leaders because of their hypocrisy.
23:13 i9dq οὐαὶ δὲ ὑμῖν 1 “How terrible it will be for you!” See how you translated this in [Matthew 11:21](../11/21.md).
23:13 j4sd rc://*/ta/man/translate/figs-metaphor κλείετε τὴν Βασιλείαν τῶν Οὐρανῶν ἔμπροσθεν τῶν ἀνθρώπων; ὑμεῖς γὰρ οὐκ εἰσέρχεσθε, οὐδὲ τοὺς εἰσερχομένους ἀφίετε εἰσελθεῖν 1 Jesus is speaking of the kingdom of heaven, which is God ruling over his people, as if it were a house, the door into which the Pharisees have shut from the outside so that neither they nor anyone else can enter the house. The phrase “kingdom of heaven” is found only in the book of Matthew. If possible, use your languages word for “heaven” in your translation. Alternate translation: “You make it impossible for people to enter the kingdom of heaven … you do not enter it … neither do you allow those about to enter to do so” or “You prevent people from accepting God, who lives in heaven, as king … you do not accept him as king … and you make it impossible for those about to accept him as king to do so” (See: [[rc://*/ta/man/translate/figs-metaphor]] and [[rc://*/ta/man/translate/figs-metonymy]])
23:15 e4a8 rc://*/ta/man/translate/figs-idiom περιάγετε τὴν θάλασσαν καὶ τὴν ξηρὰν 1 This is an idiom that means they go to distant places. Alternate translation: “you travel great distances” (See: [[rc://*/ta/man/translate/figs-idiom]])
23:15 iyl7 ποιῆσαι ἕνα προσήλυτον 1 “to make one person accept your religion”
23:15 bq91 rc://*/ta/man/translate/figs-idiom υἱὸν Γεέννης 1 Here “son of” is an idiom that means “one belonging to.” Alternate translation: “person who belongs in hell” or “person who should go to hell” (See: [[rc://*/ta/man/translate/figs-idiom]])
23:16 r5k3 rc://*/ta/man/translate/figs-metaphor ὁδηγοὶ τυφλοὶ 1 The Jewish leaders were spiritually blind. Although they thought of themselves as teachers, they were unable to understand Gods truth. See how you translated “blind guides” in [Matthew 15:14](../15/14.md). (See: [[rc://*/ta/man/translate/figs-metaphor]])
23:16 qgh8 ἐν τῷ ναῷ, οὐδέν ἐστιν 1 “by the temple does not have to keep his oath”
23:16 lni3 rc://*/ta/man/translate/figs-metaphor ὀφείλει 1 “is tied to his oath.” The phrase “bound to his oath” is a metaphor for being required to do what one has said he would do in an oath. Alternate translation: “must do what he promised to do” (See: [[rc://*/ta/man/translate/figs-metaphor]])
23:17 s7a8 rc://*/ta/man/translate/figs-metaphor μωροὶ καὶ τυφλοί! 1 The Jewish leaders were spiritually blind. Although they thought of themselves as teachers, they were unable to understand Gods truth. (See: [[rc://*/ta/man/translate/figs-metaphor]])
23:17 f9zd rc://*/ta/man/translate/figs-rquestion τίς γὰρ μείζων ἐστίν, ὁ χρυσὸς ἢ ὁ ναὸς ὁ ἁγιάσας τὸν χρυσόν? 1 Jesus uses this question to rebuke the Pharisees because they treated the gold as if it were more important than the temple. Alternate translation: “The temple that has dedicated the gold to God is more important than the gold!” (See: [[rc://*/ta/man/translate/figs-rquestion]])
23:17 j6d5 ὁ ναὸς ὁ ἁγιάσας τὸν χρυσόν 1 “the temple that makes the gold belong to God alone”
23:18 lr61 rc://*/ta/man/translate/figs-ellipsis καί 1 The understood information can be made clear. Alternate translation: “And you also say” (See: [[rc://*/ta/man/translate/figs-ellipsis]])
23:18 d331 οὐδέν ἐστιν 1 “he does not have to do what he has sworn to do” or “he does not have to keep his oath”
23:18 ngd2 τῷ δώρῳ 1 This is an animal or grain that a person would bring to God by putting it on Gods altar.
23:18 zg72 rc://*/ta/man/translate/figs-metaphor ὀφείλει 1 “is tied to his oath.” Being required to do what one has said he would do in an oath is spoken of as if he is tied to the oath. Alternate translation: “must do what he promised to do” (See: [[rc://*/ta/man/translate/figs-metaphor]])
23:19 y6hk rc://*/ta/man/translate/figs-metaphor τυφλοί 1 The Jewish leaders were spiritually blind. Although they thought of themselves as teachers, they were unable to understand Gods truth. (See: [[rc://*/ta/man/translate/figs-metaphor]])
23:19 g7qr rc://*/ta/man/translate/figs-rquestion τί γὰρ μεῖζον, τὸ δῶρον, ἢ τὸ θυσιαστήριον τὸ ἁγιάζον τὸ δῶρον? 1 Jesus uses this question to rebuke the Pharisees for treating the gift as if it were more important than the altar. Alternate translation: “The altar that makes the gift holy is greater than the gift!” (See: [[rc://*/ta/man/translate/figs-rquestion]])
23:19 gt4d τὸ θυσιαστήριον τὸ ἁγιάζον τὸ δῶρον 1 “the altar that makes the gift special to God”
23:20 x4q4 ἐν πᾶσι τοῖς ἐπάνω αὐτοῦ 1 “by all the gifts that people have placed on it”
23:21 m21b τῷ κατοικοῦντι αὐτόν 1 God the Father
23:22 ejw9 τῷ καθημένῳ ἐπάνω αὐτοῦ 1 God the Father
23:23 lg3r οὐαὶ ὑμῖν & ὑποκριταί! 1 “How terrible it will be for you … hypocrites!” See how you translated this in [Matthew 11:21](../11/21.md).
23:23 n94y rc://*/ta/man/translate/translate-unknown τὸ ἡδύοσμον, καὶ τὸ ἄνηθον, καὶ τὸ κύμινον 1 These are various leaves and seeds people used to make food taste good. (See: [[rc://*/ta/man/translate/translate-unknown]])
23:23 hga6 ἀφήκατε 1 “you have not obeyed”
23:23 c8bb τὰ βαρύτερα 1 “the more important matters”
23:23 m32j ταῦτα δὲ ἔδει ποιῆσαι 1 “You ought to have obeyed these more important laws”
23:23 nn6q rc://*/ta/man/translate/figs-doublenegatives κἀκεῖνα μὴ ἀφιέναι 1 This can be stated in positive form. Alternate translation: “while also obeying the less important laws” (See: [[rc://*/ta/man/translate/figs-doublenegatives]])
23:24 y84y rc://*/ta/man/translate/figs-metaphor ὁδηγοὶ τυφλοί! 1 Jesus uses this metaphor to describe the Pharisees. Jesus means that the Pharisees do not understand Gods commands or how to please him. Therefore, they cannot teach others how to please God. See how you translated this metaphor in [Matthew 15:14](../15/14.md). (See: [[rc://*/ta/man/translate/figs-metaphor]])
23:24 l7fh rc://*/ta/man/translate/figs-metaphor οἱ διϋλίζοντες τὸν κώνωπα τὴν δὲ κάμηλον καταπίνοντες! 1 Being careful to follow the less important laws and ignoring the more important laws is as foolish as being careful not to swallow the smallest unclean animal but eating the meat of the largest unclean animal. Alternate translation: “you are as foolish as a person who strains out a gnat that falls into his drink but swallows a camel” (See: [[rc://*/ta/man/translate/figs-metaphor]] and [[rc://*/ta/man/translate/figs-hyperbole]])
23:24 sn3z οἱ διϋλίζοντες τὸν κώνωπα 1 This means to pour a liquid through a cloth to remove a gnat from a drink.
23:24 whk2 κώνωπα 1 a small flying insect
23:25 ns27 οὐαὶ ὑμῖν & ὑποκριταί! 1 “How terrible it will be for you … hypocrites!” See how you translated this in [Matthew 11:21](../11/21.md).
23:25 ru45 rc://*/ta/man/translate/figs-metaphor ὅτι καθαρίζετε τὸ ἔξωθεν τοῦ ποτηρίου καὶ τῆς παροψίδος, ἔσωθεν δὲ γέμουσιν ἐξ ἁρπαγῆς καὶ ἀκρασίας 1 This is a metaphor that means the scribes and Pharisees appear pure on the outside to others, but on the inside they are wicked. (See: [[rc://*/ta/man/translate/figs-metaphor]])
23:25 tz8h γέμουσιν ἐξ ἁρπαγῆς καὶ ἀκρασίας 1 “they want what others have, and they act in the interest of the self”
23:26 lb5j rc://*/ta/man/translate/figs-metaphor Φαρισαῖε τυφλέ! 1 The Pharisees were spiritually blind. Although they thought of themselves as teachers, they were unable to understand Gods truth. (See: [[rc://*/ta/man/translate/figs-metaphor]])
23:26 f9p8 rc://*/ta/man/translate/figs-metaphor καθάρισον πρῶτον τὸ ἐντὸς τοῦ ποτηρίου καὶ τῆς παροψίδος, ἵνα γένηται καὶ τὸ ἐκτὸς & καθαρόν 1 This is a metaphor that means that if they would become pure in their inner being, then the result is that they would be pure on the outside as well. (See: [[rc://*/ta/man/translate/figs-metaphor]])
23:27 kry1 rc://*/ta/man/translate/figs-simile παρομοιάζετε τάφοις κεκονιαμένοις & ἀκαθαρσίας 1 This is a simile that means the scribes and Pharisees may appear to be pure on the outside, but they are wicked on the inside. (See: [[rc://*/ta/man/translate/figs-simile]])
23:27 ta1f rc://*/ta/man/translate/figs-explicit τάφοις κεκονιαμένοις 1 “tombs that someone has painted white.” The Jews would paint tombs white so that people would easily see them and avoid touching them. Touching a tomb would make a person ceremonially unclean. (See: [[rc://*/ta/man/translate/figs-explicit]])
23:29 tse6 rc://*/ta/man/translate/figs-nominaladj τῶν δικαίων 1 This nominal adjective can be stated as an adjective. Alternate translation: “of the righteous people” (See: [[rc://*/ta/man/translate/figs-nominaladj]])
23:30 kkf2 ἐν ταῖς ἡμέραις τῶν πατέρων ἡμῶν 1 “during the time of our forefathers”
23:30 nq82 οὐκ ἂν ἤμεθα κοινωνοὶ αὐτῶν 1 “we would not have joined with them”
23:30 x99m rc://*/ta/man/translate/figs-metonymy ἐν τῷ αἵματι τῶν 1 Here “blood” refers to life. To shed blood means to kill. Alternate translation: “killing” or “murdering” (See: [[rc://*/ta/man/translate/figs-metonymy]])
23:31 l7rl υἱοί ἐστε 1 Here “sons” means “descendants.”
23:32 bpz8 rc://*/ta/man/translate/figs-metaphor καὶ ὑμεῖς πληρώσατε τὸ μέτρον τῶν πατέρων ὑμῶν 1 Jesus uses this as a metaphor meaning the Pharisees will complete the wicked behavior that their forefathers started when they killed the prophets. Alternate translation: “You also finish the sins your ancestors began” (See: [[rc://*/ta/man/translate/figs-metaphor]])
23:33 va5c rc://*/ta/man/translate/figs-doublet ὄφεις, γεννήματα ἐχιδνῶν 1 Serpents are snakes, and vipers are poisonous snakes. They are dangerous and often symbols of evil. Alternate translation: “You are as evil as dangerous and poisonous snakes” (See: [[rc://*/ta/man/translate/figs-doublet]] and [[rc://*/ta/man/translate/figs-metaphor]])
23:33 blv6 γεννήματα ἐχιδνῶν 1 Here “offspring” means “having the characteristic of.” See how you translated a similar phrase in [Matthew 3:7](../03/07.md).
23:33 vi6c rc://*/ta/man/translate/figs-rquestion πῶς φύγητε ἀπὸ τῆς κρίσεως τῆς Γεέννης? 1 Jesus uses this question as a rebuke. Alternate translation: “there is no way for you to escape the judgment of hell!” (See: [[rc://*/ta/man/translate/figs-rquestion]])
23:34 an97 0 Jesus continues to rebuke the religious leaders because of their hypocrisy.
23:34 rq8c ἐγὼ ἀποστέλλω πρὸς ὑμᾶς προφήτας, καὶ σοφοὺς, καὶ γραμματεῖς 1 Sometimes the present tense is used to show that someone will do something very soon. Alternate translation: “I will send prophets, wise men, and scribes to you”
23:35 l7ya rc://*/ta/man/translate/figs-idiom ἔλθῃ ἐφ’ ὑμᾶς πᾶν αἷμα δίκαιον ἐκχυννόμενον ἐπὶ τῆς γῆς 1 The phrase “upon you will come” is an idiom that means to receive punishment. To shed blood is a metonym meaning to kill people, so “righteous blood that has been shed on the earth” represents righteous people who have been killed. Alternate translation: “God will punish you for the murders of all the righteous people” (See: [[rc://*/ta/man/translate/figs-idiom]] and [[rc://*/ta/man/translate/figs-metonymy]])
23:35 b3a7 rc://*/ta/man/translate/figs-metonymy ἀπὸ τοῦ αἵματος & ἕως τοῦ αἵματος 1 Here the word “blood” represents a person being killed. Alternate translation: “from the murder … to the murder” (See: [[rc://*/ta/man/translate/figs-metonymy]])
23:35 z95g rc://*/ta/man/translate/figs-merism Ἂβελ & Ζαχαρίου 1 Abel was the first righteous victim of murder, and Zechariah, who was murdered by Jews in the temple, was probably thought to be the last. These two men represent all the righteous people who have been murdered. (See: [[rc://*/ta/man/translate/figs-merism]])
23:35 cbq9 Ζαχαρίου 1 This Zechariah was not the father of John the Baptist.
23:35 s11l ὃν ἐφονεύσατε 1 Jesus does not mean the people to whom he is speaking actually killed Zechariah. He means their ancestors did.
23:36 ut4l ἀμὴν, λέγω ὑμῖν 1 “I tell you the truth.” This adds emphasis to what Jesus says next.
23:37 w23t 0 Jesus mourns over the people of Jerusalem because they reject every messenger that God sends to them.
23:37 vne9 rc://*/ta/man/translate/figs-apostrophe Ἰερουσαλὴμ, Ἰερουσαλήμ 1 Jesus speaks to the people of Jerusalem as though they were the city itself. (See: [[rc://*/ta/man/translate/figs-apostrophe]] and [[rc://*/ta/man/translate/figs-metonymy]])
23:37 tz4r rc://*/ta/man/translate/figs-activepassive τοὺς ἀπεσταλμένους πρὸς αὐτήν 1 This can be stated in active form. Alternate translation: “those whom God sends to you” (See: [[rc://*/ta/man/translate/figs-activepassive]])
23:37 t9y7 rc://*/ta/man/translate/figs-metaphor τὰ τέκνα σου 1 Jesus is speaking to Jerusalem as if it is a woman and the people are her children. Alternate translation: “your people” or “your inhabitants” (See: [[rc://*/ta/man/translate/figs-metaphor]])
23:37 xv4t rc://*/ta/man/translate/figs-simile ὃν τρόπον ὄρνις ἐπισυνάγει τὰ νοσσία αὐτῆς ὑπὸ τὰς πτέρυγας 1 This is a simile that emphasizes Jesus love for the people and how he wanted to take care of them. (See: [[rc://*/ta/man/translate/figs-simile]])
23:37 as8p rc://*/ta/man/translate/translate-unknown ὄρνις 1 a female chicken. You can translate with any bird that protects her children under her wing. (See: [[rc://*/ta/man/translate/translate-unknown]])
23:38 r6ss ἀφίεται ὑμῖν ὁ οἶκος ὑμῶν ἔρημος 1 “God will leave your house, and it will be empty”
23:38 ck2z rc://*/ta/man/translate/figs-metonymy ὁ οἶκος ὑμῶν 1 Possible meanings are (1) “the city of Jerusalem” or (2) “the temple.” (See: [[rc://*/ta/man/translate/figs-metonymy]])
23:39 i14n λέγω γὰρ ὑμῖν 1 This adds emphasis to what Jesus says next.
23:39 ig61 rc://*/ta/man/translate/figs-metonymy εὐλογημένος ὁ ἐρχόμενος ἐν ὀνόματι Κυρίου! 1 Here “in the name” means “in the power” or “as a representative.” See how you translated this in [Matthew 21:9](../21/09.md). Alternate translation: “He who comes in the power of the Lord is blessed” or “He who comes as the representative of the Lord will be blessed” (See: [[rc://*/ta/man/translate/figs-metonymy]])
24:intro h2a2 0 # Matthew 24 General Notes\n## Structure and formatting\n\nIn this chapter, Jesus begins to prophesy about the future from that time until he returns as king of everything. (See: [[rc://*/tw/dict/bible/kt/prophet]])\n\n## Special concepts in this chapter\n\n### “The end of the age”\n\nIn this chapter, Jesus gives an answer to his disciples when they ask how they will know when he will come again. (See: [[rc://*/ta/man/translate/writing-apocalypticwriting]])\n\n### The example of Noah\n\nIn the time of Noah, God sent a great flood to punish people for their sins. He warned them many times about this coming flood, but it actually began suddenly. In this chapter, Jesus draws a comparison between that flood and the last days. (See: [[rc://*/tw/dict/bible/kt/sin]])\n\n## Other possible translation difficulties in this chapter\n\n### “Let”\n\nThe ULT uses this word to begin several commands of Jesus, such as “let those who are in Judea flee to the mountains” (24:16), “let him who is on the housetop not go down to take anything out of his house” (24:17), and “let him who is in the field not return to take his cloak” (24:18). There are many different ways to form a command. Translators must select the most natural ways in their own languages.
24:1 dh7u 0 Jesus begins to describe events that will happen before he comes again during the end times.
24:1 ke79 rc://*/ta/man/translate/figs-explicit ἀπὸ τοῦ ἱεροῦ 1 It is implied that Jesus was not in the temple itself. He was in the courtyard around the temple. (See: [[rc://*/ta/man/translate/figs-explicit]])
24:2 mh5y rc://*/ta/man/translate/figs-rquestion οὐ βλέπετε ταῦτα πάντα? 1 Jesus uses a question to make the disciples think deeply about what he will tell them. Alternate translation: “Let me tell you something about all these buildings.” (See: [[rc://*/ta/man/translate/figs-rquestion]])
24:2 fnv8 ἀμὴν, λέγω ὑμῖν 1 “I tell you the truth.” This adds emphasis to what Jesus says next.
24:2 l45q rc://*/ta/man/translate/figs-explicit οὐ μὴ ἀφεθῇ ὧδε λίθος ἐπὶ λίθον, ὃς οὐ καταλυθήσεται 1 It is implied that enemy soldiers will tear down the stones. This can be stated in active form. Alternate translation: “when the enemy soldiers come, they will tear down every stone in these buildings” (See: [[rc://*/ta/man/translate/figs-explicit]] and [[rc://*/ta/man/translate/figs-activepassive]])
24:3 e1is rc://*/ta/man/translate/figs-explicit τί τὸ σημεῖον τῆς σῆς παρουσίας, καὶ συντελείας τοῦ αἰῶνος? 1 Here “your coming” refers to when Jesus will come in power, establishing Gods reign on earth and bringing this age to an end. Alternate translation: “What will be the sign that you are about to come and that the world is about to end” (See: [[rc://*/ta/man/translate/figs-explicit]])
24:4 s64s rc://*/ta/man/translate/figs-metaphor βλέπετε μή τις ὑμᾶς πλανήσῃ 1 Here “leads you astray” is a metaphor for persuading someone to believe something that is not true. Alternate translation: “Be careful that no one deceives you” (See: [[rc://*/ta/man/translate/figs-metaphor]])
24:5 lq71 rc://*/ta/man/translate/figs-metonymy πολλοὶ & ἐλεύσονται ἐπὶ τῷ ὀνόματί μου 1 Here “name” refers to “in the authority” or “as the representative” of someone. Alternate translation: “many will claim that they have come as my representative” or “many will say they speak for me” (See: [[rc://*/ta/man/translate/figs-metonymy]])
24:5 twh8 rc://*/ta/man/translate/figs-metaphor πολλοὺς πλανήσουσιν 1 Here “leads you astray” is a metaphor for persuading someone to believe something that is not true. Alternate translation: “will deceive many people” (See: [[rc://*/ta/man/translate/figs-metaphor]])
24:6 hdz3 rc://*/ta/man/translate/figs-activepassive ὁρᾶτε, μὴ θροεῖσθε 1 This can be stated in active form. Alternate translation: “Do not let these things trouble you” (See: [[rc://*/ta/man/translate/figs-activepassive]])
24:7 ygf2 rc://*/ta/man/translate/figs-parallelism ἐγερθήσεται γὰρ ἔθνος ἐπὶ ἔθνος, καὶ βασιλεία ἐπὶ βασιλείαν 1 Both of these mean the same thing. Jesus is emphasizing that people everywhere will fight each other. (See: [[rc://*/ta/man/translate/figs-parallelism]] and [[rc://*/ta/man/translate/figs-metonymy]])
24:8 q4gl rc://*/ta/man/translate/figs-metaphor ἀρχὴ ὠδίνων 1 This refers to the pains a woman feels before giving birth to a child. This metaphor means these wars, famines, and earthquakes are just the beginning of the events that will lead to the end of the age. (See: [[rc://*/ta/man/translate/figs-metaphor]])
24:9 u5e6 παραδώσουσιν ὑμᾶς εἰς θλῖψιν, καὶ ἀποκτενοῦσιν ὑμᾶς 1 “people will give you over to the authorities, who will make you suffer and will kill you.”
24:9 uw1i rc://*/ta/man/translate/figs-activepassive ἔσεσθε μισούμενοι ὑπὸ πάντων τῶν ἐθνῶν 1 Here “nations” is a metonym, referring to the people of nations. This can be stated in active form. Alternate translation: “People from every nation will hate you” (See: [[rc://*/ta/man/translate/figs-activepassive]] and [[rc://*/ta/man/translate/figs-metonymy]])
24:9 u2bd rc://*/ta/man/translate/figs-metonymy διὰ τὸ ὄνομά μου 1 Here “name” refers to the complete person. Alternate translation: “because you believe in me” (See: [[rc://*/ta/man/translate/figs-metonymy]])
24:11 mi2e rc://*/ta/man/translate/figs-idiom ἐγερθήσονται 1 “Rise” here is an idiom for “become established.” Alternate translation: “will come” (See: [[rc://*/ta/man/translate/figs-idiom]])
24:11 tjb3 rc://*/ta/man/translate/figs-metaphor καὶ πλανήσουσιν πολλούς 1 Here “lead … astray” is a metaphor for persuading someone to believe something that is not true. Alternate translation: “and deceive many people” (See: [[rc://*/ta/man/translate/figs-metaphor]])
24:12 w4af rc://*/ta/man/translate/figs-abstractnouns τὸ πληθυνθῆναι τὴν ἀνομίαν 1 The abstract noun “lawlessness” can be translated with the phrase “disobeying the law.” Alternate translation: “disobeying the law will increase” or “people will disobey Gods law more and more” (See: [[rc://*/ta/man/translate/figs-abstractnouns]])
24:12 bu9b rc://*/ta/man/translate/figs-idiom ψυγήσεται ἡ ἀγάπη τῶν πολλῶν 1 Possible meanings are (1) “many people will no longer love other people” or (2) “many people will no longer love God.” (See: [[rc://*/ta/man/translate/figs-idiom]])
24:13 v3ex rc://*/ta/man/translate/figs-activepassive ὁ & ὑπομείνας εἰς τέλος, οὗτος σωθήσεται 1 This can be stated in active form. Alternate translation: “God will save the person who endures to the end” (See: [[rc://*/ta/man/translate/figs-activepassive]])
24:13 l1pp ὁ δὲ ὑπομείνας 1 “the person who stays faithful”
24:13 ht34 εἰς τέλος 1 It is not clear whether the word “end” refers to when a person dies or when the persecution ends or the end of the age when God shows himself to be king. The main point is that they endure as long as necessary.
24:13 lra5 τέλος 1 “the end of the world” or “the end of the age”
24:14 x3e6 rc://*/ta/man/translate/figs-metonymy κηρυχθήσεται τοῦτο τὸ εὐαγγέλιον τῆς βασιλείας 1 Here “kingdom” refers to Gods rule as king. This can be stated in active form. Alternate translation: “People will tell the good news that God will rule” (See: [[rc://*/ta/man/translate/figs-metonymy]] and [[rc://*/ta/man/translate/figs-activepassive]])
24:14 y65s rc://*/ta/man/translate/figs-metonymy πᾶσιν τοῖς ἔθνεσιν 1 Here, “nations” stands for people. Alternate translation: “all people in all places” (See: [[rc://*/ta/man/translate/figs-metonymy]])
24:15 mf1b rc://*/ta/man/translate/figs-activepassive τὸ βδέλυγμα τῆς ἐρημώσεως, τὸ ῥηθὲν διὰ Δανιὴλ τοῦ προφήτου 1 This can be stated in active form. Alternate translation: “the shameful one who defiles the things of God, about whom Daniel the prophet wrote” (See: [[rc://*/ta/man/translate/figs-activepassive]])
24:15 lz9p ὁ ἀναγινώσκων νοείτω 1 This is not Jesus speaking. Matthew added this to alert the reader that Jesus was using words that they would need to think about and interpret.
24:17 iv2j ὁ ἐπὶ τοῦ δώματος 1 Housetops where Jesus lived were flat, and people could stand on them.
24:19 kq12 rc://*/ta/man/translate/figs-euphemism ταῖς ἐν γαστρὶ ἐχούσαις 1 This is a polite way to say “pregnant women.” (See: [[rc://*/ta/man/translate/figs-euphemism]])
24:19 f533 ἐν ἐκείναις ταῖς ἡμέραις 1 “at that time”
24:20 u4jb ἵνα μὴ γένηται ἡ φυγὴ ὑμῶν 1 “that you will not have to flee” or “that you will not have to run away”
24:20 m6mx χειμῶνος 1 “the cold season”
24:22 vd3z rc://*/ta/man/translate/figs-doublenegatives εἰ μὴ ἐκολοβώθησαν αἱ ἡμέραι ἐκεῖναι, οὐκ ἂν ἐσώθη πᾶσα σάρξ 1 This can be stated in positive and active form. Alternate translation: “If God does not shorten the time of suffering, everyone will die” (See: [[rc://*/ta/man/translate/figs-doublenegatives]])
24:22 r9qw rc://*/ta/man/translate/figs-synecdoche σάρξ 1 “people.” Here, “flesh” is poetic way of saying all people. (See: [[rc://*/ta/man/translate/figs-synecdoche]])
24:22 p6m8 rc://*/ta/man/translate/figs-activepassive κολοβωθήσονται αἱ ἡμέραι ἐκεῖναι 1 This can be stated in active form. Alternate translation: “God will shorten the time of suffering” (See: [[rc://*/ta/man/translate/figs-activepassive]])
24:23 avv5 0 Jesus continues speaking to his disciples.
24:23 avm2 μὴ πιστεύσητε 1 “do not believe the false things they have said to you”
24:24 n744 ὥστε πλανῆσαι εἰ δυνατὸν καὶ τοὺς ἐκλεκτούς 1 Here “lead astray” is a metaphor for persuading someone to believe something that is not true. This can be translated as two sentences. Alternate translation: “so as to deceive, if possible, even the elect” or “so as to deceive people. If possible, they would even deceive the elect” (See: [[rc://*/ta/man/translate/figs-metaphor]])
24:26 fmx1 rc://*/ta/man/translate/figs-quotations ἐὰν & εἴπωσιν ὑμῖν, ἰδοὺ, ἐν τῇ ἐρήμῳ ἐστίν, μὴ 1 This can be stated as an indirect quotation. Alternate translation: “if someone tells you that the Christ is in the wilderness, do” (See: [[rc://*/ta/man/translate/figs-quotations]])
24:26 zxg2 rc://*/ta/man/translate/figs-quotations ἰδοὺ, ἐν τοῖς ταμείοις 1 This can be stated as an indirect quotation. Alternate translation: “Or, if someone tells you that the Christ is in the inner room,” (See: [[rc://*/ta/man/translate/figs-quotations]])
24:26 n2pt ἐν τοῖς ταμείοις 1 “in a secret room” or “in secret places”
24:27 j1w1 rc://*/ta/man/translate/figs-simile ὥσπερ & ἡ ἀστραπὴ ἐξέρχεται & οὕτως ἔσται ἡ παρουσία 1 This means that the Son of Man will come very quickly and will be easy to see. (See: [[rc://*/ta/man/translate/figs-simile]])
24:27 za8b rc://*/ta/man/translate/figs-123person τοῦ Υἱοῦ τοῦ Ἀνθρώπου 1 Jesus is speaking about himself in the third person. (See: [[rc://*/ta/man/translate/figs-123person]])
24:28 mu35 rc://*/ta/man/translate/writing-proverbs ὅπου ἐὰν ᾖ τὸ πτῶμα, ἐκεῖ συναχθήσονται οἱ ἀετοί 1 This is probably a proverb that the people of Jesus time understood. Possible meanings are (1) when the Son of Man comes, everyone will see him and know that he has come, or (2) wherever spiritually dead people are, false prophets will be there to tell them lies. (See: [[rc://*/ta/man/translate/writing-proverbs]])
24:28 ivl8 οἱ ἀετοί 1 birds that eat the bodies of dead or dying creatures
24:29 zmm6 εὐθέως & μετὰ τὴν θλῖψιν τῶν ἡμερῶν ἐκείνων, ὁ ἥλιος 1 “as soon as the tribulation of those days has finished, the sun”
24:29 l15m τὴν θλῖψιν τῶν ἡμερῶν ἐκείνων 1 “that time of suffering”
24:29 zuk4 rc://*/ta/man/translate/figs-activepassive ὁ ἥλιος σκοτισθήσεται 1 This can be stated in active form. Alternate translation: “God will make the sun dark” (See: [[rc://*/ta/man/translate/figs-activepassive]])
24:29 w1bi rc://*/ta/man/translate/figs-activepassive αἱ δυνάμεις τῶν οὐρανῶν σαλευθήσονται 1 This can be stated in active form. Alternate translation: “God will shake things in the sky and above the sky” (See: [[rc://*/ta/man/translate/figs-activepassive]])
24:30 yc2x rc://*/ta/man/translate/figs-123person τοῦ Υἱοῦ τοῦ Ἀνθρώπου 1 Jesus is speaking about himself in the third person. (See: [[rc://*/ta/man/translate/figs-123person]])
24:30 tld8 rc://*/ta/man/translate/figs-metonymy πᾶσαι αἱ φυλαὶ 1 Here “tribes” refers to people. Alternate translation: “all the people of the tribes” or “all the people” (See: [[rc://*/ta/man/translate/figs-metonymy]])
24:31 fl54 ἀποστελεῖ τοὺς ἀγγέλους αὐτοῦ μετὰ σάλπιγγος μεγάλης 1 “He will have a trumpet sounded and send his angels” or “He will have an angel blow a trumpet, and he will send his angels”
24:31 rlb4 rc://*/ta/man/translate/figs-123person ἀποστελεῖ & αὐτοῦ 1 Jesus is speaking about himself in the third person. (See: [[rc://*/ta/man/translate/figs-123person]])
24:31 wi28 ἐπισυνάξουσιν 1 “his angels will gather”
24:31 iq8c τοὺς ἐκλεκτοὺς αὐτοῦ 1 These are the people whom the Son of Man has chosen.
24:31 ibw7 rc://*/ta/man/translate/figs-parallelism ἐκ τῶν τεσσάρων ἀνέμων, ἀπ’ ἄκρων οὐρανῶν ἕως ἄκρων αὐτῶν 1 Both of these mean the same thing. They are idioms that mean “from everywhere.” Alternate translation: “from all over the world” (See: [[rc://*/ta/man/translate/figs-parallelism]] and [[rc://*/ta/man/translate/figs-idiom]])
24:33 cu5a rc://*/ta/man/translate/figs-123person ἐγγύς ἐστιν 1 Jesus is speaking about himself in the third person. Alternate translation: “the time for me to come is near” (See: [[rc://*/ta/man/translate/figs-123person]])
24:33 cfz8 rc://*/ta/man/translate/figs-metaphor ἐπὶ θύραις 1 “close to the gates.” Jesus uses the imagery of a king or important official getting close to the gates of a walled city. It is a metaphor meaning the time for Jesus to come is soon. (See: [[rc://*/ta/man/translate/figs-metaphor]])
24:34 j8np ἀμὴν, λέγω ὑμῖν 1 “I tell you the truth.” This adds emphasis to what Jesus says next.
24:34 gld5 rc://*/ta/man/translate/figs-euphemism οὐ μὴ παρέλθῃ ἡ γενεὰ αὕτη 1 Here “pass away” is a polite way of saying “die.” Alternate translation: “this generation will not all die” (See: [[rc://*/ta/man/translate/figs-euphemism]])
24:34 y73t ἡ γενεὰ αὕτη 1 Possible interpretations are (1) “all people alive today,” referring to the people alive when Jesus was speaking, or (2) “all people alive when these things I have just told you about happen.” Try to translate so that both interpretations are possible.
24:34 fb4k ἕως ἂν πάντα ταῦτα γένηται 1 “until God causes all these things to happen”
24:34 r6sk παρέλθῃ 1 “disappear” or “someday no longer exist”
24:35 i8vv rc://*/ta/man/translate/figs-synecdoche ὁ οὐρανὸς καὶ ἡ γῆ παρελεύσεται 1 The words “heaven” and “earth” are a synecdoche that includes everything that God has created, especially those things that seem permanent. Jesus is saying that his word, unlike these things, is permanent. Alternate translation: “Even heaven and the earth will pass away” (See: [[rc://*/ta/man/translate/figs-synecdoche]])
24:35 e6bf rc://*/ta/man/translate/figs-metonymy οἱ & λόγοι μου οὐ μὴ παρέλθωσιν 1 Here “words” refers to what Jesus has said. Alternate translation: “what I say will always be true” (See: [[rc://*/ta/man/translate/figs-metonymy]])
24:36 q4pj rc://*/ta/man/translate/figs-metonymy τῆς ἡμέρας ἐκείνης καὶ ὥρας 1 Here “day” and “hour” refer to the exact time that the Son of Man will return. (See: [[rc://*/ta/man/translate/figs-metonymy]])
24:36 wq5r οὐδὲ ὁ Υἱός 1 “not even the Son”
24:36 p5vu rc://*/ta/man/translate/guidelines-sonofgodprinciples Υἱός 1 This is an important title for Jesus, the Son of God. (See: [[rc://*/ta/man/translate/guidelines-sonofgodprinciples]])
24:36 f4s2 rc://*/ta/man/translate/guidelines-sonofgodprinciples Πατὴρ 1 This is an important title for God. (See: [[rc://*/ta/man/translate/guidelines-sonofgodprinciples]])
24:37 hf51 ὥσπερ γὰρ αἱ ἡμέραι τοῦ Νῶε, οὕτως ἔσται ἡ παρουσία τοῦ Υἱοῦ τοῦ Ἀνθρώπου 1 “At the time when the Son of Man comes, it will be like the time of Noah.”
24:37 cpn8 rc://*/ta/man/translate/figs-123person τοῦ Υἱοῦ τοῦ Ἀνθρώπου 1 Jesus is speaking about himself in the third person. (See: [[rc://*/ta/man/translate/figs-123person]])
24:39 ffa6 καὶ οὐκ ἔγνωσαν 1 This can be translated as a separate sentence. Alternate translation: “The people did not realize anything was happening”
24:39 ah5v ἦρεν ἅπαντας; οὕτως ἔσται καὶ ἡ παρουσία τοῦ Υἱοῦ τοῦ Ἀνθρώπου 1 This can be translated as a separate sentence. Alternate translation: “away. This is how it will be when the Son of Man comes”
24:40 ksk6 0 Jesus begins to tell his disciples to be ready for his return.
24:40 hth3 τότε 1 This is when the Son of Man comes.
24:40 gt4l rc://*/ta/man/translate/figs-activepassive εἷς παραλαμβάνεται, καὶ εἷς ἀφίεται 1 Possible meanings are (1) the Son of Man will take one away to heaven and will leave the other on earth for punishment or (2) the angels will take one away for punishment and leave the other for blessing. (See: [[rc://*/ta/man/translate/figs-activepassive]])
24:42 j83i οὖν 1 “Because what I have just said is true”
24:42 s6ir γρηγορεῖτε 1 “pay attention”
24:43 ak6a rc://*/ta/man/translate/figs-parables ὅτι εἰ ᾔδει ὁ οἰκοδεσπότης, & διορυχθῆναι τὴν οἰκίαν αὐτοῦ 1 Jesus uses a parable of a master and servants to illustrate that his disciples should be prepared for his return. (See: [[rc://*/ta/man/translate/figs-parables]])
24:43 ki5s rc://*/ta/man/translate/figs-metaphor ὁ κλέπτης 1 Jesus is saying he will come when people are not expecting him, not that he will come to steal. (See: [[rc://*/ta/man/translate/figs-metaphor]])
24:43 zs23 ἐγρηγόρησεν ἂν 1 “he would have guarded his house”
24:43 lg7i rc://*/ta/man/translate/figs-activepassive οὐκ ἂν εἴασεν διορυχθῆναι τὴν οἰκίαν αὐτοῦ 1 This can be stated in active form. Alternate translation: “would not have allowed anyone to get into his house to steal things” (See: [[rc://*/ta/man/translate/figs-activepassive]])
24:44 gd17 rc://*/ta/man/translate/figs-123person ὁ Υἱὸς τοῦ Ἀνθρώπου 1 Jesus is speaking about himself in the third person. (See: [[rc://*/ta/man/translate/figs-123person]])
24:45 jua3 0 Jesus continues his proverb of a master and servants to illustrate that his disciples should be prepared for his return.
24:45 f92d rc://*/ta/man/translate/figs-rquestion τίς ἄρα ἐστὶν ὁ πιστὸς δοῦλος καὶ φρόνιμος, ὃν & ἐν καιρῷ? 1 Jesus uses this question to make his disciples think. Alternate translation: “So who is the faithful and wise servant? He is the one whom his master … time.” or “Be like the faithful and wise servant, whom his master … time.” (See: [[rc://*/ta/man/translate/figs-rquestion]])
24:45 lf8d τοῦ δοῦναι αὐτοῖς τὴν τροφὴν 1 “give the people in the masters home their food”
24:47 lin7 ἀμὴν, λέγω ὑμῖν 1 “I tell you the truth.” This adds emphasis to what Jesus says next.
24:48 ek9x rc://*/ta/man/translate/writing-proverbs 0 Jesus concludes his proverb of a master and servants to illustrate that his disciples should be prepared for his return. (See: [[rc://*/ta/man/translate/writing-proverbs]])
24:48 f9ft rc://*/ta/man/translate/figs-metonymy εἴπῃ & ἐν τῇ καρδίᾳ αὐτοῦ 1 Here “heart” refers to the mind. Alternate translation: “thinks in his mind” (See: [[rc://*/ta/man/translate/figs-metonymy]])
24:48 per6 rc://*/ta/man/translate/figs-activepassive χρονίζει μου ὁ κύριος 1 This can be stated in active form. Alternate translation: “My master is slow to return” or “My master will not return for a long time” (See: [[rc://*/ta/man/translate/figs-activepassive]])
24:50 bz5k rc://*/ta/man/translate/figs-parallelism ἐν ἡμέρᾳ ᾗ οὐ προσδοκᾷ, καὶ ἐν ὥρᾳ ᾗ οὐ γινώσκει 1 Both of these statements mean the same thing. They emphasize that the master will come when the servant is not expecting him. (See: [[rc://*/ta/man/translate/figs-parallelism]])
24:51 jj2z rc://*/ta/man/translate/figs-idiom διχοτομήσει αὐτὸν 1 This is an idiom that means to make the person suffer terribly. (See: [[rc://*/ta/man/translate/figs-idiom]])
24:51 pm18 τὸ μέρος αὐτοῦ μετὰ τῶν ὑποκριτῶν θήσει 1 “put him with the hypocrites” or “send him to the place where hypocrites are sent”
24:51 rwd5 rc://*/ta/man/translate/translate-symaction ἔσται ὁ κλαυθμὸς καὶ ὁ βρυγμὸς τῶν ὀδόντων 1 “Grinding of teeth” here is a symbolic act, representing extreme suffering. See how you translated this in [Matthew 8:12](../08/12.md). Alternate translation: “people will weep and grind their teeth because of their suffering” (See: [[rc://*/ta/man/translate/translate-symaction]])
25:intro qe8a 0 # Matthew 25 General Notes\n## Structure and formatting\n\nThis chapter continues the teaching of the previous chapter.\n\n## Special concepts in this chapter\n\n### The parable of the ten virgins\n\nJesus told the parable of the ten virgins ([Matthew 25:1-13](./01.md)) to tell his followers to be ready for him to return. His hearers could understand the parable because they knew Jewish wedding customs.\n\nWhen the Jews arranged marriages, they would plan for the wedding to take place weeks or months later. At the proper time, the young man would go to his brides house, where she would be waiting for him. The wedding ceremony would take place, and then the man and his bride would travel to his home, where there would be a feast. (See: [[rc://*/ta/man/translate/writing-apocalypticwriting]])
25:1 em28 rc://*/ta/man/translate/figs-parables 0 Jesus tells a parable about wise and foolish virgins to illustrate that his disciples should be prepared for his return. (See: [[rc://*/ta/man/translate/figs-parables]])
25:1 pg5i rc://*/ta/man/translate/figs-metonymy ὁμοιωθήσεται ἡ Βασιλεία τῶν Οὐρανῶν 1 Here “kingdom of heaven” refers to Gods rule as king. The phrase “kingdom of heaven” is used only in Matthew. If possible, use “heaven” in your translation. See how you translated this in [Matthew 13:24](../13/24.md). Alternate translation: “when our God in heaven shows himself to be king, it will be like” (See: [[rc://*/ta/man/translate/figs-metonymy]])
25:1 uhj1 λαμπάδας 1 These could have been (1) lamps or (2) torches made by putting cloth around the end of a stick and wetting the cloth with oil.
25:2 c8nf πέντε & ἐξ αὐτῶν 1 “Five of the virgins”
25:3 b37a οὐκ ἔλαβον μεθ’ ἑαυτῶν ἔλαιον 1 “had with them only the oil in their lamps”
25:5 r458 δὲ 1 This word is used here to mark a break in the main story line. Here Jesus starts to tell a new part of the story.
25:5 pvh4 rc://*/ta/man/translate/figs-activepassive χρονίζοντος & τοῦ νυμφίου 1 This can be stated in active form. Alternate translation: “while the bridegroom was taking a long time to arrive” (See: [[rc://*/ta/man/translate/figs-activepassive]])
25:5 qf4b ἐνύσταξαν πᾶσαι 1 “all ten virgins got sleepy”
25:6 ufp2 κραυγὴ γέγονεν 1 “someone shouted”
25:7 a3mz rc://*/ta/man/translate/figs-parables 0 Jesus continues telling a parable. (See: [[rc://*/ta/man/translate/figs-parables]])
25:7 ni6u ἐκόσμησαν τὰς λαμπάδας ἑαυτῶν 1 “adjusted their lamps so they would burn brightly”
25:8 tsh4 rc://*/ta/man/translate/figs-nominaladj αἱ & μωραὶ ταῖς φρονίμοις εἶπον 1 These nominal adjectives can be stated as adjectives. Alternate translation: “The foolish virgins said to the wise virgins” (See: [[rc://*/ta/man/translate/figs-nominaladj]])
25:8 i1r7 rc://*/ta/man/translate/figs-idiom αἱ λαμπάδες ἡμῶν σβέννυνται 1 This is an idiom. Alternate translation: “the fire in our lamps is about to burn out” (See: [[rc://*/ta/man/translate/figs-idiom]])
25:10 q6q9 rc://*/ta/man/translate/figs-parables 0 Jesus concludes the parable about the ten virgins. (See: [[rc://*/ta/man/translate/figs-parables]])
25:10 rfh6 ἀπερχομένων δὲ αὐτῶν 1 “the five foolish virgins went away”
25:10 jej8 rc://*/ta/man/translate/figs-ellipsis ἀγοράσαι 1 The understood information can be stated clearly. Alternate translation: “to buy more oil” (See: [[rc://*/ta/man/translate/figs-ellipsis]])
25:10 t229 αἱ ἕτοιμοι 1 These are the virgins who had extra oil.
25:10 g29i rc://*/ta/man/translate/figs-activepassive ἐκλείσθη ἡ θύρα 1 This can be stated in active form. Alternate translation: “the servants shut the door” (See: [[rc://*/ta/man/translate/figs-activepassive]])
25:11 e5pz rc://*/ta/man/translate/figs-explicit ἄνοιξον ἡμῖν 1 This implicit information can be stated explicitly. Alternate translation: “open the door for us so we can come inside” (See: [[rc://*/ta/man/translate/figs-explicit]])
25:12 z5u1 ἀμὴν, λέγω ὑμῖν 1 “I tell you the truth.” This adds emphasis to what the master says next.
25:12 h4a8 οὐκ οἶδα ὑμᾶς 1 “I do not know who you are.” This is the end of the parable.
25:13 hn7w rc://*/ta/man/translate/figs-metonymy οὐκ οἴδατε τὴν ἡμέραν, οὐδὲ τὴν ὥραν 1 Here “day” and “hour” refer to an exact time. The implied information can be stated explicitly. Alternate translation: “you do not know the exact time when the Son of Man will return” (See: [[rc://*/ta/man/translate/figs-metonymy]] and [[rc://*/ta/man/translate/figs-explicit]])
25:14 cn21 rc://*/ta/man/translate/figs-parables 0 Jesus tells a parable about faithful and unfaithful servants to illustrate that his disciples should remain faithful during his absence and be prepared for his return. (See: [[rc://*/ta/man/translate/figs-parables]])
25:14 zqi2 ὥσπερ 1 The word “it” here refers to the kingdom of heaven ([Matthew 13:24](../13/24.md)).
25:14 wv71 ἀποδημῶν 1 “was ready to go” or “was to go soon”
25:14 vhw1 παρέδωκεν αὐτοῖς τὰ ὑπάρχοντα αὐτοῦ 1 “put them in charge of his wealth”
25:14 fmb3 τὰ ὑπάρχοντα αὐτοῦ 1 “his property”
25:15 i81u rc://*/ta/man/translate/translate-bmoney πέντε τάλαντα 1 “five talents of gold.” Avoid translating this into modern money. A “talent” of gold was worth twenty years wages. The parable is contrasting the relative amounts of five, two, and one, as well as the large amount of wealth involved. Alternate translation: “five bags of gold” or “five bags of gold, each worth 20 years wages” (See: [[rc://*/ta/man/translate/translate-bmoney]])
25:15 vyj2 rc://*/ta/man/translate/figs-ellipsis ᾧ δὲ δύο & ἕν 1 The word “talents” is understood from the previous phrase. Alternate translation: “to another he gave two talents of gold … gave one talent of gold” or “to another he gave two bags of gold … gave one bag of gold” (See: [[rc://*/ta/man/translate/figs-ellipsis]])
25:15 d87u rc://*/ta/man/translate/figs-explicit κατὰ τὴν ἰδίαν δύναμιν 1 The implicit information can be stated explicitly. Alternate translation: “according to each servants skill in managing wealth” (See: [[rc://*/ta/man/translate/figs-explicit]])
25:16 qkr2 ἐκέρδησεν ἄλλα πέντε τάλαντα 1 “out of his investments, he earned another five talents”
25:17 m2l8 rc://*/ta/man/translate/figs-parables 0 Jesus continues telling a parable about the servants and the talents. (See: [[rc://*/ta/man/translate/figs-parables]] and [[rc://*/ta/man/translate/translate-bmoney]])
25:17 u4vs ἐκέρδησεν ἄλλα δύο 1 “earned another two talents”
25:19 ik5q rc://*/ta/man/translate/figs-parables 0 Jesus continues telling the parable about the servants and the talents. (See: [[rc://*/ta/man/translate/figs-parables]] and [[rc://*/ta/man/translate/translate-bmoney]])
25:19 vc9p δὲ 1 This word is used here to mark a break in the main story line. Here Jesus starts to tell a new part of the story.
25:20 adz4 πέντε τάλαντα ἐκέρδησα 1 “I have earned five more talents”
25:20 ttf7 rc://*/ta/man/translate/translate-bmoney τάλαντα 1 A “talent” was worth twenty years wages. Avoid translating this into modern money. See how you translated this in [Matthew 25:15](../25/15.md). (See: [[rc://*/ta/man/translate/translate-bmoney]])
25:21 l5mg εὖ 1 “You have done well” or “You have done right.” Your culture might have an expression that a master (or someone in authority) would use to show that he approves of what his servant (or someone under him) has done.
25:21 d2s9 rc://*/ta/man/translate/figs-idiom εἴσελθε εἰς τὴν χαρὰν τοῦ κυρίου σου 1 The phrase “Enter into the joy” is an idiom. Also, the master is speaking about himself in the third person. Alternate translation: “Come and be happy with me” (See: [[rc://*/ta/man/translate/figs-idiom]] and [[rc://*/ta/man/translate/figs-123person]])
25:22 yhi1 rc://*/ta/man/translate/figs-parables 0 Jesus continues telling the parable about the servants and the talents. (See: [[rc://*/ta/man/translate/figs-parables]] and [[rc://*/ta/man/translate/translate-bmoney]])
25:22 n2xc δύο τάλαντα ἐκέρδησα 1 “I have earned two more talents”
25:23 hsb6 εὖ 1 “You have done well” or “You have done right.” Your culture might have an expression that a master (or someone in authority) would use to show that he approves of what his servant (or someone under him) has done. See how you translated this in [Matthew 25:21](../25/21.md).
25:23 plv7 rc://*/ta/man/translate/figs-idiom εἴσελθε εἰς τὴν χαρὰν τοῦ κυρίου σου 1 The phrase “Enter into the joy” is an idiom. Also, the master is speaking about himself in the third person. Alternate translation: “Come and be happy with me” See how you translated this in [Matthew 25:21](../25/21.md). (See: [[rc://*/ta/man/translate/figs-idiom]] and [[rc://*/ta/man/translate/figs-123person]])
25:24 ial6 rc://*/ta/man/translate/figs-parables 0 Jesus continues telling the parable about the servants and the talents. (See: [[rc://*/ta/man/translate/figs-parables]] and [[rc://*/ta/man/translate/translate-bmoney]])
25:24 m8an rc://*/ta/man/translate/figs-parallelism θερίζων ὅπου οὐκ ἔσπειρας, καὶ συνάγων ὅθεν οὐ διεσκόρπισας 1 The words “reap where you did not sow” and “harvest where you did not scatter” mean the same thing. They refer to a farmer who gathers crops that other people have planted. The servant uses this metaphor to accuse the master of taking what rightfully belongs to others. (See: [[rc://*/ta/man/translate/figs-parallelism]] and [[rc://*/ta/man/translate/figs-metaphor]])
25:24 au9f διεσκόρπισας 1 “scatter seed.” This refers to sowing seed by gently throwing handfuls of it onto the soil.
25:25 wl5c ἴδε, ἔχεις τὸ σόν 1 “Look, here is what is yours”
25:26 hj83 rc://*/ta/man/translate/figs-parables 0 Jesus continues telling a parable about the servants and the talents. (See: [[rc://*/ta/man/translate/figs-parables]])
25:26 l3jz πονηρὲ δοῦλε καὶ ὀκνηρέ! ᾔδεις 1 “You are a wicked servant who does not want to work. You knew”
25:26 he3h rc://*/ta/man/translate/figs-parallelism θερίζω ὅπου οὐκ ἔσπειρα, καὶ συνάγω ὅθεν οὐ διεσκόρπισα 1 The words “reap where I have not sowed” and “harvest where I have not scattered” mean the same thing. They refer to a farmer who gathers crops that people who work for him have planted. See how you translated this in [Matthew 25:24](../25/24.md), where the servant uses these words to accuse the farmer. The readers should understand that the farmer is acknowledging that he does indeed gather what others have planted but is saying that he is right to do so. (See: [[rc://*/ta/man/translate/figs-parallelism]] and [[rc://*/ta/man/translate/figs-metaphor]])
25:27 rhg9 rc://*/ta/man/translate/figs-ellipsis ἐκομισάμην ἂν τὸ ἐμὸν 1 The understood information can be stated clearly. Alternate translation: “received back my own money” (See: [[rc://*/ta/man/translate/figs-ellipsis]])
25:27 n7jd τόκῳ 1 payment from the banker for the temporary use of the masters money
25:28 qm6x rc://*/ta/man/translate/figs-parables 0 Jesus concludes the parable about the servants and the talents. (See: [[rc://*/ta/man/translate/figs-parables]] and [[rc://*/ta/man/translate/translate-bmoney]])
25:28 paw8 ἄρατε οὖν & τὸ τάλαντον 1 The master is speaking to other servants.
25:28 b1ge rc://*/ta/man/translate/translate-bmoney τὸ τάλαντον 1 A “talent” was worth twenty years wages. Avoid translating this into modern money. See how you translated this in [Matthew 25:15](../25/15.md). (See: [[rc://*/ta/man/translate/translate-bmoney]])
25:29 e5py rc://*/ta/man/translate/figs-explicit τῷ & ἔχοντι 1 It is implied that the person who possesses something also uses it wisely. Alternate translation: “who uses well what he has” (See: [[rc://*/ta/man/translate/figs-explicit]])
25:29 r7lv καὶ περισσευθήσεται 1 “even much more”
25:29 pcr5 rc://*/ta/man/translate/figs-explicit τοῦ δὲ μὴ ἔχοντος 1 It is implied that the person does possess something but he does not use it wisely. Alternate translation: “from anyone does not use well what he has” (See: [[rc://*/ta/man/translate/figs-explicit]])
25:29 mdc1 rc://*/ta/man/translate/figs-activepassive ἀρθήσεται 1 This can be stated in active form. Alternate translation: “God will take away” or “I will take away” (See: [[rc://*/ta/man/translate/figs-activepassive]])
25:30 c2vb rc://*/ta/man/translate/figs-metonymy τὸ σκότος τὸ ἐξώτερον 1 Here “outer darkness” is a metonym for the place where God sends those who reject them. This is a place that is completely separated from God forever. See how you translated this in [Matthew 8:12](../08/12.md). Alternate translation: “the dark place away from God” (See: [[rc://*/ta/man/translate/figs-metonymy]])
25:30 zy3k rc://*/ta/man/translate/translate-symaction ὁ κλαυθμὸς καὶ ὁ βρυγμὸς τῶν ὀδόντων 1 “Grinding of teeth” is symbolic action, representing extreme sadness and suffering. See how you translated this in [Matthew 8:12](../08/12.md). Alternate translation: “weeping and expressing their extreme suffering” (See: [[rc://*/ta/man/translate/translate-symaction]])
25:31 qtg6 0 Jesus begins to tell his disciples how he will judge people when he returns at the end time.
25:31 e7um rc://*/ta/man/translate/figs-123person ὁ Υἱὸς τοῦ Ἀνθρώπου 1 Jesus is speaking about himself in the third person. (See: [[rc://*/ta/man/translate/figs-123person]])
25:32 f2w9 rc://*/ta/man/translate/figs-activepassive καὶ συναχθήσονται ἔμπροσθεν αὐτοῦ πάντα τὰ ἔθνη 1 This can be stated in active form. Alternate translation: “He will gather all the nations before him” (See: [[rc://*/ta/man/translate/figs-activepassive]])
25:32 kd14 ἔμπροσθεν αὐτοῦ 1 “In front of him”
25:32 ndf5 rc://*/ta/man/translate/figs-metonymy πάντα τὰ ἔθνη 1 Here “nations” refers to people. Alternate translation: “all people from every country” (See: [[rc://*/ta/man/translate/figs-metonymy]])
25:32 nk18 rc://*/ta/man/translate/figs-simile ὥσπερ ὁ ποιμὴν ἀφορίζει τὰ πρόβατα ἀπὸ τῶν ἐρίφων 1 Jesus uses a simile to describe how he will separate the people. (See: [[rc://*/ta/man/translate/figs-simile]])
25:33 pbq9 rc://*/ta/man/translate/figs-metaphor καὶ στήσει τὰ μὲν πρόβατα ἐκ δεξιῶν αὐτοῦ, τὰ δὲ ἐρίφια ἐξ εὐωνύμων 1 This is a metaphor that means the Son of Man will separate all people. He will put the righteous people at his right side, and he will put the sinners at his left side. (See: [[rc://*/ta/man/translate/figs-metaphor]])
25:34 t8pp rc://*/ta/man/translate/figs-123person ὁ Βασιλεὺς & δεξιῶν αὐτοῦ 1 Here, “the King” is another title for the Son of Man. Jesus was referring to himself in the third person. Alternate translation: “I, the King, … my right hand” (See: [[rc://*/ta/man/translate/figs-123person]])
25:34 ze81 rc://*/ta/man/translate/figs-activepassive δεῦτε οἱ εὐλογημένοι τοῦ Πατρός μου 1 This can be stated in active form. Alternate translation: “Come, you whom my Father has blessed” (See: [[rc://*/ta/man/translate/figs-activepassive]])
25:34 h2k9 rc://*/ta/man/translate/guidelines-sonofgodprinciples τοῦ Πατρός μου 1 This is an important title for God that describes the relationship between God and Jesus. (See: [[rc://*/ta/man/translate/guidelines-sonofgodprinciples]])
25:34 b57r rc://*/ta/man/translate/figs-activepassive κληρονομήσατε τὴν ἡτοιμασμένην ὑμῖν βασιλείαν 1 This can be stated in active form. Alternate translation: “inherit the kingdom that God has made ready for you” (See: [[rc://*/ta/man/translate/figs-activepassive]])
25:34 yj1p rc://*/ta/man/translate/figs-metonymy κληρονομήσατε τὴν ἡτοιμασμένην ὑμῖν βασιλείαν 1 Here “kingdom” refers to Gods rule as king. Alternate translation: “receive the blessings of Gods rule that he has planned to give you” (See: [[rc://*/ta/man/translate/figs-metonymy]])
25:34 cdi8 ἀπὸ καταβολῆς κόσμου 1 “since he first created the world”
25:37 yh3p rc://*/ta/man/translate/figs-nominaladj οἱ δίκαιοι 1 This can be stated as an adjective. Alternate translation: “the righteous people” (See: [[rc://*/ta/man/translate/figs-nominaladj]])
25:37 cs5d rc://*/ta/man/translate/figs-ellipsis ἢ διψῶντα 1 The understood information can be stated clearly. Alternate translation: “Or when did we see you thirsty” (See: [[rc://*/ta/man/translate/figs-ellipsis]])
25:38 h52x rc://*/ta/man/translate/figs-ellipsis ἢ γυμνὸν 1 This is the end of a series of questions that begins in verse 37. The understood information can be stated clearly. Alternate translation: “Or when did we see you naked” (See: [[rc://*/ta/man/translate/figs-ellipsis]])
25:40 m6mi rc://*/ta/man/translate/figs-123person ὁ Βασιλεὺς 1 This is another title for the Son of Man. Jesus is speaking about himself in the third person. (See: [[rc://*/ta/man/translate/figs-123person]])
25:40 i2aq ἐρεῖ αὐτοῖς 1 “say to those at his right hand”
25:40 mhe2 ἀμὴν, λέγω ὑμῖν 1 “I tell you the truth.” This emphasizes what the King says next.
25:40 acs3 ἑνὶ & τῶν ἐλαχίστων 1 “one of the least important”
25:40 nh4y rc://*/ta/man/translate/figs-gendernotations τούτων τῶν ἀδελφῶν μου 1 Here “brothers” refers to anyone, male or female, who obeys the King. Alternate translation: “my brothers and sisters here” or “these who are like my brothers and sisters” (See: [[rc://*/ta/man/translate/figs-gendernotations]])
25:40 k4hb ἐμοὶ ἐποιήσατε 1 “I consider that you did it for me”
25:41 z1nh rc://*/ta/man/translate/figs-123person τότε ἐρεῖ 1 “Then the King will.” Jesus is speaking about himself in the third person. (See: [[rc://*/ta/man/translate/figs-123person]])
25:41 pr8n κατηραμένοι 1 “you people whom God has cursed”
25:41 hqf5 rc://*/ta/man/translate/figs-activepassive τὸ πῦρ τὸ αἰώνιον, τὸ ἡτοιμασμένον 1 This can be stated in active form. Alternate translation: “the eternal fire that God has prepared” (See: [[rc://*/ta/man/translate/figs-activepassive]])
25:41 g51u τοῖς ἀγγέλοις αὐτοῦ 1 his helpers
25:43 g6ec rc://*/ta/man/translate/figs-ellipsis γυμνὸς καὶ οὐ περιεβάλετέ με 1 The words “I was” preceding “naked” are understood. Alternate translation: “I was naked, but you did not give me clothes” (See: [[rc://*/ta/man/translate/figs-ellipsis]])
25:43 tq4x rc://*/ta/man/translate/figs-ellipsis ἀσθενὴς καὶ ἐν φυλακῇ 1 The words “I was” preceding “sick” are understood. Alternate translation: “I was sick and in prison” (See: [[rc://*/ta/man/translate/figs-ellipsis]])
25:44 f3dc 0 This is the end of the part of the story that began in [Matthew 23:1](../23/01.md), where Jesus teaches about salvation and the final judgment.
25:44 zyc5 0 Jesus finishes telling his disciples how he will judge people when he returns at the end time.
25:44 hiy6 ἀποκριθήσονται καὶ αὐτοὶ 1 “those on his left will also answer”
25:45 nm2e ἑνὶ τούτων τῶν ἐλαχίστων 1 “for any of the least important ones of my people”
25:45 whu5 οὐδὲ ἐμοὶ ἐποιήσατε. 1 “I consider that you did not do it for me” or “I was really the one whom you did not help”
25:46 m6me καὶ ἀπελεύσονται οὗτοι εἰς κόλασιν αἰώνιον 1 “The King will send these to a place where they will receive punishment that never ends”
25:46 nj72 rc://*/ta/man/translate/figs-ellipsis οἱ δὲ δίκαιοι εἰς ζωὴν 1 The understood information can be made clear. Alternate translation: “but the King will send the righteous to the place where they will live forever with God” (See: [[rc://*/ta/man/translate/figs-ellipsis]])
25:46 kq5b rc://*/ta/man/translate/figs-nominaladj οἱ & δίκαιοι 1 This nominative adjective can be stated as an adjective. Alternate translation: “the righteous people” (See: [[rc://*/ta/man/translate/figs-nominaladj]])
26:intro mtq8 0 # Matthew 26 General Notes\n## Structure and formatting\n\nSome translations set each line of poetry farther to the right than the rest of the text to make it easier to read. The ULT does this with the poetry in 26:31, which is words from the Old Testament.\n\n## Special concepts in this chapter\n\n### Sheep\nSheep are a common image used in Scripture to refer to the people of Israel. In [Matthew 26:31](../../mat/26/31.md), however, Jesus used the words “the sheep” to refer to his disciples and to say that they would run away when he was arrested.\n\n### Passover\nThe Passover festival was when the Jews would celebrate the day God killed the firstborn sons of the Egyptians but “passed over” the Israelites and let them live.\n\n### The eating of the body and blood\n[Matthew 26:26-28](./26.md) describes Jesus last meal with his followers. At this time, Jesus told them that what they were eating and drinking were his body and his blood. Nearly all Christian churches celebrate “the Lords Supper,” the “Eucharist”, or “Holy Communion” to remember this meal.\n\n## Other possible translation difficulties in this chapter\n\n### Judas kiss for Jesus\n[Matthew 26:49](../../mat/26/49.md) describes how Judas kissed Jesus so the soldiers would know whom to arrest. The Jews would kiss each other when they greeted each other.\n\n### “I am able to destroy the temple of God”\nTwo men accused Jesus of saying that he could destroy the temple in Jerusalem and then rebuild it “in three days” ([Matthew 26:61](../../mat/26/61.md)). They were accusing him of insulting God by claiming that God had given him the authority to destroy the temple and the power to rebuild it. What Jesus actually said was that if the Jewish authorities were to destroy this temple, he would certainly raise it up in three days ([John 2:19](../../jhn/02/19.md)).
26:1 t5mz 0 This is the beginning of a new part of the story that tells of Jesus crucifixion, death, and resurrection. Here he tells his disciples how he will suffer and die.
26:1 i35c καὶ ἐγένετο ὅτε 1 “After” or “Then, after.” This phrase shifts the story from Jesus teachings to what happened next.
26:1 xiv4 πάντας τοὺς λόγους τούτους 1 This refers to all that Jesus taught starting in [Matthew 24:3](../24/03.md).
26:2 g4lh rc://*/ta/man/translate/figs-activepassive ὁ Υἱὸς τοῦ Ἀνθρώπου παραδίδοται εἰς τὸ σταυρωθῆναι 1 This can be stated in active form. Alternate translation: “some men will take the Son of Man to other people who will crucify him” (See: [[rc://*/ta/man/translate/figs-activepassive]])
26:2 r9px rc://*/ta/man/translate/figs-123person ὁ Υἱὸς τοῦ Ἀνθρώπου 1 Jesus is speaking about himself in the third person. (See: [[rc://*/ta/man/translate/figs-123person]])
26:3 wew3 rc://*/ta/man/translate/writing-background 0 These verses give background information about the Jewish leaders plot to arrest and kill Jesus. (See: [[rc://*/ta/man/translate/writing-background]])
26:3 eps8 rc://*/ta/man/translate/figs-activepassive συνήχθησαν 1 This can be stated in active form. Alternate translation: “came together” or “met together” (See: [[rc://*/ta/man/translate/figs-activepassive]])
26:4 hi4x τὸν Ἰησοῦν δόλῳ 1 “Jesus secretly”
26:5 u4fh rc://*/ta/man/translate/figs-ellipsis μὴ ἐν τῇ ἑορτῇ 1 What the leaders did not want to do during the feast can be made clearer. Alternate translation: “We should not kill Jesus during the feast” (See: [[rc://*/ta/man/translate/figs-ellipsis]])
26:5 s9p7 ἐν τῇ ἑορτῇ 1 This is the yearly Passover feast.
26:6 v2up 0 This begins the account of a woman pouring expensive oil on Jesus before his death.
26:6 zq3j δὲ 1 This word is used here to mark a break in the main story line. Here Matthew starts to tell a new part of the story.
26:6 hg3s rc://*/ta/man/translate/figs-explicit Σίμωνος τοῦ λεπροῦ 1 It is implied that this is a man whom Jesus had healed from leprosy. (See: [[rc://*/ta/man/translate/figs-explicit]])
26:7 ukb9 ἀνακειμένου 1 “Jesus was lying on his side.” You can use your languages word for the position people usually are in when they eat.
26:7 yxf8 προσῆλθεν αὐτῷ γυνὴ 1 “a woman came to Jesus”
26:7 bhs8 rc://*/ta/man/translate/translate-unknown ἀλάβαστρον 1 This is a costly container made of soft stone. (See: [[rc://*/ta/man/translate/translate-unknown]])
26:7 yu67 μύρου 1 oil that has a pleasing smell
26:7 ea5e κατέχεεν ἐπὶ τῆς κεφαλῆς αὐτοῦ 1 The woman does this to honor Jesus.
26:8 vit4 rc://*/ta/man/translate/figs-rquestion εἰς τί ἡ ἀπώλεια αὕτη? 1 The disciples ask this question out of their anger over the womans actions. Alternate translation: “This woman has done a bad thing by wasting this ointment!” (See: [[rc://*/ta/man/translate/figs-rquestion]])
26:9 y83e rc://*/ta/man/translate/figs-activepassive ἐδύνατο γὰρ τοῦτο πραθῆναι πολλοῦ καὶ δοθῆναι 1 This can be stated in active form. Alternate translation: “She could have sold this for a large amount of money and given the money” (See: [[rc://*/ta/man/translate/figs-activepassive]])
26:9 f76h rc://*/ta/man/translate/figs-nominaladj πτωχοῖς 1 Here “the poor” can be stated as an adjective. Alternate translation: “to poor people” (See: [[rc://*/ta/man/translate/figs-nominaladj]])
26:10 pfv1 rc://*/ta/man/translate/figs-rquestion τί κόπους παρέχετε τῇ γυναικί? 1 Jesus asks this question as a rebuke of his disciples. Alternate translation: “You should not be troubling this woman!” (See: [[rc://*/ta/man/translate/figs-rquestion]])
26:10 fg3v rc://*/ta/man/translate/figs-you παρέχετε 1 All occurrences of “you” are plural and refer to the disciples. (See: [[rc://*/ta/man/translate/figs-you]])
26:11 wsp9 rc://*/ta/man/translate/figs-nominaladj τοὺς πτωχοὺς 1 This can be stated as an adjective. Alternate translation: “poor people” (See: [[rc://*/ta/man/translate/figs-nominaladj]])
26:12 vk5w τὸ μύρον 1 This is oil that has a pleasing smell. See how you translated this in [Matthew 26:7](../26/07.md).
26:13 xs1w ἀμὴν, λέγω ὑμῖν 1 “I tell you the truth.” This adds emphasis to what Jesus says next.
26:13 g45l rc://*/ta/man/translate/figs-activepassive ὅπου ἐὰν κηρυχθῇ τὸ εὐαγγέλιον τοῦτο 1 This can be stated in active form. Alternate translation: “wherever people preach this good news” (See: [[rc://*/ta/man/translate/figs-activepassive]])
26:13 s12m rc://*/ta/man/translate/figs-activepassive λαληθήσεται καὶ ὃ ἐποίησεν αὕτη εἰς μνημόσυνον αὐτῆς 1 This can be stated in active form. Alternate translation: “they will remember what this woman has done and will tell others about her” or “people will remember what this woman has done and will tell others about her” (See: [[rc://*/ta/man/translate/figs-activepassive]])
26:14 i3dy 0 Judas Iscariot agrees to help the Jewish leaders arrest and kill Jesus.
26:15 es4b κἀγὼ ὑμῖν παραδώσω αὐτόν 1 “to bring Jesus to you”
26:15 x7zx τριάκοντα ἀργύρια 1 Since these words are the same as those in an Old Testament prophecy, keep this form instead of changing it to modern money.
26:15 lyl7 rc://*/ta/man/translate/translate-numbers τριάκοντα ἀργύρια 1 “30 pieces” (See: [[rc://*/ta/man/translate/translate-numbers]])
26:16 w1e4 ἵνα αὐτὸν παραδῷ 1 “to give him over to them”
26:17 e7wc 0 This begins the account of Jesus celebrating the Passover with his disciples.
26:17 f3s2 δὲ 1 This word is used here to mark a break in the main story line. Here Matthew starts to tell a new part of the story.
26:18 hc78 rc://*/ta/man/translate/figs-quotesinquotes ὁ δὲ εἶπεν, ὑπάγετε εἰς τὴν πόλιν πρὸς τὸν δεῖνα καὶ εἴπατε αὐτῷ, ὁ διδάσκαλος λέγει, ὁ καιρός μου ἐγγύς ἐστιν; πρὸς σὲ ποιῶ τὸ Πάσχα μετὰ τῶν μαθητῶν μου. 1 This has quotations within quotations. You can state some of the direct quotations as indirect quotations. Alternate translation: “He told his disciples to go into the city to a certain man and tell him that the Teacher says to him, My time is at hand. I will keep the Passover at your house with my disciples.’” or “He told his disciples to go into the city to a certain man and say to him that the Teachers time is at hand and he will keep the Passover with his disciples at that mans house.” (See: [[rc://*/ta/man/translate/figs-quotesinquotes]] and [[rc://*/ta/man/translate/figs-quotations]])
26:18 r4tg ὁ καιρός μου 1 Possible meanings are (1) “The time that I told you about” or (2) “The time God has set for me.”
26:18 a4i5 rc://*/ta/man/translate/figs-idiom ἐγγύς ἐστιν 1 Possible meanings are (1) “is near” or (2) “has come.” (See: [[rc://*/ta/man/translate/figs-idiom]])
26:18 j9pz ποιῶ τὸ Πάσχα 1 “eat the Passover meal” or “celebrate the Passover by eating the special meal”
26:20 bga4 ἀνέκειτο 1 Use the word for the position people in your culture usually are in when they eat.
26:21 ehx6 ἀμὴν, λέγω ὑμῖν 1 “I tell you the truth.” This adds emphasis to what Jesus says next.
26:22 n12r rc://*/ta/man/translate/figs-rquestion μήτι ἐγώ εἰμι, Κύριε? 1 “I am surely not the one, am I, Lord?” Possible meanings are (1) this is a rhetorical question since the apostles were sure they would not betray Jesus. Alternate translation: “Lord, I would never betray you!” or (2) this was a sincere question since Jesus statement probably troubled and confused them. (See: [[rc://*/ta/man/translate/figs-rquestion]])
26:24 n7dw rc://*/ta/man/translate/figs-123person ὁ μὲν Υἱὸς τοῦ Ἀνθρώπου 1 Jesus is speaking about himself in the third person. (See: [[rc://*/ta/man/translate/figs-123person]])
26:24 x2n9 rc://*/ta/man/translate/figs-euphemism ὑπάγει 1 Here “go” is a polite way to refer to dying. Alternate translation: “will go to his death” or “will die” (See: [[rc://*/ta/man/translate/figs-euphemism]])
26:24 vix3 rc://*/ta/man/translate/figs-activepassive καθὼς γέγραπται περὶ αὐτοῦ 1 This can be stated in active form. Alternate translation: “just as the prophets wrote about him in the scriptures” (See: [[rc://*/ta/man/translate/figs-activepassive]])
26:24 hai5 rc://*/ta/man/translate/figs-activepassive τῷ ἀνθρώπῳ ἐκείνῳ δι’ οὗ ὁ Υἱὸς τοῦ Ἀνθρώπου παραδίδοται 1 This can be stated in active form. Alternate translation: “the man who betrays the Son of Man” (See: [[rc://*/ta/man/translate/figs-activepassive]])
26:25 vpq1 rc://*/ta/man/translate/figs-rquestion μήτι ἐγώ εἰμι, Ῥαββεί? 1 “Rabbi, am I the one who will betray you?” Judas may be using a rhetorical question to deny that he is the one who will betray Jesus. Alternate translation: “Rabbi, surely I am not the one who will betray you” (See: [[rc://*/ta/man/translate/figs-rquestion]])
26:25 y9lk rc://*/ta/man/translate/figs-idiom σὺ εἶπας 1 This is an idiom that Jesus uses to mean “yes” without being completely clear about what he means. Alternate translation: “You are saying it” or “You are admitting it” (See: [[rc://*/ta/man/translate/figs-idiom]])
26:26 qh16 0 Jesus institutes the Lords Supper as he celebrates the Passover with his disciples.
26:26 mr5u λαβὼν & εὐλογήσας ἔκλασεν 1 See how you translated these words in [Matthew 14:19](../14/19.md).
26:27 jd53 καὶ λαβὼν 1 Translate “took” as you did in [Matthew 14:19](../14/19.md).
26:27 tn39 rc://*/ta/man/translate/figs-metonymy ποτήριον 1 Here “cup” refers to the cup and the wine in it. (See: [[rc://*/ta/man/translate/figs-metonymy]])
26:27 zb1i ἔδωκεν αὐτοῖς 1 “gave it to the disciples”
26:27 a9me πίετε ἐξ αὐτοῦ 1 “Drink the wine from this cup”
26:28 l55a τοῦτο γάρ ἐστιν τὸ αἷμά μου 1 “For this wine is my blood”
26:28 ct81 τὸ αἷμά & τῆς διαθήκης 1 “blood that shows that the covenant is in effect” or “blood that makes the covenant possible”
26:28 bms3 rc://*/ta/man/translate/figs-activepassive ἐκχυννόμενον 1 This can be stated in active form. Alternate translation: “will soon flow out of my body” or “will flow out of my wounds when I die” (See: [[rc://*/ta/man/translate/figs-activepassive]])
26:29 l556 λέγω & ὑμῖν 1 This adds emphasis to what Jesus says next.
26:29 h85b rc://*/ta/man/translate/figs-idiom τοῦ γενήματος τῆς ἀμπέλου 1 This is an idiom. Alternate translation: “wine” (See: [[rc://*/ta/man/translate/figs-idiom]])
26:29 q8zs rc://*/ta/man/translate/figs-metonymy ἐν τῇ βασιλείᾳ τοῦ Πατρός μου 1 Here “kingdom” refers to Gods rule as king. Alternate translation: “when my Father establishes his rule on earth” (See: [[rc://*/ta/man/translate/figs-metonymy]])
26:29 m9vq rc://*/ta/man/translate/guidelines-sonofgodprinciples τοῦ Πατρός μου 1 This is an important title for God that describes the relationship between God and Jesus. (See: [[rc://*/ta/man/translate/guidelines-sonofgodprinciples]])
26:30 nzy2 0 In verse 31, Jesus quotes the prophet Zechariah to show that in order to fulfill prophecy, all of his disciples will leave him.
26:30 nkw2 0 Jesus continues to teach his disciples as they walk to the Mount of Olives.
26:30 ed5k καὶ ὑμνήσαντες 1 a song of praise to God
26:31 v8yl σκανδαλισθήσεσθε 1 “leave me”
26:31 iap6 rc://*/ta/man/translate/figs-activepassive γέγραπται γάρ 1 This can be stated in active form. Alternate translation: “for the prophet Zechariah wrote long ago in the scriptures” (See: [[rc://*/ta/man/translate/figs-activepassive]])
26:31 u1t5 rc://*/ta/man/translate/figs-explicit πατάξω 1 Here “I” refers to God. It is implied that God will cause or allow people to harm and kill Jesus. (See: [[rc://*/ta/man/translate/figs-explicit]])
26:31 mc1e rc://*/ta/man/translate/figs-metaphor τὸν ποιμένα & τὰ πρόβατα τῆς ποίμνης 1 These are metaphors that refer to Jesus and the disciples. (See: [[rc://*/ta/man/translate/figs-metaphor]])
26:31 rvk1 rc://*/ta/man/translate/figs-activepassive διασκορπισθήσονται τὰ πρόβατα τῆς ποίμνης 1 This can be stated in active form. Alternate translation: “they will scatter all the sheep of the flock” or “the sheep of the flock will run off in all directions” (See: [[rc://*/ta/man/translate/figs-activepassive]])
26:32 pj2u rc://*/ta/man/translate/figs-activepassive μετὰ & τὸ ἐγερθῆναί με 1 Here to raise up is an idiom for causing someone who has died to become alive again. This can be stated in active form. Alternate translation: “after God raises me up” or “after God brings me back to life” (See: [[rc://*/ta/man/translate/figs-activepassive]] and [[rc://*/ta/man/translate/figs-idiom]])
26:33 m2un σκανδαλισθήσονται 1 See how you translated this in [Matthew 26:31](../26/31.md).
26:34 sf9x ἀμὴν, λέγω σοι 1 “I tell you the truth.” This adds emphasis to what Jesus says next.
26:34 ui4y rc://*/ta/man/translate/figs-metonymy πρὶν ἀλέκτορα φωνῆσαι 1 Roosters often crow about the time the sun comes up, so the hearers might have understood these words as a metonym for the sun coming up. However, the actual crowing of a rooster is an important part of the story later on, so keep the word “rooster” in the translation. (See: [[rc://*/ta/man/translate/figs-metonymy]])
26:34 lx5i ἀλέκτορα 1 a male chicken, a bird that calls out loudly around the time the sun comes up
26:34 h66w φωνῆσαι 1 This is the common English word for what a rooster does to make his loud call.
26:34 b2rh τρὶς ἀπαρνήσῃ με 1 “you will say three times that you are not my follower”
26:36 lm3n 0 This begins the account of Jesus praying in Gethsemane.
26:37 ny4m ἤρξατο λυπεῖσθαι 1 “he became very sad”
26:38 gf7k rc://*/ta/man/translate/figs-synecdoche περίλυπός ἐστιν ἡ ψυχή μου 1 Here “soul” refers to the whole person. Alternate translation: “I am very sad” (See: [[rc://*/ta/man/translate/figs-synecdoche]])
26:38 c43t rc://*/ta/man/translate/figs-idiom ἕως θανάτου 1 This is an idiom. Alternate translation: “and I feel as if I could even die” (See: [[rc://*/ta/man/translate/figs-idiom]])
26:39 kcz4 rc://*/ta/man/translate/figs-idiom ἔπεσεν ἐπὶ πρόσωπον αὐτοῦ 1 He purposely lay face down on the ground to pray. (See: [[rc://*/ta/man/translate/figs-idiom]])
26:39 nuv7 rc://*/ta/man/translate/guidelines-sonofgodprinciples Πάτερ μου 1 This is an important title for God that shows the relationship between God and Jesus. (See: [[rc://*/ta/man/translate/guidelines-sonofgodprinciples]])
26:39 f254 rc://*/ta/man/translate/figs-metaphor παρελθέτω ἀπ’ ἐμοῦ τὸ ποτήριον τοῦτο 1 Jesus speaks of the work that he must do, including dying on the cross, as if it were a bitter liquid that God has commanded him to drink from a cup. The word “cup” is an important word in the New Testament, so try to use an equivalent for that in your translation. (See: [[rc://*/ta/man/translate/figs-metaphor]])
26:39 i7rr rc://*/ta/man/translate/figs-metonymy τὸ ποτήριον τοῦτο 1 Here “cup” is a metonym that stands for the cup and the contents within it. The contents in the cup are a metaphor for the suffering that Jesus will have to endure. Jesus is asking the Father if it is possible for him not to have to experience the death and suffering that Jesus knows will soon happen. (See: [[rc://*/ta/man/translate/figs-metonymy]] and [[rc://*/ta/man/translate/figs-metaphor]])
26:39 k5in rc://*/ta/man/translate/figs-ellipsis πλὴν οὐχ ὡς ἐγὼ θέλω, ἀλλ’ ὡς σύ 1 This can be expressed as a full sentence. Alternate translation: “But do not do what I want; instead, do what you want” (See: [[rc://*/ta/man/translate/figs-ellipsis]])
26:40 ev7s rc://*/ta/man/translate/figs-you λέγει τῷ Πέτρῳ, οὕτως οὐκ ἰσχύσατε & γρηγορῆσαι 1 Jesus is speaking to Peter, but the “you” is plural, referring to Peter, James, and John. (See: [[rc://*/ta/man/translate/figs-you]])
26:40 c11a rc://*/ta/man/translate/figs-rquestion οὕτως οὐκ ἰσχύσατε μίαν ὥραν γρηγορῆσαι μετ’ ἐμοῦ? 1 Jesus uses a question to scold Peter, James, and John. Alternate translation: “I am disappointed that you could not stay awake with me for one hour!” (See: [[rc://*/ta/man/translate/figs-rquestion]])
26:41 buv4 rc://*/ta/man/translate/figs-abstractnouns μὴ εἰσέλθητε εἰς πειρασμόν 1 Here the abstract noun “temptation” can be stated as a verb. Alternate translation: “no one tempts you to sin” (See: [[rc://*/ta/man/translate/figs-abstractnouns]])
26:41 ny5w rc://*/ta/man/translate/figs-metonymy τὸ μὲν πνεῦμα πρόθυμον, ἡ δὲ σὰρξ ἀσθενής 1 Here “spirit” is a metonym that stands for a persons desires to do good. “Flesh” stands for the needs and desires of a persons body. Jesus means that the disciples may have the desire to do what God wants, but as humans they are weak and often fail. (See: [[rc://*/ta/man/translate/figs-metonymy]] and [[rc://*/ta/man/translate/figs-synecdoche]])
26:42 pz9l ἀπελθὼν 1 “Jesus went away”
26:42 tqp8 rc://*/ta/man/translate/translate-ordinal ἐκ δευτέρου 1 The first time is described in [Matthew 26:39](./39.md). (See: [[rc://*/ta/man/translate/translate-ordinal]])
26:42 ch7t rc://*/ta/man/translate/guidelines-sonofgodprinciples Πάτερ μου 1 This is an important title for God that describes the relationship between God and Jesus. (See: [[rc://*/ta/man/translate/guidelines-sonofgodprinciples]])
26:42 b6cn rc://*/ta/man/translate/figs-metaphor εἰ οὐ δύναται τοῦτο παρελθεῖν, ἐὰν μὴ αὐτὸ πίω 1 “if the only way this can pass away is if I drink it.” Jesus speaks of the work that he must do as if it were a bitter liquid that God has commanded him to drink. (See: [[rc://*/ta/man/translate/figs-metaphor]])
26:42 td6g rc://*/ta/man/translate/figs-metaphor εἰ & τοῦτο 1 Here “this” refers to the cup and the contents within it, a metaphor for suffering, as in [Matthew 26:39](../26/39.md). (See: [[rc://*/ta/man/translate/figs-metaphor]])
26:42 i135 rc://*/ta/man/translate/figs-metaphor ἐὰν μὴ αὐτὸ πίω 1 “unless I drink from it” or “unless I drink from this cup of suffering.” Here “it” refers to the cup and the contents within it, a metaphor for suffering, as in [Matthew 26:39](../26/39.md). (See: [[rc://*/ta/man/translate/figs-metaphor]])
26:42 xsk1 rc://*/ta/man/translate/figs-activepassive γενηθήτω τὸ θέλημά σου 1 This can be stated in active form. Alternate translation: “may what you want happen” or “do what you want to do” (See: [[rc://*/ta/man/translate/figs-activepassive]])
26:43 lts9 rc://*/ta/man/translate/figs-idiom ἦσαν & αὐτῶν οἱ ὀφθαλμοὶ βεβαρημένοι 1 This is an idiom. Alternate translation: “they were very sleepy” (See: [[rc://*/ta/man/translate/figs-idiom]])
26:44 v3i9 rc://*/ta/man/translate/translate-ordinal ἐκ τρίτου 1 The first time is described in [Matthew 26:39](./39.md). (See: [[rc://*/ta/man/translate/translate-ordinal]])
26:45 vvp9 rc://*/ta/man/translate/figs-rquestion καθεύδετε τὸ λοιπὸν καὶ ἀναπαύεσθε? 1 Jesus uses a question to scold the disciples for going to sleep. Alternate translation: “I am disappointed that you are still sleeping and resting!” (See: [[rc://*/ta/man/translate/figs-rquestion]])
26:45 rw3r rc://*/ta/man/translate/figs-idiom ἤγγικεν ἡ ὥρα 1 This is an idiom. Alternate translation: “the time has come” (See: [[rc://*/ta/man/translate/figs-idiom]])
26:45 g9hi rc://*/ta/man/translate/figs-activepassive ὁ Υἱὸς τοῦ Ἀνθρώπου παραδίδοται 1 This can be stated in active form. Alternate translation: “someone is betraying the Son of Man” (See: [[rc://*/ta/man/translate/figs-activepassive]])
26:45 ell4 rc://*/ta/man/translate/figs-123person ὁ Υἱὸς τοῦ Ἀνθρώπου 1 Jesus is speaking about himself in the third person. (See: [[rc://*/ta/man/translate/figs-123person]])
26:45 g9eb rc://*/ta/man/translate/figs-metonymy παραδίδοται εἰς χεῖρας ἁμαρτωλῶν 1 Here “hands” refers to power or control. Alternate translation: “betrayed into the power of sinners” or “betrayed so that sinners will have power over him” (See: [[rc://*/ta/man/translate/figs-metonymy]])
26:45 yx8v ἰδοὺ 1 “Pay attention to what I am about to tell you”
26:47 hsv7 0 This begins the account of when Judas betrayed Jesus and the religious leaders arrested him.
26:47 rlp9 καὶ ἔτι αὐτοῦ λαλοῦντος 1 “While Jesus was still speaking”
26:47 e26h ξύλων 1 large pieces of hard wood for hitting people
26:48 qb4y rc://*/ta/man/translate/writing-background δὲ & κρατήσατε αὐτόν 1 Here “Now” is used to mark a break in the main story line. Here Matthew tells background information about Judas and the signal he planned to use to betray Jesus. (See: [[rc://*/ta/man/translate/writing-background]])
26:48 gw8m rc://*/ta/man/translate/figs-quotations λέγων, ὃν ἂν φιλήσω, αὐτός ἐστιν; κρατήσατε αὐτόν. 1 This direct quotation can be stated as an indirect quotation. Alternate translation: “saying that whomever he kissed was the one they should seize.” (See: [[rc://*/ta/man/translate/figs-quotations]])
26:48 m23z ὃν ἂν φιλήσω 1 “The one I kiss” or “The man whom I kiss”
26:48 nr34 φιλήσω 1 This was a respectful way to greet ones teacher.
26:49 uig8 προσελθὼν τῷ Ἰησοῦ 1 “Judas came up to Jesus”
26:49 cyb7 κατεφίλησεν αὐτόν 1 “met him with a kiss.” Good friends would kiss each other on the cheek, but a disciple would probably kiss his master on the hand to show respect. No one knows for sure how Judas kissed Jesus.
26:50 w3d6 τότε προσελθόντες 1 Here “they” refers to the people with clubs and swords that came with Judas and the religious leaders.
26:50 vmd1 ἐπέβαλον τὰς χεῖρας ἐπὶ τὸν Ἰησοῦν, καὶ ἐκράτησαν αὐτόν 1 “grabbed Jesus, and arrested him”
26:51 vm6s καὶ ἰδοὺ 1 The word “behold” here alerts us to pay attention to the surprising information that follows.
26:52 tj6n rc://*/ta/man/translate/figs-metonymy οἱ λαβόντες μάχαιραν 1 The word “sword” is a metonym for the act of killing someone with a sword. The implied information can be stated explicitly. Alternate translation: “who pick up a sword to kill others” or “who want to kill other people” (See: [[rc://*/ta/man/translate/figs-metonymy]] and [[rc://*/ta/man/translate/figs-explicit]])
26:52 w357 μάχαιραν, ἐν μαχαίρῃ ἀπολοῦνται 1 “sword will die by means of the sword” or “sword—it is with the sword that someone will kill them”
26:53 kgx8 rc://*/ta/man/translate/figs-rquestion ἢ δοκεῖς ὅτι οὐ δύναμαι παρακαλέσαι & ἀγγέλων 1 Jesus uses a question to remind the person with the sword that Jesus could stop those who are arresting him. Alternate translation: “Surely you know that I could call … angels” (See: [[rc://*/ta/man/translate/figs-rquestion]])
26:53 eb7i rc://*/ta/man/translate/figs-you δοκεῖς 1 Here “you” is singular and refers to the person with the sword. (See: [[rc://*/ta/man/translate/figs-you]])
26:53 g3zq rc://*/ta/man/translate/guidelines-sonofgodprinciples τὸν Πατέρα μου 1 This is an important title for God that describes the relationship between God and Jesus. (See: [[rc://*/ta/man/translate/guidelines-sonofgodprinciples]])
26:53 tfw8 rc://*/ta/man/translate/translate-numbers πλείω δώδεκα λεγιῶνας ἀγγέλων 1 The word “legion” is a military term that refers to a group of about 6,000 soldiers. Jesus means God would send enough angels to easily stop those who are arresting Jesus. The exact number of angels is not important. Alternate translation: “more than 12 really large groups of angels” (See: [[rc://*/ta/man/translate/translate-numbers]])
26:54 teq5 rc://*/ta/man/translate/figs-rquestion πῶς οὖν πληρωθῶσιν αἱ Γραφαὶ, ὅτι οὕτως δεῖ γενέσθαι? 1 Jesus uses a question to explain why he is letting these people arrest him. This can be stated in active form. Alternate translation: “But if I did that, I would not be able to fulfill what God said in the scriptures must happen” (See: [[rc://*/ta/man/translate/figs-rquestion]] and [[rc://*/ta/man/translate/figs-activepassive]])
26:55 yf4p rc://*/ta/man/translate/figs-rquestion ὡς ἐπὶ λῃστὴν ἐξήλθατε μετὰ μαχαιρῶν καὶ ξύλων συνλαβεῖν με? 1 Jesus is using this question to point out the wrong actions of those arresting him. Alternate translation: “You know that I am not a robber, so it is wrong for you to come out to me bringing swords and clubs” (See: [[rc://*/ta/man/translate/figs-rquestion]])
26:55 q9vq ξύλων 1 large pieces of hard wood for hitting people
26:55 e8dq rc://*/ta/man/translate/figs-explicit ἐν τῷ ἱερῷ 1 It is implied that Jesus was not in the actual temple. He was in the courtyard around the temple. (See: [[rc://*/ta/man/translate/figs-explicit]])
26:56 ygn7 rc://*/ta/man/translate/figs-activepassive πληρωθῶσιν αἱ Γραφαὶ τῶν προφητῶν 1 This can be stated in active form. Alternate translation: “I would fulfill all that the prophets wrote in the scriptures” (See: [[rc://*/ta/man/translate/figs-activepassive]])
26:56 i2jp ἀφέντες αὐτὸν 1 If your language has a word that means they left him when they should have stayed with him, use it here.
26:57 f6nj 0 This begins the account of Jesus trial before the council of Jewish religious leaders.
26:58 jui3 ὁ δὲ Πέτρος ἠκολούθει αὐτῷ 1 “Peter followed Jesus”
26:58 isd4 τῆς αὐλῆς τοῦ ἀρχιερέως 1 an open area near the high priests house
26:58 v8th καὶ εἰσελθὼν ἔσω 1 “Peter went inside”
26:59 i8jw δὲ 1 This word is used here to mark a break in the main story line. Here Matthew starts to tell a new part of the story.
26:59 jwz5 αὐτὸν θανατώσωσιν 1 Here “they” refers to the chief priests and the members of the council.
26:59 u6v9 αὐτὸν θανατώσωσιν 1 “might have a reason to execute him”
26:60 m6n5 προσελθόντες δύο 1 “two men came forward” or “two witnesses came forward”
26:61 a8lf rc://*/ta/man/translate/writing-quotations εἶπον, οὗτος ἔφη, δύναμαι καταλῦσαι & διὰ τριῶν ἡμερῶν οἰκοδομῆσαι. 1 If your language does not allow quotes within quotes you can rewrite it as a single quote. Alternate translation: “This man said that he is able to destroy … days.” (See: [[rc://*/ta/man/translate/writing-quotations]] and [[rc://*/ta/man/translate/figs-quotations]])
26:61 i5n4 οὗτος ἔφη 1 “This man Jesus said”
26:61 mbq1 διὰ τριῶν ἡμερῶν 1 “within three days,” before the sun goes down three times, not “after three days,” after the sun has gone down the third time
26:62 v6j9 τί οὗτοί σου καταμαρτυροῦσιν? 1 The chief priest is not asking Jesus for information about what the witnesses said. He is asking Jesus to prove what the witnesses said is wrong. Alternate translation: “What is your response to what the witnesses are testifying against you?”
26:63 mm28 rc://*/ta/man/translate/guidelines-sonofgodprinciples ὁ Υἱὸς τοῦ Θεοῦ 1 This is an important title that describes the relationship between the Christ and God. (See: [[rc://*/ta/man/translate/guidelines-sonofgodprinciples]])
26:63 lry9 τοῦ Θεοῦ τοῦ ζῶντος 1 Here “living” contrasts the God of Israel to all the false gods and idols that people worshiped. Only the God of Israel is alive and has power to act. See how you translated this in [Matthew 16:16](../16/16.md).
26:64 gi6v rc://*/ta/man/translate/figs-idiom σὺ εἶπας 1 This is an idiom that Jesus uses to mean “yes” without being completely clear about what he means. Alternate translation: “You are saying it” or “You are admitting it” (See: [[rc://*/ta/man/translate/figs-idiom]])
26:64 zu47 rc://*/ta/man/translate/figs-you πλὴν λέγω ὑμῖν, ἀπ’ ἄρτι ὄψεσθε 1 Here “you” is plural. Jesus is speaking to the high priest and to the other persons there. (See: [[rc://*/ta/man/translate/figs-you]])
26:64 ll8r ἀπ’ ἄρτι ὄψεσθε τὸν Υἱὸν τοῦ Ἀνθρώπου 1 Possible meanings are (1) the phrase “from now on” is an idiom that means they will see the Son of Man in his power at some time in the future or (2) the phrase “from now on” means that from the time of Jesus trial and onward, Jesus is showing himself to be the Messiah who is powerful and victorious.
26:64 b6cb rc://*/ta/man/translate/figs-123person τὸν Υἱὸν τοῦ Ἀνθρώπου 1 Jesus is speaking about himself in third person. (See: [[rc://*/ta/man/translate/figs-123person]])
26:64 p5px rc://*/ta/man/translate/figs-metonymy καθήμενον ἐκ δεξιῶν τῆς δυνάμεως 1 Here “Power” is metonym that represents God. To sit at the “right hand of God” is a symbolic action of receiving great honor and authority from God. Alternate translation: “sitting in the place of honor beside the all-powerful God” (See: [[rc://*/ta/man/translate/figs-metonymy]] and [[rc://*/ta/man/translate/translate-symaction]])
26:64 urp9 ἐρχόμενον ἐπὶ τῶν νεφελῶν τοῦ οὐρανοῦ 1 “riding to earth on the clouds of heaven”
26:65 srg6 rc://*/ta/man/translate/translate-symaction ὁ ἀρχιερεὺς διέρρηξεν τὰ ἱμάτια αὐτοῦ 1 Tearing clothing was a sign of anger and sadness. (See: [[rc://*/ta/man/translate/translate-symaction]])
26:65 qq51 rc://*/ta/man/translate/figs-explicit ἐβλασφήμησεν 1 The reason the high priest called Jesus statement blasphemy is probably that he understood Jesus words in [Matthew 26:64](../26/64.md) as a claim to be equal with God. (See: [[rc://*/ta/man/translate/figs-explicit]])
26:65 t68t rc://*/ta/man/translate/figs-rquestion τί ἔτι χρείαν ἔχομεν μαρτύρων? 1 The high priest uses this question to emphasize that he and the members of the council do not need to hear from any more witnesses. Alternate translation: “We do not need to hear from any more witnesses!” (See: [[rc://*/ta/man/translate/figs-rquestion]])
26:65 wh4h rc://*/ta/man/translate/figs-you νῦν ἠκούσατε 1 Here “you” is plural and refers to the members of the council. (See: [[rc://*/ta/man/translate/figs-you]])
26:67 adc2 τότε ἐνέπτυσαν 1 Possible meanings are (1) “Then some of the men” or (2) “Then the soldiers.”
26:67 g1c2 ἐνέπτυσαν εἰς τὸ πρόσωπον αὐτοῦ 1 This was done as an insult.
26:68 f2bj προφήτευσον ἡμῖν 1 Here “Prophesy to us” means to tell by means of Gods power. It does not mean to tell what will happen in the future.
26:68 b5xe rc://*/ta/man/translate/figs-irony Χριστέ 1 Those hitting Jesus do not really think he is the Christ. They call him this to mock him. (See: [[rc://*/ta/man/translate/figs-irony]])
26:69 bsb3 0 These events happen at the same time as Jesus trial before the religious leaders.
26:69 h5ts 0 This begins the account of how Peter denies three times that he knows Jesus, as Jesus said he would do.
26:69 y21l δὲ 1 This word is used here to mark a break in the main story line. Here Matthew starts to tell a new part of the story.
26:70 sp1t οὐκ οἶδα τί λέγεις 1 Peter was able to understand what the servant girl was saying. He used these words to deny that he had been with Jesus.
26:71 ief5 ἐξελθόντα δὲ 1 “When Peter went out”
26:71 gyw8 τὸν πυλῶνα 1 opening in the wall around a courtyard
26:71 s7c4 λέγει τοῖς ἐκεῖ 1 “said to the people who were sitting there”
26:72 e5xl καὶ πάλιν ἠρνήσατο μετὰ ὅρκου, ὅτι οὐκ οἶδα τὸν ἄνθρωπον. 1 “he denied it again by swearing, I do not know the man!’”
26:73 hde3 ἐξ αὐτῶν 1 “one of those who were with Jesus”
26:73 w8ww γὰρ ἡ λαλιά σου δῆλόν σε ποιεῖ 1 This can be translated as a new sentence. Alternate translation: “We can tell you are from Galilee because you speak like a Galilean”
26:74 edd8 καταθεματίζειν 1 “to call down a curse on himself”
26:74 w87b ἀλέκτωρ ἐφώνησεν 1 A rooster is a bird that calls out loudly around the time the sun comes up. The sound a rooster makes is called “crowing.” See how you translated this in [Matthew 26:34](../26/34.md).
26:75 nx3j rc://*/ta/man/translate/figs-quotations καὶ ἐμνήσθη ὁ Πέτρος τοῦ ῥήματος Ἰησοῦ εἰρηκότος, ὅτι πρὶν ἀλέκτορα φωνῆσαι, τρὶς ἀπαρνήσῃ με 1 This direct quotation can be stated as an indirect quotation. Alternate translation: “Peter remembered that Jesus told him that before the rooster crowed, he would deny Jesus three times” (See: [[rc://*/ta/man/translate/figs-quotations]])
27:intro deu4 0 # Matthew 27 General Notes\n## Special concepts in this chapter\n\n### “Delivered him to Pilate the governor”\n\nThe Jewish leaders needed to get permission from Pontius Pilate, the Roman governor, before they could kill Jesus. This was because Roman law did not allow them to kill Jesus themselves. Pilate wanted to set Jesus free, but they wanted him to free a very bad prisoner named Barabbas.\n\n### The tomb\n\nThe tomb in which Jesus was buried ([Matthew 27:60](../../mat/27/60.md)) was the kind of tomb in which wealthy Jewish families buried their dead. It was an actual room cut into a rock. It had a flat place on one side where they could place the body after they had put oil and spices on it and wrapped it in cloth. Then they would roll a large rock in front of the tomb so no one could see inside or enter.\n\n## Important figures of speech in this chapter\n\n### Sarcasm\n\nThe soldiers said, “Hail, King of the Jews!” ([Matthew 27:29](../../mat/27/29.md)) to mock Jesus. They did not think that he was the king of the Jews. (See: [[rc://*/ta/man/translate/figs-irony]])
27:1 hvr4 0 This begins the account of Jesus trial before Pilate.
27:1 qe1s δὲ 1 This word is used here to mark a break in the main story line. Here Matthew starts to tell a new part of the story.
27:1 cm46 rc://*/ta/man/translate/figs-explicit συμβούλιον ἔλαβον & κατὰ τοῦ Ἰησοῦ, ὥστε θανατῶσαι αὐτόν 1 The Jewish leaders were planning how they could convince the Roman leaders to kill Jesus. (See: [[rc://*/ta/man/translate/figs-explicit]])
27:3 vzf9 rc://*/ta/man/translate/figs-events 0 This event happened after Jesus trial in front of the council of Jewish religious leaders, but we do not know if it happened before or during Jesus trial before Pilate. (See: [[rc://*/ta/man/translate/figs-events]])
27:3 bk8i 0 The author has stopped telling the story of Jesus trial so he can tell the story of how Judas killed himself.
27:3 qm12 τότε ἰδὼν Ἰούδας 1 If your language has a way of showing that a new story is starting, you may want to use that here.
27:3 v9vj rc://*/ta/man/translate/figs-activepassive ὅτι κατεκρίθη 1 This can be stated in active form. Alternate translation: “that the Jewish leaders had condemned Jesus” (See: [[rc://*/ta/man/translate/figs-activepassive]])
27:3 pe4n τὰ τριάκοντα ἀργύρια 1 This was the money that the chief priests had given Judas to betray Jesus. See how you translated it in [Matthew 26:15](../26/15.md).
27:4 f6u8 rc://*/ta/man/translate/figs-idiom αἷμα ἀθῷον 1 This is an idiom that refers to the death of an innocent person. Alternate translation: “a person who does not deserve to die” (See: [[rc://*/ta/man/translate/figs-idiom]])
27:4 mf6b rc://*/ta/man/translate/figs-rquestion τί πρὸς ἡμᾶς? 1 The Jewish leaders use this question to emphasize that they do not care about what Judas said. Alternate translation: “That is not our problem!” or “That is your problem!” (See: [[rc://*/ta/man/translate/figs-rquestion]])
27:5 tuh4 ῥίψας τὰ ἀργύρια εἰς τὸν ναὸν 1 Possible meanings are (1) he threw the pieces of silver while in the temple courtyard, or (2) he was standing in the temple courtyard, and he threw the pieces of silver into the temple.
27:6 r5r9 οὐκ ἔξεστιν βαλεῖν αὐτὰ 1 “Our laws do not allow us to put this”
27:6 ce2x βαλεῖν αὐτὰ 1 “put this silver”
27:6 gtp3 rc://*/ta/man/translate/figs-explicit τὸν κορβανᾶν 1 This is the place they kept the money they used to provide for things needed for the temple and the priests. (See: [[rc://*/ta/man/translate/figs-explicit]])
27:6 j2l8 rc://*/ta/man/translate/figs-idiom τιμὴ αἵματός 1 This is an idiom that means money paid to a person who helped kill someone. Alternate translation: “money paid for a man to die” (See: [[rc://*/ta/man/translate/figs-idiom]])
27:7 mtg6 τὸν Ἀγρὸν τοῦ Κεραμέως 1 This was a field that was bought to bury strangers who died in Jerusalem.
27:8 nts8 rc://*/ta/man/translate/figs-activepassive ἐκλήθη ὁ ἀγρὸς ἐκεῖνος 1 This can be stated in active form. Alternate translation: “people call that field” (See: [[rc://*/ta/man/translate/figs-activepassive]])
27:8 ag2n ἕως τῆς σήμερον 1 This means to the time that Matthew is writing this book.
27:9 g1gc 0 The author quotes Old Testament scripture to show that Judas suicide was a fulfillment of prophecy.
27:9 rj3u rc://*/ta/man/translate/figs-activepassive τότε ἐπληρώθη τὸ ῥηθὲν διὰ Ἰερεμίου τοῦ προφήτου 1 This can be stated in active form. Alternate translation: “This fulfilled what the prophet Jeremiah spoke” (See: [[rc://*/ta/man/translate/figs-activepassive]])
27:9 t1dj rc://*/ta/man/translate/figs-activepassive τὴν τιμὴν τοῦ τετιμημένου, ὃν ἐτιμήσαντο ἀπὸ υἱῶν Ἰσραήλ 1 This can be stated in active form. Alternate translation: “the price the people of Israel set on him” (See: [[rc://*/ta/man/translate/figs-activepassive]])
27:9 d7l7 rc://*/ta/man/translate/figs-metonymy υἱῶν Ἰσραήλ 1 This refers to those among the people of Israel who paid to kill Jesus. Alternate translation: “some of the people of Israel” or “the leaders of Israel” (See: [[rc://*/ta/man/translate/figs-metonymy]])
27:10 c2ch συνέταξέν μοι 1 Here “me” refers to Jeremiah.
27:11 pjc5 0 This continues the story of Jesus trial before Pilate, which began in [Matthew 27:2](../27/02.md).
27:11 we3a δὲ 1 If your language has a way of continuing a story after a break from the main story line, you may want to use it here.
27:11 a2e7 τοῦ ἡγεμόνος 1 “Pilate”
27:11 a6cm rc://*/ta/man/translate/figs-explicit αὐτῷ σὺ λέγεις 1 Possible meanings are (1) by saying this, Jesus implied that he is the King of the Jews. Alternate translation: “Yes, as you said, I am” or “Yes. It is as you said” or (2) by saying this, Jesus was saying that Pilate, not Jesus, was the one calling him the King of the Jews. Alternate translation: “You yourself have said so” (See: [[rc://*/ta/man/translate/figs-explicit]])
27:12 vl3a rc://*/ta/man/translate/figs-activepassive καὶ ἐν τῷ κατηγορεῖσθαι αὐτὸν ὑπὸ τῶν ἀρχιερέων καὶ τῶν πρεσβυτέρων 1 This can be stated in active form. Alternate translation: “But when the chief priests and elders accused him” (See: [[rc://*/ta/man/translate/figs-activepassive]])
27:13 wn2r rc://*/ta/man/translate/figs-rquestion οὐκ ἀκούεις πόσα σου καταμαρτυροῦσιν? 1 Pilate asks this question because he is surprised that Jesus remains silent. Alternate translation: “I am surprised that you do not answer these people who accuse you of doing bad things!” (See: [[rc://*/ta/man/translate/figs-rquestion]])
27:14 hbm8 οὐκ ἀπεκρίθη αὐτῷ πρὸς οὐδὲ ἓν ῥῆμα, ὥστε θαυμάζειν τὸν ἡγεμόνα λίαν 1 “did not say even one word; this greatly amazed the governor.” This is an emphatic way of saying that Jesus was completely silent.
27:15 jjp8 rc://*/ta/man/translate/writing-background δὲ 1 This word is used here to mark a break in the main story line so Matthew can give information to help the reader understand what happens beginning in [Matthew 27:17](../27/17.md). (See: [[rc://*/ta/man/translate/writing-background]])
27:15 p1ha ἑορτὴν 1 This is the feast for the Passover celebration.
27:15 pfk6 rc://*/ta/man/translate/figs-activepassive ἕνα τῷ ὄχλῳ δέσμιον, ὃν ἤθελον 1 This can be stated in active form. Alternate translation: “prisoner whom the crowd would choose” (See: [[rc://*/ta/man/translate/figs-activepassive]])
27:16 q2iu εἶχον & δέσμιον ἐπίσημον 1 “there was a notorious prisoner”
27:16 svr2 ἐπίσημον 1 well known for doing something bad
27:17 d8hv rc://*/ta/man/translate/figs-activepassive συνηγμένων & αὐτῶν 1 This can be stated in active form. Alternate translation: “the crowd gathered” (See: [[rc://*/ta/man/translate/figs-activepassive]])
27:17 wrl3 rc://*/ta/man/translate/figs-activepassive Ἰησοῦν, τὸν λεγόμενον Χριστόν 1 This can be stated in active form. Alternate translation: “whom some people call the Christ” (See: [[rc://*/ta/man/translate/figs-activepassive]])
27:18 jq3c παρέδωκαν αὐτόν 1 “the Jewish leaders had brought Jesus to him.” They had done this so that Pilate would judge Jesus.
27:19 t3mx καθημένου δὲ αὐτοῦ 1 “While Pilate was sitting”
27:19 s5pc καθημένου & ἐπὶ τοῦ βήματος 1 “sitting on the judges seat.” This is where a judge would sit while making a decision.
27:19 w4i8 ἀπέστειλεν 1 “sent a message”
27:19 an95 πολλὰ & ἔπαθον σήμερον 1 “I have been very upset today”
27:20 ax1i rc://*/ta/man/translate/writing-background δὲ & τὸν δὲ Ἰησοῦν ἀπολέσωσιν 1 Here “now” is used to mark a break in the main story line. Matthew tells background information about why the crowd chose Barabbas. (See: [[rc://*/ta/man/translate/writing-background]])
27:20 et2m rc://*/ta/man/translate/figs-activepassive τὸν δὲ Ἰησοῦν ἀπολέσωσιν 1 This can be stated in active form. Alternate translation: “have the Roman soldiers kill Jesus” (See: [[rc://*/ta/man/translate/figs-activepassive]])
27:21 x6vf εἶπεν αὐτοῖς 1 “asked the crowd”
27:22 zl85 rc://*/ta/man/translate/figs-activepassive τὸν λεγόμενον Χριστόν 1 This can be stated in active form. Alternate translation: “whom some people call the Christ” (See: [[rc://*/ta/man/translate/figs-activepassive]])
27:23 m5jm ἐποίησεν 1 “has Jesus done”
27:23 nb7p οἱ & ἔκραζον 1 “the crowd cried out”
27:24 yj8t rc://*/ta/man/translate/translate-symaction ἀπενίψατο τὰς χεῖρας ἀπέναντι τοῦ ὄχλου 1 Pilate does this as a sign that he is not responsible for Jesus death. (See: [[rc://*/ta/man/translate/translate-symaction]])
27:24 u1fe rc://*/ta/man/translate/figs-metonymy τοῦ αἵματος 1 Here “blood” refers to a persons death. Alternate translation: “the death” (See: [[rc://*/ta/man/translate/figs-metonymy]])
27:24 de8w ὑμεῖς ὄψεσθε 1 “This is your responsibility”
27:25 n5k1 rc://*/ta/man/translate/figs-metonymy τὸ αἷμα αὐτοῦ ἐφ’ ἡμᾶς καὶ ἐπὶ τὰ τέκνα ἡμῶν 1 Here “blood” is a metonym that stands for a persons death. The phrase “be on us and our children” is an idiom that means they accept the responsibility of what is happening. Alternate translation: “Yes! We and our descendants will be responsible for executing him” (See: [[rc://*/ta/man/translate/figs-metonymy]] and [[rc://*/ta/man/translate/figs-idiom]])
27:26 yb5y τότε ἀπέλυσεν αὐτοῖς τὸν Βαραββᾶν 1 “Then Pilate released Barabbas to the crowd”
27:26 m63d rc://*/ta/man/translate/figs-explicit τὸν δὲ Ἰησοῦν φραγελλώσας, παρέδωκεν ἵνα σταυρωθῇ 1 It is implied that Pilate ordered his soldiers to scourge Jesus. Handing Jesus over to be crucified is a metaphor for ordering his soldiers to crucify Jesus. Alternate translation: “he ordered his soldiers to scourge Jesus and to crucify him” (See: [[rc://*/ta/man/translate/figs-explicit]] and [[rc://*/ta/man/translate/figs-metaphor]] )
27:26 y3kf τὸν & Ἰησοῦν φραγελλώσας 1 “beat Jesus with a whip” or “whipped Jesus”
27:27 zz45 0 This begins the account of Jesus crucifixion and death.
27:27 bn22 τὴν σπεῖραν 1 “group of soldiers”
27:28 nx81 καὶ ἐκδύσαντες αὐτὸν 1 “pulled off his clothes”
27:28 qsz5 κοκκίνην 1 bright red
27:29 yw94 στέφανον ἐξ ἀκανθῶν 1 “a crown made of thorny branches” or “a crown made of branches with thorns on them”
27:29 dlz7 κάλαμον ἐν τῇ δεξιᾷ αὐτοῦ 1 They gave Jesus a stick to hold to represent a scepter that a king holds. They did this to mock Jesus.
27:29 qf8j rc://*/ta/man/translate/figs-irony χαῖρε, ὁ Βασιλεῦ τῶν Ἰουδαίων 1 They were saying this to mock Jesus. They were calling Jesus “King of the Jews,” but they did not really believe he was a king. And yet what they were saying was true. (See: [[rc://*/ta/man/translate/figs-irony]])
27:29 gf6a χαῖρε 1 “We honor you” or “May you live a long time”
27:30 ib5q καὶ ἐμπτύσαντες εἰς αὐτὸν 1 “using their spit, the soldiers spat on Jesus”
27:32 j5wq rc://*/ta/man/translate/figs-explicit ἐξερχόμενοι 1 This means Jesus and the soldiers came out of the city. Alternate translation: “As they came out of Jerusalem” (See: [[rc://*/ta/man/translate/figs-explicit]])
27:32 ies4 εὗρον ἄνθρωπον 1 “the soldiers saw a man”
27:32 sfj2 τοῦτον ἠγγάρευσαν ἵνα ἄρῃ τὸν σταυρὸν αὐτοῦ 1 “whom the soldiers forced to go with them so that he could carry Jesus cross”
27:33 j6hb rc://*/ta/man/translate/figs-activepassive τόπον λεγόμενον Γολγοθᾶ 1 This can be stated in active form. Alternate translation: “place that people called Golgotha” (See: [[rc://*/ta/man/translate/figs-activepassive]])
27:34 f11j rc://*/ta/man/translate/figs-activepassive αὐτῷ πιεῖν οἶνον μετὰ χολῆς μεμιγμένον 1 This can be stated in active form. Alternate translation: “him wine, which they had mixed with gall” (See: [[rc://*/ta/man/translate/figs-activepassive]])
27:34 e2uk χολῆς 1 the bitter, yellow liquid that bodies use in digestion
27:35 a1y1 rc://*/ta/man/translate/figs-explicit τὰ ἱμάτια αὐτοῦ 1 These were the clothes Jesus had been wearing. (See: [[rc://*/ta/man/translate/figs-explicit]])
27:37 j4s4 τὴν αἰτίαν αὐτοῦ 1 “a written explanation of why he was being crucified”
27:38 zq4b rc://*/ta/man/translate/figs-activepassive τότε σταυροῦνται σὺν αὐτῷ δύο λῃσταί 1 This can be stated in active form. Alternate translation: “The soldiers crucified two robbers with Jesus” (See: [[rc://*/ta/man/translate/figs-activepassive]])
27:39 d4fm rc://*/ta/man/translate/translate-symaction κινοῦντες τὰς κεφαλὰς αὐτῶν 1 They did this to make fun of Jesus. (See: [[rc://*/ta/man/translate/translate-symaction]])
27:40 t23i rc://*/ta/man/translate/figs-explicit εἰ υἱὸς εἶ τοῦ Θεοῦ, καὶ κατάβηθι ἀπὸ τοῦ σταυροῦ 1 They did not believe that Jesus is the Son of God, so they wanted him to prove it if it was true. Alternate translation: “If you are the Son of God, prove it by coming down from the cross” (See: [[rc://*/ta/man/translate/figs-explicit]])
27:40 b5lw rc://*/ta/man/translate/guidelines-sonofgodprinciples υἱὸς & τοῦ Θεοῦ 1 This is an important title for the Christ that describes his relationship to God. (See: [[rc://*/ta/man/translate/guidelines-sonofgodprinciples]])
27:42 ff4d rc://*/ta/man/translate/figs-irony ἄλλους ἔσωσεν, ἑαυτὸν οὐ δύναται σῶσαι 1 Possible meanings are (1) the Jewish leaders do not believe that Jesus saved others or that he can save himself, or (2) they believe he did save others but are laughing at him because now he cannot save himself. (See: [[rc://*/ta/man/translate/figs-irony]])
27:42 j6l7 rc://*/ta/man/translate/figs-irony Βασιλεὺς Ἰσραήλ ἐστιν, 1 The leaders are mocking Jesus. They call him “King of Israel,” but they do not really believe he is king. Alternate translation: “He says that he is the King of Israel” (See: [[rc://*/ta/man/translate/figs-irony]])
27:43 w46n 0 The Jewish leaders continue mocking Jesus.
27:43 cl97 rc://*/ta/man/translate/figs-quotesinquotes εἶπεν γὰρ, ὅτι Θεοῦ εἰμι Υἱός. 1 This is a quotation within a quotation. It can be stated as an indirect quotation. Alternate translation: “For Jesus even said that he is the Son of God.” (See: [[rc://*/ta/man/translate/figs-quotesinquotes]] and [[rc://*/ta/man/translate/figs-quotations]])
27:43 uw85 rc://*/ta/man/translate/guidelines-sonofgodprinciples Θεοῦ & Υἱός 1 This is an important title for Jesus that describes his relationship to God. (See: [[rc://*/ta/man/translate/guidelines-sonofgodprinciples]])
27:44 e26y rc://*/ta/man/translate/figs-activepassive οἱ λῃσταὶ, οἱ συνσταυρωθέντες σὺν αὐτῷ 1 This can be stated in active form. Alternate translation: “the robbers that the soldiers crucified with Jesus” (See: [[rc://*/ta/man/translate/figs-activepassive]])
27:45 e7z4 δὲ 1 This word is used here to mark a break in the main story line. Here Matthew starts to tell a new part of the story.
27:45 s2l7 ἀπὸ & ἕκτης ὥρας & ἕως ὥρας ἐνάτης 1 “from about noon … for three hours” or “from about twelve oclock midday … until about three oclock in the afternoon”
27:45 pi8e rc://*/ta/man/translate/figs-abstractnouns σκότος ἐγένετο ἐπὶ πᾶσαν τὴν γῆν 1 The word “darkness” is an abstract noun. Alternate translation: “it became dark over the whole land” (See: [[rc://*/ta/man/translate/figs-abstractnouns]])
27:46 qyp7 ἀνεβόησεν ὁ Ἰησοῦς 1 “Jesus called out” or “Jesus shouted”
27:46 xub2 rc://*/ta/man/translate/translate-transliterate Ἐλωῒ, Ἐλωῒ, λεμὰ σαβαχθάνει 1 These words are what Jesus cried out in his own language. Translators usually leave these words as is. (See: [[rc://*/ta/man/translate/translate-transliterate]])
27:48 jm37 εἷς ἐξ αὐτῶν 1 Possible meanings are (1) one of the soldiers or (2) one of those who stood by and watched.
27:48 bsy1 σπόγγον 1 This is a sea animal that is harvested and used to take up and hold liquids. These liquids can later be pushed out.
27:48 ny3e ἐπότιζεν αὐτόν 1 “gave it to Jesus”
27:50 fj1v rc://*/ta/man/translate/figs-euphemism ἀφῆκεν τὸ πνεῦμα 1 Here “spirit” refers to that which gives life to a person. This phrase is a way of saying that Jesus died. Alternate translation: “he died, giving his spirit over to God” or “he breathed his last breath” (See: [[rc://*/ta/man/translate/figs-euphemism]])
27:51 w1wq 0 This begins the account of the events that happened when Jesus died.
27:51 a92g ἰδοὺ 1 The word “behold” here alerts us to pay attention to the surprising information that follows.
27:51 m1ic rc://*/ta/man/translate/figs-activepassive τὸ καταπέτασμα τοῦ ναοῦ ἐσχίσθη εἰς δύο 1 This can be stated in active form. Alternate translation: “the curtain of the temple tore in two” or “God caused the curtain of the temple to tear in two” (See: [[rc://*/ta/man/translate/figs-activepassive]])
27:52 a1cu rc://*/ta/man/translate/figs-activepassive καὶ τὰ μνημεῖα ἀνεῴχθησαν, καὶ πολλὰ σώματα τῶν κεκοιμημένων ἁγίων ἠγέρθη 1 This can be stated in active form. Alternate translation: “God opened the tombs and raised the bodies of many godly people who had died” (See: [[rc://*/ta/man/translate/figs-activepassive]])
27:52 kj3r rc://*/ta/man/translate/figs-idiom σώματα τῶν κεκοιμημένων ἁγίων ἠγέρθη 1 Here to raise is an idiom for causing someone who has died to become alive again. This can be translated in active form. Alternate translation: “God put life back into to the dead bodies of many godly people who had fallen asleep” (See: [[rc://*/ta/man/translate/figs-idiom]])
27:52 hgn1 rc://*/ta/man/translate/figs-euphemism κεκοιμημένων 1 This is a polite way of referring to dying. Alternate translation: “died” (See: [[rc://*/ta/man/translate/figs-euphemism]])
27:53 q2x5 καὶ ἐξελθόντες ἐκ & ἐνεφανίσθησαν πολλοῖς 1 The order of the events that Matthew describes (beginning with the words “The tombs were opened” in verse 52) is unclear. After the earthquake when Jesus died and the tombs were opened (1) the holy people came back to life, and then, after Jesus came back to life, the holy people entered Jerusalem, where many people saw them, or (2) Jesus came back to life, and then the holy ones came back to life and entered the city, where many people saw them.
27:54 f6rz δὲ 1 This word is used here to mark a break in the main story line. Here Matthew starts to tell a new part of the story.
27:54 vv2g rc://*/ta/man/translate/figs-explicit οἱ & τηροῦντες τὸν Ἰησοῦν 1 “those who were guarding Jesus.” This refers to the other soldiers who were guarding Jesus with the centurion. Alternate translation: “the other soldiers with him who were guarding Jesus” (See: [[rc://*/ta/man/translate/figs-explicit]])
27:54 gw6n rc://*/ta/man/translate/guidelines-sonofgodprinciples Θεοῦ Υἱὸς 1 This is an important title for Jesus that describes his relationship to God. (See: [[rc://*/ta/man/translate/guidelines-sonofgodprinciples]])
27:56 ud33 ἡ μήτηρ τῶν υἱῶν Ζεβεδαίου 1 “the mother of James and John” or “the wife of Zebedee”
27:57 wm5z 0 This begins the account of Jesus burial.
27:57 sy9y rc://*/ta/man/translate/translate-names Ἁριμαθαίας 1 This is the name of a city in Israel. (See: [[rc://*/ta/man/translate/translate-names]])
27:58 c69n rc://*/ta/man/translate/figs-activepassive τότε ὁ Πειλᾶτος ἐκέλευσεν ἀποδοθῆναι 1 This can be stated in active form. Alternate translation: “Then Pilate ordered the soldiers to give the body of Jesus to Joseph” (See: [[rc://*/ta/man/translate/figs-activepassive]])
27:59 kj7u σινδόνι 1 a fine, costly cloth
27:60 hvs8 rc://*/ta/man/translate/figs-explicit ὃ ἐλατόμησεν ἐν τῇ πέτρᾳ 1 It is implied that Joseph had workers who cut the tomb into the rock. (See: [[rc://*/ta/man/translate/figs-explicit]])
27:60 lt4k rc://*/ta/man/translate/figs-explicit καὶ προσκυλίσας λίθον μέγαν 1 Most likely Joseph had other people there to help him roll the stone. (See: [[rc://*/ta/man/translate/figs-explicit]])
27:61 ihr8 ἀπέναντι τοῦ τάφου 1 “across from the tomb”
27:62 qj59 τὴν παρασκευήν 1 This is the day that people got everything ready for the Sabbath.
27:62 j57n συνήχθησαν & πρὸς Πειλᾶτον 1 “met with Pilate”
27:63 sc6y ἐκεῖνος ὁ πλάνος & ἔτι ζῶν 1 “when Jesus, the deceiver, was alive”
27:63 ri5s rc://*/ta/man/translate/figs-quotesinquotes εἶπεν & μετὰ τρεῖς ἡμέρας ἐγείρομαι. 1 This has a quotation within a quotation. It can be stated as an indirect quotation. Alternate translation: “he said that after three days he will rise again.” or “he said that after three day he would rise again.” (See: [[rc://*/ta/man/translate/figs-quotesinquotes]] and [[rc://*/ta/man/translate/figs-quotations]])
27:64 b8n2 rc://*/ta/man/translate/figs-activepassive κέλευσον & ἀσφαλισθῆναι τὸν τάφον 1 This can be stated in active form. Alternate translation: “command your soldiers to guard the tomb” (See: [[rc://*/ta/man/translate/figs-activepassive]])
27:64 hbh8 rc://*/ta/man/translate/translate-ordinal τῆς τρίτης ἡμέρας 1 (See: [[rc://*/ta/man/translate/translate-ordinal]])
27:64 pwc8 ἐλθόντες οἱ μαθηταὶ αὐτοῦ, κλέψωσιν αὐτὸν 1 “his disciples may come and steal his body”
27:64 t78s rc://*/ta/man/translate/figs-quotesinquotes ἐλθόντες οἱ μαθηταὶ αὐτοῦ & εἴπωσιν τῷ λαῷ, ἠγέρθη ἀπὸ τῶν νεκρῶν; καὶ 1 This has a quotation within a quotation. It can be stated as an indirect quotation. Alternate translation: “his disciples may … tell the people that he has risen from the dead, and” (See: [[rc://*/ta/man/translate/figs-quotesinquotes]] and [[rc://*/ta/man/translate/figs-quotations]])
27:64 c7bf ἀπὸ τῶν νεκρῶν 1 From among all those who have died. This expression describes all dead people together in the underworld. To rise from among them speaks of becoming alive again.
27:64 u5tg rc://*/ta/man/translate/figs-ellipsis καὶ ἔσται ἡ ἐσχάτη πλάνη χείρων τῆς πρώτης 1 The understood information can be stated clearly. Alternate translation: “and if they deceive people by saying that, it will be worse than the way he deceived people before when he said that he was the Christ” (See: [[rc://*/ta/man/translate/figs-ellipsis]])
27:65 dkq9 κουστωδίαν 1 This consisted of four to sixteen Roman soldiers.
27:66 pk1q σφραγίσαντες τὸν λίθον 1 Possible meanings are (1) they put a cord around the stone and attached it to the rock wall on either side of the entrance to the tomb or (2) they put seals between the stone and the wall.
27:66 e8uf μετὰ τῆς κουστωδίας 1 “telling the soldiers to stand where they could keep people from tampering with the tomb”
28:intro psw9 0 # Matthew 28 General Notes\n## Special concepts in this chapter\n\n### The tomb\n\nThe tomb in which Jesus was buried ([Matthew 28:1](../../mat/28/01.md)) was the kind of tomb in which wealthy Jewish families buried their dead. It was an actual room cut into a rock. It had a flat place on one side where they could place the body after they had put oil and spices on it and wrapped it in cloth. Then they would roll a large rock in front of the tomb so no one could see inside or enter.\n\n### “Make disciples”\n\nThe last two verses ([Matthew 28:19-20](./19.md)) are commonly known as “The Great Commission” because they contain a very important command given to all Christians. Christians are to “make disciples” by going to people, sharing the gospel with them and training them to live as Christians.\n\n## Other possible translation difficulties in this chapter\n\n### An angel of the Lord\n\nMatthew, Mark, Luke, and John all wrote about angels in white clothing with the women at Jesus tomb. Two of the authors called them men, but that is only because the angels looked human. Two of the authors wrote about two angels, but the other two authors wrote about only one of them. It is best to translate each of these passages as it appears in the ULT without trying to make the passages all say exactly the same thing. (See: [Matthew 28:1-2](../../mat/28/01.md) and [Mark 16:5](../../mrk/16/05.md) and [Luke 24:4](../../luk/24/04.md) and [John 20:12](../../jhn/20/12.md))
28:1 anr1 0 This begins the account of the resurrection of Jesus from the dead.
28:1 qkn8 ὀψὲ δὲ Σαββάτων, τῇ ἐπιφωσκούσῃ εἰς μίαν σαββάτων 1 “After the Sabbath ended, as the sun came up on Sunday morning”
28:1 gs43 δὲ 1 This word is used here to mark a break in the main story line. Here Matthew starts to tell a new part of the story.
28:1 zu2b ἡ ἄλλη Μαρία 1 “the other woman named Mary.” This is Mary the mother of James and Joseph ([Matthew 27:56](../27/56.md)).
28:2 j25i ἰδοὺ 1 The word “behold” here alerts us to pay attention to the surprising information that follows. Your language may have a way of doing this.
28:2 l4s2 σεισμὸς ἐγένετο μέγας; ἄγγελος γὰρ Κυρίου καταβὰς & ἀπεκύλισε τὸν λίθον 1 Possible meanings are (1) the earthquake happened because the angel came down and rolled away the stone or (2) all these events happened at the same time .
28:2 s43v σεισμὸς 1 a sudden and violent shaking of the ground
28:3 vfh4 ἡ εἰδέα αὐτοῦ 1 “The angels appearance”
28:3 p12y rc://*/ta/man/translate/figs-simile ἦν & ὡς ἀστραπὴ 1 This is a simile that emphasizes how bright in appearance the angel was. Alternate translation: “was bright like lightning” (See: [[rc://*/ta/man/translate/figs-simile]])
28:3 i4hp rc://*/ta/man/translate/figs-simile τὸ ἔνδυμα αὐτοῦ λευκὸν ὡς χιών 1 This is a simile that emphasizes how bright and white the angels clothes were. The verb “was” from the previous phrase can be repeated. Alternate translation: “his clothing was very white, like snow” (See: [[rc://*/ta/man/translate/figs-simile]] and [[rc://*/ta/man/translate/figs-ellipsis]])
28:4 b1ic rc://*/ta/man/translate/figs-simile ἐγενήθησαν ὡς νεκροί 1 This is a simile that means the soldiers fell down and did not move. Alternate translation: “fell to the ground and lay there like dead men” (See: [[rc://*/ta/man/translate/figs-simile]])
28:5 q8dd ταῖς γυναιξίν 1 “Mary Magdalene and the other woman named Mary”
28:5 tbd8 rc://*/ta/man/translate/figs-activepassive τὸν ἐσταυρωμένον 1 This can be stated in active form. Alternate translation: “whom the people and the soldiers crucified” or “whom they crucified” (See: [[rc://*/ta/man/translate/figs-activepassive]])
28:7 sp2a rc://*/ta/man/translate/figs-quotesinquotes εἴπατε τοῖς μαθηταῖς αὐτοῦ, ὅτι ἠγέρθη ἀπὸ τῶν νεκρῶν; καὶ ἰδοὺ, προάγει ὑμᾶς εἰς τὴν Γαλιλαίαν; ἐκεῖ αὐτὸν ὄψεσθε 1 This is a quotation within a quotation. It can be stated as an indirect quotation. Alternate translation: “tell his disciples that he has risen from the dead and that Jesus has gone ahead of you to Galilee where you will see him.” (See: [[rc://*/ta/man/translate/figs-quotesinquotes]] and [[rc://*/ta/man/translate/figs-quotations]])
28:7 r5cw ἠγέρθη 1 “He has come back to life”
28:7 a1ir ἀπὸ τῶν νεκρῶν 1 From among all those who have died. This expression describes all dead people together in the underworld. To rise from among them speaks of becoming alive again.
28:7 ljb2 rc://*/ta/man/translate/figs-you προάγει ὑμᾶς & αὐτὸν ὄψεσθε 1 Here “you” is plural. It refers to the women and the disciples. (See: [[rc://*/ta/man/translate/figs-you]])
28:7 hf9i rc://*/ta/man/translate/figs-you εἶπον ὑμῖν 1 Here “you” is plural and refers to the women. (See: [[rc://*/ta/man/translate/figs-you]])
28:8 j2sv καὶ ἀπελθοῦσαι 1 “Mary Magdalene and the other woman named Mary”
28:9 s393 ἰδοὺ 1 The word “behold” here alerts us to pay attention to the surprising information that follows. Your language may have a way of doing this.
28:9 n5sz χαίρετε 1 This is an ordinary greeting, much like “Hello” in English.
28:9 nmg1 ἐκράτησαν αὐτοῦ τοὺς πόδας 1 “got down on their knees and held onto his feet”
28:10 etk6 τοῖς ἀδελφοῖς μου 1 This refers to Jesus disciples.
28:11 u1ae 0 This begins the account of the reaction of the Jewish religious leaders when they heard of Jesus resurrection.
28:11 ktu5 δὲ 1 This word is used here to mark a break in the main story line. Here Matthew starts to tell a new part of the story.
28:11 mu4l αὐτῶν 1 Here this refers to Mary Magdalene and the other Mary.
28:11 rnr3 ἰδού 1 This marks the beginning of another event in the larger story. It may involve different people than the previous events. Your language may have a way of doing this.
28:12 ht82 συμβούλιόν τε λαβόντες 1 “decided on a plan among themselves.” The priests and elders decided to give the money to the soldiers.
28:13 kn8i rc://*/ta/man/translate/writing-quotations εἴπατε ὅτι, οἱ μαθηταὶ αὐτοῦ & ἐλθόντες & ἡμῶν κοιμωμένων. 1 If your language does not allow quotations within quotations you may translate this as a single quote. Alternate translation: “Tell others that Jesus disciples came … while you were sleeping” (See: [[rc://*/ta/man/translate/writing-quotations]] and [[rc://*/ta/man/translate/figs-quotations]])
28:14 n8xy καὶ ἐὰν ἀκουσθῇ τοῦτο ἐπὶ τοῦ ἡγεμόνος 1 “If the governor hears that you were asleep when Jesus disciples took his body”
28:14 u13q τοῦ ἡγεμόνος 1 “Pilate” ([Matthew 27:2](../27/02.md))
28:14 x57k ἡμεῖς πείσομεν καὶ ὑμᾶς ἀμερίμνους ποιήσομεν 1 “do not worry. We will talk to him so that he does not punish you.”
28:15 yu3c rc://*/ta/man/translate/figs-activepassive ἐποίησαν ὡς ἐδιδάχθησαν 1 This can be translated in active form. Alternate translation: “did what the priests had told them to do” (See: [[rc://*/ta/man/translate/figs-activepassive]])
28:15 cp7r ὁ λόγος οὗτος παρὰ Ἰουδαίοις μέχρι τῆς σήμερον ἡμέρας 1 “Many Jews heard this report and continue to tell others about it even today”
28:15 vp3a μέχρι τῆς σήμερον ἡμέρας 1 This refers to the time Matthew wrote the book.
28:16 h1ln 0 This begins the account of Jesus meeting with his disciples after his resurrection.
28:17 pze9 προσεκύνησαν, οἱ δὲ ἐδίστασαν 1 Possible meanings are (1) they all worshiped Jesus even though some of them doubted, or (2) some of them worshiped Jesus, but others did not worship him because they doubted.
28:17 xgr5 rc://*/ta/man/translate/figs-explicit οἱ δὲ ἐδίστασαν 1 It can be stated explicitly what the disciples doubted. Alternate translation: “some doubted that he was really Jesus and that he had become alive again” (See: [[rc://*/ta/man/translate/figs-explicit]])
28:18 v37p rc://*/ta/man/translate/figs-activepassive ἐδόθη μοι πᾶσα ἐξουσία 1 This can be stated in active form. Alternate translation: “My Father has given me all authority” (See: [[rc://*/ta/man/translate/figs-activepassive]])
28:18 sm35 rc://*/ta/man/translate/figs-merism ἐν οὐρανῷ καὶ ἐπὶ τῆς γῆς 1 Here “heaven” and “earth” are used together to mean everyone and everything in heaven and earth. (See: [[rc://*/ta/man/translate/figs-merism]])
28:19 yz6q rc://*/ta/man/translate/figs-metonymy πάντα τὰ ἔθνη 1 Here “nations” refers to the people. Alternate translation: “of all the people in every nation” (See: [[rc://*/ta/man/translate/figs-metonymy]])
28:19 l5b5 rc://*/ta/man/translate/figs-metonymy εἰς τὸ ὄνομα 1 Here “name” refers to authority. Alternate translation: “by the authority” (See: [[rc://*/ta/man/translate/figs-metonymy]])
28:19 kwa3 rc://*/ta/man/translate/guidelines-sonofgodprinciples τοῦ Πατρὸς & τοῦ Υἱοῦ 1 These are important titles that describe the relationship between God and Jesus. (See: [[rc://*/ta/man/translate/guidelines-sonofgodprinciples]])
28:20 mz6f ἰδοὺ 1 “Look” or “Listen” or “Pay attention to what I am about to tell you”
28:20 si8z ἕως τῆς συντελείας τοῦ αἰῶνος 1 “until the end of this age” or “until the end of the world”